Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights

Size: px
Start display at page:

Download "Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights"

Transcription

1 0250T Pushbuttons. Toggle Switches E0 Product Description Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications Environmentally Sealed Toggle Switches E0E Product Description Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications V7-T-2 V7-T-4 V7-T-6 V7-T-8 V7-T-9 V7-T-0.3 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled Product Description Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications M22 Modular Pushbuttons mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Product Selection Guide Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Product Selection Guide Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications V7-T-4 V7-T-6 V7-T-28 V7-T-3 V7-T-36 V7-T-04 V7-T-24 V7-T-26 V7-T mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Product Description Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications V7-T-49 V7-T-5 V7-T mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Product Description Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications V7-T-67 V7-T-72 V7-T mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Product Description Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications V7-T-240 V7-T-246 V7-T mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Product Description Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications V7-T-282 V7-T-284 V7-T mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Product Description Product Selection Technical Data and Specifications Ratings V7-T-307 V7-T-30 V7-T-343 V7-T-346 Learn nline Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-

2 . Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Toggle Switches E0 Toggle Switches E0 Contents Description Toggle Switches E0 Standards and Certifications Selection Product Selection Toggle Switches Hesitation Switches Pushbuttons Accessories Technical Data and Specifications Circuit Diagrams Dimensions Page V7-T-3 V7-T-3 V7-T-4 V7-T-5 V7-T-5 V7-T-5 V7-T-6 V7-T-6 V7-T-7 Product Description The E0 switches from Eaton s electrical sector are intended for general purpose light industrial use. Designed for retrofit and EM applications. Features General Purpose Toggles Various circuit functions include maintained and momentary Poles include from singlepole single-throw to fourpole double-throw Spade, screw, and solder terminations available Numerous ratings Short /32 in and tall 5/32 in bat lever available Standard 5/32 32 thd. Hardware furnished assembled Heavy-Duty Hesitation Switches ne-hole panel mount Three position switch offers unique positive center stop feature to assure lever cannot be thrown from one side through the center FF position without stopping Design feature is a major acceptance for motor reversing and speed control applications Prevents motor damage resulting from high current generation by counter EMF of the armature at the time of reversing Known as anti-plugging, hesitation, positive stop or positive off switch Non-Illuminated AC Rated Pushbuttons ne-hole panel mount Medium-duty Spade and screw terminations available Various bushing lengths and button extensions Numerous ampere ratings with horsepower ratings V7-T-2 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

3 Toggle Switches E0. Standards and Certifications UL Recognized CSA File No. LR40068 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Toggle Switches E0 Series Not to be used for ordering purposes Series Lever Length T = in (4.3 mm) lever E = in (7.5 mm) lever E0 T 06 A S = E0T06AS Poles = Single-pole 2 = Two-pole 3 = Three-pole 4 = Four-pole Ratings 25V 06 = 6 Amperes 5 = 5 Amperes 20 = 20 Amperes Function A = N None FF B = FF None (N) D = N FF N E = N None N F = N FF (N) G = (N) FF (N) H = N None (N) Termination S = Screw L = Solder lug P = Spade Complete Cat. No in (4.3 mm) Single-pole 6 Amperes N None FF Screw terminal Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-3

4 . Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Toggle Switches E0 Product Selection Toggle Switches Single-Pole Two-Pole Three-Pole Four-Pole E0 Series AC Rated Minimum rder Quantity 0 Pieces Function Circuit with Lever In Nominal AC Ratings Poles DWN Amperes hp and UP CENTER Position Screw Terminal 25V 250V 50V Throw Position Position Keyway Note See Circuit Diagrams on Page V7-T in (6.4 mm) Spade Terminal Solder Lug Single-Pole 6 3 P.S.T. N None FF E0T06AS E0T06AP E0T06AL 5 0 3/4 E0T5AS E0T5AP E0T5AL /4 E0E20AS E0E20AP E0E20AL 6 3 P.D.T. N FF N E0T06DS E0T06DP 5 0 3/4 E0T5DS E0T5DP E0T5DL /4 E0E20DS 6 3 P.D.T. N None N E0T06ES 5 0 3/4 E0T5ES E0T5EP E0T5EL /4 E0E20ES 0 /2 P.S.T. FF None (N) E0T5BS E0T5BP P.D.T. N FF (N) E0T5FS E0T5FP P.D.T. N None (N) E0T5HS E0T5HP P.D.T. (N) FF (N) E0T5GS E0T5GP Two-Pole P.S.T. N None FF E0T206AS E0T206AP 5 0 3/4 E0T25AS E0T25AP E0T25AL /4 E0E220AS E0E220AP E0E220AL P.D.T. N FF N E0T206DS E0T206DP 5 0 3/4 E0T25DS E0T25DP E0T25DL /4 E0E220DS E0E220DP P.D.T. N None N E0T206ES 5 0 3/4 E0T25ES E0T25EP E0T25EL /4 E0E220ES 5 0 /2 2 P.S.T. FF None (N) E0T25BS 2 P.D.T. N None (N) E0T25HS E0T25HP 2 P.D.T. (N) FF (N) E0T25GS E0T25GP Three-Pole 5 0 3/4 3 P.S.T. N None FF E0E35AS E0E35AP 3 P.D.T. N FF N E0E35DS E0E35DP E0E35DL 3 P.D.T. N None N E0E35ES E0E35EP E0E35EL Four-Pole 5 0 3/4 4 P.S.T. N None FF E0E45AS E0E45AL 4 P.D.T. N FF N E0E45DS E0E45DL 4 P.D.T. N None N E0E45ES E0E45EL V7-T-4 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

5 Toggle Switches E0. Hesitation Switches Heavy-Duty Hesitation Switch Pushbuttons ne-hole Mounted Medium-Duty, Mom. Contact Accessories E0TA04 E0TA05 E0 Series Special Purpose Minimum rder Quantity 0 Pieces Nominal Ratings Function Circuit with Lever In Amperes hp 28 Vdc 25 Vac 250 Vac 250 Vac peration UP Position CENTER Position DWN Position Keyway Toggle Switches Accessories Minimum rder Quantity 00 Pieces Description Material/Notes Hexagon locknut Zinc-chromate treated steel E0TA0 Knurled face nut Zinc-chromate treated steel E0TA02 Internal tooth lockwasher Cadmium plated steel E0TA03 Terminal screws #6-32 x 3/6 in binding head E0TA20 Spade terminal adapter in (6.4 mm) Assembles to screw terminals E0TA202 N-FF indicating plate vertical orientation Burnished nickel finish steel E0TA30 FF-N indicating plate horizontal orientation Burnished nickel finish steel E0TA302 Flip-up guard for toggle switches E0TA04 Notes Interlock mechanism prevents operation of lever through the center position until pressure is momentarily relieved. Designed for control and protection of reversing motors. See Circuit Diagrams on Page V7-T-6. 2 Rated /4 hp at 25V, /2 hp at 250V. Poles and Throw Screw Terminal /4 Maintained N FF N 2 P.D.T. E0E25SS 3 P.D.T. E0E35SS E0 Series Minimum rder Quantity 0 Pieces Nominal Ratings Amperes hp Bushing Poles Length 25 Vac 250 Vac 25 and in (mm) N NC N NC 250V Throw Contacts Dim. A Button Extension in (mm) Dim. B Typical Maximum perating Force 4 P.D.T. E0E45SS Screw Terminal Spade Terminal in (6.4 mm) 6 3 P.S.T. N 0.69 (7.5) 0.53 (3.5) 0.9 lbs E0P06RS E0P06RP 0.34 (8.6) 0.25 (6.4) E0P06JS 5 0 /3 P.S.T. N 0.69 (7.5) 0.53 (3.5) 0.9 lbs E0P5RS E0P5RP 0.34 (8.6) 0.25 (6.4) E0P5JS /4 2 P.D.T. N, NC 0.69 (7.5) 0.53 (3.5).0 lbs E0P5LS Fixed shroud for toggle switches E0TA05 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-5

6 . Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Toggle Switches E0 Technical Data and Specifications Toggle Switches Description AC ratings DC ratings Electrical life peration Poles/throws Mounting Lever lengths Terminals Hesitation Switches Description Specification peration AC ratings DC ratings Poles/throws Mounting Lever length Terminals Pushbutton Actuators Description Specification AC ratings peration Poles/throws Mounting Button extensions Terminals Circuit Diagrams SPST SPDT Specification 6 20A, 25 Vac 3 0A, 250 Vac Max. 3/4 hp at 250 Vac 6 20A, 28 Vdc 6,000 cycles make/break at switch ampere rating Slow make/slow break mechanism with butt action for AC and low voltage DC applications Maintained and momentary contacts through 4, single and double throw ne hole with threaded in-32 bushing and x in (.7 x 0.9 mm) deep keyway that serves as anti-rotational feature in (4.3 mm) or in (7.5 mm), bright nickel plated Screw, in (6.4 mm) spade and solder lug Slow make/slow break mechanism with butt action for AC and low voltage DC applications; maintained contacts; ideal for reversing motor applications; interlock mechanism prevents operation of lever through center position until manual pressure is momentarily relieved 5A, 25 Vac 0A, 250 Vac Max. 3/4 hp at 250 Vac 5A, 28 Vdc 2, 3 and 4, double throw only Single-pole with threaded in-32 bushing and x in (.7 x.2 mm) deep keyway in (7.4 mm), stainless steel Screw 6 5A, 25 Vac (N) 3 0A, 250 Vac (N) Max. /3 hp at 25/250 Vac Slow make/slow break mechanism Normally open contacts Single, single and double throw ne hole with in-32 threaded bushing and x in (.7 x 0.9 mm) deep keyway Two bushing heights: /6 in (7.5 mm) and /32 in (8.7 mm) 7/32 in (3.5 mm) and /4 in (6.4 mm), bright nickel plated Screw DPST DPDT 3PST 3PDT 4PST 4PDT V7-T-6 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

7 Toggle Switches E0. Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Toggle Switch Dimensions No. of Poles peration Momentary and maintained Toggle Switch Hesitation Switch Pushbutton Actuator Accessories E0TA0 Hexagon Locknut Bushing Length A 0.47 (.9) 2 Maintained 0.47 (.9) Momentary 0.47 (.9) 3 Maintained 0.47 (.9) 4 Maintained 0.47 (.9) 0.63 (6) D E B A C Lever Length B 0.56 (4.2) 0.56 (4.2) 0.56 (4.2) 0.69 (7.5) 0.69 (7.5) 0.08 (2) 0.63 (6) 0.07 (.8) x 0.05 (.3) Keyway E0TA02 Knurled Face Nut Screw Terminals Spade Terminals Solder Lug C D E C D E C D E.00 (25.4).06 (26.9).25 (3.8).27 (32.3).20 (30.5) Thread.47 (37.3).7 (29.7).3 (33.3).3 (33.3).34 (34.0).30 (33.0) 0.63 (6.0) 0.75 (9.) 0.75 (9.).44 (36.6).40 (35.6).3 (28.7).9 (30.2).3 (33.3).37 (34.8).30 (33.0).3 (28.7).3 (33.3).3 (33.3).34 (34.0).34 (34.0) E0TA30 N-FF Indicating Plate Vertical rientation Note Spade terminal adapters are used on 6 ampere and momentary screw terminal switches, adding 0.42 in (0.7 mm) to dimension C..34 (34) 0.07 (.8) 0.69 (7.5) 0.47 (.9).25 (3.8) 0.63 (6) 0.06 (.5) 0.63 (6) Thread 0.63 (6.0) 0.75 (9.) 0.75 (9.).44 (36.6).40 (35.6) 0.04 () x 0.07 (.8) Keyway.3 (28.7) N FF.0 (25.4) B A 0.03 (.8).3 (28.7).00 (25.4).06 (26.9).25 (3.8).23 (3.2).23 (3.2).3 (28.7).3 (33.3).3 (33.3).34 (34.0).34 (34.0) 0.63 (6.0) 0.75 (9.) 0.75 (9.).44 (36.6).44 (36.6) E0TA302 N-FF Indicating Plate Horizontal rientation FF N Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-7

8 .2 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Environmentally Sealed Toggle Switches E0E Toggle Switches E0E Contents Description Environmentally Sealed Toggle Switches E0E Product Selection Molded-In Screw Terminal Econoswitch Switch Guard Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Page V7-T-9 V7-T-9 V7-T-9 V7-T-0 V7-T- Product Description Designed for general purpose and EM applications, this line of toggle switches provides a high IP68 rating for demanding environments. Features Molded-In Screw Terminal Completely sealed against dust, moisture and other contaminants ne-hole mounted bushing for easy installation Multi-circuits offered Two- and three-position with maintained and momentary action Molded-in terminal inserts and terminals numbers Single- and two-pole circuitry Econoswitch Environmentally sealed Single- and two-pole circuitry ne-hole mounting for easy installation Multi-circuits Two- and three-position with maintained and momentary action Three types of termination offered as standard Switch Guard For use with two-position switch Cover closure transfers switch toggle lever to FF position ne-hole mounted mounting style Cover is molded out of red thermoset molding material Guard cover is springloaded to either close or lock in open position Prevents accidental operation at switches ptions Note: Contact your local Eaton Sales Representative for more information. Non-UL Recognized devices Alternate toggle levers Locking toggle levers Rocker buttons Special mounting hardware Mounting hardware furnished assembled Terminal screws furnished assembled Special circuits Panel seal, part number Spade terminal adapters available Standards and Certifications UL File number E5346; Guide card number is WYR2 CSA LR40068, class number 624 UL and CSA Nominal Ratings 25 Vac 250 Vac Amperes E0E8xx 8 9 E0E28xx 8 9 Single-Phase hp E0E8xx /4 /2 E0E28xx /2 Three-Phase hp E0E8xx E0E28xx V7-T-8 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

9 Environmentally Sealed Toggle Switches E0E.2 Product Selection Molded-In Screw Terminal Single-Pole Two-Pole Econoswitch Single-Pole Two-Pole Switch Guard Switch Guard E0E Series Molded-In Screw Terminal Circuit with Lever Position Down Nominal AC Ratings Up Center (Keyway) Amperes Single-Phase hp Three-Phase hp 25V 250V 25V 250V 25/250V Single-Pole 8 9 /4 /2 N FF N E0E8DM N NNE FF E0E8AM N NNE N E0E8EM Two-Pole 8 9 /2 N FF N E0E28DM N NNE FF E0E28AM N NNE N E0E28EM E0E Series Econoswitch Type of peration E0E Series Switch Guard Switch Guard E0TA04 Note Momentary contact. Current Ratings Amperes 28 Vdc 5 Vac, 60 or 400 Hz Lamp Load Resistive Load Inductive Load Lamp Load Resistive Load Inductive Load Circuit with Lever Position Down Up Center (Keyway) Screw Terminal Solder Lug Terminal Spade Terminal Single-Pole Maintained N FF N E0E8DS E0E8DL E0E8DP Maintained N NNE FF E0E8AS E0E8AL E0E8AP Maintained N NNE N E0E8ES E0E8EL E0E8EP Momentary N FF N E0E8GS E0E8GL E0E8GP Momentary FF NNE N E0E8BS E0E8BL E0E8BP Two-Pole Maintained N FF N E0E28DS E0E28DL E0E28DP Maintained N NNE FF E0E28AS E0E28AL E0E28AP Maintained N NNE N E0E28ES E0E28EL E0E28EP Momentary N FF N E0E28GS E0E28GL E0E28GP Momentary FF NNE N E0E28BS E0E28BL E0E28BP Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-9

10 .2 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Environmentally Sealed Toggle Switches E0E Technical Data and Specifications E0E Series Molded-In Screw Terminal Description Watertight seal Thermoset molding materials Temperature range Life Bushings Specification E0E Series Econoswitch Description Specification Watertight seal Type of terminal Life Temperature range Per MIL-STD-08E and designed to meet IP68 Meet flame retardant requirements 50 to 50 F ( 46 to 66 C) 20,000 operations at rated load; 40,000 operations mechanical life; 6,000 operations at hp ratings per UL and CSA requirements 5/32 in-32 thread Per MIL-STD-08E and designed to meet IP68 Screws 6-32 UNC-22A Solder lug 0.25 in (3.7 mm) dia. hole Spade in (6.35 mm) x in (0.8 mm) thick 50,000 operations at rated load; 00,000 operations mechanical life 50 to 50 F ( 46 to 66 C) V7-T-0 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

11 Environmentally Sealed Toggle Switches E0E.2 Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Single-Pole Molded-In Screw Terminal E0E Series (6.0) Dia. 5/32-32 UN-2A Thread to Within (.52) of Shoulder (6.35) (0.97) Toggle Switch Panel Cutout (9.65) Typ..270 (32.26) Max. 5/32 Dia. Bushing (.93) Keyway.8 (29.9) Max. #6-32 Terminal Screw with Internal Tooth Lockwasher (SEMS) (6.3) Max (9.52) 0.30 (3.30) (.57) Locking Ring (2.9) Dia. Hole (.30) Keyway (7.53) (.94) (2.9) Dia. Hole Two-Pole Molded-In Screw Terminal E0E Series (6.0) Dia. 5/32-32 UN-2A Thread to Within (.52) of Shoulder (6.35) 0.30 (3.30) (0.97) (9.65) Typ..340 (34.04) Max (.93) 0.30 (3.30) Keyway (7.53) (.94).00 (27.94) Max (9.65) (23.) Max..370 (34.80) Max. #6-32 Terminal Screw with Internal Tooth Lockwasher (SEMS) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-

12 .2 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Environmentally Sealed Toggle Switches E0E Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Single-Pole Econoswitch E0E Series (6.0) Dia. 5/32-32 UN-2A Thread to Within (.52) of Shoulder #6-32 UNC-2A Terminal Screw, SEMS (0.97) Two-Pole Econoswitch E0E Series (6.0) Dia. 5/32-32 UN-2A Thread to Within (.52) of Shoulder #6-32 UNC-2A Terminal Screw, SEMS (0.97) (3.75) (7.53) (.94).30 (33.0) Max. Keyway (.93).28 (32.5) Max (3.7) Dia. Hole (5.09) Screw Terminal Solder Lug Spade Terminal (33.5) (7.53) (.89).34 (34.) Max (22.6) Keyway (.93).32 (33.5) Max (3.7) Dia. Hole Screw Terminal Solder Lug Spade Terminal.5 (38.4) Max x (6.35) x (0.8) Thick.55 (39.4) Max x (6.35) x (0.8) Thick V7-T-2 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

13 Environmentally Sealed Toggle Switches E0E.2 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Switch Guard (6.0) Dia. 5/32-32 UN-2A Thread to Within (.52) of Shoulder pen Red-Molded Plastic Rivet (9.05) Max. Switch (Ref.) (2.07) Dia..062 (26.97).635 (4.53) Max..830 (46.48) Max (7.48) 0.03 (0.79) (.57).547 (39.29) Rad. Steel (2.34) (.89) (7.48) Max. Closed.093 (27.76) Max (0.8) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-3

14 .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled Pushbutton Control Stations Contents Description Page Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled Features V7-T-5 Product Selection M22 Assembled Control Stations V7-T-6 Commercial Control Stations V7-T-7 General Purpose Control Stations V7-T-8 Special Purpose Control Stations V7-T H Series Heavy-Duty Control Stations V7-T T Series Heavy-Duty 30.5 mm Control Stations V7-T-2 Class I Division T Series Heavy-Duty 30.5 mm Control Stations V7-T-22 Class I Division 2 E34 Series Corrosion Resistant 30.5 mm Control Stations.... V7-T-23 Accessories V7-T-23 Custom Assembled Stations Specification Form V7-T-24 Renewal Parts V7-T-26 Technical Data and Specifications V7-T-28 Dimensions V7-T-28 Product Description M22 Assembled Control Stations M22 series operators Available in horizontal and vertical configurations Impact resistant polycarbonate enclosures ptional yellow covers Base mounting contact blocks and light units for quick wiring and vibration resistance Commercial Control Stations 0250T series operators Full front label Specific function labels on front of enclosure General Purpose Control Stations Construction grade General purpose wall mount Popular with contractors UL (NEMA) Type Special Purpose Control Stations Standard grade Polyester enclosure UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, H Series Heavy-Duty Control Stations 0250H Series operators Dark brown polyester enclosure Protective rubber gaskets provide NEMA 3S rating on pushbuttons Top and bottom 3/4 in NPT conduit entrances Includes alternate legend plates and spare mounting screws 0250T Series Heavy-Duty 30.5 mm Control Stations 0250T Series operators ASA 6 gray die-cast zinc enclosures Surface or flush mounting Single 3/4 in NPT conduit entrance on one and two element stations Single in NPT conduit entrance on three element stations Class I Division T Series Heavy-Duty 30.5 mm Control Stations 0250T Series operators Factory sealed contact blocks Die-cast, polyester or stainless steel enclosures Approved for NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D or Class I Zone 2 Group IIB plus Hydrogen type hazardous locations Class I Division 2 E34 Series Corrosion Resistant 30.5 mm Control Stations E34 Series operators Factory sealed contact blocks Die-cast, polyester or stainless steel enclosures Approved for NEC Class I Division 2 Groups B, C and D or Class I Zone 2 Group IIB plus Hydrogen type hazardous locations V7-T-4 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

15 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled.3 Features M22 Assembled Control Stations IP66, UL (NEMA) Type 4, 3 Impact resistant polycarbonate enclosures ptional yellow cover 25% smaller depth than most competitor enclosures Base mounting contact blocks and light units for faster wiring and vibration resistance Commercial Control Stations ASA 6 gray die-cast zinc enclosures Pre-assembled and labeled for functions such as Fuel Shut-ff Great for commercial applications General Purpose Control Stations Construction grade General purpose wall mount Popular with contractors UL (NEMA) Type Special Purpose Control Stations Standard grade Polyester enclosure UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, H Series Heavy-Duty Control Stations Industrial grade Extra heavy-duty Polyester enclosure Booted buttons utdoor installation UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 3S, 4, 4, 2, T Series Heavy-Duty 30.5 mm Control Stations 30.5 mm operators Industrial grade Zinc die cast enclosure Popular with industrial end users UL (NEMA) Type 4, 4, 2, 3 Class I Division 2 Control Stations Available with 0250T or E mm operators Zinc die cast, polyester or stainless steel enclosures Factory-sealed contact blocks Popular with industrial end users UL (NEMA) Type 4, 4, 2, 3 NEC Class I Division 2 Groups B, C and D Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-5

16 .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled Product Selection M22 Assembled Control Stations ne Element Control Stations rientation Description Color Inscription Two Element Control Stations Element rientation Description Color Inscription Three Element Control Stations Element rientation Description Color Inscription Notes For assembled control stations not found in this selection, please contact the Eaton Technical Resource Center at -877-ETN CARE ( ) or Contact block configuration. Enclosure Cover Color Horizontal 40 mm mushroom head push-pull emergency stop operator Red NC Yellow M22-C-MH Horizontal 40 mm illuminated mushroom head push-pull emergency stop Red N-NC Yellow M22-C-M2H operator, Vac Horizontal 40 mm mushroom head twist-to-release emergency stop operator Red NC Yellow M22-C-M3H Horizontal 40 mm mushroom head key-release emergency stop operator Red NC Yellow M22-C-M4H Horizontal Flush pushbutton Green N Gray M22-C-M5H Horizontal Flush pushbutton Green N START Gray M22-C-M6H Horizontal Extended pushbutton Red NC Gray M22-C-M7H Horizontal Extended pushbutton Red NC STP Gray M22-C-M8H Horizontal Key-operated selector switch, two-position maintained N FF-N Gray M22-C-M9H Horizontal Knob type selector switch, three-position maintained 2N HAND 0 AUT Gray M22-C-M0H Horizontal Double pushbutton Green N START Gray M22-C-MH Red NC STP Element 2 Description Color Inscription Enclosure Cover Color Horizontal Extended pushbutton Red NC Flush pushbutton Green N Gray M22-C2-MH Vertical Flush pushbutton Green N START Extended pushbutton Red NC STP Gray M22-C2-M2V Vertical Flush pushbutton Black N FRWARD Flush pushbutton Black N REVERSE Gray M22-C2-M3V Horizontal Vertical Horizontal Vertical Vertical Vertical Extended pushbutton Indicating light Flush pushbutton Flush pushbutton Flush pushbutton Flush pushbutton Red NC Indicating light White Vac Flush pushbutton Green N Extended pushbutton Black N PEN Extended pushbutton Black N FRWARD Flush pushbutton Black N UP Flush pushbutton Element 2 Description Color Inscription White Vac Flush pushbutton Green N START Extended pushbutton Red NC Flush pushbutton Red NC STP Flush pushbutton Red NC STP Flush pushbutton Red NC STP Flush pushbutton Element 3 Description Color Inscription Enclosure Cover Color Green N Gray M22-C3-MH Red NC STP Gray M22-C3-M2V Green N Gray M22-C3-M3H Black N CLSE Gray M22-C3-M4V Black N REVERSE Gray M22-C3-M5V Black N DWN Gray M22-C3-M6V V7-T-6 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

17 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled.3 Commercial Control Stations Key Specifications 30.5 mm (0250T series) operators ASA 6 gray die-cast zinc enclosures Industrial grade UL Type 4, 4, 2, 3 Single 3/4 in NPT conduit entrance Dimensions in (mm) Enclosure: 3.88 W x 4.00 H x 3.00 D (98.6 x 0.6 x 76.3) perator:.63 D (to enclosure) x.50 diameter (4.4 x 38.) What is included? Eaton s pre-assembled, enclosed emergency stop pushbutton stations include an operator, an enclosure, contact blocks and a variety of unique labels. Each label has white lettering on a red background indicating the function and red lettering on a white background indicating the operator type. Available s Catalog Number perator Additional Contact Blocks (Sold Separately) Circuit Configuration Note Includes N-NC contact block. Enclosure Color Label 0250T5B62-S0 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY STP 0250T5B62-S02 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY SHUT-FF 0250T5B62-S03 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY GENERATR STP 0250T5B62-S04 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY HVAC SHUT-DWN 0250T5B62-S05 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY ELECTRICAL DISCNNECT 0250T5B62-S06 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY BILER SHUT-DWN 0250T5B62-S07 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY CHILLER STP 0250T5B62-S08 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY FUEL SHUT-FF 0250T5B62-S09 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY REFRIGERATIN STP 0250T5B62-S0 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY PWER FF 0250T5B62-S Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY GAS SHUT-FF 0250T5B62-S2 Pushbutton Gray EMERGENCY VENTILATIN SHUT-DWN 0250T5B62-S3 Pushbutton Gray GENERATR 0250T5 0250T T 0250T3 0250T2 NC N N-NC 2NC 2N Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-7

18 .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled General Purpose Control Stations Single Button Station with Padlock Attachment Accessory Selector Switch Two Button Station Three Button Station Three Button Station with Indicating Light Type N Control Stations UL (NEMA) Type Contact Symbol Button Type/Color Legends ne Element Enclosure Type Flush/green START 0250H500 Note Round button. Flush/red STP 0250H50 Extended/red STP 0250H504 Palm operated/black None 0250H89 Three-position selector switch/black knob RUN/FF/AUT 0250H289 Two Element Enclosure Type Flush/red START/STP 0250H5200 Flush/green extended/red START/STP 0250H5207 Flush/black (all) RAISE/LWER 0250H520 FR/REV 0250H5202 PEN/CLSE 0250H5203 UP/DWN 0250H5204 HIGH/LW 0250H5205 FAST/SLW 0250H5208 Three Element Enclosure Type Flush/black (all) FR/REV/STP 0250H5300 UP/DWN/STP 0250H530 RAISE/LWER/STP 0250H5302 PEN/CLSE/STP 0250H5303 FAST/SLW/STP 0250H5304 0/220V neon indicating light START/STP Clear flush/green; flush/red 0250H530 Red flush/green; flush/red 0250ED853 Amber flush/green; flush/red 0250ED853-2 V7-T-8 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

19 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled.3 Selector Switch Two Button Station Mechanically Interlocked Pushbuttons Special Purpose Control Stations 0250H_ 0250H_ Type N Control Stations pen Type Construction (No Cover) Contact Symbol Button Type/Color Legends ne Element Enclosure Type Three-position selector RUN/FF/AUT 0250H2538 switch/black knob Two Element Enclosure Type Flush/green START/STP 0250H2747 Flush/black (all) mech. interlocked Special Purpose Control Stations UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 3 Contact Symbol Feature Legends ne Element Pushbutton Type Flush START 0250H2738 Note No legend on buttons. Specify any standard legend. None STP 0250H H658 With lock hasp STP 0250H665 Two Element Pushbutton Type Flush START/STP 0250H364 With lock hasp START/STP 0250H67 Buttons interlocked FAST/SLW 0250ED664 FR/REV 0250H2740 UP/DWN 0250H274 PEN/CLSE 0250H2742 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-9

20 .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled 0250H Series Heavy-Duty Control Stations 0250H_ 0250H_ 0250H_ Type H Control Stations UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3S, 4, 4, 2, 3 Assembled Legend Element Type Feature Circuit Plate Unassembled Alternate Legend Plate ne Element Pushbuttons Without padlock hasp N-NC JG START 0250H88 STP RUN With padlock hasp NC STP 0250H4239 Knob selector Two-position N-NC FF/N 0250H4526 switch Three-position N-NC MAN/FF/AUT 0250H4527 Two Element Pushbuttons Standard N-2NC START/STP 0250H884 2N-2NC RAISE/LWER FRWARD 0250H885 REVERSE PEN CLSE Standard and N-2NC START/STP 0250H4240 standard with padlock hasp Three Element Pushbuttons Standard 2N-3NC FR/REV/STP START PEN 0250H890 Two standard and JG CLSE 0250H424 standard with padlock hasp RAISE FAST LWER SLW Indicating light and pushbuttons 20V Light-red lens and two plain N-2NC MTR RUNNING START/STP 0250H93 V7-T-20 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

21 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled T Series Heavy-Duty 30.5 mm Control Stations Break Glass Station ne Element Two Element Three Element Break Glass perator 6 Complete Assembled Stations UL (NEMA) Type 4, 4, 2, 3 Element Type Features Contact Block(s) Legend Surface Mounting Flush Mounting 2 Break Glass Station Break glass station 3 Gray enclosure NC (logic level) EMERG. FF 0250TGS Red enclosure 0250TGR ne Element Pushbutton Standard N-NC START 0250T T3573 NC STP 0250T T3575 N-NC None 0250T T3597 Mushroom head N-NC START 0250T T3574 NC STP 0250T T3576 With lock hasp 4 NC STP 0250T T3577 Selector switch Two-position N-NC FF/N 0250T T3580 black knob Three-position 2N MAN/FF/AUT 0250T T358 black knob Push-pull Momentary 2NC START/STP 0250T T3602 three-position red button Two Element Pushbuttons Standard N-2NC START/STP 0250T T3582 2N-2NC RAISE/LWER 0250T T3673 2N-2NC None 0250T T3598 With lock hasp 4 N-2NC START/STP 0250T T3599 Standard and mushroom head N-2NC START/STP 0250T T3583 Standard with N-NC START/STP 0250T T3585 maintained contact 5 Plus NC Three Element Pushbuttons Standard 2N-3NC FR, REV, STP 0250T T3589 2N-3NC UP, DWN, STP 0250T365 2N-3NC PEN, CLSE, STP 0250T364 2N-3NC None, None, STP 0250T T3600 Two standard and with lock hasp 2N-3NC None, None, STP 0250T T360 Indicating light Red lens 20V N-2NC MTR RUN, 0250T T3593 (transformer type) Red lens 240V START/STP and pushbuttons 0250T T3594 Red lens 480V 0250T T3595 Red lens 600V 0250T T3596 Break Glass Kit Description perator with hammer and five glass discs Glass discs only (5) Notes 0250TBG 0250TGL Stop buttons are red all others are black. 2 NEMA 4 3, if properly mounted on a flat surface. Consists of front plate, legend, operator and contact blocks. 3 Break glass stations will not function with Normally pen contact blocks. 4 Lock is 0250TA2. 5 Uses deep cover instead of shallow cover. Switch component is 0250TA67 mechanically interlocked operators. 6 Shown assembled to contact block (contact block supplied separately). Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-2

22 .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled Class I Division T Series Heavy-Duty 30.5 mm Control Stations 0250T T7023P 0250T7033S Complete Assembled Stations UL (NEMA) Type 4, 4, 2, 3; NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Contact Symbol Single Pushbutton N NC Two Pushbuttons N NC Each Button Button Type/Color Legend Marking Die Cast Enclosure Polyester Molded Enclosure Stainless Steel Enclosure Flush/green START 0250T T7003P 0250T7003S Extended/red STP 0250T T7005P 0250T7005S Alum. jumbo EMER. STP 0250T T7007P 0250T7007S mushroom/red (engraved button) Flush/black No legend 0250T T7009P 0250T7009S Flush/green START 0250T T7023P 0250T7023S Extended/red STP Flush/black No legend 0250T T7025P 0250T7025S Flush/black No legend Single Pilot Light Two Pushbuttons 20 Vac red No legend 0250T T7033P 0250T7033S N Flush/green START NC Extended/red STP Each Button 20 Vac red No legend 0250T T7035P 0250T7035S Flush/black Flush/black Three-Position Selector Switch 2N Maintained knob/black 2NC Maintained knob/black Single Pushbutton Maintained Push-pull with jumbo mushroom/red Pull Push N NC HAND/FF/AUT 0250T T70P 0250T70S No legend 0250T T703P 0250T703S EMER. STP (engraved button) 0250T T709P 0250T709S V7-T-22 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

23 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled.3 Class I Division 2 E34 Series Corrosion Resistant 30.5 mm Control Stations E34E_ Accessories Padlock Attachment Complete Assembled Stations UL (NEMA) Type 4, 4, 2, 3; NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Contact Symbol Single Pushbutton N NC Two Pushbuttons N NC Each Button Button Type/Color Three-Position Selector Switch 2N Maintained knob/black 2NC Maintained knob/black Single Pushbutton Maintained Push-pull with jumbo mushroom/red Pull Push N NC Type N Control Stations Description Padlock attachment For field assembly on square button type (except extended button types) Legend Marking Note Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Page V7-T-22. Die Cast Enclosure Polyester Molded Enclosure Stainless Steel Enclosure Flush/green START E34E7003 E34E7003P E34E7003S Extended/red STP E34E7005 E34E7005P E34E7005S Alum. jumbo EMER. STP E34E7007 E34E7007P E34E7007S mushroom/red (engraved button) Flush/black No legend E34E7009 E34E7009P E34E7009S Flush/green START E34E7023 E34E7023P E34E7023S Extended/red STP Flush/black No legend E34E7025 E34E7025P E34E7025S Flush/black No legend HAND/FF/AUT E34E70 E34E70P E34E70S No legend E34E703 E34E703P E34E703S EMER. STP (engraved button) E34E709 E34E709P E34E709S 0250H50 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-23

24 .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled Custom Assembled Stations Specification Form rdering Instructions Step Copy this ordering guide from catalog. Step 2 Specify 0250T or E34 pushbutton lines in the corresponding box on the following page. 0250T Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239 E34 Pages V7-T-240 to V7-T T and Pages E34 V7-T-307 to V7-T-347 Class I Div. 2 Step 3 Check back of panel dimensions specify single or double depth enclosure in the corresponding box on the following page. Step 4 Specify enclosure catalog number and price in the corresponding box on the following page. Enclosures can be found on Pages V7-T-0, V7-T-29 and V7-T-269. For pricing, reference the most recent PAD or VISTA-line. Step 5 Specify catalog numbers for desired operator, legend plate, light unit, accessory and contact block(s) for each location in the enclosure in the corresponding box on the following page. (See position locations on this page.) Position Position Position 2 Position Position 2 Position 3 Position Position 2 Position 3 Position 4 Position Locations Step 6 For non-standard legends, specify legend desired, letter size and location on the layout sketches on the following page. For limitations see Page V7-T-28. For pricing, use the blank legend catalog number and STAMP Suffix (Ex.: 0250TS36STAMP) and reference the most recent PAD or VISTA-line. Example: 0250TS36 Special Legend for Position # LETTER SIZE 3/32 in /8 in 3/6 in Step 7 Fax Sheet 2 of this form to Eaton s TRC, Technical Resource Center, at to the attention of Custom Stations rder or to TRC@eaton.com. Within a few days you will receive a confirmation fax with the custom station part number and price. Step 8 Place your order over the VISTA System. For Selector and Roto-Push perators 0250T or E34 For single contact blocks or N-NC contact blocks, the mounting position of contacts must be specified. For example: If a N-NC contact block is required, specify if N is to be mounted in Top A position or Bottom B position. V7-T-24 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

25 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled.3 To Step 2) 0250T STD Class I Division 2 E34 STD Class I Division 2 Step 5) Position Position Eaton s TRC, Custom Station rder (828) FA, or to TRC@eaton.com From Customer Name Customer Contact Phone Number Fax Number Address perator Legend Plate Price U.S. $ Light Unit Price U.S. $ Step 3) Single Depth Enclosure Double Depth Enclosure Contact Block Part Number Product Code Suffix Date Engineer Price U.S. $ A/L B/R Contact Block FACTRY USE NLY Step 4) Enclosure Price U.S. $ A/L B/R 0% Adder for Assembled Stations Step 6) Non-standard Legends Special Legend for Position # Special Legend for Position # Special Legend for Position # LETTER SIZE 3/32 inch (2.4 mm) /8 inch (3.2 mm) 3/6 inch (4.8 mm) Price U.S. $ Lens or Caps LETTER SIZE 3/32 inch (2.4 mm) /8 inch (3.2 mm) 3/6 inch (4.8 mm) Price U.S. $ Accessory Price U.S. $ LETTER SIZE 3/32 inch (2.4 mm) /8 inch (3.2 mm) 3/6 inch (4.8 mm) Total Price Total: Price Total Price Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-25

26 .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled Renewal Parts Type N Renewal Parts Assembled Stations Type N Item No. Description No. Req. Part Number Type N Square Buttons Cover Two element ne element top button ne element bottom button Cover screw Pushbutton support bracket Pushbutton support bracket screw Pushbutton spring Disc (when used two element assembly) Pushbutton top position START/green RAISE/black FRWARD/black PEN/black UP/blank Blank/green Pushbutton bottom position STP/red Extended STP/red REVERSE/black CLSE/black DWN/black LWER/black Blank/red Item No. Description No. Req. Part Number Type N Square Buttons, continued 9 Pushbutton element N-NC N N NC Cover Pushbutton support bracket Pushbutton top position FRWARD/black UP/black RAISE/black PEN/black FAST/black Pushbutton middle position REVERSE/black DWN/black LWER/black CLSE/black SLW/black Pushbutton bottom position STP/red Pushbutton element 2N-3NC Cover V7-T-26 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

27 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled.3 Assembled Stations Type N, continued Item No. Description Type H Renewal Parts Assembled Stations Type H Item No. Description No. Req. Part Number Type N Square Buttons, continued 7 Lens Clear Red Amber Shield Shield screws Lamp (neon NE48) Lamp receptacle Lamp receptacle screw 9-330F 23 Pilot light terminal base Lens Clear Red Amber Pushbutton support bracket Pushbutton element N-NC Pushbutton Type H Assembled Stations No. Req. 7 Part Number Screw Screw Base Contact blocks See Page V7-T T operator See Pages V7-T-74 to V7-T-2 6 Mounting plate Item No. Description No. Req. Part Number Type N Round Buttons Similar to 27 Pushbutton assembly and element for: 0250H H H H H H H H H H Indicating Light Selector Switch Item No. Description Type H Assembled Stations No. Req. 7 2 Part Number 7 Screw Diaphragm Mounting plate Gasket Base Mounting plate Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-27

28 .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled Technical Data and Specifications Ratings Maximum Ampere Ratings for Type N Control Stations Maximum Ampere Ratings for Type H Control Stations Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Type N Control Stations Special Purpose Control Stations Note 2.38 (60.5) for neon indicating light. Volts AC Volts DC Description Make and emergency interrupt capacity Normal load break Continuous current Volts AC 50/60 Hz Volts DC Description Make and emergency interrupt capacity Normal load break Continuous amperes Voltamperes Make and emergency interrupt capacity Normal load break (38.) 2.25 (57.2) 4.00 (0.6) 3.25 (82.6) a 2.25 (57.2) Single Button Station 2.25 (57.2) 3.3 (79.5) 5.50 (39.7) 6.25 (58.8).50 (38.) 2.25 (57.2) 0.75 (9.) Pipe Tap Ship Wt. 2.5 Lb (. kg) 4.00 (0.6) 3.25 (82.6) Two Button Station 3.38 (85.9) a 2.25 (57.2).50 (38.) 2.25 (57.2) 6.00 (52.4) 5.00 (27.0) Three Button Station a 2.25 (57.2) V7-T-28 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

29 Pushbutton Control Stations Assembled.3 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Type H Control Stations NEMA Type 3, 3R, 3S, 4, 4, 3 No. of Dimensions Elements Wide High Deep and (4.3) 8.25 (209.6) 4.50 (4.3) (4.3) 0.75 (273.) 4.25 (08.0) 0250T and E34 Approximate Enclosure Dimensions Surface Mounting Dimensions in In (mm) Number of Wide High Deep Mounting Elements A B C D E Cast 3.88 (98.6) (98.6) (98.6) (98.6) Polyester 3.8 (96.8) (96.8) (96.8) (96.8) Stainless Steel 3.00 (76.2) (88.9) (88.9) (88.9) 4.0 (0.6) 5.88 (49.4) 7.75 (96.9) 9.63 (244.6) 6.63 (68.4) 6.63 (68.4) 8.88 (225.6) 6.63 (68.4) 3.50 (88.9) 6.75 (7.5) 9.00 (228.6).25 (285.8) 3.0 (76.3) 3.0 (76.3) 3.0 (76.3) 3.0 (76.3) 3.38 (85.9) 3.38 (85.9) 3.38 (85.9) 3.38 (85.9) 3.00 (76.2) 3.00 (76.2) 3.00 (76.2) 3.00 (76.2) 2.69 (68.3) 2.69 (68.3) 2.69 (68.3) 2.69 (68.3) 2.94 (74.7) 2.94 (74.7) 2.94 (74.7) 2.94 (74.7).50 (38.).50 (38.).50 (38.).50 (38.) Note No conduit entrance holes provided. Drill as required (82.6) 5.3 (30.3) 7.0 (77.8) 8.88 (225.6) 4.88 (24.0) 4.88 (24.0) 7.3 (8.) 4.88 (24.0) 4.25 (08.0) 7.50 (90.5) 9.00 (228.6) 2.00 (304.8) Conduit Entrance 3/4 3/4 4 Mtg. Holes 0-32 Screw Size for 4 Element Die Cast/ Stainless Steel Enclosure 7/32 Screw Size for Polyester D A E B Surface C Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-29

30 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Contents Description 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Product Selection Guide Accessories Coding Adapter Guide Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Symbols Library Drawings nline Product Description Eaton s M22 industrial heavyduty pushbutton line offers a wide array of functional, attractive and ergonomically designed illuminated and nonilluminated pushbuttons, selector switches, push-pulls, alternate action and twist-torelease operators. The complete illuminated line is only offered in LED light units to ensure high-quality brightness and up to 00,000 hours of LED illumination. M22 operators are available with either a silver or a black colored bezel. The spacesaving modular construction of the M22 line makes onthe-job assembly fast and simplifies the stocking of both components and complete devices. Highly Modular and Versatile Line Field convertible functions (pushbuttons and selector switches), maintained to momentary Customizable laser engraving capabilities LED Indicators 00,000 hours of life in high-vibration environments Lenses specifically designed for LED illumination Rugged Design Most pushbutton operators and contact blocks exceed 5 million mechanical operations All components have IP66 rating, and some carry IP67 and IP69K for washdown environment; see Page V7-T-04 for further technical data Innovative Technologies ASi communicating devices Palm switches Standards and Certifications All operators and components are IEC/EN VDE All operators carry an IP66 rating with some rated for washdown environment with IP67 and IP69K. Page V7-T-3 V7-T-96 V7-T-03 V7-T-04 V7-T-08 V7-T-4 All pushbuttons, emergencystops, indicating lights, potentiometers and selector switches carry NEMA 4, 3. Marine classification societies: Bureau Veritas (BV), Germanischer Lloyd (GL), and Lloyd s Register of Shipping (LR) approved. V7-T-30 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

31 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Features Field convertible pushbuttons and mushroom operators from maintained to momentary status Field convertible selector switches from momentary to maintained operation and vice versa LED offering only for all illuminated operators Laser engraved pushbuttons, lenses and enclosures Heavy-duty construction with a minimum of IP66 and UL NEMA type 4 / 3 on front of panel operators. Many operators even carry IP67 and IP69K, for the toughest applications Product Selection Guide Pushbuttons Silver or black colored nylon bezels Snap-lock contact blocks and light units for front or base mounting Notched hole mounting with anti-rotation tab and central nut mounting on each operator ver 5 million mechanical operations and.6 million electrical (reference specification sheet) Direct opening action normally closed contacts Unique and innovative offerings, such as four-way pushbuttons and USB/ RJ45 bulkhead interfaces Screw or spring-cage terminals Benefits Modular construction makes assembly fast and simplifies stocking of components and complete devices Field convertibility of operator status for pushbuttons and selector switches helps distributors and customers reduce inventory and increase functionality LED offering only for improved brightness quality and up to 00,000 hours of operation Plastic construction is corrosion resistant. perators are designed for rugged environments, ideal for washdown applications (reference each operator s IP ratings and IEC/EN for ingress protection definition) Description Non-illuminated, flush Non-illuminated, extended Illuminated, flush Illuminated, extended Anti-rotation tab saves installation time and prevents operator rotation High mechanical and electrical life allows for use in tough and challenging applications Laser inscription capabilities allow for highquality, wear-resistant markings All normally closed (NC) contacts are direct opening action, i.e., NC contacts are physically forced open by direct linkage with the pushbutton operator in the unlikely event of contact weld Some M22 operators are capable of communication via ASi protocol M22 offers USB and RJ45 connections perator Momentary Maintained Momentary Maintained Momentary Maintained Momentary Maintained Product Selection Indicating Lights Pages V7-T-36 to V7-T-38 Pages V7-T-39, V7-T-40 Description Flat Conical Product Selection Pages V7-T-55, V7-T-56 Pages V7-T-4, V7-T-42 Pages V7-T-55, V7-T-56 Pages V7-T-43, V7-T-44 Pages V7-T-46 to V7-T-48 Pages V7-T-49, V7-T-50 Pages V7-T-5, V7-T-52 Pages V7-T-53, V7-T-54 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-3

32 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Emergency Stops Description Non-illuminated Illuminated Key release Mechanical indication Product Selection Selector Switches Description Product Selection Mushroom Head Pushbuttons Double Pushbuttons Pages V7-T-57 to V7-T-60 Non-illuminated knob type Pages V7-T-63, V7-T-64 Pages V7-T-57 to V7-T-60 Non-illuminated rotary type Pages V7-T-65, V7-T-66 Description Non-illuminated Non-illuminated perator Momentary Maintained Product Selection Description Pages V7-T-79, V7-T-80 Extended pushbuttons and center light Pages V7-T-8, V7-T-82 Flush top and center light, extended bottom perator Momentary Momentary Pages V7-T-57 to V7-T-60 Illuminated Pages V7-T-68 to V7-T-70 Flush pushbuttons and center light Product Selection Page V7-T-84 Page V7-T-85 Page V7-T-85 Pages V7-T-57 to V7-T-60 Key-operated Pages V7-T-7 to V7-T-76 V7-T-32 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

33 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Four-Way Pushbuttons Description Non-interlocked Interlocked perator Momentary Maintained Product Selection Page V7-T-88 Page V7-T-88 Joysticks Description Joysticks Product Selection Page V7-T-89 Potentiometers Description Potentiometers Product Selection Page V7-T-9 Acoustic Devices Description Acoustic devices Product Selection Page V7-T-9 Through-the-Door perators Description Through-the-door operators Product Selection Page V7-T-92 Bulkhead Interfaces Description Bulkhead interfaces Product Selection Page V7-T-92 ASi Adapter Modules Description ASi adapter modules Product Selection Page V7-T-93 Palm Switches Description Palm switches Product Selection Page V7-T-94 Assembled Control Stations Description Assembled control stations Product Selection Page V7-T-6 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-33

34 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 M22-_ Point-of-Purchase Units Color Type Note All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. Contact Configuration Black Flush momentary N/NC M22-D-S-K-P Red Extended momentary N/NC M22-DH-R-K-P Green Flush momentary N/NC M22-D-G-K-P Red Ext. illuminated (2 30V) momentary N/NC M22-DLH-R-K-R-P Red Ext. illuminated (85 264V) momentary N/NC M22-DLH-R-K-230R-P White Flush illuminated (2 30V) maintained N/NC M22-DRL-W-K-W-P White Flush illuminated (85 264V) maintained N/NC M22-DRL-W-K-230W-P Red Indicating light (2 30V) M22-L-R-R-P Green Indicating light (2 30V) M22-L-G-G-P Red Indicting light (85 264V) M22-L-R-230R-P Green Indicating light ( Vac) M22-L-G-230G-P Red Twist-to-release E-stop N/2NC M22-PVT-K2-P Red Illuminated (2 30V) push-pull E-stop N/2NC M22-PVL-K2-R-P Red Illuminated (85 264V) push-pull E-stop N/2NC M22-PVL-K2-230R-P Two-position maintained V selector switch N/NC M22-WKV-K-P Three-position momentary selector switch N/NC M22-WK3-K22-P V7-T-34 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

35 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Contents Description Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Non-Illuminated, Flush, Momentary Non-Illuminated, Flush, Maintained Non-Illuminated, Extended, Momentary..... Non-Illuminated, Extended, Maintained Illuminated, Flush, Momentary Illuminated, Flush, Maintained Illuminated, Extended, Momentary Illuminated, Extended, Maintained Page V7-T-36 V7-T-39 V7-T-4 V7-T-43 V7-T-46 V7-T-49 V7-T-5 V7-T-53 Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Product Description Features Eaton s M22 pushbutton Field convertible from line is a complete, modular maintained to momentary and versatile offering. From (available on maintained field-convertible maintained pushbuttons only) operators to customizable Customizable laser laser engraved buttons, the engraving on all buttons M22 pushbutton line provides LED offering only for endless opportunity for improved brightness flexibility and reduced quality and up to 00,000 inventory. Each operator hours of operation type provides options for ordering as complete or More than five million component parts allowing mechanical operations on for a perfect fit for each momentary and million application. All of this on maintained pushbuttons flexibility comes in a very rugged design. Modular construction makes assembly fast and simplifies stocking of components and complete devices Capable of communicating via ASi protocol with ASi adapter modules Protection Type IP67, IP69K NEMA 4, 3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-35

36 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons Product Selection Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Momentary M22-D-G-K0 M22S-D-G-K0 Bezel M22 = Silver M22S = Black perator Type D = Flush momentary DH = Extended momentary DG = Flush with guard DR = Flush maintained DGH = Extended momentary with guard DRH = Extended maintained Silver bezel only. Complete Devices Contact Block Bezel Button Color Configuration Silver Black N M22-D-S-K0 NC M22-D-S-K0 2N M22-D-S-K20 2NC M22-D-S-K02 N-NC M22-D-S-K Red N M22-D-R-K0 NC M22-D-R-K0 2N M22-D-R-K20 2NC M22-D-R-K02 N-NC M22-D-R-K Green N M22-D-G-K0 NC M22-D-G-K0 2N M22-D-G-K20 2NC M22-D-G-K02 N-NC M22-D-G-K Black Black N M22S-D-S-K0 NC M22S-D-S-K0 2N M22S-D-S-K20 2NC M22S-D-S-K02 N-NC M22S-D-S-K Red N M22S-D-R-K0 NC M22S-D-R-K0 2N M22S-D-R-K20 2NC M22S-D-R-K02 N-NC M22S-D-R-K Green N M22S-D-G-K0 NC M22S-D-G-K0 2N M22S-D-G-K20 2NC M22S-D-G-K02 N-NC M22S-D-G-K Note All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. M22 D S 0 K0 Button Plate Color G = Green Y = Yellow B = Blue S = Black R = Red W = White Inscription GB0 = STP GB = START GB2 = CLSE GB3 = UP GB4 = DWN GB5 = FF GB6 = N GB4 = RESET GB5 = FRWARD GB6 = REVERSE 0 = = 4 = 5 = 6 = 7 = 8 = K0 = N K0 = NC K20 = 2N K02 = 2NC K = N-NC Contact Blocks K30 = 3N K03 = 3NC K2 = 2N-NC K2 = N-2NC V7-T-36 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

37 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Momentary M22-D-G M22S-D-G M22-DG-G perators nly Bezel Button Color Inscription Silver Black M22-D-S Red M22-D-R STP M22-D-R-GB0 M22-D-R-0 Green M22-D-G START M22-D-G-GB M22-D-G- White M22-D-W Blue M22-D-B Yellow M22-D-Y M22-D--SRG 2 M22-D--SWRGYB 3 Black Black M22S-D-S Red M22S-D-R STP M22S-D-R-GB0 M22S-D-R-0 Green M22S-D-G START M22S-D-G-GB M22S-D-G- White M22S-D-W Blue M22S-D-B Yellow M22S-D-Y M22S-D--SRG 2 M22S-D--SWRGYB 3 Silver guarded Black M22-DG-S Red M22-DG-R Green M22-DG-G White M22-DG-W Blue M22-DG-B Yellow M22-DG-Y M22-DG--SRG 2 M22-DG--SWRGYB 3 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 Buttonless operator comes with three color buttons (black, red, green). 3 Buttonless operator comes with all six color buttons (black, white, red, green, yellow, blue). Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-37

38 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Momentary Components M22-D-G max. 5mm thickness Button Plates Color Inscription Black M22-D-S 2 Custom M22-D-S-ETCH 3 STP M22-D-S-GB0 START M22-D-S-GB CLSE M22-D-S-GB2 UP M22-D-S-GB3 DWN M22-D-S-GB4 FF M22-D-S-GB5 N M22-D-S-GB6 TEST M22-D-S-GB9 FRWARD M22-D-S-GB5 REVERSE M22-D-S-GB6 RAISE M22-D-S-GB7 LWER M22-D-S-GB8 M22-D-S-0 M22-D-S- M22-D-S-2 M22-D-S-4 M22-D-S-5 M22-D-S-7 Red M22-D-R 2 Custom M22-D-R-ETCH 3 STP M22-D-R-GB0 FF M22-D-R-GB5 M22-D-R-0 Green M22-D-G 2 Custom M22-D-G-ETCH 3 START M22-D-G-GB N M22-D-G-GB6 M22-D-G- Blue M22-D-B 2 Custom M22-D-B-ETCH 3 RESET M22-D-B-GB4 M22-D-B-6 White M22-D-W 2 Custom M22-D-W-ETCH 3 START M22-D-W-GB M22-D-W- Yellow M22-D-Y 2 Custom M22-D-Y-ETCH 3 Black, red, green M22-D-SRG Black, white, red, green, yellow, blue M22-D-SWRGYB Note: Included with operator. M22-D- M22S-D- M22-DG- M22-K0 Buttonless perator Bezel 4 Silver Black Silver guarded Contact Blocks Terminal Type M22-D- Contact Configuration 5 M22S-D- M22-DG- Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes For complete listing of available button plates and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 Minimum order quantity of (0). 3 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-D-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 4 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 5 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-38 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

39 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Maintained M22-DR-S M22S-DR-S perators nly 2 Bezel Button Color Silver Black M22-DR-S Red M22-DR-R Green M22-DR-G White M22-DR-W Blue M22-DR-B Yellow M22-DR-Y 3 M22-DR--SRG 4 M22-DR--SWRGYB Black Black M22S-DR-S Red M22S-DR-R Green M22S-DR-G White M22S-DR-W Blue M22S-DR-B Yellow M22S-DR-Y 3 M22S-DR--SRG 4 M22S-DR--SWRGYB Notes Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 2 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 3 Buttonless operator comes with three color buttons (black, red, green). 4 Buttonless operator comes with all six color buttons (black, white, red, green, yellow, blue). Note: This pilot device features a selectable function switch that enables the device to be set to either maintained or momentary operation. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-39

40 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Maintained Components M22-D-S max. 5mm thickness Button Plates 2 Color Inscription Black M22-D-S 3 Custom M22-D-S-ETCH 4 STP M22-D-S-GB0 START M22-D-S-GB CLSE M22-D-S-GB2 UP M22-D-S-GB3 DWN M22-D-S-GB4 FF M22-D-S-GB5 N M22-D-S-GB6 TEST M22-D-S-GB9 FRWARD M22-D-S-GB5 REVERSE M22-D-S-GB6 RAISE M22-D-S-GB7 LWER M22-D-S-GB8 M22-D-S-0 M22-D-S- M22-D-S-2 M22-D-S-4 M22-D-S-5 M22-D-S-7 Red M22-D-R 3 Custom M22-D-R-ETCH 4 STP M22-D-R-GB0 FF M22-D-R-GB5 M22-D-R-0 Green M22-D-G 3 Custom M22-D-G-ETCH 4 START M22-D-G-GB N M22-D-G-GB6 M22-D-G- Blue M22-D-B 3 Custom M22-D-B-ETCH 4 RESET M22-D-B-GB4 M22-D-B-6 White M22-D-W 3 Custom M22-D-W-ETCH 4 START M22-D-W-GB M22-D-W- Yellow M22-D-Y 3 Custom M22-D-Y-ETCH 4 Black, red, green M22-D-SRG Black, white, red, green, yellow, blue M22-D-SWRGYB Note: Included with operator. M22-DR- M22S-DR- M22-K0 Buttonless perator Bezel 5 Silver Black Contact Blocks 2 Terminal Type Contact Configuration 6 M22-DR- M22S-DR- Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 2 For complete listing of available button plates and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 3 Minimum order quantity of (0). 4 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-D-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 5 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 6 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-40 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

41 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Momentary Complete Devices M22-DH-R-K0 M22S-DH-R-K0 M22-DGH-R-K0 M22-DH-R M22S-DH-R M22-DGH-R Bezel Button Color Contact Block Configuration perators nly 2 Bezel Button Color Inscription Notes All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. 2 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 3 Buttonless operator comes with three color buttons (black, red, green). 4 Buttonless operator comes with all six color buttons (black, white, red, green, yellow, blue). Silver Red N M22-DH-R-K0 NC M22-DH-R-K0 2N M22-DH-R-K20 2NC M22-DH-R-K02 N-NC M22-DH-R-K Black Red N M22S-DH-R-K0 NC M22S-DH-R-K0 2N M22S-DH-R-K20 2NC M22S-DH-R-K02 N-NC M22S-DH-R-K Silver guarded Red N M22-DGH-R-K0 NC M22-DGH-R-K0 2N M22-DGH-R-K20 2NC M22-DGH-R-K02 N-NC M22-DGH-R-K Silver Black M22-DH-S Red M22-DH-R STP M22-DH-R-GB0 M22-DH-R-0 Green M22-DH-G White M22-DH-W Blue M22-DH-B Yellow M22-DH-Y 3 M22-DH--SRG 4 M22-DH--SWRGYB Black Black M22S-DH-S Red M22S-DH-R STP M22S-DH-R-GB0 M22S-DH-R-0 Green M22S-DH-G White M22S-DH-W Blue M22S-DH-B Yellow M22S-DH-Y 3 M22S-DH--SRG 4 M22S-DH--SWRGYB Silver guarded Black M22-DGH-S Red M22-DGH-R STP M22-DGH-R-GB0 M22-DGH-R-0 Green M22-DGH-G White M22-DGH-W Blue M22-DGH-B Yellow M22-DGH-Y Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-4

42 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Momentary Components M22-DH-R max. 5mm thickness Button Plates Color Inscription Black M22-DH-S 2 Custom M22-DH-S-ETCH 3 STP M22-DH-S-GB0 START M22-DH-S-GB CLSE M22-DH-S-GB2 UP M22-DH-S-GB3 DWN M22-DH-S-GB4 FF M22-DH-S-GB5 N M22-DH-S-GB6 TEST M22-DH-S-GB9 FRWARD M22-DH-S-GB5 REVERSE M22-DH-S-GB6 RAISE M22-DH-S-GB7 LWER M22-DH-S-GB8 M22-DH-S-0 M22-DH-S- M22-DH-S-2 M22-DH-S-4 M22-DH-S-5 M22-DH-S-7 Red M22-DH-R 2 Custom M22-DH-R-ETCH 3 STP M22-DH-R-GB0 FF M22-DH-R-GB5 M22-DH-R-0 Green M22-DH-G 2 Custom M22-DH-G-ETCH 3 START M22-DH-G-GB N M22-DH-G-GB6 M22-DH-G- Blue M22-DH-B 2 Custom M22-DH-B-ETCH 3 RESET M22-DH-B-GB4 M22-DH-B-6 White M22-DH-W 2 Custom M22-DH-W-ETCH 3 START M22-DH-W-GB M22-DH-W- Yellow M22-DH-Y 2 Custom M22-DH-Y-ETCH 3 Black, red, green M22-DH-SRG Black, white, red, green, yellow, blue M22-DH-SWRGYB Note: Included with operator. M22-D- M22S-D- M22-DG- M22-K0 Buttonless perator Bezel 4 Silver Black Silver guarded Contact Blocks Terminal Type M22-D- Contact Configuration 5 M22S-D- M22-DG- Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes For complete listing of available button plates and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 Minimum order quantity of (0). 3 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DH-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 4 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 5 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-42 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

43 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Maintained M22-DRH-W M22S-DRH-W perators nly 2 Bezel Button Color Silver Black M22-DRH-S Red M22-DRH-R Green M22-DRH-G White M22-DRH-W Blue M22-DRH-B Yellow M22-DRH-Y 3 M22-DRH--SRG 4 M22-DRH--SWRGYB Black Black M22S-DRH-S Red M22S-DRH-R Green M22S-DRH-G White M22S-DRH-W Blue M22S-DRH-B Yellow M22S-DRH-Y 3 M22S-DRH--SRG 4 M22S-DRH--SWRGYB Notes Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 2 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 3 Buttonless operator comes with three color buttons (black, red, green). 4 Buttonless operator comes with all six color buttons (black, white, red, green, yellow, blue). Note: This pilot device features a selectable function switch that enables the device to be set to either maintained or momentary operation. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-43

44 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Maintained Components M22-DH-W max. 5mm thickness Button Plates 2 Color Inscription Black M22-DH-S 3 Custom M22-DH-S-ETCH 4 STP M22-DH-S-GB0 START M22-DH-S-GB CLSE M22-DH-S-GB2 UP M22-DH-S-GB3 DWN M22-DH-S-GB4 FF M22-DH-S-GB5 N M22-DH-S-GB6 TEST M22-DH-S-GB9 FRWARD M22-DH-S-GB5 REVERSE M22-DH-S-GB6 RAISE M22-DH-S-GB7 LWER M22-DH-S-GB8 M22-DH-S-0 M22-DH-S- M22-DH-S-2 M22-DH-S-4 M22-DH-S-5 M22-DH-S-7 Red M22-DH-R 3 Custom M22-DH-R-ETCH 4 STP M22-DH-R-GB0 FF M22-DH-R-GB5 M22-DH-R-0 Green M22-DH-G 3 Custom M22-DH-G-ETCH 4 START M22-DH-G-GB N M22-DH-G-GB6 M22-DH-G- Blue M22-DH-B 3 Custom M22-DH-B-ETCH 4 RESET M22-DH-B-GB4 M22-DH-B-6 White M22-DH-W 3 Custom M22-DH-W-ETCH 4 START M22-DH-W-GB M22-DH-W- Yellow M22-DH-Y 3 Custom M22-DH-Y-ETCH 4 Black, red, green M22-DH-SRG Black, white, red, green, yellow, blue M22-DH-SWRGYB Note: Included with operator. M22-DR- M22S-DR- M22-K0 Buttonless perator Bezel 5 Silver Black Contact Blocks 2 Terminal Type Contact Configuration 6 M22-DR- M22S-DR- Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 2 For complete listing of available button plates and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 3 Minimum order quantity of (0). 4 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DH-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 5 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 6 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-44 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

45 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Illuminated Pushbuttons Bezel M22 = Silver M22S = Black perator Type DL = Illuminated flush momentary DLH = Illuminated extended momentary DGL = Illuminated flush momentary with guard DRL = Illuminated flush maintained DGLH = Illuminated extended momentary with guard DRLH = Illuminated extended maintained Silver bezel only. M22 DRL R GB0 K0 230R Lens Color W = White R = Red G = Green Y = Yellow B = Blue A = Amber Inscription GB0 = STP GB = START GB2 = CLSE GB3 = UP GB4 = DWN GB5 = FF GB6 = N GB4 = RESET GB5 = FRWARD GB6 = REVERSE 0 = = 4 = 5 = 6 = K0 = N K0 = NC K20 = 2N K02 = 2NC K = N-NC Contact Blocks K30 = 3N K03 = 3NC K2 = 2N-NC K2 = N-2NC Light Units 2 30 Vac/Vdc W = White R = Red G = Green B = Blue Vac 230W = White 230R = Red 230G = Green 230B = Blue Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-45

46 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Product Selection Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Momentary M22-DL-G-K0-G M22S-DL-G-K0-G Complete Devices Bezel Button Color Note All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. Contact Block Configuration Light Unit Voltage Silver Red NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-R-K0-R NC Vac M22-DL-R-K0-230R 2NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-R-K02-R 2NC Vac M22-DL-R-K02-230R N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-R-K-R N/NC Vac M22-DL-R-K-230R Green N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-G-K0-G N Vac M22-DL-G-K0-230G 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-G-K20-G 2N Vac M22-DL-G-K20-230G N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-G-K-G N/NC Vac M22-DL-G-K-230G White N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-W-K0-W N Vac M22-DL-W-K0-230W 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-W-K20-W 2N Vac M22-DL-W-K20-230W N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DL-W-K-W N/NC Vac M22-DL-W-K-230W Black Red NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-R-K0-R NC Vac M22S-DL-R-K0-230R 2NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-R-K02-R 2NC Vac M22S-DL-R-K02-230R N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-R-K-R N/NC Vac M22S-DL-R-K-230R Green N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-G-K0-G N Vac M22S-DL-G-K0-230G 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-G-K20-G 2N Vac M22S-DL-G-K20-230G N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-G-K-G N/NC Vac M22S-DL-G-K-230G White N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-W-K0-W N Vac M22S-DL-W-K0-230W 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-W-K20-W 2N Vac M22S-DL-W-K20-230W N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DL-W-K-W N/NC Vac M22S-DL-W-K-230W V7-T-46 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

47 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Momentary M22-DL-G M22S-DL-G M22-DGL-G perators nly Bezel Button Color Silver Red M22-DL-R Green M22-DL-G White M22-DL-W Blue M22-DL-B Yellow M22-DL-Y Amber M22-DL-A Black Red M22S-DL-R Green M22S-DL-G White M22S-DL-W Blue M22S-DL-B Yellow M22S-DL-Y Amber M22S-DL-A Silver guarded Red M22-DGL-R Green M22-DGL-G White M22-DGL-W Blue M22-DGL-B Yellow M22-DGL-Y Note Includes contact block mounting adapter. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-47

48 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Momentary Components M22-DL-G M22-DL- M22S-DL- M22-DGL- max. 5mm thickness Button Lenses Color Inscription Red M22-DL-R 2 Custom M22-DL-R-ETCH 3 STP M22-DL-R-GB0 FF M22-DL-R-GB5 M22-DL-R-0 Green M22-DL-G 2 Custom M22-DL-G-ETCH 3 START M22-DL-G-GB N M22-DL-G-GB6 M22-DL-G- Blue M22-DL-B 2 Custom M22-DL-B-ETCH 3 RESET M22-DL-B-GB4 M22-DL-B-6 White M22-DL-W 2 Custom M22-DL-W-ETCH 3 Yellow M22-DL-Y 2 Custom M22-DL-Y-ETCH 3 Amber M22-DL-A Custom M22-DL-A-ETCH Buttonless perator Bezel 4 Silver Black Silver guarded M22-DL- M22S-DL- M22-DGL- Note: Included with operator. M22-LED-W M22-K0 Light Units Terminal Type LED Color Contact Blocks Light Unit Voltage Screw White Red 2 30 Vac/Vdc Green Blue Screw White Red Vac Green Blue Terminal Type Contact Configuration 5 M22-LED-W M22-LED-R M22-LED-G M22-LED-B M22-LED230-W M22-LED230-R M22-LED230-G M22-LED230-B Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes For complete listing of available button lenses, light units and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 Minimum order quantity of (0). 3 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DL-R-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 4 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 5 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-48 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

49 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Maintained 2 M22-DRL-W-K0-W M22S-DRL-W-K0-W M22-DRL-W M22S-DRL-W Complete Devices Bezel Button Color perators nly 3 Bezel Button Color Contact Block Configuration Light Unit Voltage Silver White N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DRL-W-K0-W N Vac M22-DRL-W-K0-230W NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DRL-W-K0-W NC Vac M22-DRL-W-K0-230W 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DRL-W-K20-W 2N Vac M22-DRL-W-K20-230W 2NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DRL-W-K02-W 2NC Vac M22-DRL-W-K02-230W N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DRL-W-K-W N/NC Vac M22-DRL-W-K-230W Black White N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DRL-W-K0-W N Vac M22S-DRL-W-K0-230W NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DRL-W-K0-W NC Vac M22S-DRL-W-K0-230W 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DRL-W-K20-W 2N Vac M22S-DRL-W-K20-230W 2NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DRL-W-K02-W 2NC Vac M22S-DRL-W-K02-230W N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DRL-W-K-W N/NC Vac M22S-DRL-W-K-230W Silver Red M22-DRL-R Green M22-DRL-G White M22-DRL-W Blue M22-DRL-B Yellow M22-DRL-Y Amber M22-DRL-A Black Red M22S-DRL-R Green M22S-DRL-G White M22S-DRL-W Blue M22S-DRL-B Yellow M22S-DRL-Y Amber M22S-DRL-A Notes All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. 2 Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 3 Includes contact block mounting adapter. Note: This pilot device features a selectable function switch that enables the device to be set to either maintained or momentary operation. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-49

50 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Maintained Components M22-DL-W M22-DRL- M22S-DRL- max. 5mm thickness Button Lenses 2 Color Inscription Red M22-DL-R 3 Custom M22-DL-R-ETCH 4 STP M22-DL-R-GB0 FF M22-DL-R-GB5 M22-DL-R-0 Green M22-DL-G 3 Custom M22-DL-G-ETCH 4 START M22-DL-G-GB N M22-DL-G-GB6 M22-DL-G- Blue M22-DL-B 3 Custom M22-DL-B-ETCH 4 RESET M22-DL-B-GB4 M22-DL-B-6 White M22-DL-W 3 Custom M22-DL-W-ETCH 4 Yellow M22-DL-Y 3 Custom M22-DL-Y-ETCH 4 Amber M22-DL-A Custom M22-DL-A-ETCH Buttonless perator Bezel 5 Silver Black M22-DRL- M22S-DRL- Note: Included with operator. M22-LED-W M22-K0 Light Units 2 Terminal Type LED Color Contact Blocks 2 Light Unit Voltage Screw White Red 2 30 Vac/Vdc Green Blue Screw White Red Vac Green Blue Terminal Type Contact Configuration 6 M22-LED-W M22-LED-R M22-LED-G M22-LED-B M22-LED230-W M22-LED230-R M22-LED230-G M22-LED230-B Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 2 For complete listing of available button lenses, light units and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 3 Minimum order quantity of (0). 4 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DL-R-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 5 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 6 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-50 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

51 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Momentary M22-DLH-R-K-R M22S-DLH-R-K-R Complete Devices Bezel Complete Press-to-Test Units perators nly 2 Bezel Button Color Light Unit Voltage Bezel Button Color Silver Red 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-T-R-R M22-DLH-R Silver Red M22-DLH-R Blue M22-T-B-B Green M22-DLH-G Yellow M22-T-Y-W White M22-DLH-W Green M22-T-G-G Blue M22-DLH-B White M22-T-W-W Yellow M22-DLH-Y Red Vac M22-T-R-230R Amber M22-DLH-A Blue M22-T-R-230B M22S-DLH-R Black Red M22S-DLH-R Yellow M22-T-Y-230W Green M22S-DLH-G Green M22-T-G-230G White M22S-DLH-W White M22-T-W-230W Blue M22S-DLH-B Black Red 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-T-R-R Yellow M22S-DLH-Y Blue M22S-T-B-B Amber M22S-DLH-A Yellow M22S-T-Y-W M22-DGLH-R Silver guarded Red M22-DGLH-R Green M22S-T-G-G Green M22-DGLH-G White M22S-T-W-W White M22-DGLH-W Red Vac M22S-T-R-230R Blue M22-DGLH-B Blue M22S-T-B-230B Yellow M22-DGLH-Y Yellow M22S-T-Y-230W Green M22S-T-G-230G White M22S-T-W-230W Notes All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. 2 Includes contact block mounting adapter. Button Color Contact Block Configuration Light Unit Voltage Silver Red N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DLH-R-K-R N/NC Vac M22-DLH-R-K-230R Green 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DLH-G-K20-G 2N Vac M22-DLH-G-K20-230G White 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-DLH-W-K20-W 2N Vac M22-DLH-W-K20-230W Black Red N/NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DLH-R-K-R N/NC Vac M22S-DLH-R-K-230R Green 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DLH-G-K20-G 2N Vac M22S-DLH-G-K20-230G White 2N 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22S-DLH-W-K20-W 2N Vac M22S-DLH-W-K20-230W Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-5

52 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Momentary Components M22-DH-R M22-DL- M22S-DL- M22-DGL- max. 5mm thickness Button Lenses Color Inscription Red M22-DLH-R 2 Custom M22-DLH-R-ETCH 3 STP M22-DLH-R-GB0 FF M22-DLH-R-GB5 M22-DLH-R-0 Green M22-DLH-G 2 Custom M22-DLH-G-ETCH 3 START M22-DLH-G-GB N M22-DLH-G-GB6 M22-DLH-G- Blue M22-DLH-B 2 Custom M22-DLH-B-ETCH 3 RESET M22-DLH-B-GB4 M22-DLH-B-6 White M22-DLH-W 2 Custom M22-DLH-W-ETCH 3 Yellow M22-DLH-Y 2 Custom M22-DLH-Y-ETCH 3 Amber M22-DLH-A Custom M22-DLH-A-ETCH Buttonless perator Bezel 4 Silver Black Silver guarded M22-DL- M22S-DL- M22-DGL- Note: Included with operator. M22-LED-W M22-K0 Light Units Terminal Type LED Color Contact Blocks Light Unit Voltage Screw White Red 2 30 Vac/Vdc Green Blue Screw White Red Vac Green Blue Terminal Type Contact Configuration 5 M22-LED-W M22-LED-R M22-LED-G M22-LED-B M22-LED230-W M22-LED230-R M22-LED230-G M22-LED230-B Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes For complete listing of available button lenses, light units and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 Minimum order quantity of (0). 3 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DH-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 4 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 5 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-52 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

53 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Maintained M22-DRLH-W M22S-DRLH-W perators nly 2 Bezel Button Color Silver Red M22-DRLH-R Green M22-DRLH-G White M22-DRLH-W Blue M22-DRLH-B Yellow M22-DRLH-Y Amber M22-DRLH-A Black Red M22S-DRLH-R Green M22S-DRLH-G White M22S-DRLH-W Blue M22S-DRLH-B Yellow M22S-DRLH-Y Amber M22S-DRLH-A Notes Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 2 Includes contact block mounting adapter. Note: This pilot device features a selectable function switch that enables the device to be set to either maintained or momentary operation. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-53

54 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Maintained Components M22-DLH-W M22-DRL- M22S-DRL- max. 5mm thickness Button Lenses 2 Color Inscription Red M22-DLH-R 3 Custom M22-DLH-R-ETCH 4 STP M22-DLH-R-GB0 FF M22-DLH-R-GB5 M22-DLH-R-0 Green M22-DLH-G 3 Custom M22-DLH-G-ETCH 4 START M22-DLH-G-GB N M22-DLH-G-GB6 M22-DLH-G- Blue M22-DLH-B 3 Custom M22-DLH-B-ETCH 4 RESET M22-DLH-B-GB4 M22-DLH-B-6 White M22-DLH-W 3 Custom M22-DLH-W-ETCH 4 Yellow M22-DLH-Y 3 Custom M22-DLH-Y-ETCH 4 Amber M22-DLH-A Custom M22-DLH-A-ETCH Buttonless perator Bezel 5 Silver Black M22-DRL- M22S-DRL- Note: Included with operator. M22-LED-W M22-K0 Light Units 2 Terminal Type LED Color Contact Blocks 2 Terminal Type Light Unit Voltage White 2 30 Red Vac/Vdc Green Blue White Red Vac Green Blue Contact Configuration 6 M22-LED-W M22-LED-R M22-LED-G M22-LED-B M22-LED230-W M22-LED230-R M22-LED230-G M22-LED230-B Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 2 For complete listing of available button lenses, light units and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 3 Minimum order quantity of (0). 4 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DLH-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 5 Includes contact block mounting adapter. 6 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-54 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

55 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Indicating Lights Product Description Eaton s M22 indicating lights use the combination of a durable, bright LED unit and modern lenses designed specifically for this type of LED to create a bright and visible indicating light. As with the pushbuttons, the indicating light lenses can be laser engraved. Indicating lights can be ordered as complete devices, including lens and LED unit, or as modular components. Features Customizable laser engraving on all lenses LED offering only for improved brightness quality and up to 00,000 hours of operation Lenses designed specifically for LED illumination Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Indicating Lights Product Selection Indicating Lights, Flush M22-L-R-R M22-L-R perator Type M22-L = Flush indicating light Complete Devices Lens Color Light Color Light Unit Voltage White White 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-L-W-W Red Red M22-L-R-R Green Green M22-L-G-G Yellow White M22-L-Y-W Blue Blue M22-L-B-B Amber White M22-L-A-W White White Vac M22-L-W-230W Red Red M22-L-R-230R Green Green M22-L-G-230G Yellow White M22-L-Y-230W Blue Blue M22-L-B-230B Amber White M22-L-A-230W perators nly Lens Color W = White R = Red G = Green Y = Yellow B = Blue Note: Light unit should match color of lens. Use white light unit with yellow lens. Lens Color Lens Color Flat M22-LH-R Conical White M22-L-W White M22-LH-W Red M22-L-R Red M22-LH-R Green M22-L-G Green M22-LH-G Yellow M22-L-Y Yellow M22-LH-Y Blue M22-L-B Blue M22-LH-B Amber M22-L-A Amber M22-LH-A Note Includes contact block mounting adapter. M22 - L B GB8 B Plate Inscription ETCH = Custom GB5 = FF GB6 = N GB8 = FAULT GB5 = FRWARD GB6 = REVERSE 2 30 Vac/Vdc W = White R = Red G = Green B = Blue Modular construction makes assembly fast and simplifies stocking of components and complete devices Capable of communicating via ASi protocol with ASi adapter modules Protection Type IP67, IP69K NEMA 4, 3 Light Units Vac 230W = White 230R = Red 230G = Green 230B = Blue When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-L-B-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-55

56 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Indicating Lights, Flush Components M22-L-R M22-L- Lenses Color Inscription Lensless Indicating Light max. 5mm thickness Flat Red M22-L-R 2 Custom M22-L-R-ETCH 3 FF M22-L-R-GB5 Green M22-L-G 2 Custom M22-L-G-ETCH 3 N M22-L-G-GB6 REVERSE M22-L-G-GB6 Blue M22-L-B 2 Custom M22-L-B-ETCH 3 FAULT M22-L-B-GB8 White M22-L-W 2 Custom M22-L-W-ETCH 3 FF M22-L-W-GB5 N M22-L-W-GB6 FAULT M22-L-W-GB8 FRWARD M22-L-W-GB5 Yellow M22-L-Y 2 Custom M22-L-Y-ETCH 3 Amber M22-L-A 2 Custom M22-L-A-ETCH 3 Conical Red M22-LH-R Green M22-LH-G Blue M22-LH-B White M22-LH-W Yellow M22-LH-Y Amber M22-LH-A M22-L- M22-LED-W Note: Included with operator. Light Units 4 Terminal Type LED Color Light Unit Voltage Screw White Red 2 30 Vac/Vdc Green Blue Screw White Red Vac Green Blue M22-LED-W M22-LED-R M22-LED-G M22-LED-B M22-LED230-W M22-LED230-R M22-LED230-G M22-LED230-B Notes For complete listing of available lenses and light units, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 Minimum order quantity of (0). 3 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-L-R-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 4 Select the same color LED element as lens color; for yellow and amber lenses, choose a white LED. V7-T-56 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

57 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Emergency Stops Product Description Eaton s M22 emergency stops are a durable and reliable solution to a variety of e-stop applications. With standard push-pull, as well as twist-to-release and keyrelease, illuminated options and red or black operators, the M22 e-stop is a robust solution. As with all operators, they can be ordered as a ready to install complete device or as modular components for the perfect fit. Features Push-pull and twist to release options available as well as illuminated and keyed release LED offering only for improved brightness quality and up to 00,000 hours of operation Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Emergency Stops perator Color M22 = Silver M22S = Black perator Type PV = Non-illuminated push-pull emergency stop PVT = Non-illuminated twist-to-release emergency stop PVT45P = Non-illuminated twist-to-release 45 mm emergency stop PVT60P = Non-illuminated twist-to-release 60 mm emergency stop PVT45P-MPI = Non-illuminated twist-to-release with mechanical indication, 45 mm PVT60P-MPI = Non-illuminated twist-to-release with mechanical indication, 60 mm PVS = Non-illuminated keyed release (red operator only) PVS45P = Non-illuminated keyed release 45 mm (red only) PVS60P = Non-illuminated keyed release 60 mm (red only) PVL = Illuminated push-pull emergency stop PVLT = Illuminated twist-to-release emergency stop PVLT45P = Illuminated twist-to-release 45 mm emergency stop PVLT60P = Illuminated twist-to-release 60 mm emergency stop Product Selection Non-Illuminated Emergency Stops M22-PV-K0 Complete Devices Type Color Note All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. M22 PVT MS2 K0 230R Contact Block Configuration Key Release Code Blank = MS MS2 = MS2 MS3 = MS3 MS4 = MS4 MS5 = MS5 MS6 = MS6 MS7 = MS7 MS8 = MS8 RS = Ronis (45 and 60 mm only) Push-pull Red NC M22-PV-K0 2NC M22-PV-K02 N-2NC M22-PV-K2 Twist-to-release Red NC M22-PVT-K0 2NC M22-PVT-K02 N-2NC M22-PVT-K2 Key release Red NC M22-PVS-K0 2NC M22-PVS-K02 N-2NC M22-PVS-K2 Contact Blocks K0 = N K0P = N, early-make K0 = NC K0D = NC, late-break CK0 = N CK0 = NC CK0D = NC, late-break Ck20 = 2N CK02 = 2NC CK = N-NC More than 00,000 mechanical operations Capable of communicating via ASi protocol with ASi adapter modules Protection Type IP67, IP69K (IP66 key-release) NEMA 4, 3 Light Units 2 30 Vac/Vdc W = White R = Red G = Green B = Blue Vac 230W = White 230R = Red 230G = Green 230B = Blue Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-57

58 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Emergency Stops Components M22-PV M22S-PVT M22S-PVT_ max. 5mm thickness Note: Included with operator. perators nly M22-K0 Contact Blocks 4 Actuator Terminal Mounting Contact Type Color Size Type Location 5 Configuration 6 Push-pull Red 35 mm M22-PV Black 35 mm M22S-PV Red 35 mm M22-PVT 45 mm M22-PVT45P 60 mm M22-PVT60P Black M22S-PVT Key release 2 Red 35 mm M22-PVS 3 M22-PVS-MS2 M22-PVS-MS3 M22-PVS-MS4 M22-PVS-MS5 M22-PVS-MS6 M22-PVS-MS7 M22-PVS-MS8 45 mm M22-PVS45P M22-PVS45P-MS2 M22-PVS45P-MS3 M22-PVS45P-MS4 M22-PVS45P-MS5 M22-PVS45P-MS6 M22-PVS45P-MS7 M22-PVS45P-MS8 M22-PVS45P-RS 60 mm M22-PVS60P M22-PVS60P-MS2 M22-PVS60P-MS3 M22-PVS60P-MS4 M22-PVS60P-MS5 M22-PVS60P-MS6 M22-PVS60P-MS7 M22-PVS60P-MS8 M22-PVS60P-RS Mechanical Red 45 mm M22-PVT45P-MPI indication 60 mm M22-PVT60P-MPI M22-ES-MS Extra Keys 7 For Key Code Twist-torelease Screw Front N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D SMCB, NC M22-K0SMC0 SMCB, 2NC M22-K02SMC0 Base SMCB, NC M22-KC0SMC0 SMCB, 2NC M22-KC02SMC0 Springcage Front N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK MS MS2 MS3 MS4 MS5 MS6 MS7 MS8 M22-ES-MS M22-ES-MS2 M22-ES-MS3 M22-ES-MS4 M22-ES-MS5 M22-ES-MS6 M22-ES-MS7 M22-ES-MS8 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 Key included. For identical locks and keys, use the same key code. ne key is included with actuator; additional keys are available as accessories. 3 Includes Key Code MS. 4 For complete listing of available contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 5 Self-monitoring contact blocks (SMCB type) cannot be used with illuminated emergency stops. 6 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. 7 For use with key release operators only. ne key included with operator. V7-T-58 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

59 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 M22-GPV M22G-GPV M22-MGTA M22-PL-PV M22-PV60-Y-20 Illuminated Emergency Stops M22-PVL-K0-R Accessories Description Voltage Yellow guard ring M22-GPV Gray guard ring M22G-GPV Rectangular guard M22-MGTA Sealing shroud M22-PL-PV Illuminated ring 24 Vac/Vdc M22-PV60-Y Vac M22-PV60-Y Vac M22-PV60-Y-230 Complete Devices Type Button Color LED Color Note All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. Contact Block Configuration Light Unit Voltage Push-pull Red Red NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-PVL-K0-R 2NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-PVL-K02-R N-2NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-PVL-K2-R NC Vac M22-PVL-K0-230R 2NC Vac M22-PVL-K02-230R N-2NC Vac M22-PVL-K2-230R Twist-to-release NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-PVLT-K0-R 2NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-PVLT-K02-R N-2NC 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-PVLT-K2-R NC Vac M22-PVLT-K0-230R 2NC Vac M22-PVLT-K02-230R N-2NC Vac M22-PVLT-K2-230R Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-59

60 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Illuminated Emergency Stops Components M22-PVL M22S-PVLT M22-LED-W perators nly Type Color Light Units 2 Actuator Size max. 5mm thickness Push-pull Red 35 mm M22-PVL Black 35 mm M22S-PVL Twist-torelease Terminal Type Red 35 mm M22-PVLT 45 mm M22-PVLT45P 60 mm M22-PVLT60P Black 35 mm M22S-PVLT LED Color Light Unit Voltage Screw White 2 30 M22-LED-W Vac/Vdc Red 2 30 M22-LED-R Vac/Vdc Screw White M22-LED230-W Vac Red M22-LED230-R Vac Screw White Vac M22-LED230H-W Red Vac M22-LED230H-R Note: Included with operator. M22-K0 M22-GPV M22G-GPV M22-MGTA M22-PL-PV Contact Blocks 2 Terminal Type Contact Configuration 3 Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Accessories Description Voltage Yellow guard ring M22-GPV Gray guard ring M22G-GPV Rectangular guard M22-MGTA Sealing shroud M22-PL-PV Illuminated ring 24 Vac/Vdc M22-PV60-Y Vac M22-PV60-Y Vac M22-PV60-Y-230 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 For complete listing of available light units and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 3 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-60 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

61 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Selector Switches Contents Description Selector Switches Non-Illuminated Switches Illuminated Switches Key perated Page V7-T-62 V7-T-67 V7-T-7 Selector Switches Product Description Eaton s M22 selector switch line offers an almost endless variety of options in maintained/momentary, keyremoval and illuminated devices. The coding adapters used for maintained/ momentary and key removal positions make the M22 stand out from competitive devices. By simply adding or removing a coding adapter from inside the operator, the end-user can change the function of the button. perator options include standard knob, rotary head, illuminated and keyed versions. As with all operators, they can be ordered as a ready to install complete device or as modular components to meet application specific requirements. Features Adding or removing coding adapters allows for field convertibility of maintained/momentary and key removal positions LED offering only for improved brightness quality and up to 00,000 hours of operation More than 00,000 mechanical operations Coding adapter options make assembly fast and simplify stocking of different configurations of selector switches Capable of communicating via ASi protocol with ASi adapter modules Protection Type IP66 NEMA 4, 3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-6

62 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Non-Illuminated Selector Switches Bezel Color M22 = Silver M22S = Black Handle Type W = Momentary rotary WK = Momentary knob WKV = Maintained V-position knob WR = Maintained rotary WRK = Maintained knob All momentary selector switches can be converted in the field to maintained operation with the removal of a colorcoded adapter. M22 WRK 9 K0 Number of Positions Blank = Two-position 3 = Three-position 4 = Four-position Inscription 2 9 = AUT-HAND 92 = II-I 2 Rotary type only. Contact Blocks K0 = N K0P = N, early-make ptions K = N-NC K22 = 2N-2NC K20 = 2N K02 = 2NC V7-T-62 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

63 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Product Selection Non-Illuminated Selector Switches M22-WKV-K0 Complete Devices, Knob Type Type Switching Position Bezel Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. Contact Block Configuration 2 Two-position Maintained Silver N M22-WRK-K0 N-NC M22-WRK-K 2N-2NC M22-WRK-K22 Black N M22S-WRK-K0 N-NC M22S-WRK-K 2N-2NC M22S-WRK-K22 Maintained V Silver N M22-WKV-K0 N-NC M22-WKV-K 2N-2NC M22-WKV-K22 Black N M22S-WKV-K0 N-NC M22S-WKV-K 2N-2NC M22S-WKV-K22 Three-position Maintained Silver 2N M22-WRK3-K20 2N-2NC M22-WRK3-K22 Black 2N M22S-WRK3-K20 2N-2NC M22S-WRK3-K22 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-63

64 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Selector Switches Components perators nly, Knob Type M22-WK Type Switching Position Bezel Two-position Momentary 2 Silver M22-WK Black M22S-WK Maintained Silver M22-WRK Black M22S-WRK Maintained V Silver M22-WKV Black M22S-WKV Three-position Momentary 2 Silver M22-WK3 Black M22S-WK3 Maintained Silver M22-WRK3 Black M22S-WRK3 Maintained, return from left Silver M22-WRK3-2 Black M22S-WRK3-2 Maintained, return from right Silver M22-WRK3- Black M22S-WRK3- Four-position Maintained Silver M22-WRK4 Black M22S-WRK4 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 Momentary selector switches can be converted in the field to maintained operation with the removal of a color coded adapter. See Page V7-T-03. V7-T-64 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

65 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Non-Illuminated Selector Switches Components M22S-WR3-94 perators nly, Rotary Type Type Switching Position Bezel Inscription Two-position Momentary 2 Silver I- M22-W Black I- M22S-W Maintained Silver I- M22-WR Custom M22-WR-ETCH 3 AUT-HAND M22-WR-9 II-I M22-WR-92 Black I- M22S-WR Custom M22S-WR-ETCH 3 AUT-HAND M22S-WR-9 II-I M22S-WR-92 Three-position Momentary 2 Silver I--II M22-W3 Black I--II M22S-W3 Maintained Silver I--II M22-WR3 Custom M22-WR3-ETCH 3 AUT--MAN M22-WR3-94 Black I--II M22S-WR3 Custom M22S-WR3-ETCH 3 AUT--MAN M22S-WR3-94 Four-position Maintained Silver M22-WR4 Black M22S-WR4 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 Momentary selector switches can be converted in the field to maintained operation with the removal of a color coded adapter. See Page V7-T When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-WR3-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 88, Line item #_. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-65

66 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Selector Switches Components M22-K0 Contact Blocks Terminal Type Contact Configuration 2 max. 5mm thickness Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Note: Included with operator. M22-W M22-WS M22-C-R M22-C-Y M22-GWK Accessories Description Plunger bridge 3 Key cover Key withdraw adapter 4 Coding adapter Guard ring M22-W M22-WS M22-C-R M22-C-Y M22-GWK Notes For complete listing of available contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. 3 Plunger needed to actuate center-mounted contact blocks. Used for non-illuminated three-position selector switches only. 4 Enables a keyed selector switch to be set to user-selected key withdraw position. V7-T-66 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

67 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Illuminated Selector Switches Bezel Color M22 = Silver M22S = Black Handle Type WLK = Illuminated knob type momentary, two-position WLKV = Illuminated Knob type momentary, V-position WLK3 = Illuminated knob type momentary, three-position M22 WLK R K0 R Handle Color W = White R = Red G = Green Y = Yellow B = Blue K0 = N K0 = NC K20 = 2N K02 = 2NC K = N-NC Contact Blocks K30 = 3N K03 = 3NC K2 = 2N-NC K2 = N-2NC Light Units 2 30 Vac/Vdc W = White R = Red G = Green B = Blue Vac 230W = White 230R = Red 230G = Green 230B = Blue Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-67

68 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Product Selection Illuminated Selector Switches Components M22-WLK-W perators nly, Knob Type Type Switching Position Bezel Button Color Two-position Momentary 2 Silver White M22-WLK-W Red M22-WLK-R Green M22-WLK-G Yellow M22-WLK-Y Blue M22-WLK-B Black White M22S-WLK-W Red M22S-WLK-R Green M22S-WLK-G Yellow M22S-WLK-Y Blue M22S-WLK-B Maintained Silver White M22-WRLK-W Red M22-WRLK-R Green M22-WRLK-G Yellow M22-WRLK-Y Blue M22-WRLK-B Black White M22S-WRLK-W Red M22S-WRLK-R Green M22S-WRLK-G Yellow M22S-WRLK-Y Blue M22S-WRLK-B Maintained V Silver White M22-WLKV-W Red M22-WLKV-R Green M22-WLKV-G Yellow M22-WLKV-Y Blue M22-WLKV-B Black White M22S-WLKV-W Red M22S-WLKV-R Green M22S-WLKV-G Yellow M22S-WLKV-Y Blue M22S-WLKV-B Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 Momentary selector switches can be converted in the field to maintained operation with the removal of a color coded adapter. See Page V7-T-03. V7-T-68 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

69 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Illuminated Selector Switches Components M22-WLK3-W perators nly, Knob Type Type Switching Position Bezel Button Color Three-position Momentary 2 Silver White M22-WLK3-W Red M22-WLK3-R Green M22-WLK3-G Yellow M22-WLK3-Y Blue M22-WLK3-B Black White M22S-WLK3-W Red M22S-WLK3-R Green M22S-WLK3-G Yellow M22S-WLK3-Y Blue M22S-WLK3-B Maintained Silver White M22-WRLK3-W Red M22-WRLK3-R Green M22-WRLK3-G Yellow M22-WRLK3-Y Blue M22-WRLK3-B Black White M22S-WRLK3-W Red M22S-WRLK3-R Green M22S-WRLK3-G Yellow M22S-WRLK3-Y Blue M22S-WRLK3-B Maintained, return from right Silver White M22-WRLK3--W Red M22-WRLK3--R Green M22-WRLK3--G Yellow M22-WRLK3--Y Blue M22-WRLK3--B Black White M22S-WRLK3--W Red M22S-WRLK3--R Green M22S-WRLK3--G Yellow M22S-WRLK3--Y Blue M22S-WRLK3--B Maintained, return from left Silver White M22-WRLK3-2-W Red M22-WRLK3-2-R Green M22-WRLK3-2-G Yellow M22-WRLK3-2-Y Blue M22-WRLK3-2-B Black White M22S-WRLK3-2-W Red M22S-WRLK3-2-R Green M22S-WRLK3-2-G Yellow M22S-WRLK3-2-Y Blue M22S-WRLK3-2-B Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 Momentary selector switches can be converted in the field to maintained operation with the removal of a color coded adapter. See Page V7-T-03. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-69

70 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Illuminated Selector Switches M22-LED-W M22-K0 Light Units 5 Terminal LED Type Color Contact Blocks max. 5mm thickness Light Unit Voltage Screw White Red 2 30 Vac/Vdc Green Blue Screw White Red Vac Green Blue Terminal Type Contact Configuration 3 M22-LED-W M22-LED-R M22-LED-G M22-LED-B M22-LED230-W M22-LED230-R M22-LED230-G M22-LED230-B Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Note: Included with operator. M22-W M22-WS M22-C-R M22-C-Y M22-GWK Accessories Description Plunger bridge 2 Key cover Key withdraw adapter 4 Coding adapter Guard ring M22-W M22-WS M22-C-R M22-C-Y M22-GWK Notes For complete listing of available light units and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 Plunger needed to actuate center-mounted contact blocks. Used for non-illuminated three-position selector switches only. 3 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. 4 Enables a keyed selector switch to be set to user-selected key withdraw position. 5 Select the same color LED element as lens color; for yellow lens, choose a white LED. V7-T-70 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

71 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Key-perated Selector Switches Bezel Color M22 = Silver M22S = Black Product Selection Key-perated Selector Switches 2 Components M22-WS M22 WS MS2 A Handle Type WS = Two-position, momentary WS3 = Three-position, momentary WRS = Two-position, maintained WRS3 = Three-position, maintained Key Code Blank = MS MS2 = MS2 MS3 = MS3 MS4 = MS4 MS5 = MS5 MS6 = MS6 MS7 = MS7 MS8 = MS8 Key Removal Position Refer to coding adapter assembly and functional test guide on Page V7-T-03. perators nly 3 Type Switching Position Bezel Key Removal Position Key Code Two-position Momentary 4 Silver Return from right, key MS M22-WS removable left MS2 M22-WS-MS2 MS3 M22-WS-MS3 MS4 M22-WS-MS4 MS5 M22-WS-MS5 MS6 M22-WS-MS6 MS7 M22-WS-MS7 MS8 M22-WS-MS8 Black Return from right, key MS M22S-WS removable left MS2 M22S-WS-MS2 MS3 M22S-WS-MS3 MS4 M22S-WS-MS4 MS5 M22S-WS-MS5 MS6 M22S-WS-MS6 MS7 M22S-WS-MS7 MS8 M22S-WS-MS8 Notes Includes one key. 2 Key removal positions can be modified in the field using coding adapters; see chart on Page V7-T Includes contact block mounting adapter. 4 Momentary selector switches can be converted in the field to maintained operation with the removal of a color coded adapter. See Page V7-T-03. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-7

72 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Key-perated Selector Switches 2 Components perators nly, continued 3 M22S-WRS M22-WS3-93 Type Switching Position Bezel Key Removal Position Key Code Two-position Maintained Silver Key removable left MS M22-WRS-A MS2 M22-WRS-MS2-A MS3 M22-WRS-MS3-A MS4 M22-WRS-MS4-A MS5 M22-WRS-MS5-A MS6 M22-WRS-MS6-A MS7 M22-WRS-MS7-A MS8 M22-WRS-MS8-A Key removable left/right MS M22-WRS MS2 M22-WRS-MS2 MS3 M22-WRS-MS3 MS4 M22-WRS-MS4 MS5 M22-WRS-MS5 MS6 M22-WRS-MS6 MS7 M22-WRS-MS7 MS8 M22-WRS-MS8 Black Key removable left MS M22S-WRS-A MS2 M22S-WRS-MS2-A MS3 M22S-WRS-MS3-A MS4 M22S-WRS-MS4-A MS5 M22S-WRS-MS5-A MS6 M22S-WRS-MS6-A MS7 M22S-WRS-MS7-A MS8 M22S-WRS-MS8-A Key removable left/right MS M22S-WRS MS2 M22S-WRS-MS2 MS3 M22S-WRS-MS3 MS4 M22S-WRS-MS4 MS5 M22S-WRS-MS5 MS6 M22S-WRS-MS6 MS7 M22S-WRS-MS7 MS8 M22S-WRS-MS8 Three-position Momentary 4 Silver Return from left/right, MS M22-WS3 key removable center MS2 M22-WS3-MS2 MS3 M22-WS3-MS3 MS4 M22-WS3-MS4 MS5 M22-WS3-MS5 MS6 M22-WS3-MS6 MS7 M22-WS3-MS7 MS8 M22-WS3-MS8 Black Return from left/right, MS M22S-WS3 key removable center MS2 M22S-WS3-MS2 MS3 M22S-WS3-MS3 MS4 M22S-WS3-MS4 MS5 M22S-WS3-MS5 MS6 M22S-WS3-MS6 MS7 M22S-WS3-MS7 MS8 M22S-WS3-MS8 Notes Includes one key. 2 Key removal positions can be modified in the field using coding adapters; see chart on Page V7-T Includes contact block mounting adapter. 4 Momentary selector switches can be converted in the field to maintained operation with the removal of a color coded adapter. See Page V7-T-03. V7-T-72 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

73 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Key-perated Selector Switches 2 Components M22-WS3-93 perators nly, continued 3 Type Switching Position Bezel Key Removal Position Key Code Three-position Maintained Silver Key removable center MS M22-WRS3-A MS2 M22-WRS3-MS2-A MS3 M22-WRS3-MS3-A MS4 M22-WRS3-MS4-A MS5 M22-WRS3-MS5-A MS6 M22-WRS3-MS6-A MS7 M22-WRS3-MS7-A MS8 M22-WRS3-MS8-A Key removable MS M22-WRS3-A2 center/left MS2 M22-WRS3-MS2-A2 MS3 M22-WRS3-MS3-A2 MS4 M22-WRS3-MS4-A2 MS5 M22-WRS3-MS5-A2 MS6 M22-WRS3-MS6-A2 MS7 M22-WRS3-MS7-A2 MS8 M22-WRS3-MS8-A2 Key removable MS M22-WRS3-A3 center/right MS2 M22-WRS3-MS2-A3 MS3 M22-WRS3-MS3-A3 MS4 M22-WRS3-MS4-A3 MS5 M22-WRS3-MS5-A3 MS6 M22-WRS3-MS6-A3 MS7 M22-WRS3-MS7-A3 MS8 M22-WRS3-MS8-A3 Key removable left/right MS M22-WRS3 MS2 M22-WRS3-MS2 MS3 M22-WRS3-MS3 MS4 M22-WRS3-MS4 MS5 M22-WRS3-MS5 MS6 M22-WRS3-MS6 MS7 M22-WRS3-MS7 MS8 M22-WRS3-MS8 Return from left, MS M22-WRS3-A7 key removable center MS2 M22-WRS3-MS2-A7 MS3 M22-WRS3-MS3-A7 MS4 M22-WRS3-MS4-A7 MS5 M22-WRS3-MS5-A7 MS6 M22-WRS3-MS6-A7 MS7 M22-WRS3-MS7-A7 MS8 M22-WRS3-MS8-A7 Return from left, MS M22-WRS3-A6 key removable center/right MS2 M22-WRS3-MS2-A6 MS3 M22-WRS3-MS3-A6 MS4 M22-WRS3-MS4-A6 MS5 M22-WRS3-MS5-A6 MS6 M22-WRS3-MS6-A6 MS7 M22-WRS3-MS7-A6 MS8 M22-WRS3-MS8-A6 Notes Includes one key. 2 Key removal positions can be modified in the field using coding adapters; see chart on Page V7-T Includes contact block mounting adapter. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-73

74 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Key-perated Selector Switches 2 Components M22-WS3-93 perators nly, continued 3 Type Switching Position Bezel Key Removal Position Key Code Three-position Maintained Silver Return from right, MS M22-WRS3-A4 key removable left/center MS2 M22-WRS3-MS2-A4 MS3 M22-WRS3-MS3-A4 MS4 M22-WRS3-MS4-A4 MS5 M22-WRS3-MS5-A4 MS6 M22-WRS3-MS6-A4 MS7 M22-WRS3-MS7-A4 MS8 M22-WRS3-MS8-A4 Return from right, MS M22-WRS3-A5 key removable center MS2 M22-WRS3-MS2-A5 MS3 M22-WRS3-MS3-A5 MS4 M22-WRS3-MS4-A5 MS5 M22-WRS3-MS5-A5 MS6 M22-WRS3-MS6-A5 MS7 M22-WRS3-MS7-A5 MS8 M22-WRS3-MS8-A5 Black Key removable center MS M22S-WRS3-A MS2 M22S-WRS3-MS2-A MS3 M22S-WRS3-MS3-A MS4 M22S-WRS3-MS4-A MS5 M22S-WRS3-MS5-A MS6 M22S-WRS3-MS6-A MS7 M22S-WRS3-MS7-A MS8 M22S-WRS3-MS8-A Key removable MS M22S-WRS3-A2 center/left MS2 M22S-WRS3-MS2-A2 MS3 M22S-WRS3-MS3-A2 MS4 M22S-WRS3-MS4-A2 MS5 M22S-WRS3-MS5-A2 MS6 M22S-WRS3-MS6-A2 MS7 M22S-WRS3-MS7-A2 MS8 M22S-WRS3-MS8-A2 Key removable MS M22S-WRS3-A3 center/right MS2 M22S-WRS3-MS2-A3 MS3 M22S-WRS3-MS3-A3 MS4 M22S-WRS3-MS4-A3 MS5 M22S-WRS3-MS5-A3 MS6 M22S-WRS3-MS6-A3 MS7 M22S-WRS3-MS7-A3 MS8 M22S-WRS3-MS8-A3 Key removable MS M22S-WRS3 left/right/center MS2 M22S-WRS3-MS2 MS3 M22S-WRS3-MS3 MS4 M22S-WRS3-MS4 MS5 M22S-WRS3-MS5 MS6 M22S-WRS3-MS6 MS7 M22S-WRS3-MS7 MS8 M22S-WRS3-MS8 Notes Includes one key. 2 Key removal positions can be modified in the field using coding adapters; see chart on Page V7-T Includes contact block mounting adapter. V7-T-74 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

75 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Key-perated Selector Switches 2 Components M22-WS3-93 perators nly, continued 3 Type Switching Position Bezel Key Removal Position Key Code Three-position Maintained Black Return from left, MS M22S-WRS3-A7 key removable center MS2 M22S-WRS3-MS2-A7 MS3 M22S-WRS3-MS3-A7 MS4 M22S-WRS3-MS4-A7 MS5 M22S-WRS3-MS5-A7 MS6 M22S-WRS3-MS6-A7 MS7 M22S-WRS3-MS7-A7 MS8 M22S-WRS3-MS8-A7 Return from left, MS M22S-WRS3-A6 key removable center/right MS2 M22S-WRS3-MS2-A6 MS3 M22S-WRS3-MS3-A6 MS4 M22S-WRS3-MS4-A6 MS5 M22S-WRS3-MS5-A6 MS6 M22S-WRS3-MS6-A6 MS7 M22S-WRS3-MS7-A6 MS8 M22S-WRS3-MS8-A6 Return from right, MS M22S-WRS3-A4 key removable left/center MS2 M22S-WRS3-MS2-A4 MS3 M22S-WRS3-MS3-A4 MS4 M22S-WRS3-MS4-A4 MS5 M22S-WRS3-MS5-A4 MS6 M22S-WRS3-MS6-A4 MS7 M22S-WRS3-MS7-A4 MS8 M22S-WRS3-MS8-A4 Return from right, MS M22S-WRS3-A5 key removable center MS2 M22S-WRS3-MS2-A5 MS3 M22S-WRS3-MS3-A5 MS4 M22S-WRS3-MS4-A5 MS5 M22S-WRS3-MS5-A5 MS6 M22S-WRS3-MS6-A5 MS7 M22S-WRS3-MS7-A5 MS8 M22S-WRS3-MS8-A5 Notes Includes one key. 2 Key removal positions can be modified in the field using coding adapters; see chart on Page V7-T Includes contact block mounting adapter. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-75

76 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Key-perated Selector Switches Components M22-K0 M22-ES-MS Contact Blocks Terminal Type Extra Keys Key Code Contact Configuration 2 max. 5mm thickness Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK MS MS2 MS3 MS4 MS5 MS6 MS7 MS8 M22-ES-MS M22-ES-MS2 M22-ES-MS3 M22-ES-MS4 M22-ES-MS5 M22-ES-MS6 M22-ES-MS7 M22-ES-MS8 Note: Included with operator. M22-W M22-WS M22-C-R M22-C-Y M22-GWK Accessories Description Plunger bridge 3 Key cover Key withdraw adapter 4 Coding adapter Guard ring M22-W M22-WS M22-C-R M22-C-Y M22-GWK Notes For complete listing of available contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. 3 Plunger needed to actuate center-mounted contact blocks. Used for non-illuminated three-position selector switches only. 4 Enables a keyed selector switch to be set to user-selected key withdraw position. V7-T-76 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

77 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Mushroom Head Pushbuttons Product Description Features Eaton s M22 mushroom head operators are a durable and unique way to include standard pushbutton functionality. Like the standard pushbutton line, the maintained pushbuttons are field convertible to momentary. They also offer laser engraving and a robust five million mechanical operations on the standard momentary operator. As with all operators, they can be ordered as a ready to install complete device or as modular components. Field convertible from maintained to momentary (available on maintained pushbuttons only) Customizable laser engraving on all buttons More than five million mechanical operations on momentary and one million on maintained pushbuttons Modular construction makes assembly fast and simplifies stocking of components and complete devices Capable of communicating via ASi protocol with ASi adapter modules Protection Type IP67, IP69K NEMA 4, 3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-77

78 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Mushroom Head Pushbuttons Bezel M22 = Silver M22S = Black perator Type DP = Non-illuminated momentary mushroom head pushbutton DRP = Non-illuminated maintained mushroom head pushbutton M22 DP R GB4 K0 perator Color R = Red S = Black G = Green Y = Yellow ETCH = Custom GB0 = STP GB = START GB3 = UP GB4 = DWN GB5 = FF GB6 = N GB5 = FRWARD GB6 = REVERSE Plate Inscription 0 = = 4 = 5 = 6 = 7 = When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DP-R-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. Contact Blocks K0 = NC K0 = N K =N-NC K2 = N-2NC V7-T-78 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

79 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Product Selection Mushroom Head Pushbuttons, Momentary M22-DP-R-K0 M22S-DP-R-K0 M22-DP-G M22S-DP-G Complete Devices Bezel Button Color perators nly 2 Bezel Button Color Notes 35 mm diameter mushroom head button. 2 Includes contact block mounting adapter. Contact Block Configuration 2 Silver Red NC M22-DP-R-K0 2NC M22-DP-R-K02 N-2NC M22-DP-R-K2 N-NC M22-DP-R-K Black Red NC M22S-DP-R-K0 2NC M22S-DP-R-K02 N-2NC M22S-DP-R-K2 N-NC M22S-DP-R-K Silver Black M22-DP-S Red M22-DP-R Green M22-DP-G Yellow M22-DP-Y Black Black M22S-DP-S Red M22S-DP-R Green M22S-DP-G Yellow M22S-DP-Y Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-79

80 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Mushroom Head Pushbuttons, Momentary Components M22-DP-G Mushroom Head Plates Color Inscription Black - M22-DP-S 2 Custom M22-DP-S-ETCH 3 STP M22-DP-S-GB0 START M22-DP-S-GB FRWARD M22-DP-S-GB5 REVERSE M22-DP-S-GB6 UP M22-DP-S-GB3 DWN M22-DP-S-GB4 FF M22-DP-S-GB5 N M22-DP-S-GB6 M22-DP-S-0 M22-DP-S- M22-DP-S-4 M22-DP-S-5 M22-DP-S-7 Red M22-DP-R 2 Custom M22-DP-R-ETCH 3 STP M22-DP-R-GB0 FF M22-DP-R-GB5 M22-DP-R-0 Green M22-DP-G 2 Custom M22-DP-G-ETCH 3 START M22-DP-G-GB N M22-DP-G-GB6 M22-DP-G-0 M22-DP-G- White M22-DP-W 2 Custom M22-DP-W-ETCH 3 Yellow M22-DP-Y 2 Custom M22-DP-Y-ETCH 3 Note: Included with operator. M22-DP-G- M22-K0 Insertless Mushroom Head perators Bezel Color Silver Black M22-DP-S- Red M22-DP-R- Green M22-DP-G- Yellow M22-DP-Y- Black Black M22S-DP-S- Red M22S-DP-R- Green M22S-DP-G- Yellow M22S-DP-Y- Contact Blocks 4 Terminal Type Contact Configuration 5 Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes 35 mm diameter mushroom head button. 2 Minimum order quantity of (0). 3 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DP-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 4 For complete listing of available contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 5 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-80 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

81 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Product Selection Non-Illuminated Mushroom Head Pushbuttons, Maintained 2 M22-DRP-R-K0 M22S-DRP-R-K0 M22-DRP-G M22S-DRP-G Complete Devices Bezel Button Color Contact Block Configuration 3 Silver Red NC M22-DRP-R-K0 2NC M22-DRP-R-K02 N-2NC M22-DRP-R-K2 N-NC M22-DRP-R-K Black Red NC M22S-DRP-R-K0 2NC M22S-DRP-R-K02 N-2NC M22S-DRP-R-K2 N-NC M22S-DRP-R-K perators nly Bezel Button Color Silver Black M22-DRP-S Red M22-DRP-R Green M22-DRP-G Yellow M22-DRP-Y Black Black M22S-DRP-S Red M22S-DRP-R Green M22S-DRP-G Yellow M22S-DRP-Y Notes 35 mm diameter mushroom head button. 2 Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 3 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. Note: This pilot device features a selectable function switch that enables the device to be set to either maintained or momentary operation. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-8

82 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Non-Illuminated Mushroom Head Pushbuttons, Maintained 2 Components M22-DP-G Mushroom Head Plates 5 Color Inscription Black M22-DP-S 3 Custom M22-DP-S-ETCH 4 STP M22-DP-S-GB0 START M22-DP-S-GB FRWARD M22-DP-S-GB5 REVERSE M22-DP-S-GB6 UP M22-DP-S-GB3 DWN M22-DP-S-GB4 FF M22-DP-S-GB5 N M22-DP-S-GB6 M22-DP-S-0 M22-DP-S- M22-DP-S-4 M22-DP-S-5 M22-DP-S-7 Red M22-DP-R 3 Custom M22-DP-R-ETCH 4 STP M22-DP-R-GB0 FF M22-DP-R-GB5 M22-DP-R-0 Green M22-DP-G 3 Custom M22-DP-G-ETCH 4 START M22-DP-G-GB N M22-DP-G-GB6 M22-DP-G-0 M22-DP-G- White M22-DP-W 3 Custom M22-DP-W-ETCH 4 Yellow M22-DP-Y 3 Custom M22-DP-Y-ETCH 4 Note: Included with operator. M22-DRP-G- M22-K0 Insertless Mushroom Head perators Bezel Color Silver Black M22-DRP-S- Red M22-DRP-R- Green M22-DRP-G- Yellow M22-DRP-Y- Black Black M22S-DRP-S- Red M22S-DRP-R- Green M22S-DRP-G- Yellow M22S-DRP-Y- Contact Blocks 5 Terminal Type Contact Configuration 6 Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes 35 mm diameter mushroom head button. 2 Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. 3 Minimum order quantity of (0). 4 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DP-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 5 For complete listing of available button plates and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 6 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-82 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

83 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Double Pushbuttons Product Description Eaton s M22 double pushbutton line is perfect for applications such as motor and pump starting, as well as anytime space is limited. In addition to the two buttons that fit in one 22 mm hole is the integrated white indicating light between them. These three operators allow for multiple functions to occur in a single space. Green/red, black/white and black/black color options along with laser engraving allow for further custom applications. Features Flush and extended, as well as color options allow for the perfect combination button Integrated indicating light adds even more functionality in one standard 22 mm hole Customizable laser engraving on all buttons LED offering only for improved brightness quality and up to 00,000 hours of operation More than 200,000 mechanical operations Capable of communicating via ASi protocol with ASi adapter modules Protection Type IP66 NEMA 4, 3 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Double Pushbuttons Bezel M22 = Silver M22S = Black perator Type DDL = Extended buttons and light DDLF = Flush buttons and light DDLM = Extended bottom button M22 DDL GR GB5 K0 G GR = WS = S = Button Plate Color Top Bottom Green White Black Red Black Black Inscription GB0 = STP GB = START GB3 = UP GB4 = DWN GB5 = FF GB6 = N GB4 = RESET GB5 = FRWARD GB6 = REVERSE 0 = = 5 = 5 = 6 = 7 = 5 = K0 = N K0 = NC K20 = 2N K02 = 2NC K = N-NC Contact Blocks K30 = 3N K03 = 3NC K2 = 2N-NC K2 = N-2NC Light Units 2 30 Vac/Vdc W = White R = Red G = Green B = Blue Vac 230W = White 230R = Red 230G = Green 230B = Blue Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-83

84 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Product Selection Components Double Pushbuttons, Extended Pushbuttons and Center Light, Momentary M22-DDL-GR-GB-GB0 M22S-DDL-GR--0 perators nly Color Inscription Bezel Top Bottom Top Bottom Silver Green Red M22-DDL-GR Custom Custom M22-DDL-GR-ETCH 2 M22-DDL-GR--0 START STP M22-DDL-GR-GB-GB0 White Black M22-DDL-WS Custom Custom M22-DDL-WS-ETCH 2 M22-DDL-WS--0 START STP M22-DDL-WS-GB-GB0 Black Black M22-DDL-S Custom Custom M22-DDL-S-ETCH 2 M22-DDL-S-4-5 M22-DDL-S-7-7 Black Green Red M22S-DDL-GR Custom Custom M22S-DDL-GR-ETCH 2 M22S-DDL-GR--0 START STP M22S-DDL-GR-GB-GB0 White Black M22S-DDL-WS Custom Custom M22S-DDL-WS-ETCH 2 M22S-DDL-WS--0 START STP M22S-DDL-WS-GB-GB0 Black Black M22S-DDL-S Custom Custom M22S-DDL-S-ETCH 2 M22S-DDL-S-4-5 M22S-DDL-S-7-7 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DDL-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. V7-T-84 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

85 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Double Pushbuttons, Flush Top Pushbuttons and Center Light, Momentary M22-DDLF-GR M22S-DDLF-GR--0 perators nly Color Inscription Bezel Top Bottom Top Bottom Silver Green Red M22-DDLF-GR Custom Custom M22-DDLF-GR-ETCH 2 White Black M22-DDLF-WS Custom Custom M22-DDLF-WS-ETCH 2 Green Red M22-DDLF-GR--0 White Black M22-DDLF-WS--0 Black Green Red M22S-DDLF-GR Custom Custom M22S-DDLF-GR-ETCH 2 White Black M22S-DDLF-WS Custom Custom M22S-DDLF-WS-ETCH 2 Green Red M22S-DDLF-GR--0 White Black M22S-DDLF-WS--0 Double Pushbuttons, Flush Top Pushbutton and Center Light, Extended Bottom Pushbutton, Momentary M22-DDLM-GR M22-DDLM-GR--0 perators nly Color Inscription Bezel Top Bottom Top Bottom Silver Green Red M22-DDLM-GR Custom Custom M22-DDLM-GR-ETCH 2 White Black M22-DDLM-WS Custom Custom M22-DDLM-WS-ETCH 2 Green Red M22-DDLM-GR--0 White Black M22-DDLM-WS--0 Black Green Red M22S-DDLM-GR Custom Custom M22S-DDLM-GR-ETCH 2 White Black M22S-DDLM-WS Custom Custom M22S-DDLM-WS-ETCH 2 Green Red M22S-DDLM-GR--0 White Black M22S-DDLM-WS--0 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-DDLM-GR-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-85

86 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Double Pushbuttons M22-LED-W max. 5mm thickness Note: Included with operator. Light Units M22-K0 Contact Blocks Terminal LED Light Unit Terminal Contact Type Color Voltage Type Configuration 2 Screw White 2 30 Vac/Vdc Vac M22-LED-W M22-LED230-W Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Notes For complete listing of available light units and contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-86 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

87 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Four-Way Pushbuttons Product Description Eaton s M22 four-way pushbutton is a truly unique offering. A four-way pushbutton offers four different buttons mounted in a single 22 mm hole. This is ideal not only for an application with limited space, but also directional applications (when ordered with the four arrow engraving option). Another unique option is the interlocked version, which prevents two opposite buttons from being actuated at the same time. Features Four buttons in one operator allows for increased functionality in limited space ptional interlocking option, which prevents two buttons from being actuated at the same time Customizable laser engraving on all buttons for directional or other applications Capable of communicating via ASi protocol with ASi adapter modules Protection Type IP66 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Four-Way Pushbuttons Bezel M22 = Silver M22S = Black perator Type D4 = Four-way pushbutton, momentary, non-interlocked DI4 = Four-way pushbutton, momentary, interlocked M22 D4 S 7 K0 Button Color S = Black Inscription ETCH = Custom 7 = When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-D4-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. K0 = N K0 = NC K20 = 2N K02 = 2NC K = N-NC Contact Blocks K30 =3N K03 =3NC K2 =2N-NC K2 =N-2NC Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-87

88 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Product Selection Four-Way Pushbuttons, Momentary Components M22-D4-S-7 M22-K0 perators nly Type Bezel Color Inscription Non-interlocked Silver Black M22-D4-S Contact Blocks 2 Custom M22-D4-S-ETCH 3 Directional arrows M22-D4-S-7 Black Black M22S-D4-S Custom M22S-D4-S-ETCH 3 Directional arrows M22S-D4-S-7 Interlocked Silver Black M22-DI4-S Terminal Type Custom M22-DI4-S-ETCH 3 Directional arrows M22-DI4-S-7 Black Black M22S-DI4-S Contact Configuration 4 max. 5mm thickness Custom M22S-DI4-S-ETCH 3 Directional arrows Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Note: Included with operator. M22S-DI4-S-7 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 For complete listing of available contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 3 When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-D4-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 4 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. V7-T-88 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

89 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Joysticks Product Description Eaton s M22 joystick line comes in a wide variety of options. From vertical and horizontal two-position switches to the maintained four-position, these operators fit a variety of applications. An additional option, two switch points, allows for eight isolated circuits to be actuated individually on a single operator. Product Selection Joysticks Components M22-WJ2H perators Bezel Features Available in four-position and two-position Two switch point option allows for two contacts in each direction (up to eight total contacts in one operator) Number of Directions Note Includes contact block mounting adapter. Switching Position Capable of communicating via ASi protocol with ASi adapter modules Protection Type IP66 Silver Two-position horizontal Momentary M22-WJ2H Two switch points M22-WJ2H-2P Two-position horizontal Maintained M22-WRJ2H Two-position vertical Momentary M22-WJ2V Two switch points M22-WJ2V-2P Two-position vertical Maintained M22-WRJ2V Four-position Momentary M22-WJ4 Two switch points M22-WJ4-2P Four-position Maintained M22-WRJ4 Black Two-position horizontal Momentary M22S-WJ2H Two switch points M22S-WJ2H-2P Two-position horizontal Maintained M22S-WRJ2H Two-position vertical Momentary M22S-WJ2V Two switch points M22S-WJ2V-2P Two-position vertical Maintained M22S-WRJ2V Four-position Momentary M22S-WJ4 Two switch points M22S-WJ4-2P Four-position Maintained M22S-WRJ4 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-89

90 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Joysticks max. 5mm thickness Note: Included with operator. M22-K0 Contact Blocks 2 Terminal Type Contact Configuration 3 Notes Includes contact block mounting adapter. 2 For complete listing of available contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 3 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. Screw N M22-K0 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC, late-break M22-K0D Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N M22-CK20 2NC M22-CK02 N-NC M22-CK Joystick with Double Contact The joystick allows the control of up to four directions of movement on machines. Different variants of the joystick have two/fourpositions and other variants have two settings for each position. This allows, for example, two-speed settings for each direction. For this application, a standard normally open contact and an early-make contact are fitted in series. Momentary contact and latching contact versions are available V7-T-90 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

91 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Potentiometers Product Description Eaton s M22 potentiometers allow for a ready to use operator in a conveniently sized package. M22 potentiometers include the resistive element, instead of just a knob, and a built in legend surrounding the knob. The slim design, with integrated contacts and the range of resistances available, allows for a quick install. Features Scale markings on the knob allows the operator to be used without an additional legend plate versized knob option available Slim design allows for space saving and simple wiring and installation Protection Type IP66 NEMA 4, 3 Product Selection Potentiometers M22-R0K Complete Devices Bezel Resistance Rk Silver M22-RK 4.7 M22-R4K7 0 M22-R0K 47 M22-R47K 00 M22-R00K 470 M22-R470K Black M22S-RK 4.7 M22S-R4K7 0 M22S-R0K 47 M22S-R47K 00 M22S-R00K 470 M22S-R470K versized Knob Silver M22-RK-RH 4.7 M22-R4K7-RH 0 M22-R0K-RH 47 M22-R47K-RH 00 M22-R00K-RH 470 M22-R470K-RH Black M22S-RK-RH 4.7 M22S-R4K7-RH 0 M22S-R0K-RH 47 M22S-R47K-RH 00 M22S-R00K-RH 470 M22S-R470K-RH Acoustic Devices Product Description Eaton s M22 acoustic devices are a simple and aesthetic way to add a buzzer or indicator to any application. Fitting in the same 22 mm hole, these devices can be ordered in continuous or pulsed tone and with or without the IP40 enclosure. Features Continuous or pulsed tone available 83dB/0 cm decibel rating Slim design allows for space saving and simple wiring and installation Protection Type IP40 NEMA 2 Product Selection Acoustic Devices M22-AMC-AM M22-AM Complete Devices Decibel Description Rating Indicator with buzzer, black continuous tone, 8 30 Vac/Vdc Indicator with buzzer, black pulsed tone, 8 30 Vac/Vdc Buzzers Description Indicator without buzzer, black Buzzer only, continuous tone, 8 30 Vac/Vdc Buzzer only, pulsed tone, 8 30 Vac/Vdc 83 db/ 0 cm 83 db/ 0 cm Decibel Rating 83 db/ 0 cm 83 db/ 0 cm 83 db/ 0 cm M22-AMC-AM M22-AMC-AMP M22-AMC M22-AM M22-AMP Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-9

92 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Through-the-Door perators Product Description Eaton s M22 through-the-door operators use the same familiar flush pushbutton look with the addition of a cut-to-length rod that allows for a simple reset operator. Features Customizable laser engraving on all buttons More than five million mechanical operations Pushrod can be cut to length Protection Type IP67, IP69K NEMA 4, 3 Product Selection Through-the-Door perators M22-DZ-B-6 M22-DZ- M22-D-B Complete Devices Color Inscription Blue M22-DZ-B RESET M22-DZ-B-GB4 M22-DZ-B-6 Red M22-DZ-R M22-DZ-R-0 STP M22-DZ-R-GB0 Buttonless perator Bezel Silver M22-DZ- Button Plates 2 Color Inscription Blue M22-D-B 3 RESET M22-D-B-GB4 M22-D-B-6 Red M22-D-R 3 M22-D-R-0 STP M22-D-R-GB0 Bulkhead Interfaces Product Description Eaton s M22 bulkhead interfaces are another unique offering in the M22 line. This device allows for a secure connection to any USB or RJ45 connected device within an enclosure or panel. With an IP65 rating when closed, these devices are not only convenient, but robust and reliable. Features Convenient and safe way to make a data connection to inside of the panel without opening the panel door Protection Type IP65 when closed, IP20 when connected Product Selection Bulkhead Interfaces M22-USB-SA M22-RJ45-SA USB Socket 45 Description Used for USB connection USB 2.0 Type A plug IP65 when closed IP20 when connected RJ45 Socket 6 Description Used for RJ45 Ethernet connection IP65 when closed IP20 when connected Notes The pushrod is 3.24 in long and can be cut to length. 2 Any combination of plate color and inscription is available. 3 Minimum order quantity of (0). 4 USB interface is complete with 2-ft-long USB cable. 5 USB interface is not UL Listed or CSA approved. 6 RJ45 interface is an eight-wire connector. M22-USB-SA M22-RJ45-SA V7-T-92 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

93 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 ASi Adapter Modules Product Description Eaton s M22 ASi adapter modules add functionality to every operator in the M22 line. These devices can be connected to any operator that uses contact blocks or LED units. The simple snapon design allows for a quick integration of an entire application of operators to a communicating network. Features Allows compatible operators to communicate on an ASi network Not only can the status of a contact block be read, but LEDs can be illuminated by an ASi adapter ASi adapters simply clip on to the back of the contact blocks and LEDs Insulation displacement connectors allow for installation of adapters without any tools Two integrated LEDs indicate status of communications Protection Type IP20 Product Selection ASi Adapter Modules M22-ASI Complete Devices Description ASi adapter module ASi adapter module for base mounting ASi adapter module for E-stop ASi adapter module for E-stop base mounting M22-ASI M22-ASI-C M22-ASI-S M22-ASI-CS Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-93

94 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Palm Switches Product Description Eaton s M22 palm switches are an oversized button that mount directly to an enclosure base. This allows for a standalone button that can be mounted anywhere. The enclosure uses basemounted contact blocks, which allows for quick wiring and mounting. The palm switches come in momentary or maintained versions. As with other M22 operators, the palm switches are available as complete devices, including the enclosure and contact blocks or as modular components. Features versized operator in black, red and yellow color options Button integrated directly into an enclosure Base mounting contact blocks allow for simple wiring and installation More than one million mechanical operations on momentary and 00,000 on maintained operators Protection Type IP67, IP69K NEMA 4, 3 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Palm Switches, Type 4/3 Enclosure perator Type FAK = Palm switch Product Selection Complete Devices FAK-S-KC-I FAK-R-V-KC0-IY perator Color S = Black R = Red Y = Yellow FAK S KC0 I perator, Base and Contact Blocks Button Color Contact Blocks KC0 = N KC0 = NC CKC0 = N CKC0 = NC Contact Block Configuration 2 Notes For complete listing of available contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. Enclosure Top Color I = Gray IY = Yellow Momentary Black N-NC FAK-S-KC-I Red N-NC FAK-R-KC-I Yellow N-NC FAK-Y-KC-I Maintained Red NC FAK-R-V-KC0-IY 2NC FAK-R-V-KC02-IY N-2NC FAK-R-V-KC2-IY N-NC FAK-R-V-KC-IY V7-T-94 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

95 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Components FAK-S FAK-IU M22-KC0 perators nly Type Button Color Momentary Black FAK-S Palm Switch Enclosure Base Contact Blocks Red Yellow Notes For complete listing of available contact blocks, see Accessories, Pages V7-T-96 to V7-T-0. 2 All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. FAK-R FAK-Y Maintained Red FAK-R-V-Y FAK-IU Terminal Type Contact Configuration 2 Screw N M22-KC0 NC M22-KC0 Spring-cage N M22-CKC0 NC M22-CKC0 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-95

96 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Accessories M22-D-S M22-DH-R M22-DP-G Button Plates Color Inscription Flush Pushbutton Note Refer to the Symbols Library, (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2), for symbol image. Extended Pushbutton Mushroom Head Button Black M22-D-S M22-DH-S M22-DP-S White M22-D-W M22-DH-W M22-DP-W Red M22-D-R M22-DH-R M22-DP-R Green M22-D-G M22-DH-G M22-DP-G Yellow M22-D-Y M22-DH-Y M22-DP-Y Blue M22-D-B M22-DH-B Black, white, red, green, yellow, blue M22-D-SWRGYB M22-DH-SWRGYB Black, red, green M22-D-SRG M22-DH-SRG Black Custom M22-D-S-ETCH M22-DH-S-ETCH M22-DP-S-ETCH White Custom M22-D-W-ETCH M22-DH-W-ETCH M22-DP-W-ETCH Red Custom M22-D-R-ETCH M22-DH-R-ETCH M22-DP-R-ETCH Green Custom M22-D-G-ETCH M22-DH-G-ETCH M22-DP-G-ETCH Yellow Custom M22-D-Y-ETCH M22-DH-Y-ETCH M22-DP-Y-ETCH Blue Custom M22-D-B-ETCH M22-DH-B-ETCH Black STP M22-D-S-GB0 M22-DH-S-GB0 M22-DP-S-GB0 Red STP M22-D-R-GB0 M22-DH-R-GB0 M22-DP-R-GB0 Black START M22-D-S-GB M22-DH-S-GB M22-DP-S-GB White START M22-D-W-GB M22-DH-W-GB Green START M22-D-G-GB M22-DH-G-GB M22-DP-G-GB Black CLSE M22-D-S-GB2 M22-DH-S-GB2 Black UP M22-D-S-GB3 M22-DH-S-GB3 M22-DP-S-GB3 Black DWN M22-D-S-GB4 M22-DH-S-GB4 M22-DP-S-GB4 Black FF M22-D-S-GB5 M22-DH-S-GB5 M22-DP-S-GB5 Red FF M22-D-R-GB5 M22-DH-R-GB5 M22-DP-R-GB5 Black N M22-D-S-GB6 M22-DH-S-GB6 M22-DP-S-GB6 Green N M22-D-G-GB6 M22-DH-G-GB6 M22-DP-G-GB6 Black TEST M22-D-S-GB9 M22-DH-S-GB9 Blue RESET M22-D-B-GB4 M22-DH-B-GB4 Black FRWARD M22-D-S-GB5 M22-DH-S-GB5 M22-DP-S-GB5 Black REVERSE M22-D-S-GB6 M22-DH-S-GB6 M22-DP-S-GB6 Black RAISE M22-D-S-GB7 M22-DH-S-GB7 Black LWER M22-D-S-GB8 M22-DH-S-GB8 Black M22-D-S-0 M22-DH-S-0 M22-DP-S-0 Red M22-D-R-0 M22-DH-R-0 M22-DP-R-0 Green M22-DP-G-0 Black M22-D-S- M22-DH-S- M22-DP-S- White M22-D-W- M22-DH-W- Green M22-D-G- M22-DH-G- M22-DP-G- Black M22-D-S-2 M22-DH-S-2 Green M22-D-G-2 M22-DH-G-2 Black M22-D-S-4 M22-DH-S-4 M22-DP-S-4 Black M22-D-S-5 M22-DH-S-5 M22-DP-S-5 Blue M22-D-B-6 M22-DH-B-6 Black M22-D-S-7 M22-DH-S-7 M22-DP-S-7 Black M22-D-S-8 M22-DH-S-8 Black See below M22-D-S-9 M22-DH-S-9 Black See below M22-D-S-0 M22-DH-S-0 Black See below M22-D-S- M22-DH-S- Black See below M22-D-S-2 M22-DH-S-2 Black See below M22-D-S-3 M22-DH-S-3 Black See below M22-D-S-4 M22-DH-S-4 Black See below M22-D-S-5 M22-DH-S-5 Black See below M22-D-S-6 M22-DH-S-6 Black See below M22-D-S-7 M22-DH-S-7 V7-T-96 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

97 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 M22-DLH-W M22-DL-G M22-A M22-A4 M22-LS M22-K0 Button Lenses Color Mounting Adapters Description Contact Blocks Mounting Location Terminal Type Notes All NC contact blocks are positively driven contact. 2 Not stackable. Inscription Flush Extended Color Inscription Flush Extended White M22-DL-W M22-DLH-W Blue Custom M22-DL-B-ETCH M22-DLH-B-ETCH Red M22-DL-R M22-DLH-R Red STP M22-DL-R-GB0 M22-DLH-R-GB0 Green M22-DL-G M22-DLH-G Green START M22-DL-G-GB M22-DLH-G-GB Yellow M22-DL-Y M22-DLH-Y Red FF M22-DL-R-GB5 M22-DLH-R-GB5 Blue M22-DL-B M22-DLH-B Green N M22-DL-G-GB6 M22-DLH-G-GB6 White Custom M22-DL-W-ETCH M22-DLH-W-ETCH Blue RESET M22-DL-B-GB4 M22-DLH-B-GB4 Red Custom M22-DL-R-ETCH M22-DLH-R-ETCH Red M22-DL-R-0 M22-DLH-R-0 Green Custom M22-DL-G-ETCH M22-DLH-G-ETCH Green M22-DL-G- M22-DLH-G- Yellow Custom M22-DL-Y-ETCH M22-DLH-Y-ETCH Blue M22-DL-B-6 M22-DLH-B-6 Contact block mounting adapter Contact block mounting adapter, four-position (for use with four-way pushbuttons, joysticks and four-position selector switches only). Allows mounting of M22 pushbuttons to LS-Titan limit switch bodies (for the full LS-Titan catalog section, see PG E). M22-A M22-A4 M22-LS Contact Configuration Package Qty. Front Screw N M22-K0 N 25 M22-K0-B25 N 00 M22-K0-B00 N, early-make M22-K0P NC M22-K0 NC 25 M22-K0-B25 NC 00 M22-K0-B00 NC, late-break M22-K0D SMCB, NC M22-K0SMC0 SMCB, 2NC M22-K02SMC0 Base N M22-KC0 N 25 M22-KC0-B25 N 00 M22-KC0-B00 NC M22-KC0 NC 25 M22-KC0-B25 NC 00 M22-KC0-B00 SMCB, NC M22-KC0SMC0 SMCB, 2NC M22-KC02SMC0 Front Spring-cage N M22-CK0 NC M22-CK0 NC, late-break M22-CK0D 2N 2 M22-CK20 2NC 2 M22-CK02 N-NC 2 M22-CK Base N M22-CKC0 NC M22-CKC0 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-97

98 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 M22-LED-W M22-LED60 Light Units Terminal Type Mounting Location LED Color Light Unit Voltage Screw Front White 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-LED-W Red M22-LED-R Green M22-LED-G Blue M22-LED-B White Vac M22-LED230-W Red M22-LED230-R Green M22-LED230-G Blue M22-LED230-B White Vac M22-LED230H-W Red M22-LED230H-R Green M22-LED230H-G Blue M22-LED230H-B Base White 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-LEDC-W Red M22-LEDC-R Green M22-LEDC-G Blue M22-LEDC-B White Vac M22-LEDC230-W Red M22-LEDC230-R Green M22-LEDC230-G Blue M22-LEDC230-B White Vac M22-LEDC230H-W Red M22-LEDC230H-R Green M22-LEDC230H-G Blue M22-LEDC230H-B Spring-cage Front White 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-CLED-W Red M22-CLED-R Green M22-CLED-G Blue M22-CLED-B White Vac M22-CLED230-W Red M22-CLED230-R Green M22-CLED230-G Blue M22-CLED230-B Base White 2 30 Vac/Vdc M22-CLEDC-W Red M22-CLEDC-R Green M22-CLEDC-G Blue M22-CLEDC-B White Vac M22-CLEDC230-W Red M22-CLEDC230-R Green M22-CLEDC230-G Blue M22-CLEDC230-B LED Resistor and Test Elements Terminal Type Mounting Location Element Type Voltage Screw Front Resistor Vac/Vdc M22-LED Vdc M22-LED220 Test Vac/Vdc M22-LED-T Vac M22-LED230-T Notes Resistor units to be used with 2 30V light units. 2 Refer to IL E for use of resistor elements in series for higher DC voltage. V7-T-98 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

99 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 M22S-ST- M22-ST-GB0 Legend Plate Holders and Inserts, Pushbuttons and Double Pushbuttons 2 Description Inscription Legend plate holder, without legend plate insert, M22S-ST- for pushbuttons Legend plate holder, without legend plate insert, M22S-STDD- for double pushbuttons Legend plate insert M22-ST Custom M22-ST-ETCH STP M22-ST-GB0 START M22-ST-GB FF M22-ST-GB5 N M22-ST-GB6 RUN M22-ST-GB7 FAULT M22-ST-GB8 FF N M22-ST-GB0 MAN. AUT M22-ST-GB MAN. AUT M22-ST-GB2 HAND AUT M22-ST-D HAND AUT M22-ST-D2 M22-ST-52 2 M22-ST-53 I M22-ST-88 - I M22-ST-89 I II M22-ST-93 Notes When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-D-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 2 Legend plates are IP66 and NEMA 4/3. Example To order a legend plate for a pushbutton with non-standard markings (FRWARD):. Select legend plate holder M22S-ST-. 2. Select legend plate insert M22-ST-ETCH. 3. Select FRWARD from the Symbols Library, Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2, identified by GB5 suffix. 4. Indicate on the order form in the order notes suffix GB5, line item #. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-99

100 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 M22S-ST-GB0 M22-ZK M22-YK M22-BK M22-CK Legend Plates, Complete 2 Description Inscription For use with pushbuttons Legend plate holder with insert STP M22S-ST-GB0 and indicating lights START M22S-ST-GB FF M22S-ST-GB5 N M22S-ST-GB6 RUN M22S-ST-GB7 FAULT M22S-ST-GB8 M22S-ST-52 2 M22S-ST-53 Selector switches FF N M22S-ST-GB0 MAN. AUT M22S-ST-GB MAN. AUT M22S-ST-GB2 HAND AUT M22S-ST-D HAND AUT M22S-ST-D2 I M22S-ST-88 - I M22S-ST-89 I II M22S-ST-93 Emergency-stop operators Rectangular yellow legend plate M22-ZK Custom M22-ZK-ETCH EMERGENCY-STP M22-ZK-GB99 Four-way pushbutton, joystick and four-position selector switches Square yellow legend plate M22-YK M22-YK-ETCH EMERGENCY-STP four-language M22-YK EMERGENCY-STP (top and bottom) M22-YK5 Round yellow legend plate, 90 mm M22-AK Custom M22-AK-ETCH EMERGENCY-STP four-language M22-AK EMERGENCY-STP (top and bottom) M22-AK5 Round yellow legend plate, 60 mm M22-BK Custom M22-BK-ETCH EMERGENCY-STP four-language M22-BK EMERGENCY-STP (top and bottom) M22-BK5 Silver square legend plate M22-CK Custom M22-CK-ETCH Four directional arrows M22-CK M22-CK2 Two directional arrows M22-CK3 Notes When ordering, specify inscription per catalog number suffix from the Symbols Library (see Pages V7-T-4 to V7-T-2) into the rder Notes. For example, M22-D-S-ETCH; rder Notes: Mark with symbol 9, Line item #_. 2 Legend plates are IP66 and NEMA 4/3. V7-T-00 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

101 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Surface Mounting Enclosures Description Selector Switch Accessories Description M22-IY-PG Yellow top, black base for emergency-stop operators M22-IY-PG M22-W Plunger bridge 2 M22-W M22-WS Key cover M22-WS M22-IY-PG M22-EY ne-element enclosure Two-element enclosure Three-element enclosure Four-element enclosure Six-element enclosure M20 connecting screw M20 cord grip M22-I-PG M22-I2-PG M22-I3-PG M22-I4-PG M22-I6-PG M22-I V-M20 Flush Mounting Plates, Aluminum Finish Rating ne Hole Yellow paint for M22-EY emergency-stop operators Gray anodized IP65 M22-E Two Holes Gray anodized IP65 M22-E2 Three Holes Gray anodized IP65 M22-E3 Four Holes Gray anodized IP65 M22-E4 Five Holes Gray anodized IP65 M22-E5 Six Holes Anodized IP40 M22-E6 M22-C-R M22-C-Y M22-GWK Key withdraw adapter 3 Coding adapter Guard ring M22-C-R M22-C-Y M22-GWK Notes Requires use of base mounted contact blocks. 2 Plunger needed to actuate center-mounted contact blocks. Used for non-illuminated three-position selector switches only. 3 Enables a keyed selector switch to be set to user-selected key withdraw position. M22-H Shrouds, Plastic Description Rating ne-element IP55 M22-H Two-element IP55 M22-H2 Three-element IP55 M22-H3 Four-element IP40 M22-H4 Five-element IP40 M22-H5 Six-element IP40 M22-H6 Mounting plate M22-E5 Plaster keys for flush mounting M22-UPE Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-0

102 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Emergency Stop perator Accessories Description Voltage Mounting Accessories Description M22-GPV Yellow guard ring M22-GPV M22-TC and M22-TA Telescopic clip with top-hat rail Telescopic clip Telescopic clip extension M22-TC M22-TA M22-TCV M22G-GPV Gray guard ring M22G-GPV M22-IVS DIN rail mounting adapter M22-IVS M22-MGTA Rectangular guard M22-MGTA M22-GR Mounting ring M22-GR M22-PL-PV Sealing shroud M22-PL-PV M22-MS Mounting ring tool M22-MS M22-PV60-Y-20 Illuminated ring 24 Vac/Vdc M22-PV60-Y Vac M22-PV60-Y Vac M22-PV60-Y-230 M22S-R30 Adapter ring set for 30 mm holes M22S-R30 M22-B Blanking Plugs Color Gray Black M22-B M22S-B M22-T-D and M22-T-DD Protective Diaphragm For Use with Flush pushbuttons and indicating lights Double pushbuttons M22-T-D M22-T-DD M22-ADC4 Dust Covers Description Contact block dust cover perator dust cover, max three contact blocks perator dust cover, max four contact blocks M22-KDP M22-ADC M22-ADC4 Kits Description Includes one each: M22-W, M22-C-R, M22-C-Y, M22S-B, M22-A, M22-D-SWRGYB M22-KT V7-T-02 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

103 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Coding Adapter Guide Selector Switches Top (B) Bottom (A) Two-Position Selector Switch Top (B) Bottom (A) Function M22(S)-W(L)(K) M22(S)-WR(L)(K) Three-Position Selector Switch Top (B) Bottom (A) Momentary Maintained Function Left Two-Position Key-perated Selector Switch Center Top (B) Bottom (A) Key Withdraw Three-Position Key-perated Selector Switch Left Top (B) Bottom (A) Function Right M22(S)-W(L)(K)3 Momentary Momentary M22(S)-WR(L)(K)3 Maintained Maintained M22(S)-WR(L)(K)3- Maintained M22(S)-WR(L)(K)3-2 Momentary Momentary Maintained Right Function M22(S)-WS Yes Momentary No M22(S)-WRS Yes Maintained Yes M22(S)-WRS-A Yes Maintained No Key Withdraw Key Withdraw Center Key Withdraw Right Function M22(S)-WS3 Momentary No Yes Momentary No M22(S)-WRS3 Maintained Yes Yes Maintained Yes M22(S)-WRS3-A Maintained No Yes Maintained No M22(S)-WRS3-A2 Maintained Yes Yes Maintained No M22(S)-WRS3-A3 Maintained No Yes Maintained Yes M22(S)-WRS3-A4 Maintained Yes Yes Momentary No M22(S)-WRS3-A5 Maintained No Yes Momentary No M22(S)-WRS3-A6 Momentary No Yes Maintained Yes M22(S)-WRS3-A7 Momentary No Yes Maintained No Key Withdraw Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-03

104 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Technical Data and Specifications Pushbuttons, Indicating Lights, Selector Switches and Emergency-Stop perators Description General Momentary Pushbuttons Standards IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #E2984 Maintained Pushbuttons IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #E2984 Indicating Lights, Buzzers and Potentiometers IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #E2984 Emergency-Stop perators IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #34049 Selector Switches IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #E2984 Key-perated perators IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #E2984 Lifespan, mechanical perations x 0 6 >5 > >0. >0. >0. >0.2 perating frequency perations/h >3600 >800 >600 >2000 >00 >3600 Actuating force n >5 >5 >50 >5 perating torque Nm >0.3 >0.5 (screw terminals) Protection Type IP IP67, IP69K IP67, IP69K Indicating lights: IP67, 69K IP67, IP69K IP66 IP66 IP66 Buzzers: IP40 Potentiometers: IP66 UL type 4, 3 4, 3 Indicating lights: 4/3 Buzzers: 2 Potentiometers: 4/3 4, 3 4, 3 4, 3 4, 3 Climatic proofing Damp heat, constant, according to IEC Damp heat, cyclical to IEC Ambient temperature, operating F ( C) 3 to 58 ( 25 to 70) 3 to 58 ( 25 to 70) 3 to 58 ( 25 to 70) 3 to 58 ( 25 to 70) 3 to 58 ( 25 to 70) 3 to 58 ( 25 to 70) Double Pushbuttons IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #E to 58 ( 25 to 70) Mounting position As required As required As required As required As required As required As required Mechanical shock g >30 >30 >30 >50 >30 >30 >30 resistance to IEC shock duration ms, half-sinusoidal Terminal Capacities Solid AWG 20-6 mm Stranded AWG 20-6 mm Contacts Rated impulse withstand U imp Vac 4000 voltage Rated insulation voltage U i V 2500 vervoltage category/ pollution degree III/3 V7-T-04 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

105 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Contact Blocks and Light Units Description General Contact Blocks Standards IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #E2984 LED Light Units IEC/EN VDE 0660 UL #E2984 Lifespan, mechanical perations x 0 6 >5 perating frequency perations/h >3600 Actuating force n >5 perating torque (screw terminals) Nm <0.8 Protection Type IP IP20 IP20 UL type Climatic proofing Damp heat, constant, according to IEC Damp heat, cyclical to IEC Ambient temperature, operating F ( C) 3 to 58 ( 25 to 70) 3 to 58 ( 25 to 70) Mounting position As required As required Mechanical shock resistance to g >30 >30 IEC shock duration ms, half-sinusoidal Terminal Capacities Solid AWG mm Stranded AWG mm Contacts Rated impulse withstand voltage U imp Vac Rated insulation voltage U i V vervoltage category/ III/3 III/3 pollution degree NEMA contact ratings A600, Q300 Current draw 5 5 ma Control Circuit Reliability at 24 Vdc/5 ma H F Fault probability <0-7, < fault in 0 7 operations at 5 Vdc/ ma H F Fault probability <5 x 0-6, < fault in 5 x 0 6 operations Max. Short-Circuit Protective Device Fuse gg/gl A 0 Switching Capacity Rated perational Current AC-5 5V I e A 6 230V I e A 6 400V I e A 4 500V I e A 2 DC-3 24V I e A 3 42V I e A.7 60V I e A.2 0V I e A V I e A 0.3 Lifespan, Electrical AC-5 230V/0.5A perations x V/.0A perations x V/3.0A perations x DV-3 2V/2.8A perations x Contact Element Note: >200 Vac/60 Hz: 25/55 C Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-05

106 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Palm Switches Description Momentary Maintained FAK-R-V-KC-I General Standards IEC/EN VDE 0660 IEC/EN VDE 0660 IEC/EN VDE 0660 Lifespan, mechanical perations x 0 6 > >0. >0. perating frequency perations/h >3600 >600 >600 Actuating force n perating torque Nm Degree of protection, IEC/EN IP IP67, IP69K IP67, IP69K IP65 UL Type 4, 3 4, 3 4, 3 Climatic proofing Damp heat, constant, to IEC Damp heat, cyclic, to IEC Ambient temperature, operating F ( C) 73 to 04 ( 25 to 40) 73 to 04 ( 25 to 40) 73 to 04 ( 25 to 40) Mounting position As required Mechanical shock resistance to IEC shock duration ms, half-sinusoidal g >5 >5 >5 ASi Adapter Modules Description M22-ASI M22-ASI-C General Standards IEC/EN 60947, DIN EN Radio interference suppression EN 550, EN IEC/EN 60947, DIN EN EN 550, EN Limit value class Protection type IP20 IP00 Climatic proofing Damp heat, constant, to IEC , cyclical, to IEC Ambient temperature, operating F ( C) 3 to 3 ( 25 to 55) 3 to 3 ( 25 to 55) Shock resistance shock duration ms g >30 >30 Vibration to IEC Hz (amplitude mm) Dimensions mm Weight kg Mounting Front mounting Front mounting Mounting position As required As required Power Supply Rated voltage to AS-interface Vdc specification Connection technique Yellow plug-in terminal as insulation Two cables onboard piercing terminal Power supply Completely from the AS-interface cable Addressing Via connection to AS-interface cable Total power consumption of ma >40 >40 the AS-interface AS-interface Rated operational current at full load ma Rated operational current when idle ma (no I, set) Status LEDs PWER AS-interface cable: green LED on the rear side of the element PWER AS-interface cable: green LED on the board ERRR AS-interface, AS-interface master failure: red LED on the rear side of the element ERRR AS-interface, AS-interface master failure: red LED on the board V7-T-06 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

107 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 ASi-S Adapter Modules Description M22-ASI-S M22-ASI-CS Inputs Inputs, protected against Number Two (normally 22V/5 ma) Two (normally 22V/5 ma) short-circuit Voltage range Vdc Rated current per input ma High signal level V Low signal ma Length of connecting cables cm utputs utputs, protected against Number ne (normally 9V/8 ma) ne (normally 9V/8 ma) short-circuit Voltage range Vdc Max. Current Carrying Capacity All outputs S three external outputs Length of connecting cables cm Profile S-3.A.E S-3.A.E Specification Addresses Number Emergency-Stop Circuits Connection of the AS-interface line Yellow plug terminal with insulation Two cables on the circuit board piercing Power supply Complete from AS-interface, cable Vdc Complete from AS-interface, cable Vdc Fixing Front mounted Base mounted Addressing Via AS-interface cable Via AS-interface cable Max. total current A 45 ma 45 ma Ambient temperature, operating F ( C) 3 to 3 ( 25 to 55) 3 to 3 ( 25 to 55) Shock resistance 30g/ ms as per IEC g/ ms as per IEC Protection type IP20 IP00 Climatic proofing Damp heat, constant, to IEC , cyclical, to IEC Mounting position As required As required Standards EN 5078 EN Inputs Two-channel input (22V/5 ma) (moduled by code sequence) (two break contact sets M22-K0) utputs ne output, typically 9V/8 ma, short-circuit proof Status Displays Damp heat, constant, to IEC , cyclical, to IEC EN 5078 EN Two-channel input (22V/5 ma) (moduled by code sequence) (two break contact sets M22-K0) ne output, typically 9V/8 ma, short-circuit proof Power, AS-interface cable Green LED on the back Green LED on the back AS-interface error, Red LED on the back Red LED on the back AS-interface master failure Profile S-7.B.E S-7.B.E Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-07

108 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) perators and Indicating Lights M22 x 0.06 (.5) Ø.7 (29.7) 0.04 () 0.24 (6) Pushbuttons M22 -D-_ 0.39 (0) 0.75 (9) Ø.6 (29.5) M22 -DH-_.7 (29.7) Selector Switches perators M22 -W-_ M22 -WL-_ 0.39 (0) 0.65 (6.4) 0.93 (23.7).06 (26.9) M22-DG(L)-_ Ø.7 (29.7) 0.65 (6.5) M22-D, Base Mounted M22 -DD-_ 2.5 (54.7) 0.52 (3.2) Key-perated Selector Switches M22 -W(R)S-_ Ø.7 (29.7) 0.8 (20.6).88 (47.75).47 (37.2) Indicating Light M22-L_ >0.0 (0.3).78 (45.3) 0.04 () 0.45 (.5) V7-T-08 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

109 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Illuminated Pushbuttons M22 -DL-_ 0.39 (0) 0.65 (6.4) Mushroom Head Pushbutton M22 -DP-_ Ø.44 (36.5) 0.93 (23.6) Emergency-Stop perators M22-PV_ M22S-PV_ M22-PVL_ M22-PVS_ 2.96 (75.) Potentiometer M22(S)-R_.38 (35).5 (38).89 (47.9).5 (29.2).3 (32.9) M22 -DLH_ Contact Block Mounting Adapter M22-A_.77 (45).73 (44).8 (30) Front Mounted Centering Adapter M22-ZA 0.84 (2.4).8 (30) 0.7 (7.8) Front Mounted Indicating Light.8 (30).77 (45) Pushbutton, Complete Devices 0.39 (0) 0.39 (0) 0.39 (0) M22S-A 0.85 (2.5) 0.76 (9.3).77 (45) 2.8 (7).46 (37) A.8 (30) x M22-K_ 2 x M22-K_ x M22-CK_ 2 x M22-CK_ A.46 (37.2).46 (37.2).54 (39.0).54 (39.0) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-09

110 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) DIN-Rail Mounting Adapter 0.88 (22.4) 0.88 (22.4) M22-D... M22-L... M22-W... M22-P... Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights with M22-TC Telescopic Clip and M22-TVC Extension M22-D_ M22-L_ M22-W_ M22-P_ A Top-hat rail to IEC/EN Palm Switches 2.23 (56.7) 0.2 (3.) B C.39 (35.2) D E F 2.5 (54.5) 2.54 (64.5) 0.8 (4.5 (M4)) A B C D E F G H.77 (45) FAK_.36 (34.5).42 (36) (60 00) L (0) 0.79 (20) 3.35 (85) 3 x M20 lateral, x M6 in bottom (20) Ø94 M22-TC 0.8 (4.5).57 (40) 2.56 (65) 0.39 (0) 0.26 (6.5) 0.3 (7.5) 0.7 (8) 54 (39) G M5 x 20 M22-TCV 0.39 (0) H Front Mounted Mounting Plate M22-E_.3 (33) e a Catalog Number a e.42 (36) 2.2 (56) 2.83 (72) 0. (2.5) Base Mounted Surface Mounting Enclosure 4 x M4 x (3) Catalog Number a e M22-E(Y) 2.83 (72) 2.2 (56) M22-E (7) 6.0 (55) M22-E2 4.3 (05) 3.50 (89) M22-E (204) 7.40 (88) M22-E (38) 4.80 (22) M22-E (237) 8.70 (22) M22-I_ M20 Catalog Number M20.3 (33) b a.89 (48) M20 M20.73 (44) 3.5 (80) 0.7 (7.8) 2.2 (56) e M20/M25 Mounting Locations a b e Cable Entries M22-I(Y) 2.83 (72.0) M22-I (20.0) M22-I (53.0) M22-I (86.0) M22-I (252.0).68 (42.6) 3.37 (85.6) 4.67 (8.6) 5.97 (5.6) 8.57 (27.6) 2.30 (58.5) 4.9 (06.5) 5.49 (39.5) 6.79 (72.5) 9.39 (238.5) M (66.5) 2 x M6 3 x M20 2 x M25 2 x M20 3 x M20 2 x M25 2 x M20 2 x M25 4 x M20 2 x M20 2 x M25 4 x M20 2 x M20 2 x M25 4 x M20 V7-T-0 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

111 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Covers M22-H_ a2 M20 M20 M20 Connecting Screw 2.32 (59) 3.74 (95) Catalog Number a2 Cable Entry Style M22-H.65 (42) 3 x M20 ne-piece M22-H (75) 4 x M20 M22-H (08) 4 x M20 M22-H (4) 4 x M20 Split M22-H (74) 5 x M20 M22-HE6 8.5 (207) 6 x M20 M22-I Legend Plates M22S-ST-_ M22S-STDD-.38 (35) 0.59 (5).8 (30).8 (30) Mounting Hole with Lug Slot 0.3 (3.2) 0.95 (24.).08 (27.5).85 (47) 0.04 () 0.88 (22.3) 0.04 () 0.24 (6) Gasket. Shroud with Plaster Keys M22-UPE a (42) a (32) a2 M22-H (4) 2.2 (56) 2.76 (70) e e (3) 0.35 (9) 0.3 (8) M22-H... 2 Box for closing off when plastering. 3 Plaster thickness less than 8 mm. 4 Plaster thickness more than 8 mm M22-UPE 0.35 (9).02 (26) (8) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-

112 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Grid Dimension to IEC/EN (50).8 (30) Grid Dimension for Various Combinations B A Pushbutton Diaphragm Pushbutton diaphragm cannot be combined with label mount. A > B > M22(S)-_(IEC/EN 60947).8 (30.0).97 (50.0) RMQ-Titan min..8 (30.0).58 (40.0) M22-D_ + M22-T-D.30 (33.0).58 (40.0) M22-D(R)P_.50 (38.0).58 (40.0) M22-PV_.50 (38.0).58 (40.0) M22-PV(L) + M22-PL-PV.89 (48.0) 2.20 (56.0) M22-PV(L)(S_) + M22-D_.30 (33.0).58 (40.0) M22-DDL_.8 (30.0) 2.7 (55.0) M22-DDL_ + M22-T-DD.30 (33.0) 2.28 (58.0) M22-ST_.8 (30.0).97 (50.0) M22-STDD_.8 (30.0) 2.95 (75.0) M22-CK_.8 (30.0).77 (45.0) M22-CLED_.8 (30.0).77 (45.0) M22-AK_ 3.54 (90.0) 3.54 (90.0) M22-ZK_.30 (33.0) 2.04 (52.0) M22-BK_ 2.36 (60.0) 2.36 (60.0) M22-YK_.97 (50.0).97 (50.0) M22-D4 2.7 (55.0) 2.7 (55.0) M22-WR 4.97 (50.0).97 (50.0) M22-W J4.97 (50.0).97 (50.0) Grid Dimension for M22-DD_ Grid Dimension for M22-DDL_ b.73 (44).8 (30) a.8 (30) 2.48 (63) b 2.28 (58) 2.95 (75) Emergency Stop Sealing Cover Pushbutton Diaphragm M22-T-DD Pushbutton diaphragm cannot be combined with label mount. M22-PL-PV.26 (32) 0.4 (0.4) 2.03 (5.6).89 (48) V7-T-2 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

113 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Blanking Plugs M22 B-_.6 (29.5) Pushbutton Diaphragm M22-T-D M22-T-D.3 (33).3 (33) 0.67 (7) 0.9 (23) Guard Ring M22-GWK Ø.42 (36) Key Cover M22-WS 0.79 (20) 0.47 (2) 0.67 (7) 2.28 (58) 0.98 (25) M22-GPV R35 R (68).97 (50) 3.07 (78) 0.2 (5) Ø 0.98 (25) Emergency Stop Legend Plate M22-AK_ M22-(Y)ZK_ d= 0.03 (0.8).3 (33) 3.54 (90) M22-BK-_ M22-YK-_ Ø 0.89 (22.5) 0.3 (3.2) 0.49 (2.5).97 (50) Ø 2.36 (60) Joystick M22 W J_ 2.95 (75).8 (30) Four-Way Pushbutton M22 -D 4-_ 2.7 (55) 0.45 (.5) 0.65 (6.5).97 (50).97 (50) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-3

114 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Symbols Library Instructions for rdering Laser Inscriptions. Identify part number to be inscribed. 2. Pick symbol from library and identify suffix code associated with the symbol. 3. rder part number already listed in the catalog with -ETCH suffix. 4. When placing an order by fax or Vistaline on the Web, reference order item number and indicate appropriate suffix code. Example To order a green flush button plate with the inscription AUT HAND: rder : M22-D-G-ETCH (see Page V7-T-38). AUT HAND inscription is found on Page V7-T-8 in the Symbols Library, suffix code is 9. In the order notes, reference item number and suffix 9. Letter height 3 mm: max three lines, max. 2 characters per line. Letter height 5 mm: max. two lines, max. eight characters per line. Note: For symbols or text not found in the Symbols Library, please contact the Eaton Technical Resource Center at -877-ETN CARE ( ) or TRC@eaton.com. V7-T-4 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

115 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Letter Height Specifications: < five characters; letter height = 0.97 in (5 mm). > five characters; letter height = 0.8 in (3 mm). Text English Text German Inscription Catalog Number Suffix GB0 GB GB2 GB3 GB4 GB5 GB6 GB7 GB8 GB9 GB0 GB GB2 GB4 GB5 GB6 GB7 Inscription Text Size: 3 mm Max. eight characters in first line; 0 characters in second line; eight characters in third line. Catalog Number Suffix GB8 GB9 GB20 GB2 GB22 GB23 GB24 GB25 GB26 GB27 GB32 GB62 GB63 GB64 GB65 GB66 GB99 Inscription Text Size: 5 mm Max. five characters per line. Catalog Number Suffix D0 D D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D0 D D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 D20 D2 D22 D23 D24 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix D25 D28 D29 D30 D3 D32 D33 D34 D35 D36 D37 D38 D39 D40 D4 D42 D43 D44 D72 D73 D74 D75 D99 D00 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-5

116 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Letter Height Specifications: < five characters; letter height = 0.97 in (5 mm). > five characters; letter height = 0.8 in (3 mm). Text French Text Swedish Symbols Inscription Catalog Number Suffix F0 F F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9 F0 F F2 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9 F20 F67 F68 F99 Inscription Text Size: 3 mm Max. eight characters in first line; 0 characters in second line; eight characters in third line. Catalog Number Suffix S0 S S2 S3 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 S9 S0 S S2 S4 S5 S6 S7 S8 S9 S20 S2 S22 S23 S32 S45 S46 S99 Inscription Text Size: 5 mm Max. five characters per line. Catalog Number Suffix Inscription Catalog Number Suffix V7-T-6 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

117 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 26 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 40 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 54 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix Text Size: 3 mm Max. eight characters in first line; 0 characters in second line; eight characters in third line. Text Size: 5 mm Max. five characters per line. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-7

118 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 82 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 04 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 8 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix Text Size: 3 mm Max. eight characters in first line; 0 characters in second line; eight characters in third line. Text Size: 5 mm Max. five characters per line. V7-T-8 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

119 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 46 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 60 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 74 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix Text Size: 3 mm Max. eight characters in first line; 0 characters in second line; eight characters in third line. Text Size: 5 mm Max. five characters per line. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-9

120 .4 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 202 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 26 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 230 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix Text Size: 3 mm Max. eight characters in first line; 0 characters in second line; eight characters in third line. Text Size: 5 mm Max. five characters per line. V7-T-20 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

121 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22.4 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 258 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 265 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix 272 Inscription Catalog Number Suffix Text Size: 3 mm Max. eight characters in first line; 0 characters in second line; eight characters in third line. Text Size: 5 mm Max. five characters per line. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-2

122 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Contents Description 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Product Selection Guide Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Indicating Lights Emergency Stops Selector Switches Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Product verview Product Description Eaton s C22 compact pushbutton line offers an industry leading array of functional, attractive, and ergonomically designed all-in-one illuminated and non-illuminated pushbuttons, selector switches, emergency stops and indicating lights. The complete illuminated line is only offered in LED light units to ensure high-quality brightness and up to 00,000 hours of LED illumination. C22 operators are available with either a silver or black bezel and share the exact same front of the panel look and feel as Eaton s M22 line. The C22 s compact, all-in-one design with the contact block(s) and operators integral provides the user with a simple solution. Wide Product Breadth In addition to the standard compact offering of indicating lights and pushbuttons, Eaton s C22 offers keyed and non-keyed operators and emergency stops Hundreds of styles with standard laser etch markings with the ability to use custom M22 laser etched buttons in conjunction with C22 buttonless operators LED Indicators 00,000 hours of life in high-vibration environments Lenses specifically designed for LED illumination Rugged Design Pushbuttons (momentary) rated for 5 million mechanical operations and selector switches (non-keyed) rated for million mechanical operations All components have IP65 rating, and some carry IP67 and IP69K for washdown environment Page V7-T-24 V7-T-25 V7-T-34 V7-T-36 V7-T-39 V7-T-44 V7-T-46 Standards and Certifications All operators are IEC/EN VDE 0660, UL Listed, and CSA Certified. All operators carry an IP65, IP66, IP67 or IP69K rating. All products carry ratings of NEMA, 3R, 4, 2 and 3 V7-T-22 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

123 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Features Field convertible maintained pushbuttons from maintained to momentary Field convertible selector switches from momentary to maintained operation and vice versa LED offering only for all illuminated operators Laser engraved pushbuttons and lenses Heavy-duty construction with a minimum of IP65 and UL NEMA Type 4/3 on front of panel operators. Many operators even carry IP67 and IP69K, for the toughest applications Silver or black colored nylon bezels Notched hole mounting with anti-rotation tab and central nut mounting on each operator Pushbuttons (momentary) rated for 5 million mechanical operations and selector switches (non-keyed) rated for million mechanical operations Unique compact offerings, including keyed and nonkeyed operators and emergency stops Benefits Compact, all-in-one operator and contact block design simplifies product selection, inventory, and installation Field convertibility of pushbuttons and selector switches helps distributors and customers reduce inventory and increase functionality LED offering only for improved brightness quality and up to 00,000 hours of operation Plastic construction is corrosion resistant perators are designed for rugged environments, ideal for wash-down applications (reference each operator s IP ratings for ingress protection definition) Anti-rotation tab saves installation time and prevents operator rotation High mechanical and electrical life allows for use in tough and challenging applications Laser inscription capabilities allow for high quality, wear-resistant markings By having a compact design emergency stop, the C22 design eliminates the need for self-monitoring contact blocks Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-23

124 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Product Selection Guide Pushbuttons Description Non-illuminated, flush Non-illuminated, extended Illuminated, flush Illuminated, extended perator Momentary Maintained Momentary Maintained Momentary Maintained Momentary Maintained Product Selection Page V7-T-26 Page V7-T-27 Page V7-T-28 Page V7-T-29 Page V7-T-30 Page V7-T-3 Page V7-T-32 Page V7-T-33 Indicating Lights Description Indicating lights Product Selection Page V7-T-35 Emergency Stops Description Twist release Keyed-release Product Selection Page V7-T-37 Page V7-T-37 Selector Switches Description Non-illuminated, knob type Key-operated Product Selection Page V7-T-40 Page V7-T-4 V7-T-24 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

125 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Contents Description Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Non-Illuminated, Flush, Momentary Non-Illuminated, Flush, Maintained Non-Illuminated, Extended, Momentary..... Non-Illuminated, Extended, Maintained Illuminated, Flush, Momentary Illuminated, Flush, Maintained Illuminated, Extended, Momentary Illuminated, Extended, Maintained Indicating Lights Emergency Stops Selector Switches Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Page V7-T-26 V7-T-27 V7-T-28 V7-T-29 V7-T-30 V7-T-3 V7-T-32 V7-T-33 V7-T-34 V7-T-36 V7-T-39 V7-T-44 V7-T-46 Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Product Description Features Eaton s C22 Compact Field convertible Pushbuttons are a complete maintained pushbuttons line of monoblock type from maintained to pushbuttons with the contact momentary blocks, mounting adapter, and operator all-in-one. The C22 pushbuttons offer the same look and feel as their modular counterpart, the Laser engraved M22. They also carry many of pushbuttons and lenses the same rugged ratings and options, such as laser etching, field convertibility, and LED technology. Note: For additional accessories, please see Volume 7 Motor Controls, Logic and Connectivity, CA E, Tab 37, section 37.4, 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22. LED offering only for improved brightness quality and up to 00,000 hours of operation Pushbuttons (momentary) rated for 5 million mechanical operations Protection Type IP67/IP69K NEMA 4, 3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-25

126 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons Product Selection Non-Illuminated, Flush, Momentary C22(S)-D-_ Bezel C22 = Silver C22S = Black Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Momentary Button Color perator Type D = Flush, momentary DR = Flush, maintained DH = Extended, momentary DRH = Extended, maintained Button Etching C22 -D-G--K0 Contact Block Configuration Button Plate Color G =Green R =Red S =Black W =White = Buttonless Silver Bezel Button Etching 0 = = Black Bezel Green N C22-D-G-K0 C22S-D-G-K0 2N C22-D-G-K20 C22S-D-G-K20 N/NC C22-D-G-K C22S-D-G-K N C22-D-G--K0 C22S-D-G--K0 2N C22-D-G--K20 C22S-D-G--K20 N/NC C22-D-G--K C22S-D-G--K Red NC C22-D-R-K0 C22S-D-R-K0 2NC C22-D-R-K02 C22S-D-R-K02 N/NC C22-D-R-K C22S-D-R-K 0 NC C22-D-R-0-K0 C22S-D-R-0-K0 0 2NC C22-D-R-0-K02 C22S-D-R-0-K02 0 N/NC C22-D-R-0-K C22S-D-R-0-K Black NC C22-D-S-K0 C22S-D-S-K0 2NC C22-D-S-K02 C22S-D-S-K02 N/NC C22-D-S-K C22S-D-S-K 0 NC C22-D-S-0-K0 C22S-D-S-0-K0 0 2NC C22-D-S-0-K02 C22S-D-S-0-K02 0 N/NC C22-D-S-0-K C22S-D-S-0-K White N C22-D-W-K0 C22S-D-W-K0 2N C22-D-W-K20 C22S-D-W-K20 N/NC C22-D-W-K C22S-D-W-K N C22-D-W--K0 C22S-D-W--K0 2N C22-D-W--K20 C22S-D-W--K20 N/NC C22-D-W--K C22S-D-W--K Buttonless N C22-D--K0 C22S-D--K0 2N C22-D--K20 C22S-D--K20 NC C22-D--K0 C22S-D--K0 2NC C22-D--K02 C22S-D--K02 N/NC C22-D--K C22S-D--K Contact Blocks K0 =N K20 =2N K0 = NC K02 =2NC K =N/NC V7-T-26 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

127 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Non-Illuminated, Flush, Maintained C22(S)-DR-_ Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Maintained Button Color Button Etching Contact Block Configuration Silver Bezel Black Bezel Green N C22-DR-G-K0 C22S-DR-G-K0 2N C22-DR-G-K20 C22S-DR-G-K20 N/NC C22-DR-G-K C22S-DR-G-K N C22-DR-G--K0 C22S-DR-G--K0 2N C22-DR-G--K20 C22S-DR-G--K20 N/NC C22-DR-G--K C22S-DR-G--K Red NC C22-DR-R-K0 C22S-DR-R-K0 2NC C22-DR-R-K02 C22S-DR-R-K02 N/NC C22-DR-R-K C22S-DR-R-K 0 NC C22-DR-R-0-K0 C22S-DR-R-0-K0 0 2NC C22-DR-R-0-K02 C22S-DR-R-0-K02 0 N/NC C22-DR-R-0-K C22S-DR-R-0-K Black NC C22-DR-S-K0 C22S-DR-S-K0 2NC C22-DR-S-K02 C22S-DR-S-K02 N/NC C22-DR-S-K C22S-DR-S-K 0 NC C22-DR-S-0-K0 C22S-DR-S-0-K0 0 2NC C22-DR-S-0-K02 C22S-DR-S-0-K02 0 N/NC C22-DR-S-0-K C22S-DR-S-0-K White N C22-DR-W-K0 C22S-DR-W-K0 2N C22-DR-W-K20 C22S-DR-W-K20 N/NC C22-DR-W-K C22S-DR-W-K N C22-DR-W--K0 C22S-DR-W--K0 2N C22-DR-W--K20 C22S-DR-W--K20 N/NC C22-DR-W--K C22S-DR-W--K Buttonless N C22-DR--K0 C22S-DR--K0 2N C22-DR--K20 C22S-DR--K20 NC C22-DR--K0 C22S-DR--K0 2NC C22-DR--K02 C22S-DR--K02 N/NC C22-DR--K C22S-DR--K Note: Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-27

128 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Non-Illuminated, Extended, Momentary C22(S)-DH-_ Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Momentary Button Color Button Etching Contact Block Configuration Silver Bezel Black Bezel Green N C22-DH-G-K0 C22S-DH-G-K0 2N C22-DH-G-K20 C22S-DH-G-K20 N/NC C22-DH-G-K C22S-DH-G-K N C22-DH-G--K0 C22S-DH-G--K0 2N C22-DH-G--K20 C22S-DH-G--K20 N/NC C22-DH-G--K C22S-DH-G--K Red NC C22-DH-R-K0 C22S-DH-R-K0 2NC C22-DH-R-K02 C22S-DH-R-K02 N/NC C22-DH-R-K C22S-DH-R-K 0 NC C22-DH-R-0-K0 C22S-DH-R-0-K0 0 2NC C22-DH-R-0-K02 C22S-DH-R-0-K02 0 N/NC C22-DH-R-0-K C22S-DH-R-0-K Black NC C22-DH-S-K0 C22S-DH-S-K0 2NC C22-DH-S-K02 C22S-DH-S-K02 N/NC C22-DH-S-K C22S-DH-S-K 0 NC C22-DH-S-0-K0 C22S-DH-S-0-K0 0 2NC C22-DH-S-0-K02 C22S-DH-S-0-K02 0 N/NC C22-DH-S-0-K C22S-DH-S-0-K White N C22-DH-W-K0 C22S-DH-W-K0 2N C22-DH-W-K20 C22S-DH-W-K20 N/NC C22-DH-W-K C22S-DH-W-K N C22-DH-W--K0 C22S-DH-W--K0 2N C22-DH-W--K20 C22S-DH-W--K20 N/NC C22-DH-W--K C22S-DH-W--K V7-T-28 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

129 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Non-Illuminated, Extended, Maintained C22(S)-DRH-_ Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Maintained Button Color Button Etching Contact Block Configuration Silver Bezel Black Bezel Green N C22-DRH-G-K0 C22S-DRH-G-K0 2N C22-DRH-G-K20 C22S-DRH-G-K20 N/NC C22-DRH-G-K C22S-DRH-G-K N C22-DRH-G--K0 C22S-DRH-G--K0 2N C22-DRH-G--K20 C22S-DRH-G--K20 N/NC C22-DRH-G--K C22S-DRH-G--K Red NC C22-DRH-R-K0 C22S-DRH-R-K0 2NC C22-DRH-R-K02 C22S-DRH-R-K02 N/NC C22-DRH-R-K C22S-DRH-R-K 0 NC C22-DRH-R-0-K0 C22S-DRH-R-0-K0 0 2NC C22-DRH-R-0-K02 C22S-DRH-R-0-K02 0 N/NC C22-DRH-R-0-K C22S-DRH-R-0-K Black NC C22-DRH-S-K0 C22S-DRH-S-K0 2NC C22-DRH-S-K02 C22S-DRH-S-K02 N/NC C22-DRH-S-K C22S-DRH-S-K 0 NC C22-DRH-S-0-K0 C22S-DRH-S-0-K0 0 2NC C22-DRH-S-0-K02 C22S-DRH-S-0-K02 0 N/NC C22-DRH-S-0-K C22S-DRH-S-0-K White N C22-DRH-W-K0 C22S-DRH-W-K0 2N C22-DRH-W-K20 C22S-DRH-W-K20 N/NC C22-DRH-W-K C22S-DRH-W-K N C22-DRH-W--K0 C22S-DRH-W--K0 2N C22-DRH-W--K20 C22S-DRH-W--K20 N/NC C22-DRH-W--K C22S-DRH-W--K Note: Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-29

130 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Illuminated Pushbuttons Bezel C22 = Silver C22S = Black Product Selection Illuminated, Flush, Momentary C22(S)-DL-_ perator Type DL = Illuminated, flush, momentary DRL = Illuminated, flush, maintained DHL = Illuminated, extended, momentary DRHL = Illuminated, extended, maintained Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Momentary LED Color Button Color Voltage C22 -DL-G--K0-24 LED/Lens Color G = Green R =Red W =White B = Blue G = Green without lens R = Red without lens W = White without lens B = Blue without lens Button Etching Contact Block Configuration Lens Etching 0 = = Silver Bezel Contact Blocks K0 =N K0 =NC Black Bezel LED Voltage 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc 20 = 20 Vac 230 = 230 Vac Green Green 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DL-G-K0-24 C22S-DL-G-K Vac N C22-DL-G-K0-20 C22S-DL-G-K Vac N C22-DL-G-K0-230 C22S-DL-G-K Vac/Vdc N C22-DL-G--K0-24 C22S-DL-G--K Vac N C22-DL-G--K0-20 C22S-DL-G--K Vac N C22-DL-G--K0-230 C22S-DL-G--K0-230 Buttonless 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DL-G-K0-24 C22S-DL-G-K Vac N C22-DL-G-K0-20 C22S-DL-G-K Vac N C22-DL-G-K0-230 C22S-DL-G-K0-230 Red Red 24 Vac/Vdc NC C22-DL-R-K0-24 C22S-DL-R-K Vac NC C22-DL-R-K0-20 C22S-DL-R-K Vac NC C22-DL-R-K0-230 C22S-DL-R-K Vac/Vdc 0 NC C22-DL-R-0-K0-24 C22S-DL-R-0-K Vac 0 NC C22-DL-R-0-K0-20 C22S-DL-R-0-K Vac 0 NC C22-DL-R-0-K0-230 C22S-DL-R-0-K0-230 Buttonless 24 Vac/Vdc NC C22-DL-R-K0-24 C22S-DL-R-K Vac NC C22-DL-R-K0-20 C22S-DL-R-K Vac NC C22-DL-R-K0-230 C22S-DL-R-K0-230 White White 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DL-W-K0-24 C22S-DL-W-K Vac N C22-DL-W-K0-20 C22S-DL-W-K Vac N C22-DL-W-K0-230 C22S-DL-W-K Vac/Vdc N C22-DL-W--K0-24 C22S-DL-W--K Vac N C22-DL-W--K0-20 C22S-DL-W--K Vac N C22-DL-W--K0-230 C22S-DL-W--K0-230 Buttonless 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DL-W-K0-24 C22S-DL-W-K Vac N C22-DL-W-K0-20 C22S-DL-W-K Vac N C22-DL-W-K0-230 C22S-DL-W-K0-230 Blue Blue 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DL-B-K0-24 C22S-DL-B-K Vac N C22-DL-B-K0-20 C22S-DL-B-K Vac N C22-DL-B-K0-230 C22S-DL-B-K0-230 Buttonless 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DL-B-K0-24 C22S-DL-B-K Vac N C22-DL-B-K0-20 C22S-DL-B-K Vac N C22-DL-B-K0-230 C22S-DL-B-K0-230 V7-T-30 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

131 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Illuminated, Flush, Maintained C22(S)-DRL-_ Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Maintained LED Color Button Color Voltage Contact Block Configuration Silver Bezel Note: Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. Black Bezel Green Green 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRL-G-K0-24 C22S-DRL-G-K Vac N C22-DRL-G-K0-20 C22S-DRL-G-K Vac N C22-DRL-G-K0-230 C22S-DRL-G-K0-230 Buttonless 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRL-G-K0-24 C22S-DRL-G-K Vac N C22-DRL-G-K0-20 C22S-DRL-G-K Vac N C22-DRL-G-K0-230 C22S-DRL-G-K0-230 Red Red 24 Vac/Vdc NC C22-DRL-R-K0-24 C22S-DRL-R-K Vac NC C22-DRL-R-K0-20 C22S-DRL-R-K Vac NC C22-DRL-R-K0-230 C22S-DRL-R-K0-230 Buttonless 24 Vac/Vdc NC C22-DRL-R-K0-24 C22S-DRL-R-K Vac NC C22-DRL-R-K0-20 C22S-DRL-R-K Vac NC C22-DRL-R-K0-230 C22S-DRL-R-K0-230 White White 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRL-W-K0-24 C22S-DRL-W-K Vac N C22-DRL-W-K0-20 C22S-DRL-W-K Vac N C22-DRL-W-K0-230 C22S-DRL-W-K0-230 Buttonless 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRL-W-K0-24 C22S-DRL-W-K Vac N C22-DRL-W-K0-20 C22S-DRL-W-K Vac N C22-DRL-W-K0-230 C22S-DRL-W-K0-230 Blue Blue 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRL-B-K0-24 C22S-DRL-B-K Vac N C22-DRL-B-K0-20 C22S-DRL-B-K Vac N C22-DRL-B-K0-230 C22S-DRL-B-K0-230 Buttonless 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRL-B-K0-24 C22S-DRL-B-K Vac N C22-DRL-B-K0-20 C22S-DRL-B-K Vac N C22-DRL-B-K0-230 C22S-DRL-B-K0-230 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-3

132 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Illuminated, Extended, Momentary C22(S)-DLH-_ Illuminated Pushbuttons, Extended, Momentary LED Color Button Color Voltage Button Etching Contact Block Configuration Silver Bezel Black Bezel Green Green 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DLH-G-K0-24 C22S-DLH-G-K Vac N C22-DLH-G-K0-20 C22S-DLH-G-K Vac N C22-DLH-G-K0-230 C22S-DLH-G-K Vac/Vdc N C22-DLH-G--K0-24 C22S-DLH-G--K Vac N C22-DLH-G--K0-20 C22S-DLH-G--K Vac N C22-DLH-G--K0-230 C22S-DLH-G--K0-23 Red Red 24 Vac/Vdc NC C22-DLH-R-K0-24 C22S-DLH-R-K Vac NC C22-DLH-R-K0-20 C22S-DLH-R-K Vac NC C22-DLH-R-K0-230 C22S-DLH-R-K Vac/Vdc 0 NC C22-DLH-R-0-K0-24 C22S-DLH-R-0-K Vac 0 NC C22-DLH-R-0-K0-20 C22S-DLH-R-0-K Vac 0 NC C22-DLH-R-0-K0-230 C22S-DLH-R-0-K0-23 White White 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DLH-W-K0-24 C22S-DLH-W-K Vac N C22-DLH-W-K0-20 C22S-DLH-W-K Vac N C22-DLH-W-K0-230 C22S-DLH-W-K Vac/Vdc N C22-DLH-W--K0-24 C22S-DLH-W--K Vac N C22-DLH-W--K0-20 C22S-DLH-W--K Vac N C22-DLH-W--K0-230 C22S-DLH-W--K0-23 Blue Blue 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DLH-B-K0-24 C22S-DLH-B-K Vac N C22-DLH-B-K0-20 C22S-DLH-B-K Vac N C22-DLH-B-K0-230 C22S-DLH-B-K0-230 V7-T-32 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

133 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Illuminated, Extended, Maintained C22(S)-DRLH-_ Illuminated Pushbuttons, Flush, Maintained LED Color Button Color Voltage Button Etching Contact Block Configuration Silver Bezel Note: Maintained pushbuttons can be converted in the field to momentary operation by switching the locking ring, which is accessible through the side of the operator body. Black Bezel Green Green 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRLH-G-K0-24 C22S-DRLH-G-K Vac N C22-DRLH-G-K0-20 C22S-DRLH-G-K Vac N C22-DRLH-G-K0-230 C22S-DRLH-G-K Vac/Vdc N C22-DRLH-G--K0-24 C22S-DRLH-G--K Vac N C22-DRLH-G--K0-20 C22S-DRLH-G--K Vac N C22-DRLH-G--K0-230 C22S-DRLH-G--K0-230 Red Red 24 Vac/Vdc NC C22-DRLH-R-K0-24 C22S-DRLH-R-K Vac NC C22-DRLH-R-K0-20 C22S-DRLH-R-K Vac NC C22-DRLH-R-K0-230 C22S-DRLH-R-K Vac/Vdc 0 NC C22-DRLH-R-0-K0-24 C22S-DRLH-R-0-K Vac 0 NC C22-DRLH-R-0-K0-20 C22S-DRLH-R-0-K Vac 0 NC C22-DRLH-R-0-K0-230 C22S-DRLH-R-0-K0-230 White White 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRLH-W-K0-24 C22S-DRLH-W-K Vac N C22-DRLH-W-K0-20 C22S-DRLH-W-K Vac N C22-DRLH-W-K0-230 C22S-DRLH-W-K Vac/Vdc N C22-DRLH-W--K0-24 C22S-DRLH-W--K Vac N C22-DRLH-W--K0-20 C22S-DRLH-W--K Vac N C22-DRLH-W--K0-230 C22S-DRLH-W--K0-230 Blue Blue 24 Vac/Vdc N C22-DRLH-B-K0-24 C22S-DRLH-B-K Vac N C22-DRLH-B-K0-20 C22S-DRLH-B-K Vac N C22-DRLH-B-K0-230 C22S-DRLH-B-K0-230 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-33

134 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Indicating Lights Contents Description Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Indicating Lights Selection Product Selection Emergency Stops Selector Switches Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Page V7-T-25 V7-T-35 V7-T-35 V7-T-36 V7-T-39 V7-T-44 V7-T-46 Indicating Lights Product Description C22 indicating lights use a combination of a durable, bright LED unit and modern lenses designed specifically for this type of LED to create a bright and visible indicating light. As with the pushbuttons, the indicating light lenses can be laser etched, simply order without lens and order M22/C22 custom etched lenses to attach. Note: For additional accessories, please see Volume 7 Motor Controls, Logic and Connectivity, CA E, Tab 37, section 37.4, 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22. Features LED offering only for improved brightness quality and up to 00,000 hours of operation Lenses specifically designed for LED illumination Lenses capable of being laser etched for custom solutions that last Protection Type IP67/IP69K NEMA 4, 3 V7-T-34 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

135 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Indicating Lights Product Selection Indicating Lights C22-L-_ Bezel C22-L = Flush indicating light Indicating Lights Lens Color LED Color Voltage Green Green 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-G Vac C22-L-G Vac C22-L-G-230 Red Red 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-R Vac C22-L-R Vac C22-L-R-230 White White 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-W Vac C22-L-W Vac C22-L-W-230 Yellow White 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-Y Vac C22-L-Y Vac C22-L-Y-230 Blue Blue 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-B Vac C22-L-B Vac C22-L-B-230 Without Lens Green 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-G Vac C22-L-G Vac C22-L-G-230 Red 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-R Vac C22-L-R Vac C22-L-R-230 White 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-W Vac C22-L-W Vac C22-L-W-230 Blue 24 Vac/Vdc C22-L-B Vac C22-L-B Vac C22-L-B-230 Note Use white LED for both white and yellow lenses. C22 -L-G-24 LED/Lens Color G =Green R =Red W =White Y = Yellow B = Blue G = Green without lens R = Red without lens W = White without lens B = Blue without lens LED Voltage 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc 20 = 20 Vac 230 = 230 Vac Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-35

136 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Emergency Stops Contents Description Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Indicating Lights Emergency Stops Non-Illuminated, Twist-Release Non-Illuminated, Keyed-Release Selector Switches Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Page V7-T-25 V7-T-34 V7-T-37 V7-T-37 V7-T-39 V7-T-44 V7-T-46 Emergency Stops Product Description C22 emergency stops are a durable and reliable solution to a variety of e-stop applications. This compact e-stop, available as twist-torelease and keyed-release, is a simple product that eliminates the need for selfmonitoring contact blocks, all while still meeting almost all of the industry safety standards. Note: For additional accessories, please see Volume 7 Motor Controls, Logic and Connectivity, CA E, Tab 37, section 37.4, 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22. Features Available in both twistrelease and keyed-release with either 45 mm or 60 mm operators Protection Type Twist-Release IP67/IP69K Keyed-Release IP66 NEMA 4, 3 V7-T-36 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

137 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Emergency Stops Product Selection Non-Illuminated, Twist-Release C22-PVT_ Non-Illuminated, Keyed-Release C22-PVS_ perator Type PVT45P = Twist-release, 45 mm PVT60P = Twist-release, 60 mm PVS45P = Key-release, 45 mm PVS60P = Key-release, 60 mm C22 - PVS45P -MS-K0 Key Code MS =MS MS2 =MS2 MS3 =MS3 MS4 =MS4 MS5 =MS5 MS6 =MS6 MS7 =MS7 MS8 =MS8 RS = Ronis-445 Non-Illuminated Emergency Stops, Twist-Release Contact Block Release Method perator Size Configuration Non-Illuminated Emergency Stops, Keyed-Release Contact Block Release Method perator Size Key Code Configuration Twist-release 45 mm 2NC C22-PVT45P-K02 N/NC C22-PVT45P-K 60 mm 2NC C22-PVT60P-K02 N/NC C22-PVT60P-K Keyed-release 45 mm MS 2NC C22-PVS45P-MS-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-MS-K MS2 2NC C22-PVS45P-MS2-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-MS2-K MS3 2NC C22-PVS45P-MS3-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-MS3-K MS4 2NC C22-PVS45P-MS4-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-MS4-K MS5 2NC C22-PVS45P-MS5-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-MS5-K MS6 2NC C22-PVS45P-MS6-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-MS6-K MS7 2NC C22-PVS45P-MS7-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-MS7-K MS8 2NC C22-PVS45P-MS8-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-MS8-K Ronis 2NC C22-PVS45P-RS-K02 N/NC C22-PVS45P-RS-K Contact Blocks K02 = 2NC K = N/NC Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-37

138 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 C22-PVS_ Non-Illuminated Emergency Stops, Keyed-Release, continued Contact Block Release Method perator Size Key Code Configuration Keyed-release 60 mm MS 2NC C22-PVS60P-MS-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-MS-K MS2 2NC C22-PVS60P-MS2-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-MS2-K MS3 2NC C22-PVS60P-MS3-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-MS3-K MS4 2NC C22-PVS60P-MS4-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-MS4-K MS5 2NC C22-PVS60P-MS5-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-MS5-K MS6 2NC C22-PVS60P-MS6-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-MS6-K MS7 2NC C22-PVS60P-MS7-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-MS7-K MS8 2NC C22-PVS60P-MS8-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-MS8-K Ronis 2NC C22-PVS60P-RS-K02 N/NC C22-PVS60P-RS-K V7-T-38 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

139 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Selector Switches Contents Description Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated and Illuminated Indicating Lights Emergency Stops Selector Switches Non-Illuminated, Knob Type Non-Illuminated, Key perated Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Page V7-T-25 V7-T-34 V7-T-36 V7-T-40 V7-T-4 V7-T-44 V7-T-46 Selector Switches Product Description With over 20 variations of operation and 8 varieties of key codes, the C22 line offers a very complete line of selector switches. Note: For additional accessories, please see Volume 7 Motor Controls, Logic and Connectivity, CA E, Tab 37, section 37.4, 22.5 mm Modular Pushbuttons M22. Features Selector switch (nonkeyed) rated for million mechanical operations Momentary selector switches are field convertible from momentary to maintained Protection Type IP65 NEMA 4, 3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-39

140 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Selector Switches Non-Keyed Product Selection Non-Illuminated, Knob Type C22(S)-WK-_/ C22(S)-WRK_ Non-Illuminated Selector Switches, Knob Type Type Bezel C22 = Silver C22S = Black Switching Position Contact Block Configuration C22 -WK-K0 perator Type WK = 2-position, momentary WKV = 2-position, momentary, V position WRK = 2-position, maintained WRKV = 2-position, maintained, V position WK3 = 3-position, momentary WRK3 = 3-position, maintained Silver Bezel Note: Momentary selector switches can be field converted to maintained. Black Bezel Two-position Momentary N C22-WK-K0 C22S-WK-K0 40 2N C22-WK-K20 C22S-WK-K20 NC C22-WK-K0 C22S-WK-K0 2NC C22-WK-K02 C22S-WK-K02 N/NC C22-WK-K C22S-WK-K Momentary N C22-WKV-K0 C22S-WKV-K0 60 2N C22-WKV-K20 C22S-WKV-K20 NC C22-WKV-K0 C22S-WKV-K0 2NC C22-WKV-K02 C22S-WKV-K02 N/NC C22-WKV-K C22S-WKV-K Maintained N C22-WRK-K0 C22S-WRK-K0 40 2N C22-WRK-K20 C22S-WRK-K20 NC C22-WRK-K0 C22S-WRK-K0 2NC C22-WRK-K02 C22S-WRK-K02 Contact Blocks K0 =N K20 =2N K0 =NC K02 =2NC K =N/NC N/NC C22-WRK-K C22S-WRK-K Maintained N C22-WRKV-K0 C22S-WRKV-K0 60 2N C22-WRKV-K20 C22S-WRKV-K20 NC C22-WRKV-K0 C22S-WRKV-K0 2NC C22-WRKV-K02 C22S-WRKV-K02 N/NC C22-WRKV-K C22S-WRKV-K Three-position Momentary 2N C22-WK3-K20 C22S-WK3-K NC C22-WK3-K02 C22S-WK3-K02 N/NC C22-WK3-K C22S-WK3-K Maintained 2N C22-WRK3-K20 C22S-WRK3-K NC C22-WRK3-K02 C22S-WRK3-K02 N/NC C22-WRK3-K C22S-WRK3-K V7-T-40 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

141 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Selector Switches Keyed Non-Illuminated, Key perated C22(S)-WS-MS_ Bezel C22 = Silver C22S = Black Non-Illuminated Selector Switches, Key perated Position Type Key Code Two-position Momentary key removal left 40 C22 -WS-MS-A-K0 perator Type WS = 2-position, momentary WRS = 2-position, maintained WRS- -A = 2-position, maintained, key removal left WS3 = 3-position, momentary WRS3 = 3-position, maintained Contact Block Configuration Note: Momentary selector switches can be field converted to maintained. Key Code MS =MS MS2 =MS2 MS3 =MS3 MS4 =MS4 MS5 =MS5 MS6 =MS6 MS7 =MS7 MS8 =MS8 Silver Bezel Contact Blocks K0 =N K20 =2N K0 =NC K02 =2NC K = N/NC Black Bezel MS N C22-WS-MS-K0 C22S-WS-MS-K0 2N C22-WS-MS-K20 C22S-WS-MS-K20 NC C22-WS-MS-K0 C22S-WS-MS-K0 2NC C22-WS-MS-K02 C22S-WS-MS-K02 N/NC C22-WS-MS-K C22S-WS-MS-K MS2 N C22-WS-MS2-K0 C22S-WS-MS2-K0 2N C22-WS-MS2-K20 C22S-WS-MS2-K20 NC C22-WS-MS2-K0 C22S-WS-MS2-K0 2NC C22-WS-MS2-K02 C22S-WS-MS2-K02 N/NC C22-WS-MS2-K C22S-WS-MS2-K MS3 N C22-WS-MS3-K0 C22S-WS-MS3-K0 2N C22-WS-MS3-K20 C22S-WS-MS3-K20 NC C22-WS-MS3-K0 C22S-WS-MS3-K0 2NC C22-WS-MS3-K02 C22S-WS-MS3-K02 N/NC C22-WS-MS3-K C22S-WS-MS3-K MS4 N C22-WS-MS4-K0 C22S-WS-MS4-K0 2N C22-WS-MS4-K20 C22S-WS-MS4-K20 NC C22-WS-MS4-K0 C22S-WS-MS4-K0 2NC C22-WS-MS4-K02 C22S-WS-MS4-K02 N/NC C22-WS-MS4-K C22S-WS-MS4-K MS5 N C22-WS-MS5-K0 C22S-WS-MS5-K0 2N C22-WS-MS5-K20 C22S-WS-MS5-K20 NC C22-WS-MS5-K0 C22S-WS-MS5-K0 2NC C22-WS-MS5-K02 C22S-WS-MS5-K02 N/NC C22-WS-MS5-K C22S-WS-MS5-K Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-4

142 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 C22(S)-WRS-MS_ Non-Illuminated Selector Switches, Key perated, continued Contact Block Position Type Key Code Configuration Two-position, continued Two-position Momentary key removal left 40 Maintained key removal left/right 40 Note: Momentary selector switches can be field converted to maintained. Silver Bezel Black Bezel MS6 N C22-WS-MS6-K0 C22S-WS-MS6-K0 2N C22-WS-MS6-K20 C22S-WS-MS6-K20 NC C22-WS-MS6-K0 C22S-WS-MS6-K0 2NC C22-WS-MS6-K02 C22S-WS-MS6-K02 N/NC C22-WS-MS6-K C22S-WS-MS6-K MS7 N C22-WS-MS7-K0 C22S-WS-MS7-K0 2N C22-WS-MS7-K20 C22S-WS-MS7-K20 NC C22-WS-MS7-K0 C22S-WS-MS7-K0 2NC C22-WS-MS7-K02 C22S-WS-MS7-K02 N/NC C22-WS-MS7-K C22S-WS-MS7-K MS8 N C22-WS-MS8-K0 C22S-WS-MS8-K0 2N C22-WS-MS8-K20 C22S-WS-MS8-K20 NC C22-WS-MS8-K0 C22S-WS-MS8-K0 2NC C22-WS-MS8-K02 C22S-WS-MS8-K02 N/NC C22-WS-MS8-K C22S-WS-MS8-K MS N C22-WRS-MS-K0 C22S-WRS-MS-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS-K20 C22S-WRS-MS-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS-K0 C22S-WRS-MS-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS-K02 C22S-WRS-MS-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS-K C22S-WRS-MS-K MS2 N C22-WRS-MS2-K0 C22S-WRS-MS2-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS2-K20 C22S-WRS-MS2-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS2-K0 C22S-WRS-MS2-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS2-K02 C22S-WRS-MS2-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS2-K C22S-WRS-MS2-K MS3 N C22-WRS-MS3-K0 C22S-WRS-MS3-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS3-K20 C22S-WRS-MS3-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS3-K0 C22S-WRS-MS3-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS3-K02 C22S-WRS-MS3-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS3-K C22S-WRS-MS3-K V7-T-42 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

143 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 C22(S)-WRS -MS_ Non-Illuminated Selector Switches, Key perated, continued Contact Block Position Type Key Code Configuration Two-position, continued Two-position Three Position Maintained key removal left/right 40 Maintained key removal left 40 Momentary Key Removal Center Maintained Key Removal Left/Right Note: Momentary selector switches can be field converted to maintained. Silver Bezel Black Bezel MS4 N C22-WRS-MS4-K0 C22S-WRS-MS4-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS4-K20 C22S-WRS-MS4-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS4-K0 C22S-WRS-MS4-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS4-K02 C22S-WRS-MS4-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS4-K C22S-WRS-MS4-K MS5 N C22-WRS-MS5-K0 C22S-WRS-MS5-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS5-K20 C22S-WRS-MS5-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS5-K0 C22S-WRS-MS5-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS5-K02 C22S-WRS-MS5-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS5-K C22S-WRS-MS5-K MS6 N C22-WRS-MS6-K0 C22S-WRS-MS6-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS6-K20 C22S-WRS-MS6-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS6-K0 C22S-WRS-MS6-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS6-K02 C22S-WRS-MS6-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS6-K C22S-WRS-MS6-K MS7 N C22-WRS-MS7-K0 C22S-WRS-MS7-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS7-K20 C22S-WRS-MS7-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS7-K0 C22S-WRS-MS7-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS7-K02 C22S-WRS-MS7-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS7-K C22S-WRS-MS7-K MS8 N C22-WRS-MS7-K0 C22S-WRS-MS7-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS7-K20 C22S-WRS-MS7-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS7-K0 C22S-WRS-MS7-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS7-K02 C22S-WRS-MS7-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS7-K C22S-WRS-MS7-K MS N C22-WRS-MS-A-K0 C22S-WRS-MS-A-K0 2N C22-WRS-MS-A-K20 C22S-WRS-MS-A-K20 NC C22-WRS-MS-A-K0 C22S-WRS-MS-A-K0 2NC C22-WRS-MS-A-K02 C22S-WRS-MS-A-K02 N/NC C22-WRS-MS-A-K C22S-WRS-MS-A-K MS 2N C22-WS3-MS-K20 C22S-WS3-MS-K20 2NC C22-WS3-MS-K02 C22S-WS3-MS-K02 N/NC C22-WS3-MS-K C22S-WS3-MS-K MS 2N C22-WRS3-MS-K20 C22S-WRS3-MS-K20 2NC C22-WRS3-MS-K02 C22S-WRS3-MS-K02 N/NC C22-WRS3-MS-K C22S-WRS3-MS-K Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-43

144 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Technical Data and Specifications 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Pushbutton Actuators Illuminated Pushbuttons C22 Description Unit Momentary Maintained General Indicator Lights C22 Selector Switch Actuators C22 Key-perated Buttons C22 Emergency Stop/ Emergency Switching FF Pushbuttons C22 Standards IEC/EN VDE 0660 Lifespan, mechanical perations x perating frequency perations/h >3600 >3600 >2000 >00 >300 Actuating force N >5 >5 >50 perating torque Nm >0.3 >0.5 Terminal screw tightening torque Nm Threaded ring tightening torque Nm Protection type IP67, IP69K IP67, IP69K IP67, IP69K IP65 IP66 IP67, IP69K Climatic proofing Damp heat, constant, to IEC Damp heat, cyclic, to IEC Ambient temperature pen C 25 to to to to to to 70 Storage C 30 to to to to to to 80 Mounting position As required As required As required As required As required As required Mechanical shock resistance to g IEC Shock duration ms, half-sinusoidal Terminal capacities Solid mm 2 2 x x x x x x Flexible with ferrule mm 2 2 x x x x x x Contacts Rated impulse withstand voltage U imp Vac Rated insulation voltage U i V vervoltage category/pollution III/3 III/3 III/3 III/3 III/3 III/3 degree Control circuit reliability at 5 Vdc/ ma H F Fault probability Values follow Values follow Values follow Values follow Values follow at 7 Vdc/7 ma H F Fault probability at 24 Vdc/5 ma H F Fault probability Max. short-circuit protective device N/ contact: statistically determined failure per 7 x 06 operations N/C contact: statistically determined failure per 0.9 x 0 6 operations N/ contact: statistically determined failure per 7 x 06 operations N/C contact: statistically determined failure per 0.9 x 0 6 operations Values follow Values follow Values follow Values follow Values follow Fuse gg/gl A V7-T-44 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

145 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C mm Compact Pushbuttons C22, continued Push-button Actuators Emergency Stop/ Illuminated Pushbuttons C22 Indicator Selector Switch Key-perated Emergency Switching Description Unit Momentary Maintained Lights C22 Actuators C22 Buttons C22 FF Pushbuttons C22 Switching Capacity Rated operational current AC-5 24V I e A V I e A V I e A DC-3 24V I e A V I e A 0V I e A V I e A Lifespan, electrical AC-5 230V/0.5A perations x V/.0A x Contact Travel Contact Travel Diagram Contact closed Contact open Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-45

146 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in mm [in] Illuminated Pushbuttons Flat Extended C22(S)-DRL_/C22(S)-DL_ [ ] 6.0 [0.24] 4.0 [0.6] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x.5 C22(S)-DRLH_/C22(S)-DLH_ [ ] 6.0 [0.24] 4.0 [0.6] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x.5 Ø29.7 [.7] 20.2 [0.80] Ø29.5 [.6] Ø29.7 [.7] 20.2 [0.80] Ø29.5 [.6] 0.4 [0.4] 54.6 [2.5] 6.7 [0.66] 60.9 [2.40] Pushbutton Actuators Flat C22(S)-DR_/C22(S)-D_ [ ] 6.0 [0.24] 4.0 [0.6] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x.5 Extended C22(S)-DRH_/C22(S)-DH_ [ ] 6.0 [0.24] 4.0 [0.6] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x.5 Ø29.7 [.7] 20.2 [0.80] Ø29.5 [.6] Ø29.7 [.7] 20.2 [0.80] Ø29.5 [.6] Indicating Lights Flat C22-L_ 0.4 [0.4] 54.6 [2.5] 6.7 [0.66] 60.9 [2.40] [ ] 6.0 [0.24] 4.0 [0.6] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x.5 Ø29.7 [.7] Ø20.2 [0.80] Ø29.5 [.6].7 [0.46] 55.9 [2.20] V7-T-46 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

147 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22.5 Approximate Dimensions in mm [in] Emergency Stop/Emergency Switching FF Pushbuttons C22-PVT45P_ Ø45.0 [.77] C22-PVT45P-MS_ Ø45.0 [.7] C22-PVT60P-MS_ C22-PVT60P-MS_ [ ] Ø60.0 [2.36] Ø60.0 [2.36] 48.0 [.89] 6.0 [0.24] 93.0 [3.66] [ ] 45.0 [.77] 6.0 [0.24] 9.3 [0.37] 4.0 [0.6] Ø20.4 [0.80] 48.0 [.89] 45.0 [.77] 75.0 [2.95] 20.0 [4.72] [ ] 48.0 [.89] 75.0 [2.95] 20.0 [4.72] [ ] 48.0 [.89] 7.0 [2.80] 6.0 [4.57] 6.0 [0.24] 45.0 [.77] 6.0 [0.24] 45.0 [.77] Ø29.5 [.6] M22 x [0.37] Ø20.4 [0.80] 4.0 [0.6] Ø29.5 [.6] M22 x [0.37] Ø20.4 [0.80] 9.3 [0.37] 4.0 [0.6] M22 x [0.6] Ø29.5 [.6] Ø29.5 [.6] Ø20.4 [0.80] M22 x.5 C22-PVT60P_ C22-PVT45P-RS_ Ø45.0 [.77] Ø60.0 [2.36] [ ] 48.0 [.89] [ ] 6.0 [0.24] 92.0 [3.62] 6.0 [4.57] 45.0 [.77] 6.0 [0.24] 48.0 [.89] 45.0 [.77] 7.0 [2.80] 9.3 [0.37] 4.0 [0.6] Ø29.5 [.6] Ø20.4 [0.80] M22 x [0.37] Ø20.4 [0.80] 4.0 [0.6] Ø29.5 [.6] M22 x.5 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-47

148 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 22.5 mm Compact Pushbuttons C22 Approximate Dimensions in mm [in] Selector Switch Actuators C22(S)-W(R)K_ Ø29.7 [.7] [ ] 27.8 [.09] Key perated Actuators C22(S)-WS(3)-MS_/C22(S)-WRS(3)-MS_ Ø29.7 [.7] 72.0 [2.83] C22(S)-WS(3)-RS_/C22(S)-WRS(3)-RS_ Ø29.7 [.7] 6.0 [0.24] [ ] 20.8 [0.82] 47.9 [.89] [ ] 47.9 [.89] 4.0 [0.6] 92. [3.63] 24.9 [0.98] 92. [3.63] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x [0.80] 6.0 [0.24] 4.0 [0.6] 44.2 [.74] 6.0 [0.24] 4.0 [0.6] 44.2 [.74] Ø29.5 [.6] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x [0.80] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x [0.80] Selector Switch Actuators/V Position C22(S)-W(R)KV_ 30 Ø29.5 [.6] Ø29.5 [.6] Ø29.7 [.7] [ ] 27.8 [.09] 6.0 [0.24] 72.0 [2.83] 4.0 [0.6] 9.6 [0.38] M22 x [0.80] Ø29.5 [.6] V7-T-48 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

149 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Contents Description 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Product Identification Product Selection perators perator Components Accessories ptions Replacement Parts Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Product Description The E30 industrial pushbutton and indicating light line from Eaton s electrical sector features a wide selection of square, multifunction operators which conveniently mount in a standard 30.5 mm (-3/64 in) diameter panel hole. Up to six input and indicating functions can be grouped into a single operating head, saving valuable panel space. Attractive square operator styling, coupled with custom legending of colored buttons and lenses and many special function accessories, makes E30 components ideally suited for use on control consoles and for a variety of industrial EM applications. Features Type E30 control units consist of a basic operator with one or more buttons and lenses and contact block selection dependent on the specific operator configuration. Pushbutton operators will accommodate up to four single depth stackable contact blocks behind each operating button, up to eight circuits maximum. Indicating lights are supplied complete with either a transformer light unit up to 600 Vac supply line voltage or full voltage light unit up to 20 Vac/Vdc supply line voltage. Combination pushbutton with indicating light operators are supplied complete with a transformer or full voltage unit. Contact blocks must be ordered separately, up to four circuits maximum. Die Cast Construction Each operator has high pressure type seals to prevent the passage of oil and other contaminants through the operator into the contact structure or panel interior. Each operator uses a Buna N cork gasket between the mounting flange on the operator and the panel to maintain oiltightness. Standards and Certifications Page V7-T-50 V7-T-5 V7-T-54 V7-T-60 V7-T-6 V7-T-64 V7-T-65 V7-T-66 UL Listed File No. E3568 CSA Certified File No. LR6855 Ingress Protection Single and dual indicating lights UL (NEMA) Type, 2, 3, 3R, 3S, 4, 4, 2, 3 All other operators UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-49

150 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Product Identification 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight Multifunction perator (see Pages V7-T-5 to V7-T-53) Buttons and Lenses Supplied Blank or with Custom Legend(s) (see Pages V7-T-54 to V7-T-58) Lower Contact Block perating Plunger Upper Contact Block perating Plunger Gasket Retaining Nut Secures perator to Panel Locking Ring Supplied with perator Serves as Mount for Light Element and Contact Blocks Quarter Turn Screw Mounts Locking Ring to perator Transformer or Full Voltage Light Element Supplied with perator Single Circuit Contact Block Two Circuit Contact Block V7-T-50 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

151 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30.6 Product Selection perators When rdering a Complete E30 Control Unit Specify of rdering Example (E30AB) perator E30KB30 START Button(s) E30KB23 STP Contact block(s) E30KLA N Accessories (if required) E30KLA2 NC Square Multifunction perators UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Single Button perator Single Button perator/without Button (rder Button Separately) Button Type Required peration Special Features Shown with Extended Button Two Button perator Shown with Extended Buttons Two Button perator Shown with Long Release Bar Momentary E30AA Two Button perator/without Buttons (rder Buttons Separately) Button Types peration Required Top Button Bottom Button Special Features Momentary Momentary E30AB Momentary Momentary With mechanical E30AC interlock Maintained Release E30AD 2 (all contacts) (all contacts) Maintained (all contacts) Release (all contacts) With mechanical interlock E30AP 23 Two Button perator with Long (FF) Release Bar Includes FF Bar/Button (rder ther Buttons Separately) Button Types Required 45 peration Top Button Bottom Button Special Features Maintained Maintained E30AF Maintained Maintained With mechanical interlock Maintained Momentary With mechanical interlock Maintained (all contacts) Maintained (bottom contacts only) Top button operates both top and bottom contacts E30AG E30AH E30AK 6 Notes rder from table on Page V7-T Limited to two single circuit, one double circuit 600V or two 20V (E30KLA9) contact blocks behind each button. 3 Buttons are interlocked so that one of the two is maintained at all times. Depressing the other button releases the maintained button and maintains the depressed button. 4 perators are supplied as standard with red extended bar(s) marked FF as shown in sketch. For other colors or markings, contact your nearest Eaton Distributor or call our Customer Service Center For replacement of standard red release bar, order E30KR00. 5 rder from table on Page V7-T Limited to two single circuit, one double circuit 600V or two 20V (E30KLA9) contact blocks behind each button. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-5

152 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Square Multifunction perators and Indicating Lights UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two Button perator Shown with Release Bar for Top Button Two Button perator Shown with Release Bars for Each Button Single Indicating Light Unit Shown with Lens Dual Indicating Light Unit Shown with Lens Two Button perator with (FF) Release Includes FF Bar/Button(s) (rder ther Buttons Separately) Button Types Required 2 Single Indicating Light Unit/without Lens (rder Lens Separately) Type of Light Element Lens Type Required 3 Dual Indicating Light Unit/without Lenses (rder Lenses Separately) Type of Light Element Lens Types Required 5 Notes peration Top Button Bottom Button Special Features Maintained Momentary Release bar for top button Maintained Maintained Individual release bars for each button Maintained with interlock Transformer (60/50 Hertz AC) Voltage Maintained with interlock Lamp Number 4 Voltage Individual release bars for each button Full Voltage (60/50 Hertz AC or DC) Lamp Number 4 E30AL E30AN E30AM 20 6PSB E30BA 24 24PSB E30BJ 20 20PSB E30BM Transformer (60/50 Hertz AC) Voltage Lamp Number 4 Voltage Full Voltage (60/50 Hertz AC or DC) Lamp Number PSB E30CA 24 24PSB E30CJ 20 20PSB E30CM rder from table on Page V7-T perators are supplied as standard with red extended release bar(s) marked FF as shown in sketch. For other colors or markings, contact your nearest Eaton Distributor or call our Customer Service Center For replacement of standard red release bar, order E30KR0. 3 rder from table on Page V7-T Light units will also accept LED lamps. For LED part numbers, see table on Page V7-T rder from table on Page V7-T-57. V7-T-52 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

153 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30.6 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Single Button perator and Indicating Light Shown with Button and Lens Single Button perator with Release Bar and Indicating Light Shown with Button and Lens Two Button perator with Indicating Light Shown with Button and Lens Two Button perator with Dual Indicating Lights Shown with Button and Lens Single Button perator with Indicating Light/without Button or Lens (rder Button and Lens Separately) Type of Light Element Button and Lens Types Required Single Button perator with (FF) Release Bar and Indicating Light Includes FF Bar/Button (rder ther Button and Lens Separately) Type of Light Element Button and Lens Types Required Two Button perator with Indicating Light/without Buttons or Lens (rder Buttons and Lens Separately) Type of Light Element Button and Lens Types Required 4 Two Button perator with Dual Indicating Lights/without Buttons and Lens Type of Light Element Button and Lens Types Required Notes peration (Bottom Button) Transformer (60/50 Hertz AC) Voltage Lamp Number 2 Voltage Full Voltage (60/50 Hertz AC or DC) Lamp Number 2 Momentary 20 6PSB E30DA 24 24PSB E30D PSB E30DF peration (Bottom Button) Transformer (60/50 Hertz AC) Voltage Lamp Number 3 Voltage Full Voltage (60/50 Hertz AC or DC) Lamp Number 2 Maintained 20 6PSB E30DG 24 24PSB E30D PSB E30DM Button peration Transformer (60/50 Hertz AC) Voltage Lamp Number 2 Voltage Full Voltage (60/50 Hertz AC or DC) Lamp Number 2 Momentary 20 6PSB E30EA 24 24PSB E30E3 Momentary with interlock Button peration 20 20PSB E30EF 20 6PSB E30EG 24 24PSB E30E3 Transformer (60/50 Hertz AC) Voltage Lamp Number 2 Voltage 20 20PSB E30EM Full Voltage (60/50 Hertz AC or DC) Lamp Number 2 Momentary 20 6PSB E30JA 24 24PSB E30J PSB E30JF rder from tables on Pages V7-T-54 to V7-T Light units will also accept LED lamps. For LED part numbers, see table on Page V7-T perators are supplied as standard with red extended release bar(s) marked FF as shown in sketch. For other colors or markings, contact your nearest Eaton Distributor or call our Customer Service Center For replacement of standard red release bar, order E30KR0. 4 rder from tables on Pages V7-T-56 and V7-T-57. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-53

154 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 perator Components perating Buttons nly Type A Extended Button Type B Extended Button Type A Buttons with Standard Markings Button Extended Button Application Color Marking Short Button Color Marking Notes Use with operator E30AA, legend characters 3/6 in (4.8 mm) high. 2 Use with operators E30AB thru AE, AL and DA thru DF, legend characters 3/6 in (4.8 mm) high. Extended Button Short Button Black Blank E30KA00 E30KA50 Green START E30KA330 E30KA380 START E30KA80 Yellow Blank E30KA400 E30KA450 Red Blank E30KA200 E30KA250 White Blank E30KA500 E30KA550 EMERG. STP E30KA204 Gray Blank E30KA600 E30KA650 FF E30KA28 E30KA268 Brown Blank E30KA700 E30KA750 STP E30KA23 E30KA28 range Blank E30KA800 E30KA950 Green Blank E30KA300 E30KA350 Blue Blank E30KA900 E30KA950 Type B Buttons with Standard Markings 2 Button Extended Button Application Color Marking Short Button Color Marking Extended Button Short Button Black Blank E30KB00 E30KB50 Black REVERSE E30KB25 E30KB75 AUT E30KB0 E30KB5 RUN E30KB26 E30KB76 CLSE E30KB02 E30KB52 SLW E30KB28 E30KB78 DWN E30KB03 E30KB53 START E30KB30 E30KB80 FAST E30KB05 E30KB55 TEST E30KB32 E30KB82 FRWARD E30KB07 E30KB57 UP E30KB34 E30KB84 HIGH E30KB09 E30KB59 Red Blank E30KB200 E30KB250 IN E30KB0 E30KB60 EMERG. STP E30KB204 INCH E30KB E30KB6 FF E30KB28 E30KB268 JG E30KB2 E30KB62 STP E30KB23 E30KB28 JG FR. E30KB3 E30KB63 Green Blank E30KB300 E30KB350 JG REV. E30KB4 E30KB64 START E30KB330 E30KB380 LW E30KB5 E30KB65 Yellow Blank E30KB400 E30KB450 LWER E30KB6 E30KB66 White Blank E30KB500 E30KB550 MAN E30KB7 E30KB67 AUT E30KB50 N E30KB9 E30KB69 HAND E30KB508 PEN E30KB20 E30KB70 Gray Blank E30KB600 E30KB650 UT E30KB2 E30KB7 Brown Blank E30KB700 E30KB750 RAISE E30KB22 E30KB72 range Blank E30KB800 E30KB850 RESET E30KB24 E30KB74 Blue Blank E30KB900 E30KB950 V7-T-54 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

155 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30.6 Type C Extended Button Type C Buttons with Standard Markings Button Extended Button Application Color Marking Short Button Color Marking Note Use with operators E30AF thru AK, AL thru AM and DG thru DM, legend characters /8 in (3.2 mm) high. Extended Button Short Button Black Blank E30KC00 E30KC50 Black RESET E30KC24 E30KC74 AUT E30KC0 E30KC5 REVERSE E30KC25 E30KC75 CLSE E30KC02 E30KC52 RUN E30KC26 E30KC76 DWN E30KC03 E30KC53 SLW E30KC28 E30KC78 FAST E30KC05 E30KC55 START E30KC30 E30KC80 FRWARD E30KC07 E30KC57 TEST E30KC32 E30KC82 HAND E30KC08 E30KC58 UP E30KC34 E30KC84 HIGH E30KC09 E30KC59 Red Blank E30KC200 E30KC250 IN E30KC0 E30KC60 FF E30KC28 INCH E30KC E30KC6 STP E30KC23 E30KC28 JG E30KC2 E30KC62 Green Blank E30KC300 E30KC350 JG FR. E30KC3 E30KC63 START E30KC330 E30KC380 JG REV. E30KC4 E30KC64 Yellow Blank E30KC400 E30KC450 LW E30KC5 E30KC65 White Blank E30KC500 E30KC550 LWER E30KC6 E30KC66 Gray Blank E30KC600 E30KC650 MAN E30KC7 E30KC67 Brown Blank E30KC700 E30KC750 N E30KC9 E30KC69 range Blank E30KC800 E30KC850 PEN E30KC20 E30KC70 Blue Blank E30KC900 E30KC950 UT E30KC2 E30KC7 RAISE E30KC22 E30KC72 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-55

156 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 perating Buttons and Lens nly Standard Color Buttons and Lens Marking Black lettering on White, Amber, Yellow and Clear. White lettering on Green, Red, Blue, Brown, Black, range and Gray. Type E Button Type F Lens Type E Buttons with Standard Markings 2 Button Extended Button Application Color Marking Color Marking Type F Lenses with Standard Markings 3 Button Application Color Marking Color Marking Notes For lenses with special markings or with standard markings but in a different color, refer to instructions on Pages V7-T-6 to V7-T Use with operators E30EA thru EM, FA thru FM and JA thru JM, legend characters /8 in (3.2 mm) high. 3 Use with operators E30BA thru BY, legend characters 3/6 in (4.8 mm) high. Extended Button Black Blank E30KE00 Black RESET E30KE24 CLSE E30KE02 REVERSE E30KE25 DWN E30KE03 RUN E30KE26 FAST E30KE05 SLW E30KE28 FRWARD E30KE07 START E30KE30 HIGH E30KE09 TEST E30KE32 IN E30KE0 UP E30KE34 INCH E30KE Red Blank E30KE200 JG E30KE2 FF E30KE28 JG FR. E30KE3 STP E30KE23 JG REV. E30KE4 Green Blank E30KE300 LW E30KE5 START E30KE330 LWER E30KE6 Yellow Blank E30KE400 N E30KE9 White Blank E30KE500 PEN E30KE20 Gray Blank E30KE600 UT E30KE2 Brown Blank E30KE700 PHASE E30KE22 range Blank E30KE800 Blue Blank E30KE900 Red Blank E30KF0 Green FF E30KF22 MTR RUN E30KF Amber Blank E30KF30 N E30KF2 Blue Blank E30KF40 PWER N E30KF3 Clear Blank E30KF50 Green Blank E30KF20 White Blank E30KF60 MTR STP E30KF2 MTR RUN E30KF23 V7-T-56 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

157 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30.6 perating Lens nly Standard Color Buttons and Lens Marking Black lettering on White, Amber, Yellow and Clear. White lettering on Green, Red, Blue, Brown, Black, range and Gray. Type G Lens Type J Lens Type K Lenses Type G Lenses with Standard Markings 2 Lens Application Color Marking Color Marking Red Blank E30KG0 Green FF E30KG22 MTR RUN E30KG READY E30KG23 N E30KG2 Amber Blank E30KG30 PWER N E30KG3 Blue Blank E30KG40 Green Blank E30KG20 Clear Blank E30KG50 MTR RUN E30KG24 White Blank E30KG60 MTR STP E30KG2 Type J Lenses with Standard Markings 3 Lens Application Color Marking Color Marking Red Blank E30KJ0 Green FF E30KJ22 MTR RUN E30KJ N E30KJ24 N E30KJ2 Amber Blank E30KJ30 PWER N E30KJ3 Blue Blank E30KJ40 MTR STP E30KJ4 Clear Blank E30KJ50 Green Blank E30KJ20 White Blank E30KJ60 MTR STP E30KJ2 MTR RUN E30KJ23 Type K Lenses with Standard Markings (Sold in Pairs nly) 4 Lens Application Color Marking Left Hand Lens Right Hand Lens Left Hand Lens Right Hand Lens Red Red N N E30KK2 Green N FF E30KK3 Green FF FF E30KK22 Red FF N E30KK23 Notes For lenses with special markings or with standard markings but in a different color, refer to instructions on Pages V7-T-6 to V7-T Use with operators E30CA thru CM and DA thru DM, legend characters 3/6 in (4.8 mm) high except MTR RUN, PWER N and MTR STP are /8 in (3.2 mm) high. 3 Use with operators E30EA thru EM, FA thru FM and GA thru GM, legend characters /8 in (3.2 mm) high. 4 Use with operators E30JA thru JW, legend characters /8 in (3.2 mm) high Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-57

158 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Type K Lenses Type K Lenses Blank (Sold in Pairs nly) Color Color Left Hand Lens Right Hand Lens Left Hand Lens Right Hand Lens Red Red E30KK0 Blue Red E30KK4 Green E30KK Green E30KK42 Amber E30KK7 Amber E30KK43 Blue E30KK4 Blue E30KK40 Clear E30KK5 Clear E30KK45 White E30KK6 White E30KK46 Green Red E30KK2 Clear Red E30KK5 Green E30KK20 Green E30KK52 Amber E30KK27 Amber E30KK53 Blue E30KK24 Blue E30KK54 Clear E30KK25 Clear E30KK50 White E30KK26 White E30KK56 Amber Red E30KK3 White Red E30KK6 Green E30KK32 Green E30KK62 Amber E30KK30 Amber E30KK63 Blue E30KK34 Blue E30KK64 Clear E30KK35 Clear E30KK65 White E30KK36 White E30KK60 V7-T-58 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

159 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30.6 Contact Blocks Standard Contact Blocks Molded, phenolic construction. Enclosed silver contacts with reliability nibs that improve the reliability of switching performance under dry circuit, corrosive atmosphere and fine dust conditions. For more extreme conditions, the logic level contact blocks described below are recommended. Logic Level Contact Blocks Feature palladium contacts. Palladium, which is more inert than gold, is well suited for voltages and currents approaching zero. When mounted in an enclosure rated for highly corrosive environments, logic level contact blocks can be used where exposure to chemicals may cause failure to other types of materials. Mounting Limitations See the contact block mounting limitations for Type E30 pushbutton and combination pushbutton and light operators on this page. Mounting positions thru 8 indicate single depth contact blocks. Each of these positions can represent either a single circuit 600 volt block or a two-circuit 20 volt block. The two-circuit 600 volt block requires two of the numbered positions shown. Contact Block Type 2 Single Circuit, Screw Terminals Two Circuit, Screw Terminals Two Circuit, Quick Connect Terminals 20 Vac nly Two Circuit Contact Block Selection Circuit Special Contact peration N-NC verlapping Mounting Positions Lower Contact Block Stack perating Plunger of perator Notes Except operator E30AD, AJ or AK which will accommodate contact blocks, 2, 5 and 6 only. (See Mounting Positions above.) 2 Individually boxed contact blocks master packed 0 per carton. 3 Supplied with non-stacking screws. Limited to 2 contact blocks mounted in positions and 5. 4 Do not use with maintained operators. 5 Contacts must be same polarity. Upper Contact Block Stack perating Plunger Lower Contact Block Stack Upper Contact Block Stack Contact Block Mounting Positions Contact Blocks Can Be Mounted in Positions Listed Below Upper Stack Lower Stack E30AA thru E30AM E30BA thru E30CM None None E30DA thru E30DM None E30EA thru E30GM E30JA thru E30JM Pressure Terminals Quick Connect Terminals 3 Standard Logic Level Standard N 600 Vac, 250 Vdc Single Circuit E30KLA E30KLAE E30KLB NC E30KLA2 E30KLAE2 E30KLB2 N-NC 600 Vac, 250 Vdc Two Circuit E30KLA3 E30KLAE3 E30KLB3 2N E30KLA4 E30KLAE4 E30KLB4 2NC E30KLA5 E30KLAE5 E30KLB5 2N (ne early closing) 2NC (ne late opening) N-NC E30KLA6 4 E30KLB6 4 E30KLA7 4 E30KLB7 4 E30KLA8 E30KLB8 20 Vac nly Two Circuit E30KLA9 5 E30KLB9 5 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-59

160 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Accessories E30KR_ E30KT_ Half Shroud E30KR3_ E30KR30 E30KT_ E30KT3 E30KT_ E30KV E22CW E30KV2 Full Shroud Accessories Description Color/Type Collar Snap on mounting for assembly in the field. Permits Black E30KR color coding of operator heads. Size: -9/32 x -9/32 x 9/6 in. Red E30KR2 Green E30KR3 Yellow E30KR4 White E30KR5 Gray E30KR6 range E30KR8 Blue E30KR9 Brown E30KR0 Shroud Similar to collar above except for extension above Full shroud E30KT6 the face of button to prevent accidental actuation of button. (gray) Half shroud with an extension on only half the collar may be positioned to protect top or bottom button. E30KT7 Guard Two collars deep, removable slide prevents accidental operation. White slide can be marked with grease pencil. Terminal Block 2 terminals, each will accommodate 2-wire terminations. Padlock Attachment for locking single button and bottom button of multi-function operators in the depressed position. Locks NC contacts open or early closing N contacts closed. Cannot be used in conjunction with collar, shroud or boot. Transparent Boot Guards against ingress of foreign material and freezing rain. Note: If this boot is used in conjunction with operator types AD or AE, an extended type button must be used in the top position and a short button in the lower position. Square Hole Plug Gray enameled Stainless steel Lamp and Lens Removal Tool Will not fit Cat. No. E30B light units listed on Page V7-T-52. ctagonal Wrench for mounting operators to panel. Button and Lens Removal Tool Half shroud (gray) Red with white slide Red with clear slide Short button Extended button E30KR3 E30KR32 E30KR30 E30KT E30KT2 E30KT3 E30KT4 E30KT5 E30KV E22CW E30KV2 Note Color coordinating collars, padlock attachments or legend plates cannot be used with operators equipped with a transparent boot. V7-T-60 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

161 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30.6 ptions Markings and Legend Plates Buttons or Lenses with Non- Standard Horizontal Markings Markings not listed as Standard Markings below are considered non-standard. If more than one marking is required on a button or lens, order non-standard markings. Legend Locations Type A buttons and Type F lenses /8 in (3 mm) High Char. 3/6 in (5 mm) High Char. Standard Markings AUT CLSE DWN C 6 B G Type B buttons and Type G lenses /8 in (3 mm) High 9 C 8 Char. Type C buttons /8 in (3 mm) High Char. Type D buttons /8 in (3 mm) High Char. F EMERG. STP FAST FRWARD HAND HIGH IN B D 5 5 rdering Instructions Specify catalog number of blank button or lens of desired color, plus suffix STAMP for non-standard or STD for standard markings in order notes. See Pages V7-T-54 to V7-T-58. Specify size, legend desired and location in order notes by alphas as shown in example. Do not exceed maximum number of legend characters per line A C E J D H B D INCH JG JG FR JG REV. LW LWER D G K B F K B MAN. FF N rdering Example Green Type B button to be marked with non-standard legend ALL ELEVATRS DWN. Catalog No.: E30KB300STAMP Letter Size: /8 in Pos. A ALL Pos. C ELEVATRS Pos. F DWN 4 A 3/6 in 5 6 C (5 mm) 6 C 4 E High 5 Char. 3/6 in (5 mm) High Char PEN UT RAISE B E J M B E J K RESET REVERSE RUN B D B 4 E 4 A 4 C 4 SLW START STP D 4 F 4 How to Use the Legend Location Figure No. of Characters per Line Buttons Lenses TEST UP MTR RUN Line Position A C E /6 in 7 A 8 (5 mm) 8 B 8 9 C 8 9 C 8 High 7 F 8 8 D 8 Char. Type K buttons /8 in (3 mm) High Char. Type E buttons and Type J lenses /8 in 3/6 in (3 mm) 7 A 8 9 B 8 (5 mm) 9 B 8 High 7 C 8 High Char. Char A D G K N 3/6 in (5 mm) High Char Type F lens only B 4 A C F J L MTR STP PWER N READY E Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-6

162 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Legend Arrangements and Legend Locations Legend plates E30KM or KM Legend plates E30KM3 or KM3 Legend plates E30KM4 or KM4 Legend Plates E30KN76 or KN76B L I N E A Legend plates E30KM5 or KM5 Legend plates E30KM2 or KM2 Legend plates E30KM6 or KM6 Maximum Number and Size of Permissible Legend Characters of Custom Stamped Legend Plates Size and Maximum Number of Characters Per Line ne Span Two Span Three Span Type B A B B C D C LINE B E F F L I N E C No.of Lines A B Legend plates E30KN76 or KN76B /8 in character size only with a maximum of six characters. 3/32 in (2.5 mm) /8 in (3 mm) B B B D D 3/6 in (5 mm) H F F 3/32 in (2.5 mm) K M M /8 in (3 mm) 3/6 in (5 mm) A B C D G H G J K L M B F M A B 3/32 in (2.5 mm) Standard Large Characters available for non-standard markings 3/32 in (2.5 mm) /8 in (3 mm) 3/6 in (5 mm) A B C D E F G H I J K L M N P Q R S T U V W Y Z. /, E F /8 in (3 mm) L M 3/6 in (5 mm) V7-T-62 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

163 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30.6 Buttons or Lenses with Non-Standard Vertical Markings rdering Instructions Specify catalog number of blank button or lens of desired color, selected from listings on Pages V7-T-54 to V7-T-58. Specify size, legend desired, location and state vertically marked in order notes. Note: Specify either /8 or 3/6 in (3.2 or 4.8 mm) character height. Do not exceed maximum number of characters as outlined in table below. rdering Example: Green Type K button to be marked with RUN N. Catalog No.: E30KK20STAMP Letter Size: 3/6 in (4.8 mm) Vertically Marked Pos. B RUN Pos. E N Maximum Number of Characters Description Type Legend Plates Legend plates for Type E30 compact pushbutton and indicating light operators hook directly onto the operator and are clamped in place when the operator locking nut behind the panel is secured. Two and three span plates are designed for use where two or more operators are mounted adjacent to each other on minimum horizontal mounting centers. These legend plates mount in the same manner as single span units. Maximum Number of Characters /8 in (3.2 mm) 3/6 in (4.8 mm) Buttons A 7 5 B 7 5 C 4 3 D 5 3 E 7 5 Lenses F 7 5 G 7 5 J 7 5 K 3 2 When rdering Legend Plates with Markings Catalog number of blank legend plate Insert the following in order notes: Legends required Size of characters 3/32, /8, 3/6 in (2.4, 3.2, 4.8 mm) Positions of legends on one line standard and two line large legend plates by alphas as shown in sketches on following page. Standard ne Span Large ne Span rdering Example: Three span legend plate to be marked MASTER CNTRL, STATIN A and STATIN B. Catalog No.: E30KM3STAMP Letter Size: /8 in (3.2 mm) Pos. C MASTER CNTRL Pos. B STATIN A Pos. F STATIN B Blank Legend Plates and Legend Plates with Markings ne Span Type Black Standard Large E30KM E30KM4 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-63

164 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Replacement Parts Replacement Light Units for E30 Components Part Numbers Receptacles without Lamps Voltage AC and DC Replacement Lamps for E30 Illuminated perators Mfg. Lamp Type Voltage Base Style Application Part Number 6PSB 6V T2 slide E30 transformer and full voltage PSB 2V T2 slide E30 full voltage PSB 24V T2 slide E30 full voltage PSB 28V T2 slide E30 full voltage PSB 48V T2 slide E30 full voltage PSB 60V T2 slide E30 full voltage PSB 20V T2 slide E30 full voltage # V T3-/4 wedge E30 single transformer Replacement Lamps Incandescent and LED Incandescent Lamps Note Single Indicating Light Dual Indicating Light E30 blue LED bulbs may not provide sufficient intensity for some applications. Single Light Single Pushbutton Single Light Dual Pushbutton Dual Light Dual Pushbutton Full Voltage Type 6V A A A A V A A A A /24V A A A A V A A A A V A A A V A A A A V A A A A Transformer Type 20V A A A A A 208V A A A A A 240V A A A A A 380V A A A A A 480V A A A A A 600V A A A A A Description and Part Numbers Related Parts Inner lens Retaining nut Gasket Locking ring Lamp Voltage Manufacturer s Part Number Base Style Eaton s Part Number LED Lamps Eaton s Part Number Red Green Yellow Blue 6 6PSB T2 slide PSB T2 slide PSB T2 slide PSB T2 slide PSB T2 slide PSB T2 slide V7-T-64 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

165 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30.6 Technical Data and Specifications perator Specifications Description Specification Climate Conditions perating 20 to 50 F ( 29 to 65 C) Terminals Light units Terminals are saddle clamp type for 2 stranded or solid wires up to 2 AWG (4.0 mm 2 ) Torque 7 lb-in (0.8 Nm) Contact block Terminals are saddle clamp type for 2 stranded or solid wires up to 2 AWG (4.0 mm 2 ) Torque 7 lb-in (0.8 Nm) Materials perator Zinc base die casting with a copper-nickel-chrome plated finish Withstands the 200 hr. salt spray test in accordance with MIL Spec. QQ-M-5A and NEMA 4 testing. Internal parts Including shafts, washers and springs, are made of stainless steel Buttons and lenses Colorfast, wear resistant, molded acetal resin Contact blocks Made of molded, heat resistant, mineral filled phenolic Contact block plungers are molded of nylon filled phenolic Contacts are silver Reliability nibs These nibs combine a scrubbing action with high pressure density when the contacts are closed They push through particles and films found on contact surfaces in industrial environments Reliability nibs self-adjust to the application dry circuit, normal or heavy-duty Reliability Nibs Dry Circuit Electrical Ratings Medium Duty Contact Blocks Meet or Exceed NEMA Contact Rating Designation A600 and P300 Vac A600 Vdc P300 Description 20V 240V 480V 600V 24/28V 25V 250V Make and emergency interrupting capacity (Amps) Normal load break (Amps) Continuous current (Amps) UL A600/P300 nominal connect 0A N, NC, 2N, 2NC, N-NC, early make, late break and overlapping configurations Mechanical positive drive operation on NC contacts Palladium alloy contact for logic level or highly corrosive environments Maximum Ratings for Logic Level and Hostile Atmosphere Application Description Specification Maximum amperes 0.5A Maximum volts 20 Vac/Vdc Note Logic level contact blocks are UL A600/P500 rated per table above. Heavy-Duty Light Unit Description Bulbs Average Life Transformer type Resistor/direct voltage type LED Specification 20,000 hrs. 2,500 hrs. min. at rated voltage 60,000 to 00,000 hrs. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-65

166 .6 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Square Multifunction Watertight/iltight E30 Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Pushbutton perators.88 (47.8).75 (44.5) Combination Pushbutton and Indicating Light perators Padlocking Attachment and Half Shroud E30KT7 Legend Plates 0.53 (3.5).3 (28.7).47 (37.3) 0.63 (6) Square Std. Button 0.78 (9.8) Ext. Button.88 (47.8).75 (44.5).47 (37.3) Square.44 (36.6) 0. (2.8) Max (9.8) 0.39 (9.9) Large.3 (28.7) 0.75 (9.) 0.53 (3.5) 0.84 (2.3).3 (28.7) 0.3 (7.9) Dia. Hole 0.8 (20.6).72 (43.7) Panel 0.06 (.5) Min (6.4) Max. 0.8 (20.6) 0.88 (22.4) 2 Circ. Cont. Blocks.72 (43.7) 4.69 (9.) Three Span 3.06 (77.7) Two Span.44 (36.6) ne Span Standard.72 (43.7) Plunger Extends to 0.25 (6.4) (22.4) (22.4) Circ. Cont. Blocks Full Voltage Types DF, DM and D Transformer Types DA DL 0.88 (22.4) 0.88 (22.4) Panel Plunger Extends 0.06 (.5) Min. to 0.25 (6.4) on 0.25 (6.4) Max. Contact Blocks 0.08 (.9) 0.05 (.3) 0.5 (2.7) 0.69 (7.5).59 (40.4) 0.56 (4.2) 0.02 (0.5) Combination Pushbutton and Indicating Light perators.88 (47.8) Indicating Light perators.88 (47.8) Drilling Dimensions Minimum Spacing a (57) Notes.75 (44.5).47 (37.3) Square.75 (44.5).47 (37.3) Square.63 a (4.3) Drill.4 (3.5).3 (28.7).3 (28.7) 0.53 (3.5) 0.53 (3.5) ø.20 (30.5) 0.6 (5) 0.84 (2.3) 0.84 (2.3) 0.8 (20.6) 0.8 (20.6) 0.88 (22.4).72 (43.7) Panel 0.06 (.5) Min (6.4) Max (22.4).72 (43.7) Panel 0.06 (.5) Min (6.4) Max. perator Types E30EA E30GM perator Types E30JA E30JW Transformer or Full Voltage Light Element Plungers Extended to 0.25 (6.4) perator Types E30BA E30BM perator Types E30CA E30CM Dimensions shown allow adequate space for the addition of one or two high legend plates and color coordinating collars. 2 Locating nib hole or notch is 0.36 in (3.5 mm) drill. Alternate to drilling mounting holes use Greenlee Tool Co. punch (No. 730-S) to punch the hole and (No. 730-K) to punch the notch. V7-T-66 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

167 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Contents Description 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Product verview Product Identification Selection Product Selection Point-of-Purchase Packaging Non-Illuminated Momentary Pushbutton Units Pushbuttons Illuminated Momentary Pushbutton Units. Indicating Light Units Illuminated Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Push-Pull Emergency Stop Illuminated Push-Pull Units Potentiometers Push-Pull perators Selector Switch Units Selector Switch Selection Selector Switch perators Illuminated Selector Switch perators.... Joystick Units Joysticks Roto-Push Units Roto-Push perators AccessoriesAccessories ptions Replacement Parts Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Drawings nline Product Description The 30.5 mm pushbutton line features a zinc die cast construction with chromeplated housing and mounting nut. The same durable construction is also available with the corrosive resistant E34 line of pushbuttons. See E34 section on Pages V7-T-240 to V7-T-274. Features Heavy-duty zinc die cast construction Enclosed silver contacts with reliability nibs Diaphragm seals with drainage holes Grounding nibs on the operator casing Benefits Reliability nibs improve contact reliability even under dry circuit and fine dust conditions Drainage holes prevent buildup of liquid inside the operator which can prevent operation in freezing environments Grounding nibs bit through paint and other coatings to provide secure ground Application Description Contact peration Slow make and break. All normally closed contacts have positive opening operation, i.e., normally closed contacts are forced open in the event of contact weld or spring breakage. Standards and Certifications Page V7-T-68 V7-T-69 V7-T-70 V7-T-72 V7-T-73 V7-T-74 V7-T-78 V7-T-79 V7-T-80 V7-T-82 V7-T-85 V7-T-88 V7-T-89 V7-T-93 V7-T-94 V7-T-97 V7-T-200 V7-T-20 V7-T-202 V7-T-205 V7-T-206 V7-T-2 V7-T-26 V7-T-225 V7-T-227 V7-T-230 CE EN and UL 508 File No CSA C22.2 No. 4 File No. LR6855 Ingress Protection When mounted in similarly rated enclosure Standard indicating lights UL (NEMA) Type, 2, 3, 3R, 3S, 4, 4, 2, 3 IEC IP65 Most other operators UL (NEMA) Type, 2, 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 IEC IP65 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-67

168 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Product verview Reliability Nibs Eaton s contact blocks feature enclosed silver contacts with pointed reliability nibs for reliable performance from logic level up to 600V. To ensure reliable switching, nibs bite through oxide which can form on silver contacts, eliminating the need for expensive logic level blocks for most applications. Reliability Nibs Dry Circuit Medium Duty Heavy-Duty Reliability nibs improve performance in dry circuit, corrosive, fine dust and other contaminated atmospheres. Under normal environmental conditions, the minimum operational voltage is 5V and the minimum operational current is ma, AC/DC. For operation under a wider range of environmental conditions, logic level contact blocks with inert palladium tipped contacts are recommended. Grounding Nibs 0250T line operators have grounding nibs four metal points on the operator casting designed to bite through most paints and other coatings on metal panels to enhance the ground connection when the operator is securely tightened. Grounding Nibs Grounding Nibs Diaphragm Seal with Drainage Holes Liquid Drainage Eaton s pushbutton operators offer front of panel drainage via holes in the operator bushing. Hidden from view by the mounting nut, these holes prevent buildup of liquid inside the operator, which can prevent operation in freezing environments. The holes also provide a route for escaping liquid in high pressure washdowns, effectively relieving pressure from the internal diaphragm seal, ensuring reliable sealing in applications even beyond NEMA 4. Diaphragm Seal Foam Neoprene Panel Sealing Gasket Drainage Hole Flexible Diaphragm Stainless Steel perating Spring Colorfast Molded Button Drainage Hole Mounting Nut V7-T-68 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

169 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Product Identification 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Series Mounting Nut Legend Plate perator Color Coded Plungers Red = NC Green = N Terminal Clamps Shipped Ready to Wire Stackable Contact Blocks up to 2 Circuits per perator Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-69

170 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons Illuminated and Non-Illuminated Push-Pulls Note perator 5 = Two-position maintained 4 = Three-position mom push-mom pull 9 = Three-position mt push-mom pull 0 = Three-position mom push-mom pull Incandescent Light Unit Blank = Non-illuminated 89 = 24V/FR 63 = 20V/FR 64 = 208V/FR 65 = 240V/FR 82 = 277V/FR 66 = 380V/FR 67 = 480V/FR 68 = 600V/FR 69 = 6V/FV 70 = 2V/FV 79 = 24V/FV 83 = 32V/FV 80 = 20V/RES 8 = 240V/RES perator 0 = Flush = Extended 2 = 40 mm mushroom 7 = 65 mm mushroom 50 = /2 shroud vertical mount 5 = /2 shroud horizontal mount Add at end of catalog number to receive parts assembled from factory. 0250T 0 = Black 2 = Red 3 = Green 4 = Yellow Button Color 5 = Gray 6 = White 8 = Blue 9 = range 0250T 5 63 C47 LED Light Unit Blank = Non-illuminated 89L = 24V/FR 63L = 20V/FR 64L = 208V/FR 65L = 240V/FR 82L = 277V/FR 66L = 380V/FR 67L = 480V/FR 68L = 600V/FR 97L = Full voltage Circuit Blank = perator only = N-NC 2 = 2N 3 = 2NC 5 = NC 53 = N Non-illuminated Illuminated Button Incandescent LED Lens Type B60 = Black 40 mm B62 = Red 40 mm B63 = Red 40 mm E STP B6 = Green 40 mm B64 = Blue 40 mm J60 = Black 65 mm J62 = Red 65 mm J63 = Red 65 mm E STP J6 = Green 65 mm J64 = Yellow 65 mm LED Voltage Blank = Non-illuminated Blank = Incandescent 06 = 6 Vac/Vdc 2 = 2 Vac/Vdc 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc 48 = 48 Vac/Vdc 60 = 60 Vac/Vdc 2A = 20 Vac 2D = 20 Vdc C47 = C53 = C48 = C49 = C50 = C5 = C52 = C57 = C63 = C58 = C59 = C64 = C60 = C6 = C62 = C65 = C66 = C67 = RD = ED = GD = LD = AD = WD = = RS = ES = GS = LS = AS = YS = WS = = RH = GH = AH = Circuit Blank = perator only = N-NC 2 = 2N 3 = 2NC 5 =NC 53 =N Red 40 mm Red 40 mm E STP Green 40 mm Blue 40 mm Amber 40 mm White 40 mm Clear 40 mm Red side light Red side light E STP Green side light Blue side light Amber side light Yellow side light White side light Clear side light Red heavy-duty Green heavy-duty Amber heavy-duty V7-T-70 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

171 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Illuminated Pushbuttons Standard Indicating Lights, PresTest and Master Test Note Incandescent Light Unit 46 = 24V/FR 42 = 20V/FR 42 = 240V/FR 49 = 277V/FR 43 = 380V/FR 44 = 480V/FR 45 = 600V/FR 473 = 6V/FV 474 = 2V/FV 476 = 24V/FV 477 = 32V/FV 478 = 48V/FV 47 = 20V/RES 472 = 240V/RES LED Light Unit 46L = 24V/FR 4L = 20V/FR 42L = 240V/FR 49L = 277V/FR 43L = 380V/FR 44L = 480V/FR 45L = 600V/FR 497L = Full voltage Light Unit Type Standard Incandescent 8N = 20V/FR 82N = 240V/FR 98N = 277V/FR 83N = 380V/FR 84N = 480V/FR 85N = 600V/FR 203N = 6V/FV 204N = 2V/FV 206N = 24V/FV 207N = 32V/FV 208N = 48V/FV 20N = 20V/RES 202N = 240V/RES 226N = 20V/neon 227N = 240V/neon PresTest Incandescent 22N = 20V/FR 222N = 240V/FR 223N = 380V/FR 224N = 480V/FR 225N = 600V/FR 232N = 6V/FV 233N = 2V/FV 235N = 24V/FV 238N = 32V/FV 239N = 48V/FV 23N = 20V/RES 240N = 240V/RES Master Test Incandescent 87N = 20V/FR 89N = 240 Vac SS Standard LED 8L = 20V/FR 82L = 240V/FR 98L = 277V/FR 83L = 380V/FR 84L = 480V/FR 85L = 600V/FR 97L = Full voltage PresTest LED 22L = 20V/FR 222L = 240V/FR 223L = 380V/FR 224L = 480V/FR 225L = 600V/FR 297L = Full voltage Add at end of catalog number to receive parts assembled from factory. 0250T 46 C2 Incandescent Lens Color C2 = Red C22 = Green C23 = Yellow C26 = White C24 = Blue C43 = Amber C25 = Clear LED Lens Color RD =Red GD = Green YD = Yellow WD =White LD = Blue AD =Amber 0250T 203N CN LED Voltage Blank = Incandescent 06 = 6 Vac/Vdc 2 = 2 Vac/Vdc 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc 48 = 48 Vac/Vdc 60 = 60 Vac/Vdc 2A = 20 Vac 2D = 20 Vdc Plastic Glass Lens Color Plastic Glass Lens Color Standard/Master Incandescent Standard/Master/PresTest LED CN = C2N = C3N = C6N = C4N = C9N = C5N = C7N = Red C8N = Green = Yellow C2N = White C0N = Blue C9N = Amber CN = Clear PresTest Incandescent C2 = C22 = C23 = C26 = C24 = C43 = C25 = C3N = Red C4N = Green = Yellow C8N = White C6N = Blue C5N = Amber C7N = Clear RP = GP = YP = WP = LP = AP = RG = Red GG = Green = Yellow WG = White LG = Blue AG = Amber Circuit Blank = perator only = N-NC 2 = 2N 3 = 2NC 5 =NC 53 =N LED Voltage Blank = Incandescent 06 = 6 Vac/Vdc 2 = 2 Vac/Vdc 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc 48 = 48 Vac/Vdc 60 = 60 Vac/Vdc 2A = 20 Vac 2D = 20 Vdc LED Voltage Blank = Incandescent 06 = 6 Vac/Vdc 2 = 2 Vac/Vdc 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc 48 = 48 Vac/Vdc 60 = 60 Vac/Vdc 2A Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-7

172 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Product Selection Point-of-Purchase Packaging Point-of-Purchase Packaged Pilot Device 0250T Point-of-Purchase Packaged Pilot Devices Product Description Emergency Stop perators Red non-illuminated push-pull Red mushroom pushbutton Red jumbo mushroom pushbutton Momentary Pushbuttons Black flush pushbutton Red extended pushbutton Indicating Lights Red indicating light Red indicating light Illuminated Pushbuttons Red illuminating pushbutton Red illuminating pushbutton Selector Switches Black knob two-position selector switch Black knob three-position selector switch Black knob three-position selector switch N-NC contact block. Also includes two square engraved legend plates: EMERG. STP and STP. N-NC contact block. Also includes two square engraved legend plates: EMERG. STP and STP. Engraved EMERG. STP with N-NC contact block. N-NC contact block. Also includes two square engraved legend plates: START and JG. N-NC contact block. Also includes one square engraved legend plate: STP. Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc with two extra lenses: Green and amber. Also includes two square engraved legend plates: RUN and JG. Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc with two extra lenses: Green and Amber. Also includes one square engraved legend plate: RUN and JG. Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc with N-NC contact block and two extra lenses: Green and amber. Also includes one square engraved legend plate: PWER N. Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc with N-NC contact block and two extra lenses: Green and amber. Also includes one square engraved legend plate: PWER N. N-NC contact block. Also includes three square engraved legend plates: FF/N, HAND/AUT and RUN/JG. 2N-2NC contact blocks. Also includes square engraved legend plate: HAND/FF/AUT. N-NC contact block. Also includes legend plate: HAND/FF/AUT 0250T5B62--PP 0250T32R-PP 0250T33-PP 0250T30B-PP 0250T3R-PP 0250T206NCN-PP 0250T34R-PP 0250T476C2--PP 0250T4C2--PP 0250T20KB-PP 0250T22KB-PP 0250T2KB-PP V7-T-72 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

173 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Non-Illuminated Momentary Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Flush Button Extended Button Mushroom Button Jumbo Mushroom Pushbutton Units Flush, Extended, Mushroom Head or Jumbo Mushroom Head perators Contact Type Button Color Flush Button Note Anodized aluminum head is not suitable for use in ultraviolet light applications. Extended Button Mushroom Button Jumbo Mushroom N Black 0250T23B 0250T25B 0250T26B 0250T27B Red 0250T23R 0250T T T72-53 Green 0250T23G 0250T25G 0250T26G 0250T27G Yellow 0250T23Y 0250T25Y 0250T26Y 0250T27Y Red Engraved EMERG. STP 0250T NC Black 0250T T T T7-5 Red 0250T T25R 0250T26R 0250T27R Green 0250T T T T73-5 Yellow 0250T T T T74-5 Red Engraved EMERG. STP 0250T29 N-NC Black 0250T30B 0250T3B 0250T32B 0250T33B Red 0250T30R 0250T3R 0250T32R 0250T33R Green 0250T30G 0250T3G 0250T32G 0250T33G Yellow 0250T30Y 0250T3Y 0250T32Y 0250T33Y Red Engraved EMERG. STP 0250T33 2N Black 0250T T T T7-2 Red 0250T T T T72-2 Green 0250T T T T73-2 Yellow 0250T T T T74-2 Red Engraved EMERG. STP 0250T NC Black 0250T T T T7-3 Red 0250T T T T72-3 Green 0250T T T T73-3 Yellow 0250T T T T74-3 Red Engraved EMERG. STP 0250T723-3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-73

174 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Pushbuttons UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, T0_ 0250T_ 0250T5_ 0250T2_ 0250T7_ 0250ED64_ Momentary Pushbutton perators, Non-illuminated Button Color Note: To order complete assembled unit Flush button Black 0250T0 using one composite catalog number, add contact block and legend plate suffix Red 0250T02 to the end of operator catalog number. Example: 0250T0-TS33 Green 0250T03 Yellow 0250T04 Gray 0250T05 White 0250T06 Blue 0250T08 range 0250T09 Extended button Black 0250T perator 0250T0 Red 0250T2 Green 0250T3 Yellow 0250T20 White 0250T6 Blue 0250T8 range 0250T9 Half shrouded button Vertical Horizontal Black 0250T T5 Red 0250T T52 Green 0250T T53 Yellow 0250T T54 Gray 0250T T55 White 0250T T56 Blue 0250T T58 range 0250T T59 Mushroom button Black 0250T2 Red 0250T22 Green 0250T23 Yellow 0250T24 Blue 0250T29 Jumbo mushroom button 2 Black 0250T7 Red 0250T72 Red (EMERG. STP) 0250T723 Green 0250T73 Yellow 0250T74 Low operating force Black 0250ED64-2 jumbo mushroom 23 Red 0250ED64-3 Green Yellow Clear 0250ED ED ED64 Notes To order operator with factory assembled extended retaining nut, 0250TA2, for thick panel applications, add suffix letter E to listed catalog number. Example: 0250T0E. 2 Anodized aluminum head is not suitable for use in ultraviolet light applications. 3 perating force Standard = 2.4 lb; low force =.6 lb. Contact Block 0250T Legend Plate 0250TS33 V7-T-74 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

175 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, TA_ Mechanically Interlocked Pushbutton perators Description Black flush and green flush 0250TA66 Black flush and long red 0250TA67 Black flush and red mushroom head 0250TA68 Black flush and lock-down red mushroom head 0250TA69 Black flush and red jumbo mushroom head 0250TA76 Green flush and long red 0250TA72 Black long and long red 0250TA73 Green flush and red mushroom head 0250TA77 Green flush and black flush 0250TA75 Note NC contacts must be mounted behind lock-down mushroom head operator to ensure lockout. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-75

176 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Lockout Pushbutton perators with Padlock Attachments UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 The following pushbutton and mushroom operators include an integral padlock attachment for applications requiring lockout/tagout of specific machine functions. They are available in styles which allow locking of a button in the down position 0250TA6 0250TA4_ 0250TA5_ (stopped position) or locking a button in the up position (to prevent starting). Select the Hand latch type which functions as a momentary pushbutton until the operator presses the button and moves the padlock attachment into position for locking, or choose the Spring Loaded latch type where the padlock attachment springs into place when the button is pressed. Units accept a customer supplied /4 in padlock. Padlockable in the Down Position perator Type Color Latch Type Flush head Red Hand 0250TA6 Mushroom head Red Hand 0250TA42 Red Spring loaded 0250TA45 Jumbo head 2 Red Hand 0250TA52 Red Spring loaded 0250TA55 Red (EMERG. STP) Spring loaded 0250ED952 Padlockable in the Up Position perator Type Color Latch Type Mushroom head Black Hand 0250TA4 Green Hand 0250TA43 Jumbo mushroom Black Hand 0250TA5 head 2 Green Hand 0250TA53 Yellow Hand 0250TA54 Notes Hand attachment must be manually moved into place for locking. Spring loaded: when operator is pressed attachment springs into place. Must be moved manually to release button. perators can be latched down without a padlock. Padlock not included. 2 Jumbo mushroom heads are not recommended for use in applications where exposure to ultraviolet light exists. V7-T-76 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

177 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Key Pushbutton perator UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 These devices incorporate an integral locking mechanism which enables locking units in various positions (Locked Down), locking units to prevent operation (Locked Up) or setting unit to lock when the button is pressed (Push to Lock), requiring the key to be inserted to return to Replacement Keys or Dissimilar Locks for Key perators Below Listed operators have Replacement Keys identical locks and keys Description (Key Code H66) Catalog Number 0250ED824. For Replacement keys 0250ED824 (code H66) dissimilar lock and key combinations, see listing on Page V7-T T43_ Key Pushbutton perator Key Position and C L R Pushbutton perations Latch-In, Twist-to-Release perator UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, ED043-4 perator nly with Button Description Latch-in, twist-to-release operator with red mushroom head button Note Horizontal mounting available on request. Key Removal Positions normal operation. With the key in the center position, these operators function as a normal momentary pushbutton (Free). Vertical Mounting Three-Position Lock up Free Lock down All 0250T430 Lock up Free Lock down L and R 0250T43 Lock up Free Lock down C and R 0250T432 Two-Position Lock up Free L and C 0250T433 Lock up Free L 0250T434 Free Lock down C and R 0250T435 Free Lock down R 0250T436 Free Push to lock C and R 0250T437 Free Push to lock R 0250T ED043-4 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-77

178 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Illuminated Momentary Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 LED or incandescent Full voltage, resistor or transformer type Plastic lenses 24V Full Voltage Illuminated Pushbutton Illuminated Pushbutton Units Illuminated Pushbutton LED/Lamp N N-NC NC Type Voltage Color Number LED Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red Bayonet 0250T397LRD T397LRD T397LRD24-5 Green base 0250T397LGD T397LGD T397LGD24-5 Amber 0250T397LAD T397LAD T397LAD24-5 Yellow 0250T397LYD T397LYD T397LYD24-5 Blue 0250T397LLD T397LLD T397LLD24-5 White 0250T397LWD T397LWD T397LWD Vac Red 0250T397LRD2A T397LRD2A- 0250T397LRD2A-5 Green 0250T397LGD2A T397LGD2A- 0250T397LGD2A-5 Amber 0250T397LAD2A T397LAD2A- 0250T397LAD2A-5 Yellow 0250T397LYD2A T397LYD2A T397LYD2A-5 Blue 0250T397LLD2A T397LLD2A- 0250T397LLD2A-5 White 0250T397LWD2A T397LWD2A- 0250T397LWD2A-5 Transformer 20 Vac Red 0250T4LRD T4LRD T4LRD06-5 Green 0250T4LGD T4LGD T4LGD06-5 Amber 0250T4LAD T4LAD T4LAD06-5 Yellow 0250T4LYD T4LYD T4LYD06-5 Blue 0250T4LLD T4LLD T4LLD06-5 White 0250T4LWD T4LWD T4LWD06-5 Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red # T476C T476C2-0250T476C2-5 Green 0250T476C T476C T476C22-5 Amber 0250T476C T476C T476C43-5 Yellow 0250T476C T476C T476C23-5 Blue 0250T476C T476C T476C24-5 Clear 0250T476C T476C T476C25-5 White 0250T476C T476C T476C26-5 Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc Red 20MB 0250T47C T47C2-0250T47C2-5 Green 0250T47C T47C T47C22-5 Amber 0250T47C T47C T47C43-5 Yellow 0250T47C T47C T47C23-5 Blue 0250T47C T47C T47C24-5 Clear 0250T47C T47C T47C25-5 White 0250T47C T47C T47C26-5 Transformer 20 Vac Red # T75R 0250T76R 0250T77R Green 0250T75G 0250T76G 0250T77G Amber 0250T75A 0250T76A 0250T77A Yellow 0250T75Y 0250T76Y 0250T77Y Blue 0250T75B 0250T76B 0250T77B Clear 0250T75C 0250T76C 0250T77C White 0250T75W 0250T76W 0250T77W Note For flashing module catalog number 0250TFL, add suffix code FM to listed catalog number. Example: 0250T75RFM. V7-T-78 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

179 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Indicating Light Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 LED or incandescent Full voltage, resistor or transformer type 24V Full Voltage Illuminated Light 20 Vac Transformer PresTest Standard and PresTest types Plastic lenses Notes Standard indicating lights are rated UL (NEMA) 3S as well. 2 For flashing lamp add letter F to listed catalog number. Example: 0250T34RF. PresTest This device incorporates a press-to-test feature whereby depressing the lens disconnects the light from the source being monitored and connects the lamp to a continuously energized circuit for immediate detection of faulty lamps. Indicating Light Units LED/Lamp Indicating Light PresTest Type Voltage Color Number LED Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red Bayonet 0250T97LRP T297LRP24 Green base 0250T97LGP T297LGP24 Amber 0250T97LAP T297LAP24 Yellow 0250T97LYP T297LYP24 Blue 0250T97LLP T297LLP24 White 0250T97LWP T297LWP24 20 Vac Red 0250T97LRP2A 0250T297LRP2A Green 0250T97LGP2A 0250T297LGP2A Amber 0250T97LAP2A 0250T297LAP2A Yellow 0250T97LYP2A 0250T297LYP2A Blue 0250T97LLP2A 0250T297LLP2A White 0250T97LWP2A 0250T297LWP2A Transformer 20 Vac Red 0250T8LRP T22LRP06 Green 0250T8LGP T22LGP06 Amber 0250T8LAP T22LAP06 Yellow 0250T8LYP T22LYP06 Blue 0250T8LLP T22LLP06 White 0250T8LWP T22LWP06 Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red # T206NCN 0250T235NC2 Green 0250T206NC2N 0250T235NC22 Amber 0250T206NC9N 0250T235NC43 Yellow 0250T206NC3N 0250T235NC23 Blue 0250T206NC4N 0250T235NC24 Clear 0250T206NC5N 0250T235NC25 White 0250T206NC6N 0250T235NC26 Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc Red 20MB 0250T20NCN 0250T23NC2 Green 0250T20NC2N 0250T23NC22 Amber 0250T20NC9N 0250T23NC43 Yellow 0250T20NC3N 0250T23NC23 Blue 0250T20NC4N 0250T23NC24 Clear 0250T20NC5N 0250T23NC25 White 0250T20NC6N 0250T23NC26 Transformer 2 20 Vac Red # T34R 0250T74NR Green 0250T34G 0250T74NG Amber 0250T34A 0250T74NA Yellow 0250T34Y 0250T74NY Blue 0250T34B 0250T74NB Clear 0250T34C 0250T74NC White 0250T34W 0250T74NW Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-79

180 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Illuminated Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights LED or incandescent Full voltage, resistor or transformer type Illuminated Pushbutton Indicating Light PresTest Master Test perators without Lens Type Voltage LED/Lamp Number Illuminated Pushbutton Indicating Light PresTest Master Test Incandescent Unit Full voltage AC/DC 6 # T T203N 0250T232N 2 # T T204N 0250T233N 24 # T T206N 0250T235N 32 # T T207N 0250T238N 48 # T T208N 0250T239N Resistor AC/DC MB 0250T T20N 0250T23N MB 0250T T202N 0250T240N Transformer AC only 3 24 # T T4 0250T8N 0250T22N T T82N 0250T222N T T98N T T83N 0250T223N T T84N 0250T224N T T85N 0250T225N Neon AC/DC 4 20 NE5H-R T226N 240 NE5H-R T227N Solid-state 50/60 Hz only 20 20MB 0250T89N LED (LEDs not included) Full voltage Bayonet 0250T397L 0250T97L 0250T297L Transformer AC only 24 base 0250T46L T4L 0250T8L 0250T22L T42L 0250T82L 0250T222L T49L 0250T98L T43L 0250T83L 0250T223L T44L 0250T84L 0250T224L T45L 0250T85L 0250T225L Notes These units do not include lamps. rder LED separately to match lens color. See Page V7-T-225 for LED Selection and Page V7-T-7 for ing System. 2 Resistor units are not available for use with LEDs, choose either transformer or full voltage LED style. 3 For flashing lamp, add letter F to listed catalog number. Example: 0250T8NF. 4 Resistant to shock and vibration. For best illumination use amber, yellow or clear lens. V7-T-80 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

181 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Plastic Glass 0250TC2_ Plastic Glass Indicating and Master Test Lenses Color Illuminated Pushbutton Lenses Color PresTest Lenses Plastic Glass Red 0250TCN 0250TC7N Green 0250TC2N 0250TC8N Amber 0250TC9N 0250TC9N Yellow 0250TC3N Blue 0250TC4N 0250TC0N Clear 0250TC5N 0250TCN White 0250TC6N 0250TC2N Red Green Yellow Amber Blue Clear White Color 0250TC2 0250TC TC TC TC TC TC26 Plastic Glass Red 0250TC2 0250TC3N Green 0250TC TC4N Amber 0250TC TC5N Yellow 0250TC23 Blue 0250TC TC6N Clear 0250TC TC7N White 0250TC TC8N Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-8

182 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Push-Pull Emergency Stops (Compliant with IEC ) UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two- and three-position Non-illuminated LNC contact block 0250T579C47-7 Button Type/Color Lamp Type Voltage Two-Position Push-Pull Units Pull Push perator Position 40 mm red illuminated Incandescent Transformer 20 Vac/Vdc 0250T563C mm red illuminated EMERG. STP Incandescent Transformer 20 Vac/Vdc 0250T563C mm red illuminated EMERG. STP LED Transformer 20 Vac/Vdc 0250T563LED mm red illuminated Incandescent Full voltage 24 Vdc 0250T579C mm red illuminated EMERG. STP Incandescent Full voltage 24 Vdc 0250T579C mm red illuminated Incandescent Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc 0250T580C mm red illuminated EMERG. STP Incandescent Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc 0250T580C mm red illuminated Incandescent Transformer 24 Vac 0250T589C mm red illuminated EMERG. STP Incandescent Transformer 24 Vac 0250T589C mm red illuminated EMERG. STP LED Transformer 24 Vac 0250T589LED mm red illuminated LED Transformer 24 Vac 0250T589LRD mm red illuminated EMERG. STP LED Full voltage 24 Vdc 0250T597LED mm red illuminated EMERG. STP LED Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc 0250T597LED2A-7 40 mm red illuminated LED Full voltage 24 Vdc 0250T597LRD mm red illuminated LED Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc 0250T597LRD2A-7 40 mm red 0250T5B mm red 0250T5B mm red 0250T5J mm red 0250T5J63-7 Note = closed circuit, = open circuit. V7-T-82 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

183 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, T5B T5B T5J ED080-2 Standard Jumbo Mushroom Head Two-Position Push-Pull Units perator Position Pull Push Contact Mounting Location Button Type/Color 2 Type A B 2 Two-Position Maintained Push, Maintained Pull 40 mm/red N 0250T5B62- NC Button and Color Selection Color Suffix Code Standard 40 mm Red B TB62 Red (EMERG. STP) B TB63 Green B6 0250TB6 Black B TB60 Blue B TB64 Jumbo Mushroom Head 3 (Anodized) Aluminum 65 mm Red J TJ62 Red (EMERG. STP) J TJ63 Green J6 0250TJ6 Black J TJ60 Yellow J TJ64 Notes 40 mm engraved EMERG. STP/red 65 mm aluminum engraved EMERG. STP/red 65 mm aluminum engraved EMERG. STP/red Special security jumbo mushroom head = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color buttons, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the table. Example: 0250T5B Anodized aluminum head is not suitable for use in ultraviolet light applications. N NC N NC N NC 0250T5B T5J ED080-2 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-83

184 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, T_ Standard Jumbo Mushroom Head Three-Position Push-Pull Units perator Position Pull Intermediate Push Mounting Location Contact Button Type/Color 2 Type A B 2 Maintained Push, Momentary Pull Button and Color Selection Color Suffix Code Standard 40 mm Red B TB62 Red (EMERG. STP) B TB63 Green B6 0250TB6 Black B TB60 Blue B TB64 Jumbo Mushroom Head 3 (Anodized) Aluminum 65 mm Red J TJ62 Red (EMERG. STP) J TJ63 Green J6 0250TJ6 Black J TJ60 Yellow J TJ64 Notes Momentary Push, Momentary Pull 40 mm/black NC 0250T9B mm/red NC 0250T9B mm engraved EMERG. STP/red = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color buttons, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the table. Example: 0250T5B Anodized aluminum head is not suitable for use in ultraviolet light applications. 0250T9B mm/black NC 0250T4B mm/red NC 0250T4B mm/black N 0250T0B60-40 mm/red NC 0250T0B62- V7-T-84 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

185 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Illuminated Push-Pull Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 LED or incandescent Full voltage, resistor or transformer type Two-position maintained Two-Position Push- Pull perator 0250ED37_ Two-Position Illuminated Maintained Push, Maintained Pull perator Position Maintained Pull Jumbo Lens Illuminated E-Stops Notes Maintained Push Lamp Type Voltage Contact Type Mounting Location A B LED/Lamp Number Red Standard Push-Pull 2 LED Full Voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N Bayonet 0250T597LRD24-20 Vac/Vdc NC base 0250T597LRD2A- Transformer 24 Vac 0250T589LRD06-20 Vac 0250T563LRD06- Incandescent Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N # T579C47- Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc NC 20MB 0250T580C47- Transformer 24 Vac # T589C47-20 Vac 0250T563C47- Lamp Button Type/Color Type Voltage LED LED LED LED Two-position illuminated maintained push/pull 50 mm jumbo lens/red Three-position illuminated momentary push/pull 50 mm jumbo lens/red Three-position illuminated momentary push/pull 50 mm jumbo lens/red Three-position illuminated maintained push/momentary pull 50 mm lens/red Contact Type Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N NC Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC NC Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N NC Full voltage N NC 0250ED ED ED ED378 = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color lens, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from table on next page. Example: 0250T579C63-. For LEDs with different voltages see ordering example on Page V7-T-9. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-85

186 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Standard Side-Lighted Aluminum Aluminum Transparent Center Jumbo Lens Lens and Color Selection Color Note Clear anodized aluminum and colored lens. Incandescent Suffix Code LED Suffix Code Standard 40 mm Red C47 RD 0250TC47 Red (EMERG. STP) C53 ED 0250TC53 Green C48 GD 0250TC48 Blue C49 LD 0250TC49 Amber C50 AD 0250TC50 White C5 WD 0250TC5 Clear C52 CD 0250TC52 Side-Lighted Aluminum 40 mm Red C57 RS 0250TC57 Red (EMERG. STP) C63 ES 0250TC63 Green C58 GS 0250TC58 Blue C59 LS 0250TC59 Amber C64 AS 0250TC64 Yellow C60 YS 0250TC60 White C6 WS 0250TC6 Clear C62 CS 0250TC62 Aluminum Transparent Center 40 mm Red C65 RH 0250TC65 Green C66 GH 0250TC66 Amber C67 AH 0250TC67 Jumbo Lens 50 mm Red 0250TC77 V7-T-86 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

187 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Three-Position Push- Pull perator Three-Position Push- Pull perator Three-Position Illuminated Momentary Push, Momentary Pull perator Position Momentary Pull Three-Position Illuminated Maintained Push, Momentary Pull perator Position Momentary Pull Notes Maintained Intermediate Maintained Intermediate Momentary Push Momentary Push Lamp Type Voltage Contact Type Mounting Location A B = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color lens, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from table on Page V7-T-86. Example: 0250T079C53-. For LEDs with different voltages see ordering example on Page V7-T-9. 3 To order different type or color lens, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from table on Page V7-T-86. Example: 0250T979C53. For LEDs with different voltages see ordering example on Page V7-T-9. LED/ Lamp Number Red Standard Push-Pull 3 LED Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N Bayonet 0250T097LRD24-20 Vac NC base 0250T097LRD2A- Transformer 24 Vac 0250T089LRD06-20 Vac 0250T063LRD06- Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC Bayonet 0250T497LRD Vac NC base 0250T497LRD2A-3 Transformer 24 Vac 0250T489LRD Vac 0250T463LRD06-3 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N # T079C47- Resistor 20 Vac NC 20MB 0250T080C47- Transformer 24 Vac # T089C47-20 Vac 0250T063C47- Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC # T479C47-3 Resistor 20 Vac NC 20MB 0250T480C47-3 Transformer 24 Vac # T489C Vac 0250T463C47-3 Lamp Type Voltage Contact Type Mounting Location A B LED/ Lamp Number Red Standard Push-Pull 2 LED Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC Bayonet 0250T997LRD Vac NC base 0250T997LRD2A-3 Incandescent Incandescent Transformer 24 Vac 0250T989LRD Vac 0250T963LRD06-3 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC # T979C47-3 Resistor 20 Vac NC 20MB 0250T980C47-3 Transformer 24 Vac # T989C Vac 0250T963C47-3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-87

188 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Potentiometers UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 2, 3 Vertical or Horizontal ne-hole Mounting Potentiometer with Knob and Standard Dial Plate Linear Type ±0% Potentiometer hms 2 Watt (60V Max.) Single Potentiometer with Standard Aluminum Dial Plate T T T T T T335 perator only T330 Alternative black plastic large legend with standard markings E34LP99 Notes Shown with standard aluminum dial plate. 2 Large dial plate with space for legend is available at no charge. To order, add suffix 36 to catalog number. Example: 0250T3336. To order separately, see footnote 3 below. 3 Large dial plate has space at top for 5 letters. 3/32 in high. For custom stamped legend plates, order legend plate as separate item 0250TR30 and specify stamping. 4 For use with commercially purchased potentiometers having shaft dimensions per dimension drawing on Page V7-T-235. V7-T-88 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

189 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Push-Pull perators An illuminated push-pull pushbutton unit, arranged for one-hole mounting, can replace two pushbuttons and a pilot light or the nonilluminated form can replace two pushbuttons. These units are available in three basic types: Two-Position Maintained Push-Pull Maintained (Twoposition). Maintains in the pulled or pushed position until manually actuated to the opposite mode. Momentary (Threeposition). Spring returns to an intermediate position when pulled or pushed and released. Momentary Pull, Maintained Push (Threeposition). Spring returns to intermediate position when pulled. Maintains in pushed position until manually returned to intermediate (ready to reset) position. Maintained stop holds circuit open and will prevent other series connected operators from starting the system. Typical Applications Control Line Diagram perator Circuits perator Mode Three-wire three-position momentary Two-wire two-position maintained Three-wire momentary pull maintained push L L L A Circuit B Circuit M A or B Circuit A Circuit B Circuit Push-Pull perator M L Push-Pull perator M L M Push-Pull perator M L Momentary push and pull 0250T4 Momentary push and pull 0250T0 Maintained push and pull 0250T5 Maintained push and momentary pull 0250T9 2NC contact block 0250T3 N-NC contact block 0250T NC contact block 0250T5 2NC contact block 0250T3 START (mom.) START (maint.) START (mom.) Notes A and B circuits shown in the application illustrations are defined in the Application Guide on the following page. Shown without button on lens. L2 L2 L2 The operators, buttons, contact blocks, etc., are offered as building block components that can be intermixed to satisfy many requirements. This minimizes the need for a varied and costly inventory. Normal pos. (maint.) No intermediate position Normal pos. (maint.) STP (mom.) STP (maint.) STP (maint.) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-89

190 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Application Guide To assist in the selection of contact blocks, the sketch to the right shows pictorially by symbols A and B locations of contact circuits after assembly of contact blocks 0250T579C47-7 and adapter to the operator. The table below shows the effect of the push and pull operations on either N or NC contacts. ( = contact closed, = contact open). Contact Circuit Locations Locating Nib Push-Pull perator Components perator Position and Circuit Arrangement ut Pull Intermediate In Push Type of perator Two-Position perator without Lens Maintained push-pull Maintained push-pull with anti-theft jumbo mushroom Contact Block Mounting Location A B A B A B Three-Position perator without Lens Momentary push-pull Maintained push-momentary pull Momentary push-pull or or or or or No intermediate position No intermediate position or or or Note Maximum of two blocks, four circuits. Special function contact blocks shown on Page V7-T-22 CANNT be used with three-position push-pull operators 0250T4, 0250T9 or 0250T0. or or or or or A B Contact Block N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2ND 0250T5 0250ED T4 0250T9 0250T0 V7-T-90 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

191 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Push-Pull Light Units, Lenses and Buttons rdering Example with ne Composite Number Non-illuminated: 0250T TB T = 0250T5B62- Incandescent: 0250T T TC T = 0250T579C47- LED: 0250T T97L TC47 + Voltage code T = 0250T597LRD Vac/Vdc 2 2 Vac/Vdc Vac/Vdc Vac/Vdc Vac/Vdc 2A 20 Vac 2D 20 Vdc Light Units for Illuminated Push-Pull Devices Light Unit Type Type Voltage LED/Lamp Number LED Full voltage Bayonet (LEDs not included) base Transformer 24 AC only 20 50/60 Hz Incandescent Full voltage AC or DC Resistor AC or DC Transformer AC only 50/60 Hz / MB Note These units do not include lamps. rder LED separately to match lens color, see Page V7-T T97L 0250T89L 0250T63L 0250T64L 0250T65L 0250T82L 0250T66L 0250T67L 0250T68L 0250T T T T T T8 # T T T T T T T T68 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-9

192 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Standard Side-Lighted Anodized Aluminum Ring Heavy-Duty Aluminum Jumbo Lens Standard Jumbo Mushroom Head Alternate Lenses for Illuminated Push-Pull Devices Lens Color Buttons for Non-Illuminated Push-Pull Devices Color Suffix Code Legend Plates Standard For a complete listing Red B TB62 of available legend plates see Pages V7-T-26 to Red (EMERG. STP) B TB63 V7-T-28. Green B6 0250TB6 Jumbo Black B TB60 Standard Blue B TB64 P R Jumbo Mushroom Head 2 S T (Anodized) Aluminum Red J TJ62 Red (EMERG. STP) J TJ63 Green J6 0250TJ6 Black J TJ60 Yellow J TJ64 Notes Incandescent Suffix Code LED Suffix Code Standard Red C47 RD 0250TC47 Red (EMERG. STP) C53 ED 0250TC53 Green C48 GD 0250TC48 Blue C49 LD 0250TC49 Amber C50 AD 0250TC50 White C5 WD 0250TC5 Clear C52 CD 0250TC52 Side-Lighted Anodized Aluminum Ring Red C57 RS 0250TC57 Red (EMERG. STP) C63 ES 0250TC63 Green C58 GS 0250TC58 Blue C59 LS 0250TC59 Amber C64 AS 0250TC64 Yellow C60 YS 0250TC60 White C6 WS 0250TC6 Clear C62 CS 0250TC62 Heavy-Duty Aluminum with Transparent Center Red C65 RH 0250TC65 Green C66 GH 0250TC66 Amber C67 AH 0250TC67 Blue C TC69 White C TC68 Jumbo Lens 50 mm Red 0250TC77 Suffix codes should only be used for assembling composite catalog numbers. To order lens above, order by catalog number. 2 Anodized aluminum head is not suitable for use in ultraviolet light applications. V7-T-92 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

193 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Selector Switch Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two-, three- and four-position maintained Non-illuminated and illuminated Two-Position Maintained Switch Three-Position Maintained Switch Three-Position Maintained Switch Three-Position Maintained Switch Two-Position Selector Switch perator Position Three-Position Selector Switch perator Position Four-Position Selector Switch perator Position Color Selection Notes perator Action 2 Contact Type Mounting Location A B Non-Illuminated Black Knob 3 Black Lever 3 Illuminated 20V Transformer Red Knob 3 Red Lever 3 NC 0250T20KB 0250T20LB 0250ED7-KR 0250ED7-LR M M N perator Action 2 Contact Type Mounting Location A B Non-Illuminated Black Knob 3 Black Lever 3 Illuminated 20V Transformer Red Knob 3 Red Lever 3 M N 0250T2KB 0250T2LB 0250ED7-2KR 0250ED7-2LR M M N N 0250T22KB 0250T22LB 0250ED7-3KR 0250ED7-3LR 2NC (Series) N perator Action 2 Contact Type Mounting Location A B Non-Illuminated Black Knob 3 Black Lever 3 Illuminated 20V Transformer Red Knob 3 Red Lever 3 M M NC 0250T46KB 0250T46LB 0250ED7-4KR 0250ED7-4LR M M N N NC Illuminated Code Color Letter Red Green R G Color White Blue Code Letter W B Color Amber Clear Code Letter A C Non-Illuminated Code Color Letter = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 M = Maintained. 3 To order different type or color selector switch, substitute the underlined character with appropriate suffix code from the Color Selection table. Example: 0250T20KG. Black Red B R Color Green White Code Letter G W Color Blue range Code Letter L Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-93

194 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Selector Switch Selection Cam and Contact Block Selection Selector switches in their varied forms (two-position, three-position and fourposition) are a big factor contributing to the great flexibility of control that a well rounded line of pushbuttons can achieve. Because of their flexibility, they tend to cause difficulty with product selection and application. The following systematic approach should simplify that task. Cam and contact block selection is better understood if you: Work with each incoming and outgoing wire/circuit separately. Recognize the terms N and NC only identify the type of contact by its mode before mounting to the operator. The - table (Page V7-T-96) shows how that contact will act after assembly to the operator with the selected cam shape. = closed circuit, = open circuit. Up to six N or NC contacts may be mounted behind each plunger location for a total of twelve contacts. Single circuit contact blocks have only one plunger with the other side of the block open. Therefore, single circuit contact blocks transmit motion to blocks behind them only for the position containing the circuit. Each cam has two separate lobes, each of which operates one of the two contact block plungers independently of each other. Those are identified as position A (locating nib side) and position B (opposite of locating nib). The position designations give direction in selecting and mounting of the contact blocks. Contact Circuit Locations Locating Nib A B Systematic Approach Application: HAND-FF- AUT selector switch. In this circuit, one incoming line is distributed to two other outgoing circuits by the switch. The two circuits can be looked at individually. Step : Elementary Diagram. Construct on paper, or in your mind, a simple elementary diagram of the switching scheme as follows: Incoming Line Step 2: - Pattern. From the elementary diagram, you can construct an - diagram which describes when the contacts are to be closed () or open () in the various positions of the switch. The - for the HAND circuit looks like this: HAND HAND FF AUT FF AUT utgoing Circuit utgoing Circuit In this circuit, you want a contact closed on the left (HAND) but open in the center and right. For the AUT circuit, the - diagram would look like this: HAND FF AUT Putting them together, the complete - diagram is: nce the - diagram has been generated the next step is to select the cam and contact block, or blocks, needed to perform the desired - functions. The selection tables on the following pages list the various types (shapes) of cams by number to choose from and the type of contact and position to achieve the function outlined in your - diagram. V7-T-94 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

195 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Step 3: Cam Selection. The cam you select determines the operation of all contact blocks mounted to the operator. It is selected on the basis that it provides the simplest circuitry for the desired - diagram. The selection tables show all the - combinations. For the purpose of this example, the applicable portion of those tables is shown on this page. Now to make the cam selection, make a simple worksheet such as: Cam 2 Cam 3 (A)N-(B)NC (B)N (A)N (B)N It becomes immediately obvious that cam 3 is the better choice for two reasons, () the series combination can be avoided making it simpler to wire, (2) only two contacts are required, which is less expensive than the three contacts required by cam 2. Step 4: Contact Block Selection. Having selected the cam, contact block selection is simply a matter of gathering the A position and B position circuits into pairs which make up the most convenient contact block arrangement. If there is an imbalance in the number of circuits under A or B, then single circuit blocks must be selected for these leftover circuits. Step 5: Selector Switch perator. Lastly, you have to choose from the many types of operators knob and lever in various colors or keyed. Also what combinations of maintained and spring return functions are required. Selection of these operators can be found on Page V7-T-98. For the example in step 4 you may want a three-position maintained black knob, cam T323. The Complete Switch: 0250T323 with one 0250T2 or, for one composite catalog number, 0250T2KB found on Page V7-T-93. Diagrams Circuits shown illustrate connections to obtain a selector switch circuit combination and are shown with their appropriate line diagrams. Field wiring of jumper connections required as shown. = Closed circuit = pen circuit Wiring of Jumper Connections Series Connection Parallel Connection Example Selection Table No. Two-Position Selector Switch Contact Block Selection Desired Circuit and perator Position Contact Blocks Required to Accomplish Circuit Function No. Top Plunger A Bottom Plunger B Note - Pattern Wired in series. Cam Code #2 Cam Code #3 Top A Bottom B Top A Bottom B N NC N 4 2 a NC N N or or NC N N Back to the worksheet, having selected cam 3 do this: AN BN 0250T2 Four-position selector switches are limited to four contact blocks. Contact Blocks For selection and number of available contact blocks per operator, see Pages V7-T-22 to V7-T-224. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-95

196 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Three-Position Switch Cam and Contact Block Selection Contact Blocks Required to Accomplish Circuit Function (Jumpers must be installed where indicated) Desired Circuit and perator with Cam Code #2 perator with Cam Code #3 perator Position Mounting Location Mounting Location No Top Plunger A Four-Position Switch Contact Block Selection Contact Blocks Required to Accomplish Circuit Function Desired Circuit and Mounting Location perator Position No Top Plunger A NC N NC N N NC Bottom Plunger B N NC N N NC Bottom Plunger B N NC NC N NC N N NC NC N N Top Plunger A N NC Bottom Plunger B NC N N NC NC NC No. Desired Circuit and perator Position Contact Blocks Required to Accomplish Circuit Function Mounting Location Top Plunger A NC N NC N N N NC NC Bottom Plunger B N NC N NC N NC V7-T-96 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

197 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Selector Switch perators Key perators UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two-Position Maintained Key perators with Cam Positions perator Action 2 Cam Code 3 Removal Positions 4 ptional Key Vertical Mounting Notes Horizontal mount, key removal # keyed selector switch, cam shown. 2 M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow (R). 3 For selection of the proper cam and contact block to obtain the proper circuit sequence, see selection instructions and tables on Pages V7-T-94, V7-T-95 and V7-T Choose key removal position required for application from table on Page V7-T-98. Add key removal code no. to listed catalog number. Example: 0250T52. Horizontal Mounting Two-position 60 throw, 2, T5_ 0250T6_ M M M S T57_ 0250T58_ Three-position 60 throw M T522_ 0250T622_ M M T523_ 0250T623_ M 2, 4, T532_ 0250T632_ S M T533_ 0250T633_ M T542_ 0250T642_ S S T543_ 0250T643_ M 2 2, 4, T652_ 0250T662_ M S T653_ 0250T663_ Four-position 40 throw M M T677_ 0250T687_ M M Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-97

198 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Key Removal Positions L Code Suffix C R Key Removal Position Right only 2 Left only 3 Right and left 4 Center only 5 Right and center 6 Left and center 7 All positions Note: Key removal in spring return from positions not recommended. Replacement Keys or Dissimilar Locks for Key perators perators listed on Page V7-T-98 have identical locks and keys (Key Code H66) 0250ED824. For dissimilar lock and key combinations, see listing on this page. Selector Switch perators with Caps UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two-Position Maintained Three-Position Maintained 5 Replacement Key Description Replacement keys 0250ED824 (code H66) Selector Switch perators with Dissimilar Locks and Keys (UL [NEMA] 4, 4 and 3) The locks in all key operators listed on Pages V7-T-77, V7-T-98 and V7-T-335 are identical and use key code number H66. Two keys are supplied with every lock. For additional code number H66 keys, order 0250ED824. For others, order 0250ED30 and designate lock number. When dissimilar locks for each operator or each group of operators are required, select from the lock and key combination listed below. When rdering perator nly or a complete control unit with a substitute lock, order from table below and add except Lock and Key Code No. H Series Locks without Master Key with Key Slot Cover Lock and Key Code Numbers H50 H635 H663 H620 H639 H675 H62 H643 H683 H634 H654 H688 M Series Locks with Master Key with Key Slot Cover Lock and Key Code Numbers MD MD4 ME8 MJ6 MD2 MD5 ME MJ0 MD3 MD6 ME6 MJ MD4 MD9 ME7 MJ3 MD5 MD20 ME8 MJ5 MD7 ME2 ME9 MJ6 MD9 ME3 MJ MD7 MD0 ME5 MJ3 MD ME6 MJ4 MD3 ME7 MJ5 Master Keys for Above Locks Application For code: MD MD ED825-3 ME2 ME8 0250ED825-4 MJ MJ6 0250ED825-5 Selector Switch perators with Caps Black Knob Selector Switch Black Lever Selector Switch Vertical Mounting 3 Vertical Mounting 3 Positions perator Action 2 Cam Code 4 Cam Code 4 Two-position 60 throw 0250T3 0250T30 M M M S 0250T T307 Three-position 60 throw M T T3022 M M T T3023 M T T3032 S M T T3033 M T T304 S S T T3043 M T T3052 M S T T3053 Four-position 40 throw M M T T3067 M M Notes Black knob selector switch, cam shown. 2 M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow (R). 3 Field convertible to horizontal mounting or order operator only and separate operator cap. 4 For selection of the proper cam and contact block to obtain the proper circuit sequence, see selection instructions and tables on Pages V7-T-94, V7-T-95 and V7-T Black lever selector switch, cam 3 shown. V7-T-98 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

199 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Selector Switch perators without Caps perators can be ordered with caps assembled to them by adding the code number from the table on this page to the end of catalog number below. Example: 0250T40KB Two-Position Selector Switch Maintained Knob Lever Lever for Use with Maintained perators Coin Slot Selector Switch perators without Caps Positions perator Action Cam Code 2 Two-position 60 throw 0250T40 M M perating Caps Notes 0250T408 Three-position 60 throw M T4022 M M T T T T T T T4053 Four-position 40 throw M M T4067 Color Knob Catalog and Code Number M S S M M M M M S M S S M Lever Catalog and Code Number M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow (R). 2 For selection of the proper cam and contact block to obtain the proper circuit sequence, see selection instructions and tables on Pages V7-T-94, V7-T-95 and V7-T Designed for added ingress protection. For use in maintained operators only. Color Lever 3 Catalog and Code Number Coin Slot Catalog and Code Number Black 0250TKB 0250TLB Black 0250TSB 0250TCB Red 0250TKR 0250TLR Red 0250TSR 0250TCR Green 0250TKG 0250TLG Green 0250TSG 0250TCG Yellow 0250TKY 0250TLY Yellow 0250TSY 0250TCY White 0250TKW 0250TLW White 0250TSW 0250TCW Gray 0250TKA 0250TLA Gray 0250TSA 0250TCA Blue 0250TKL 0250TLL Blue 0250TSL 0250TCL range 0250TKD 0250TL range 0250TS 0250TC Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-99

200 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Illuminated Selector Switch perators Illuminated Selector Switches without Caps Two-Position Selector Switch Maintained perator without Knob or Lever Full Voltage Type AC or DC 4 Lamps: 6V #755, 2V #756, 24V #757, 48V #835, 20/240V 20MB Transformer Type 50/60 Hz 6 Volt #755 Lamp Cam Code Number and Cam Positions perator Action Code 2 Voltage 3 Code 2 Voltage Two-position 60 throw T T620 M M T T T T T T T T T T T60 Three-position 60 throw M + 2 or T602_ + 2 or T624_ M M T603_ T625_ T652_ T626_ T604_ T627_ T605_ T638_ T606_ T639_ T607_ M + 2 or T654_ + 2 or T62_ M S T620_ T632_ T655_ T642_ T656_ T672_ T657_ T622_ T658_ T682_ T659_ M + 2 or T660_ + 2 or T63_ S M T62_ T633_ T66_ T643_ T662_ T673_ T663_ T623_ T664_ T683_ T665_ M + 2 or T64_ + 2 or T628_ S S T65_ T629_ T653_ T630_ T66_ T63_ T67_ T640_ T68_ T64_ T69_ Four-position 40 throw M M T T T T6337 M M T T T T T T T T T637 Code Number and 3 Notes M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow (R). 2 For selection of the proper cam and contact block, to obtain the proper circuit sequence, see selection tables on Pages V7-T-94, V7-T-95 and V7-T perator includes lens gasket and lens attachment screws. 4 Full voltage light units can be used at other than listed voltages by changing lamp. Replacement lamps are listed on Page V7-T Resistor type. May generate excess heat if used in high density. V7-T-200 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

201 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Knob Lever Joystick Units Two-Position Joystick Illuminated Knobs and Levers Color Knob Code Number and Lever Code Number and Red 0250TER 0250TFR Green 0250TEG 0250TFG Yellow 0250TEA 0250TFA Blue 0250TEL 0250TFL Clear 0250TEC 0250TFC White 0250TEW 0250TFW Amber 0250TEM 0250TFM Joystick Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 perator Position 2 Up Down Center perator Action 3 Contact Type Mounting Location A B Notes Amber, clear and white lenses have a black arrow (pointer), red, green and blue lenses have a white arrow (pointer). 2 = closed circuit, = open circuit. 3 M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow (R). 4 Field convertible momentary to maintained or vice versa. Two-Position Assembled Unit 4 S NC 0250T452-3 M S NC Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-20

202 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Joysticks Two-Position Joystick perators The device mounts in the standard 30.5 mm mounting hole. Allow sufficient panel space for lever movement. Two-Position Joystick perator The maximum travel of the knob operator (full up to full down) is 2.2 in (24 ) momentary, 2.5 in (30 ) maintained, but ample space for lever operation must be allowed. These operators are field convertible from momentary to maintained operation or vice versa. The use of NC contacts is preferred because they provide positive drive contact opening and a direct relationship between lever movement and affected terminal, i.e., up movement affects the top terminals. Two-Position Joystick perators UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Contact Block Limitations Momentary Mode 4NC contact blocks max. 3N contact blocks max. Maintained Mode 2 contact blocks max. Contact Block peration and Selection Handle Position 2 Up Down Center Contact Block Mounting Location 23 Type 4 Top A Bottom B A and B Mounting Location Notes Two-Position perator nly AC Applications nly Description Momentary up and down 0250T452 Maintained up momentary down 0250T452 Maintained down momentary up 0250T4522 Maintained up and down 0250T4525 Field convertible momentary to maintained or vice versa. To expedite shipment of maintained types, order momentary operator 0250T452 which is a stocked device. 2 Bolded circuit corresponds to - circuit selection. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 3 See above for A and B mounting location. 4 N = normally open, NC = normally closed, LNC = late opening normally closed. 5 Four circuits in single block depth rated 300V max. NC 0250T5 NC 0250T5 2LNC (Series) 0250T45 NC 0250T3 NC LNC 0250T45 LNC NC 0250T44 5 N NC N Up NC Contact at Top Is Closed, N at Bottom Is Closed Top Contacts Bottom Contacts Locating Nib Center All NC and N Contacts Are pen (/2 Way), Late pening NC Is Closed Up Center Down Down NC Contact at Bottom Is Closed, N at Top Is Closed Application Caution Joystick operators are not recommended on certain DC applications above 24 Vdc which may involve lightly engaging the contacts (teasing) to achieve speed control, positioning, jogging, etc. Excessive arcing and deterioration of the contacts will occur. V7-T-202 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

203 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Four-Position Joystick perators The joystick operated control unit is intended for AC application only. For other use, see Application Caution on preceding page. Four-Position Joystick perator Four-Position Joystick perator with Latch Field Conversion Gate The factory assembled fourposition operator is assembled with a gate arranged for four handle positions. Handle Positions Four-Position Gate Three additional gates, supplied with every operator, allow on the job conversion to three- or eight-position operation as illustrated. The panel area required for the four-position operator is equivalent to two standard pushbutton operators. The latch holds the lever in the center position. The trigger latch must be released before lever can moved into any position. Four-Position Joystick perators UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Contact Block Limitations Description perator nly AC Application nly Four contact blocks max. two in each position Four-position without latch 0250T45_ Four-position with latch 0250T46_ Hole Plug Four contact blocks max. two in each position To plug unused hole 0250TA7 Two-, Three- or Eight- Position peration The eight-position gate controls the four functions shown as Up, Down, Left and Right. The remaining four diagonal positions each actuate two adjacent functions; for example, Left Down actuates both Left and Down. The operator may be arranged for spring return of handle to center position, or maintained in up to eight positions (see description of maintained position operator). Note Momentary operators spring return to center. For maintained operators add suffix code from table on this page. Example: 0250T450. perator without latch, maintained in left and right positions. or Two-Position Gate or or or Three-Position Gate Eight-Position Gate Adjacent Functions Left Up Left Left Down Up Down Right Up Right Right Down Maintained Position For maintained position (nonspring return), locate required maintained position or positions of operating lever and add appropriate suffix number to the catalog number selected from the table above. Maintained Positions Maintained Positions Suffix Up Down Left Right Number n an eight-position gate, when an adjacent vertical and horizontal position are both maintained, the included diagonal position is also maintained. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-203

204 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Contact Block peration Contact blocks mount directly to the back of the operator. For reliable operation, the maximum number of contact blocks that should be installed behind each operator lever is two (four total). The figure below identifies the circuits activated by each of the eight possible lever positions. Contact block plungers, 2, 3, 4 are depressed (change state) when handle is in the position indicated by arrows below. Circuit Activation Note: Joystick in its resting state, center position, does not activate contact block plungers. rdering Example: Suppose you are looking for a four-position momentary joystick without a latch and the following circuit arrangements. = Closed Circuit, = pen Circuit. Example Circuit Arrangements Circuit Up Down Left Right st 2nd The contact blocks and their mounting locations would be as follows: Example Contact Blocks and Locations 2nd Circuit N A complete bill of material for this example would include: Example rder Qty. 0250T T T st Circuit NC N 0250T 0250T2 NC N N N N 0250T 0250T2 Blank Legend Plates for Joystick perators When ordering engraved legend plates, order by catalog number and insert the following into order notes: Legend required Size of characters: 3/6, /8, 3/32 in (4.8, 3.2, 2.4 mm) Location by letter (A N) Locations K and M can accommodate up to two lines horizontally; L and N up to two lines vertically. Maximum number of characters: Horizontal 3/6 in 3, /8 in 4, 3/32 in 9 Vertical 3/6 in 0, /8 in 3, 3/32 in 4 rdering Example: Two-position legend plate to be marked UP DWN. Catalog No. 0250TJ2S4STAMP Letter Size: 3/6 in (4.8 mm) Pos. K UP Pos. M DWN Two-Position 2.9 (55.6) Sq. L K M Blank Plate 0250TJS3 Engraved Plate 0250TJS3STAMP Four-Position A B C D E F G H J Blank Plate 0250TJS Engraved Plate 0250TJSSTAMP N M 0250TJS4 0250TJS4STAMP 0250TJS2 K A B C D E F G H J 0250TJS2STAMP V7-T-204 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

205 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Roto-Push Units Two-Position Momentary Complete assembled twoposition Roto-Push Units are listed below. These operators have black flush buttons and are arranged for vertical mounting. rder legend plates separately. Roto-Push Black Flush Button Two-Position Latched The two-position Roto-Push Latch Unit is fully assembled and only requires a legend plate for a great variety of applications. When the selector collar is in the extreme left position, the button is in the free or normal position and can be operated as a standard pushbutton. Rotating the collar to the Red Long Notes = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 Roto-Push assembled with contact blocks. Mounting Location Locating Nib Roto-Push Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 perator Position Collar Left Collar Right Typical Applications (Most Common Examples) Two-Position FRWARD/REVERSE; HIGH/LW; PEN/CLSE; UP/DWN; etc. JG/RUN; MAN./AUT; etc. RUN/JG; START/JG; etc. SAFE/RUN; etc. extreme right position automatically depresses and latches the button in the depressed position. The white filled groove in the button indicates the selector collar position. The selector collar has spring return to the left position except when in the extreme right latched position. Rotates to a Latch-ut Mode Color and Type of Button Red long Contact Block NC 2NC A B Contact Mounting Location Normal Depressed Normal Depressed Type A B 2 Vertical Mounting 0250T T73 N 0250T24-2 N N 0250T24-2 N N 0250T24- NC N 0250T245-2 N Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-205

206 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Roto-Push perators Roto-Push Components A Roto-Push control unit combines the function of a pushbutton and a selector switch. The contacts are operated by the combined action of rotating the outer collar and pushing a button contained in the collar. perator and Cam perator and Cam Color and Type of Button In selecting the cam and contact blocks for the listed function, the analysis involves considering the function with the collar rotated to the given position with the button free (designated as N ) and then in that same position with the button depressed (designated D ). This is done for each rotational position of the collar. Two-Position Roto-Push perator Rotates to a Latch-ut Mode Special Rotor Latch This differs from the other Roto-Push operators in that as the collar is rotated to the right it depresses the button and releases the button when rotated left. But the button in the released position can be momentarily pushed independent of the collar or Special Roto Latch Red Long Button Note Not to be used for emergency stop application. Cam Code No. Select from Tables its position. As the button is depressed by rotating the collar, the button also rotates and indicates its mode by a white line on the button face. This button can be used as an emergency stop or latched stop. Special Rotor Latch UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Vertical Mounting Catalog and Code Number When rdering Specify Catalog number of operator with cam code suffix from tables below and on following pages, Example: 0250T24. Catalog number(s) for contact blocks and legend plates if required. To select the cam and contact blocks needed for two-position and threeposition switches, use the tables on following pages. Horizontal Mounting Catalog and Code Number Black flush + to T24_ 0250T25_ Red flush 0250T242_ 0250T252_ Green flush 0250T243_ 0250T253_ Black long 0250T26_ 0250T27_ Red long 0250T262_ 0250T272_ Green long 0250T263_ 0250T273_ Color and Type of Button Red long Black long Vertical Mounting 0250T T324 V7-T-206 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

207 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Cam and Contact Block Selection for Two-Position Roto-Push Collar Position Combination Number Series and Parallel Connections Circuit Sequence N D N D The connections are not made at the factory. They are illustrated in the selection table as requirements, but must be made on the job. Note N = Button in free or normal position. D = Button depressed. Circuit Location Cam Code Cam Code 2 Cam Code 3 Cam Code 4 Cam Code 5 Cam Code 6 A N A N A N 2 A NC A NC 3 4 A NC B N B N 5 A N B N A N B N 6 7 A or B N B N B N 8 A or B NC B NC B NC 9 0 A NC B NC A NC B B NC A N B NC 2 NC 3 A N A N B NC B NC 4 A NC A NC A NC A B Series Connection A B N NC N NC Parallel Connection Locating Nib A B Letters A and B represent the locations which the two circuits of a contact block will occupy in relation to the locating nib of the operator. B N B N B N A N A B A B NC N N NC B NC A NC Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-207

208 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Cam and Contact Block Selection for Two-Position Roto-Push, continued Collar Position Combination Circuit Sequence Number N D N D Cam Code 0 Cam Code Cam Code 2 Cam Code 3 Cam Code 4 5 A N B N 6 A NC A NC A or B NC A NC 7 B N B N 8 A N A N B N B NC 9 A N B N 20 2 A N A N A NC B N B N B N 22 A NC A NC A N B NC B NC B NC A NC B NC 25 A NC A N B N 26 B NC B NC 27 A or B N A N A N A N B NC 28 A NC B NC Series and Parallel Connections A B Series Connection A B N NC N NC Parallel Connection The connections are not made at the factory. They are illustrated in the selection table as requirements, but must be made on the job. Note N = Button in free or normal position. D = Button depressed. Circuit Location Locating Nib A B Letters A and B represent the locations which the two circuits of a contact block will occupy in relation to the locating nib of the operator. B N A B A B B NC N N NC NC V7-T-208 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

209 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Cam and Contact Block Selection for Three-Position Roto-Push Collar Position Combination Number Circuit Sequence N D N D N D Series and Parallel Connections The connections are not made at the factory. They are illustrated in the selection table as requirements, but must be made on the job. Notes N = Button in free or normal position. D = Button depressed. 2 Limited to 4 contact blocks. See Note on Page V7-T-222. Cam Code 7 Cam Code 8 Cam Code 9 Cam Code 5 2 Cam Code 6 Cam Code 7 Cam Code 8 2 A NC A NC A N B N B N B N B N B N 2 B N A N 3 A N A B NC B 4 B 5 2 A N 6 A N B N 7 B N 8 A NC B N 9 B N 0 2 A N A N A N B NC B NC A N A N B N B NC A N A N A N B N B N 2 A N B N A N 6 A N B N 7 A N B N A N B NC Series Connection A B N NC Parallel Connection Circuit Location Locating Nib A B N N N Letters A and B represent the locations which the two circuits of a contact block will occupy in relation to the locating nib of the operator. A A B N N N Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-209

210 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Cam and Contact Block Selection for Three-Position Roto-Push, continued Collar Position Combination Number Circuit Sequence N D N D N D Series and Parallel Connections The connections are not made at the factory. They are illustrated in the selection table as requirements, but must be made on the job. Notes N = Button in free or normal position. D = Button depressed. 2 Limited to 4 contact blocks. See Note on Page V7-T-222. Cam Code 7 Cam Code 8 2 Cam Code 9 Cam Code 5 Cam Code 6 Cam Code 7 Cam Code 8 8 A NC B NC 9 A NC 20 A NC B 2 A NC 22 A NC A NC A NC B NC B N B N 23 A NC A NC 24 A NC 25 A NC2 A NC 26 B NC A NC2 27 A N B NC 28 B NC 29 A NC A NC B N B N 30 B NC A NC 3 A NC A N B NC B NC B NC 32 2 B NC 33 A N B NC A B Series Connection A B N NC N NC Parallel Connection NC B Circuit Location Locating Nib A B NC B NC B NC A B NC N Letters A and B represent the locations which the two circuits of a contact block will occupy in relation to the locating nib of the operator. A B A B B A B NC NC N NC NC NC NC V7-T-20 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

211 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Accessories Padlocks not included with padlocking attachments. For operators with built-in padlock attachment, see Page V7-T TA2 0250TA TA TA TA TA TA Accessories Description Padlock Attachments Padlocking Attachment for Flush Pushbutton perators Permits locking NC contacts in open position with /4 in padlock. Will not lock N contact. Padlocking Attachment for Use with Extended Pushbutton Permits locking NC contacts in open position with /4 in padlock. Padlocking Cover Guard Cover locked over flush button makes it unaccessible or on extended button locks NC contacts open. Takes /4 in shank size padlock. Padlock Hasp or Flip-Up Guard When used with a /4 in padlock, makes flush and long button and knob selector switch unaccessible, but not locked down. Without the padlock, it is a flip-up guard. Padlock hasp can be removed before assembly. Padlocking Attachment for Use with Flexible Weather Resistant Boot Used on long button operators. Stainless steel. Use only for locking NC contacts open. Padlock Attachment For use with illuminated pushbuttons and maintained push-pull operators having standard button or lens only. Use /4 in padlock. Locks in down position only. Padlocking Attachment for Non-Illuminated Knob Selector Switches Provision for up to 5, /4 in padlocks. 0250TA2 0250TA TA TA TA TA TA Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-2

212 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T 0250TA6 0250TA2 0250TA5 0250TA56_ 0250ED TA0 0250TA_ 0250TA TA4_ Accessories, continued Description Shrouds and Guards Shroud for Mushroom Head perator Prevents accidental operation. (Not for push-pull operators.) Extended Retaining Nut Replaces standard nut and provides guard for flush head pushbutton operators. Guard for Illuminated Pushbutton Shroud For jumbo mushroom head operator. Gray Yellow Half Shroud Yellow For jumbo mushroom head operator. Fingerproof Shroud 0 per package Fits new style contact blocks and light units. Boots Flexible Weather Resistant Boot For use with button operators (extended buttons preferred). Temperature to 25 F ( 32 C). (See Page V7-T-25 for 0250TA96 Tightening Tool.) Black Notes Should not be used on flush button for STP function. 2 Not suitable for single contact block depth cast enclosure. Cover is too thick. 0250TA6 0250TA2 0250TA5 0250TA TA56Y 0250ED TA0 0250TA3 Red 0250TA4 Green 0250TA0 Transparent Boot For regular illuminated pushbutton operators and PresTest Temperature to 38 F ( 39 C). 2 Boot for Flush Pushbutton Clear Black Red Green 0250TA TA TA TA TA49 V7-T-22 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

213 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T TK3 0250TK TA3_ 0250TA TA8 0250TA TA2_ 0250TKG_ 0250TA7_ Accessories, continued Description Hardware and Kits Thrust Washers To meet Ford Motor Co. mounting specifications. Contact Block Tape Seal Seals plunger openings on last contact block. rder in multiples of 0 pieces. Selector Switch perator Gasket Seals out dust from getting in-between the cam and contact block plungers. Supplied as standard with all selector switches. Special Retaining Nut To accommodate thick panel: Indicating lights PresTest, pushbuttons and selector switches Terminal Block Two terminals, each will accommodate two wire terminations. Spacer Ring Used when legend plate is not required. Stacking Screw Replaces transformer mounting screws on indicating light so terminal block 0250TA62 can be mounted to light to support and connect a series resistor. This screw also fits all contact blocks. rder in multiples of 0. Base Mounting Spacers Equivalent to contact block in depth (one block deep). Complete with screws, washers, etc. (two block deep). Grounding Kits Kits consist of a ring connector and a #6 screw for mounting connector to rear of contact block mounting screw. Notes Component only. Not to be used for custom built (factory assembled) stations. 2 Not suitable for single contact block depth cast enclosure. Cover is too thick. 0250TK3 0250TK TA TA3 0250TA TA8 0250TA TA TA23 All components except standard indicating lights and PresTest indicating lights. 0250TKG Standard indicating lights 0250TKG2 2 PresTest indicating lights 0250TKG3 2 Contact Block Terminal Jumpers Available in multiples of 00 only. Terminal to terminal within block (short) 00 per pkg. 0250TA per pkg. 0250TA70-2 Terminal to terminal block to block (long) 00 per pkg. 0250TA7 000 per pkg. 0250TA7-2 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-23

214 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T 0250TA5 0250TA4 0250TA_ 0250TA 0250TA3 0250TA TFL_ 0250ED986-4 Accessories, continued Description Special perators and Attachments Wobble Stick Complete with retaining nut fits standard button. Lever perator For use with two vertically mounted flush pushbuttons. Maintained Contact Attachment Release Button Assembly Mechanically interlocks with another pushbutton and contact block (not included). Provides mode indication. Minimum hole centers.62 in (4. mm), maximum 2.33 in (58.8 mm). Black Red Green Yellow Same with Long Button Black Maintained Contact Attachment Mechanically interlocks two buttons and provides position indication for one. Use with two pushbutton operators and one or more contact blocks. Roto-Push Lever perator Used to provide lever operation for Roto-Push operators. Note Not suitable for single contact block depth cast enclosure. Cover is too thick. 0250TA5 0250TA4 0250TA7 0250TA8 0250TA9 0250TA TA TA 0250TA3 Special Light Modules Master Test (Dual Input) Module Internal Form C relay suitable for either AC or DC applications. Total electrical isolation between monitored and test circuit. Fits all illuminated 0250T, E22, E30 and E34 devices. 48 Vdc 0250TMT8 Flasher Module Changes any AC illuminated device to a controlled flashing light. Fits 0250T, E30 and E34 devices. 24V 20V Flashing Incandescent Lamp For use with 20V transformer type or 6V full voltage type indicating lights including PresTest and most E29 devices. 0250TFL2 0250TFL 0250ED986-4 V7-T-24 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

215 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T TA7 0250TA95 E22CW 0250TA TA TA74 E30KV E29KLT Accessories, continued Description Hole Plugs Plug For unused holes steel, painted gray (stainless steel, use E30KT5, see Page V7-T-60) Tools ctagonal 0250T (notched to fit over selector switch lever), E29 and E TA7 0250TA95 E22, E30, E34 and octagonal 0250T (will not fit over selector switch levers) E22CW Tool for Tightening Boots Used to install boot s 0250TA3, A4, A0 and A T, E34 Allen Wrench Used for removal of jumbo mushroom head. Lamp Removal Tools For transformer type illuminated pushbuttons, push-pull and selector switches. Fits #2 lamp. For full voltage and resistor type illuminated pushbuttons, push-pull and selector switches and E30. Standard indicating lights. Fits #44, #755, #6S6 and #0S TA TA TA74 E30KV E29KLT Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-25

216 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T ptions Legend Plates Legend Plates with Standard Markings The legend plates listed spacing less than.75 in, below are sized for all replace the S in the catalog standard commercial number with MS, or the M enclosures and Eaton s cast with P (except push-pull). No enclosures. For vertical change in price. The smaller Square Legend Plate For Pushbutton perators and Indicating Lights Standard Legend size legend plates, MS or P size, have limited space for legend. Blank Plastic Legend Plates Square Color Standard Jumbo 2 Extra Large Lettering Field Black White or silver TSP TLP TEP76 White Red or black TSP TLP TEP77 Notes Color of Field Square /2 Round Legend Square legend plates have a satin aluminum field. Color is on lower portion. 2 Cannot be used on cast enclosures except for top row. Suitable for most sheet metal enclosures. 3 If legend plate is to be engraved, specify field color required. Color of Field Square /2 Round Blank see table on Page V7-T-28. /2 Round Legend Plate Letters on Legend Plates Below are 3/6 in High CLAMP Black 0250TS TM90 FF Red 0250TS TM24 CLSE 0250TS TM N Black 0250TS TM25 DWN 0250TS TM2 PEN 0250TS TM26 EMERG. STP Red 0250TS3 0250TM3 UT 0250TS TM27 FAST Black 0250TS TM4 PWER N 0250TS TM80 FASTER 0250TS TM87 RAISE 0250TS TM28 FEEDER N 0250TS TM94 READY 0250TS TM86 FEEDER FF 0250TS TM95 RESET 0250TS TM29 FRWARD 0250TS5 0250TM5 REVERSE 0250TS TM30 HIGH 0250TS6 0250TM6 RUN 0250TS3 0250TM3 IN 0250TS7 0250TM7 SAFE 0250TS TM85 INCH 0250TS8 0250TM8 SLW 0250TS TM32 JG 0250TS9 0250TM9 SLWER 0250TS TM88 JG FR. 0250TS TM20 START 0250TS TM33 JG REV. 0250TS2 0250TM2 STP Red 0250TS TM34 LW 0250TS TM22 TEST Black 0250TS TM83 LWER 0250TS TM23 TRANSFER 0250TS TM93 LUBE-FAIL 0250TS TM92 TRIP 0250TS TM84 MTR RUN 0250TS8 0250TM8 UNCLAMP 0250TS9 0250TM9 MTR STP 0250TS TM82 UP 0250TS TM35 V7-T-26 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

217 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Square Legend Plate /2 Round Legend Plate 70 mm Round Plastic Legend Plate For Selector Switch and Roto-Push perators Standard Size Legend 45 mm and 70 mm Plastic Round Color Lettering Field For Push-Pull Units 3 Notes Color of Field Square /2 Round Square legend plates have a satin aluminum field. Color is on lower portion. 2 If legend plate is to be engraved, specify field color required. 3 All push-pull legend plates include the symbols in the center of the plate. Legend Color of Field Square /2 Round Blank see table on Page V7-T Position 5/32 in High Lettering 3-Position /8 in High Lettering FR. REV. Black 0250TS TM38 AUT FF HAND Black 0250TS TM49 HAND AUT 0250TS TM39 FR. FF REV. 0250TS TM50 HIGH LW 0250TS TM40 FR. SAFE REV. 0250TS TM69 JG RUN 0250TS4 0250TM4 HAND FF AUT 0250TS5 0250TM5 MAN. AUT 0250TS TM67 MAN. FF AUT 0250TS TM68 FF N 0250TS TM42 PEN FF CLSE 0250TS TM53 PEN CLSE 0250TS TM43 RUN SAFE JG 0250TS TM70 RUN JG 0250TS TM44 UP FF DWN 0250TS TM54 SAFE RUN 0250TS TM45 N STP SAFE Red 0250TS7 0250TM7 START JG 0250TS TM46 START STP 0250TS TM47 UP DWN 0250TS TM48 45 mm Blank Yellow or red TRP78 70 mm Blank Yellow or red TRP76 Red EMERG. STP Yellow 0250TRP79 Legend Color of Field Square /2 Round Standard Size Letters on Legend Plates Below are 3/32 in High PULL START/PUSH STP Green/red 0250TPP2 0250TR2 PUSH N/PULL FF Black 0250TPP5 0250TR5 PULL PEN/PUSH CLSE Black 0250TPP8 0250TR8 PULL UP/PUSH DWN Black 0250TPP 0250TR Jumbo Size Letters on Legend Plates Below are /8 in High PULL START/PUSH STP Green/red 0250TPP3 0250TR3 PULL N/PUSH FF Black 0250TPP6 0250TR6 PULL PEN/PUSH CLSE Black 0250TPP9 0250TR9 PULL UP/PUSH DWN Black 0250TPP2 0250TR2 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-27

218 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Legend Plates with Non-Standard Markings When rdering Specify rdering Example: Catalog number of blank plate phase plus Suffix STAMP. Insert the following into rder Notes: legend, letter size and locations (letters A W) combine letters for definitive locations as shown. Legend Positions Blank and Custom Engraved Legend Plates Catalog No.: 0250TS36STAMP Letter Size: 3/32 in (2.4 mm) Pos. A PWER HUSE Pos. B START PUMP Legend Characters Available A B C D E F G H I J K L M N P Q R S T U V W Y Z / -., Legend characters on black and red plates are white on satin aluminum plates, characters are black. Blackening Kit Solution blackens aluminum exposed by engraving process. Must be applied immediately after engraving. 0.3 oz. bottle sufficient for approximately 00 legend plates. : 0250TBK Four-Position Selector Switch Push-Pull with Symbols Style Color Small Standard Jumbo 2 Extra Large 3 Custom 4 Standard Standard Jumbo 2 Square 5 Black 0250TMS TS TL TS TS TPP7 0250TPP8 Red 0250TMS TS TL37 Green/red 0250TPP TPP2 Satin alum. 0250TNP99 /2 Round Black 0250TP TM TJ TM TR7 0250TR8 Red 0250TP TM TJ37 Green/red 0250TR TR2 Satin alum. 0250TM TJ89 Maximum Characters per Legend Plate and Approximate Dimensions Character Size Top Approximate Dimensions 3/32 in High /8 in High 3/6 in High (Aluminum in Inches (mm) Number Number of Number Number of Number Number of and Plastic) Width Height Style of Lines Characters of Lines Characters of Lines Characters Small 6.59 (40.4).59 (40.4) Square 7 /2 Round Standard and.75 (44.5).75 (44.5) Square custom /2 Round Jumbo (55.6) 2.9 (55.6) Square /2 Round Extra large (62) 2.44 (62) Square Notes Extra Large Size Cat. No. 0250TNP99 A B C D K L All push-pull legend plates include the symbols in the center of the plate. 2 Cannot be used on cast enclosures except for top row. Suitable for most sheet metal enclosures. 3 When used to meet Ford Motor Co. specifications, specify engraved legend. Cannot be used on standard cast or sheet metal enclosures. 4 Slightly larger than standard size for legends requiring more space fits cast enclosures. 5 Square legend plates have a satin aluminum field. Color is on lower portion. 6 Recommended only when mounting on minimum centers (less than -3/4 in [44.5 mm] vertical centers). 7 Can be used on top row only of any enclosure. Small Size 0250TMS or TP Series A Jumbo Size 0250TL or TJ Series A B C D K B4 A4 Standard Size 0250TS or TM Series A B G AB C4 D4 AE G A H F AF I V7-T-28 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

219 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Enclosures Die Cast, Polyester and Stainless Steel Enclosures Die Cast Enclosure Polyester Enclosure Stainless Steel Enclosure Mounting Instructions Two-position joystick must be used with two contact block deep enclosures (maximum number of contact blocks = ). Four-position joysticks cannot be used within these enclosures. Enclosures (Case and Cover) Surface Mounting Number of ne Contact Block Depth Two Contact Block Depth Elements Die Cast Enclosure In-Line 234 NEMA 4, 4, 2, TN 0250TN TN2 0250TN TN3 0250TN TN4 Polyester 4 In-Line NEMA 3, 4, 2 E34N5 2 E34N52 3 E34N53 4 E34N54 Stainless Steel 45 In-Line NEMA 4, 4, TN TN TN TN36 Dimensions, see Page V7-T-232. ne and Two Contact Block Depth Enclosures ne Contact Block Depth Enclosure Two Contact Block Depth Enclosure Enclosure Layouts Top For Vertical Mounting Notes For spacing increments, see Page V7-T All die cast enclosures can be converted to base mounting of contact blocks, with spacers 0250TA22 or 0250TA23. See listing on Page V7-T When used with E30 pushbuttons, only the one element enclosure can be used. 4 When used with resistor light units, only the 2 contact block depth enclosure can be used. 5 4 gauge, type Top For Horizontal Mounting Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-29

220 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Die Cast and Stainless Steel Flush Mount, Covers nly Flush Mounting Covers Covers nly Flush Mounting Number of Elements Flush Die Cast Covers Spacing Increments Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Spacing Increments for Enclosures Note Not oiltight. NEMA applications only. In-Line Deep Cover Enclosure Layouts In-Line Flat Cover 0250TF 0250TF TF2 0250TF TF3 0250TF TF4 0250TF4 In-Line Stainless Steel Flush Plates With Pullbox Without Pullbox 0250TS0 0250TS TS 0250TS TS2 0250TS TS4 0250TS4 Dimensions, see Page V7-T-233. Type F G H Die cast 2.44 (62) 2.5 (63.5).88 (47.8) Polyester.88 (47.8) Min. 2.3 (54.) 2.25 (57.2) Stainless steel.69 (42.9) Min..73 (43.9) 2.25 (57.2) F G H Top For Vertical Mounting Top For Horizontal Mounting V7-T-220 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

221 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Contact Blocks Standard Contact Blocks UL A600/P600 rated Color-coded plungers red/ green for NC/N circuits Silver contact tips with reliability nibs Gray (opaque) or amber (translucent) housings Pressure plate or spade terminals Fingerproof shrouds (for pressure terminals only) Logic Level Contact Blocks UL A600/P600 rated Color-coded plungers Inert palladium knife-blade contacts Gray (opaque) housings Pressure plate or spade terminals Special Function Contact Blocks UL A600/P600 rated Color-coded plungers Silver contact tips with reliability nibs Gray (opaque) housings Pressure plate terminals only Special Purpose Contact Block Maximum 300V rated Black plungers Silver contact tips with reliability nibs Black (opaque) housings Pressure plate terminals only Fingerproof shrouds not available Reliability Nibs Reliability nibs are the hallmark of Eaton s contact blocks. A pointed silver nib on the contact tip ensures reliable switching from logic level (5V) up to 600V applications. Therefore standard contact blocks can be used for most logic level applications where the contacts are not exposed to any harsh environmental conditions. Palladium Contacts Palladium, which is more inert than gold, is well suited for voltages and currents approaching zero and is recommended for applications where environmental conditions are a factor. Maximum Contact Block Mounting per perator Type Max. perator Stack Pushbuttons 6 Push-pull operators 2 Roto-push operators 4 Two- or three-position 6 selector switches Four-position selector 4 switches Joysticks 4 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-22

222 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T 0250T Contact Blocks Symbol Circuit Description Blank No Plunger Blank No Plunger NC N N-NC 2NC 2N Special Function Blocks 3 Blank No Plunger LNC ECN- NC ECN- N 2LNC LNC- ECN Special Purpose Blocks 5 2N- 2NC Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Late opening NC. Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard NC. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard N. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Two late opening NC contacts. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. verlapping contacts. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Four circuits in single block depth. Rated 300V max. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Standard Pressure Terminal Spade Terminal 2 Logic Level Pressure Terminal Spade Terminal T5 0250T T5E 0250T59E 0250T T T53E 0250T60E 0250T 0250T TE 0250T40E 0250T3 0250T T3E 0250T42E 0250T2 0250T4 0250T2E 0250T4E 0250T T7E T T47E T T57E T T45E T T55E T44 5 Notes All 0250T contact blocks shown are suitable for use on standard 0250T and E34 operators. These contact blocks are not suitable for Class I Division 2 type 0250T or E34 devices. 2 Contact blocks with spade terminals are limited to a maximum of one contact block per operator and minimum spacing between devices is 2.5 in (63.5 mm). Not suitable for use in 0250T or E34 enclosures. Also available in amber housing. Not available with fingerproof shrouds. 3 Special function contact blocks are not suitable for use with roto-push operators, three-position push-pull operators, or four-position selector switches. 4 ECN contact blocks are not suitable for use with two-position joysticks or when operators are used with padlock attachments. 5 Special purpose 0250T44 contact blocks are not suitable on selector switches or roto-push operators. kay to use with three-position push-pull operators only on low voltage (30V or less) circuits. Fingerproof shrouds not available. V7-T-222 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

223 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T TCP Contact Blocks with Fingerproof Shrouds Symbol Circuit Description Blank No Plunger Blank No Plunger Special Function Blocks 3 Blank No Plunger Standard Pressure Terminal 2 Logic Level Pressure Terminal 2 NC Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250T5P 0250T5EP N Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250T53P 0250T53EP N-NC Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250TP 0250TEP 2NC Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250T3P 0250T3EP 2N Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250T2P 0250T2EP LNC ECN-NC ECN-N 2LNC LNC-ECN Late opening NC. Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard NC. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard N. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Two late opening NC contacts. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. verlapping contacts. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. 0250T7P T7EP T47P T47EP T57P T57EP T45P T45EP T55P T55EP 4 Notes All 0250T contact blocks shown are suitable for use on standard 0250T and E34 operators. These contact blocks are not suitable for Class I Division 2 type 0250T or E34 devices. 2 To order contact blocks with translucent amber housing, change suffix P to CP in catalog number e.g. 0250T5CP. 3 ECN contact blocks are not suitable for use with two-position joysticks or when operators are used with padlock attachments. 4 Special function contact blocks are not suitable for use with roto-push operators, three-position push-pull operators, or four-position selector switches. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-223

224 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T 0250TC Amber Contact Blocks Symbol Circuit Description Blank No Plunger Blank No Plunger NC N N-NC 2NC 2N Special Function Blocks 3 Blank No Plunger LNC ECN- NC ECN- N 2LNC LNC- ECN Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Standard Pressure Terminal 2 Spade Terminal 3 Logic Level Pressure Terminal 2 Spade Terminal T5C 0250T59C 0250T5EC 0250T59EC 0250T53C 0250T60C 0250T53EC 0250T60EC 0250TC 0250T40C 0250TEC 0250T40EC 0250T3C 0250T42C 0250T3EC 0250T42EC 0250T2C 0250T4C 0250T2EC 0250T4EC Late opening NC. Stack up to six 0250T7C T7EC 4 blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard NC. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard N. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Two late opening NC contacts. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. verlapping contacts. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. 0250T47C T47EC T57C T57EC T45C T45EC T55C T55EC 4 Notes All 0250T contact blocks shown are suitable for use on standard 0250T and E34 operators. These contact blocks are not suitable for Class I Division 2 type 0250T or E34 devices. 2 To order amber contact blocks with fingerproof shrouds, change suffix to CP in the catalog number e.g. 0250T5CP. Not available with spade terminals. 3 Contact blocks with spade terminals are limited to a maximum of one contact block per operator and minimum spacing between devices is 2.5 in (63.5 mm). Not suitable for use in 0250T or E34 enclosures. Also available in amber housing. Not available with fingerproof shrouds. 4 Special function contact blocks are not suitable for use with roto-push operators, three-position push-pull operators, or four-position selector switches. 5 ECN contact blocks are not suitable for use with two-position joysticks or when operators are used with padlock attachments. V7-T-224 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

225 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Replacement Parts Replacement Lamps For 0250T Illuminated perators Mfg. Lamp Type Voltage Base Style Application Part Number 20MB 20V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T resistor indicating light # V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T flasher 0250ED986-4 # V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T transformer, PresTest and full voltage #756 2V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T full voltage #757 24V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T full voltage #828 32V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T full voltage #835 55V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T resistor NE48 20V T 4-/2 bayonet 0250T neon NE5H-R22 20V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T neon NE5H-R68 240V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T neon Standard LED Lamp Replacement LED Lamps For 0250T, E34 and E22 Units Continuous Flashing Voltage Color AC/DC AC DC 6 2V Red E22LED62RN E22LED006RAF E22LED006RDF range E22LED62N E22LED006AF E22LED006DF Yellow E22LED62YN E22LED006YAF E22LED006YDF Green E22LED62GN E22LED006GAF E22LED006GDF Blue E22LED62BN E22LED006BAF E22LED006BDF White E22LED62WN E22LED006WAF E22LED006WDF 24V Red E22LED024RN E22LED024RAF E22LED024RDF range E22LED024N E22LED024AF E22LED024DF Yellow E22LED024YN E22LED024YAF E22LED024YDF Green E22LED024GN E22LED024GAF E22LED024GDF Blue E22LED024BN E22LED024BAF E22LED024BDF White E22LED024WN E22LED024WAF E22LED024WDF 48V Red E22LED048RN E22LED048RAF E22LED048RDF range E22LED048N E22LED048AF E22LED048DF Yellow E22LED048YN E22LED048YAF E22LED048YDF Green E22LED048GN E22LED048GAF E22LED048GDF Blue E22LED048BN E22LED048BAF E22LED048BDF White E22LED048WN E22LED048WAF E22LED048WDF 60V Red E22LED060RN E22LED060RAF E22LED060RDF range E22LED060N E22LED060AF E22LED060DF Yellow E22LED060YN E22LED060YAF E22LED060YDF Green E22LED060GN E22LED060GAF E22LED060GDF Blue E22LED060BN E22LED060BAF E22LED060BDF White E22LED060WN E22LED060WAF E22LED060WDF 20V Red E22LED20RN E22LED20RAF E22LED20RDF range E22LED20N E22LED20AF E22LED20DF Yellow E22LED20YN E22LED20YAF E22LED20YDF Green E22LED20GN E22LED20GAF E22LED20GDF Blue E22LED20BN E22LED20BAF E22LED20BDF White E22LED20WN E22LED20WAF E22LED20WDF Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-225

226 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Two-Position Joystick perator Four-Position Joystick perator (without Latch) Flush Head Pushbutton perator Illuminated Pushbutton perator 0250T Style perator Replacement Parts Item No. Description Mushroom Head Pushbutton perator No. Req. Mushroom Head perator with Padlock Attachment Full Voltage, Resistor and Transformer Type Illuminated Selector Switch Part Number Gasket Mounting nut Handle Knob Knob (not shown) for joystick operator with latch Common gate (supplied with operator) Set screw (#6-32 x in long hollow hex) Mushroom head button (includes [2] Item 6) As Req. Below Black Red Yellow Green Blue Set screw (#0-32 x in long hollow hex) Jumbo mushroom head button As Req. Below (aluminum includes [2] Item 8) Red Black Yellow Green Jumbo mushroom head button (aluminum red EMERG. STP) does not include Item Position gate: Two-position Three-position Four-position Eight-position Mounting screw (#6-32 x 0.70 in long) TA79 Washer Terminal screw and lug (captive) Req KIT Item No. Jumbo Mushroom Head perator Transformer Type Indicating Light Description Knob-perated Selector Switch perator Potentiometers No. Req. Part Number 4 Gasket (supplied with basic unit) Round head screw (#4-40 x in long) (supplied with basic unit) 6 Mounting screw Simple potentiometer As Req. Below (does not include items 8, 28 or 29),000 ohms ,500 ohms ,000 ohms ,000 ohms ,000 ohms ,000 ohms Connector (includes screw and lug) Indicating plate As Req. Above Standard size (without legend) Large size (specify legend) 0250TR30 20 Retaining nut Knob Socket set screw (#6-32 x in long) Coupling Set screw (#6-32 x 0.88 in long) Spacer Connector (includes screw and lug) Mounting nut Four-position joystick operating mechanism (complete) 28 Four-position joystick operating mechanism (not shown) (with latch) complete 29 Spring loaded latch Hand operated latch V7-T-226 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

227 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Technical Data and Specifications Mechanical Ratings Description Specification Frequency of peration All pushbuttons 6000 operations/hr. Key and lever selection switches 3000 operations/hr. Auto-latch devices 200 operations/hr. Life Pushbuttons 0 x 0 6 operations Contact blocks 0 x 0 6 operations PresTest units 0 x 0 6 operations Lever and key selector switches 0.25 x 0 6 operations Twist to release pushbuttons 0.3 x 0 6 operations Shock Resistance Duration 20 ms >5g General Specifications Description Specification Climate Conditions perating temperature to 50 F ( 7 to 66 C) Storage temperature 40 to 76 F ( 40 to 80 C) Altitude 6,562 ft (2,000m) Humidity Max. 95% RH at 60 C Terminals Marking NC-N on the contact block to meet the NEMA requirements. Dual marking system 2 for normally closed, 3 4 for normally open to meet BS5472 (Cenelec EN50 005). Clamps Terminals are saddle clamp type for x 22 AWG (0.34 mm 2 ) to 2 x 4 AWG (2.5 mm 2 ) conductors Torque 7 lb-in (0.8 Nm) Degree of protection against direct electrical contact IP2 with fingerproof shroud Light Units Transformers Will withstand short-circuit for hour per IEC Bulbs average life: Transformer type 20,000 hrs. Resistor/direct voltage type 2500 hrs. minimum at rated voltage LED 60,000 to 00,000 hrs. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-227

228 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Electrical Ratings Description Insulation Thermal Electrical Ratings Contact Block Specification U i = 660 Vac or Vdc I th = 0A Short Circuit Coordination to IEC/EN Rated conditional short circuit current ka Fuse type GE power controls TIA 0, red spot type gg, 0A, 660 Vac, 460 Vdc, BS88-2, IEC UL rating A600, P600 AC load life duty cycle 200 operations/hour 0A 0V pf 0.4 x 0 6 operations 5A 250V pf 0.4 x 0 6 operations 2A 600V pf 0.4 x 0 6 operations Switching capacity AC 5 rated make/break ( x l e at. x U e ) 6A 20V pf 0.3 4A 240V pf 0.3 2A 660V pf 0.3 DC3 rated make/break (. x l e at. x U e ).0A 25V L/R >0.95 at 300 ms 0.55A 250V L/R >0.95 at 300 ms 0.A 660V L/R >0.95 at 300 ms 0A 0V pure resistive Maximum ratings for logic level and hostile atmosphere application Maximum amperes 0.5A Maximum volts Description 20 Vac/Vdc 50 Vac or 60 Hz Vdc / Meet or Exceed NEMA Rating Designations A600, A300 and B300 for AC and P600 for DC Make and emerg. interrupting capacity (amp) Normal load break (amp) Thermal current (amp) Voltamperes: Make and emerg. interrupting capacity Normal load break V7-T-228 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

229 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Mounting ptions Panel Thickness Minimum: 0.06 in (.6 mm) Maximum: 0.25 in (8 mm) including legend plate Maximum can be increased to in (5.9 mm) using optional retaining nut Indicating light: 0250TA30 Pushbutton/selector switch: 0250TA3 Mounting Matrix Legend Plate Mounting ptions in Inches (mm) Horizontal mounting means terminals are located top and bottom of contact block. Vertical mounting means terminals are left and right of contact block. This allows close spacing of adjacent operators with easy access to terminals. Locating nib hole or notch is 0.4 in (3.6 mm) #29 drill. Drilling Dimensions in Inches (mm) Dimensions in Inches (mm) A B C D Small.63 (4.3) 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2).63 (4.3) Medium.75 (44.5) 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2).75 (44.5) Large 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2) 0.4 (3.6) Dia. B Min. 0.4 (3.6) Dia. Terminals on Top A Min. Horizontal Mounting.20 (30.5) 0.6 (5.2) C Min. D Min..22 (3) Vertical Mounting 0.6 (5.2) Terminals at Side Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-229

230 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Mechanically Interlocked Pushbutton perators 0.88 (22.4) for Each Additional Contact Block Lockout Pushbutton perator Padlockable in the Down Position.3 (28.7) 2.03 (5.6).09 (27.7).07 (27.2) Adjustable.62 (4.) Min. 2.5 (63.5) Max. 2.0 (50.8) 0.89 (22.6) Lockout Pushbutton perator Padlockable in the Up Position Mushroom Head 2.5 (63.5).5 (38.).78 (45.2).63 (4.4).75 (44.5) 2.0 (50.8) Lockout Pushbutton perator Padlockable in the Up Position Jumbo Mushroom Head 2.5 (63.5) 2.3 (58.7).75 (44.5) 2.38 (60.5) Potentiometer Large Dial Plate.88 (47.8) Std. Dial Plate.09 (27.7) 0.94 (23.9) 0.75 (9.).0 (25.4).3 (33.3) Potentiometer A B C 2 watt single.3 (33.3) 0.94 (23.9) 0.94 (23.9) 25 watt up to 25 mohms 2.38 (60.5).9 (30.2) 0.8 (20.6) 50 mohms 2.56 (65).69 (42.9).25 (3.8) Two-Position Joystick perator Four-Position Joystick perator 0.94 (23.9) 0.94 (23.9) 2.2 (55.9) 2.06 mom. (52.3) 2.5 (63.5) main..88 (47.8) Contact Block 2.3 (54.) 4.0 (0.6) 0.89 (22.6) 0.88 (22.4) Per Unit 0.88 (22.4) per Block.9 (30.2) 3.88 (98.6) 0.06 (.5) to 0.26 (6.6) Panel Thickness 3.75 (95.3).25 (3.8).25 (3.8) V7-T-230 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

231 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Key perated Pushbutton perator.5 (38.).3 (28.7).38 (35.) Latch-In, Twist-to-Release perator nly with Button 0.24 (6).55 (39.3) Spring Return 0.86 (2.8) 2.37 (60.3) Auto-Latch.5 (38.) perator and Cam.53 (38.9) Special Rotor Latch.53 (38.9).3 (28.7).3 (28.7).38 (35.) 0.38 (9.7) Long Button nly.38 (35.) 0.38 (9.7) Long Button nly Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-23

232 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Surface Mounting Die Cast, Polyester and Stainless Steel Enclosures 4 Mtg. Holes 0-32 Screw Size for 4 Element Die Cast/ Stainless Steel Enclosure 7/32 Screw Size for Polyester Number of Elements D A E B Surface Element Arrangement C Wide A High B Deep C Mounting D Die Cast In-line 3.88 (98.6) 4.0 (0.6) 3.0 (76.3) 2.69 (68.3) 3.25 (82.6) 3/ (98.6) 5.88 (49.4) 3.0 (76.3) 2.69 (68.3) 5.3 (30.3) (98.6) 7.75 (96.9) 3.0 (76.3) 2.69 (68.3) 7.0 (77.8) (98.6) 9.63 (244.6) 3.0 (76.3) 2.69 (68.3) 8.88 (225.6) Polyester In-line 3.8 (96.8) 6.63 (68.4) 3.38 (85.9) 2.94 (74.7) 4.88 (24.0) (96.8) 6.63 (68.4) 3.38 (85.9) 2.94 (74.7) 4.88 (24.0) (96.8) 8.88 (225.6) 3.38 (85.9) 2.94 (74.7) 7.3 (8.) (96.8).3 (282.7) 3.38 (85.9) 2.94 (74.7) 9.38 (238.3) Stainless Steel In-line 3.00 (76.2) 3.50 (88.9) 3.00 (76.2).50 (38.) 4.25 (08.0) (88.9) 6.75 (7.5) 3.00 (76.2).50 (38.) 7.50 (90.5) (88.9) 9.00 (228.6) 3.00 (76.2).50 (38.) 9.00 (228.6) (88.9).25 (285.8) 3.00 (76.2).50 (38.) 2.00 (304.8) Notes Depth given is for two contact block deep stations. ne contact block deep stations subtract 3/4 in (9. mm). 2 No conduit entrance holes provided. Drill as required. E Conduit Entrance V7-T-232 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

233 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Flush Mounting Die Case and Stainless Steel Covers nly 4 Mtg. Holes Screw Size for - Element Encl, /4-20 Screw Size for 2 Element and Larger Number of Elements E B D C A Surface or Pendant Wide A High B Notes Depth given includes pull box. 2 Depth given is for flat cover. Deep cover is 3/4 in (9. mm) deeper. Deep C Mounting D Die Cast 3.88 (98.6) 4.0 (0.6) 0.25 (6.4) (88.9) 3.63 (92.2) (98.6) 5.88 (49.4) 0.25 (6.4) (88.9) 5.50 (39.7) (98.6) 7.75 (96.9) 0.25 (6.4) (88.9) 6.0 (52.4) (98.6) 9.63 (244.6) 0.25 (6.4) (88.9) 9.25 (235) Stainless Steel 5.00 (27) 5.0 ( (63.5) (82.6).88 (47.8) (27) 6.88 (74.8) 2.50 (63.5) (82.6) 3.63 (92.2) (27) 8.63 (29.2) 2.50 (63.5) (82.6) 5.50 (39.7) (27) 0.50 (266.7) 2.50 (63.5) (82.6) 7.25 (84.2) E Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-233

234 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Flush and Long Pushbutton Half Shroud.8 (46).78 (45.2).09 (27.7) Mushroom and Jumbo Head Pushbutton Pushbutton with Cylinder Lock Illuminated Pushbutton 0.38 (9.7).06 (26.9).38 (35.) Half Shroud Is Same as Long Pushbutton with Lower Half of Guard Ring Cut Back (22.4) (28.7) for Each Additional Contact Block.09 (27.7).9 (48.5).3 (28.7).09 (27.7).38 (35.) 0.06 (.5) to 0.25 (6.4) Panel Thickness.63 (4.4).75 (44.5) 0.69 (7.5).3 (28.7).38 (35.) (63.5) (38.) Long Button nly Push-Pull Switch 0.88 (22.4) Flush Pushbutton perator with Padlock Attachment.3 (28.7) 0.88 (22.4) 0.25 (6.4) 2.03 (5.6) 0.06 (.5) to 0.25 (6.4) Panel Thickness.3 (28.7).78 (45.2).09 (27.7) 2.63 (66.8).65 (4.9) 2.0 (50.8) Mushroom Head Pushbutton perator with Padlock Attachment 2.5 (63.5).63 (4.4).5 (38.).78 (45.2) Indicating Light Transformer Type.8 (45.7).78 (45.2).75 (44.5). (27.9) 2.0 (50.8) A.38 (35.) V7-T-234 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

235 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) PresTest Indicating Light Transformer Type.78 (45.2) Jumbo Mushroom Head Pushbutton perator with Padlock Attachment Indicating Light Resistor and Neon Type Lens.8 (46) 2.5 (63.5) 2.9 (55.6) 2.3 (58.7).78 (45.2) A Plastic.38 (35.) Glass.56 (39.6).75 (44.5). (27.9).94 (49.3) A 2.38 (60.5).56 (39.6).38 (35.).38 (35.) PresTest Indicating Light Resistor Type.88 (47.8) Master Test Indicating Light Description B C Relay type 4.38 (.2) 4.28 (08.7) Solid-state type 2.94 (74.7) 2.88 (73.2) Potentiometer Shaft perator A B 0250T (45.2) Plastic.38 (35.) Glass.59 (40.4).63 (4.4).78 (45.2).38 (35.).88 (47.8) Shaft Dimensions of Potentiometer That C-H perator Will Accept A B Shaft Threaded Bushing 0.38 (9.7) dia. x 0.38 (9.7) long.56 (39.6).38 (35.) B Spade Terminal A Screw Terminal 0.25 (6.4) dia. x 0.63 (6) long Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-235

236 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Coin perated Selector Switch Coin Slot Knob Lever A perator Dim. A Knob.38 (35.) Lever.50 (38.) Coin slot.38 (35.) Key perated Selector Switch.75 (44.5) Illuminated Selector Switch.09 (27.7) Roto-Push.53 (38.9).3 (28.7).38 (35.).96 (49.8).3 (28.7).3 (28.7).38 (35.) 0.38 (9.7) Long Button nly.38 (35.) Wobble Stick Catalog No. 0250TA5.38 (35.) Lever perator For Use with Two Vertically Mounted Flush Pushbuttons Catalog No. 0250TA4 Flexible Boot For Protecting Flush or Long Pushbutton Catalog No. 0250TA3 Typical Transparent Flexible Boot For Illuminated Pushbutton Catalog No. 0250TA25.59 (40.4) 2.9 (55.6).44 (36.6).47 (37.3).22 (3) 3.75 (95.3).88 (47.8).59 (40.4) 2.44 (62) Cam.33 (33.8) (9.2).88 (47.8) V7-T-236 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

237 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Padlock Attachment For Knob Selector Switch Catalog No. 0250TA 0.44 (.2) Padlock Attachment For Flush Pushbutton Catalog No. 0250TA (9.) 0.84 (2.3) Padlock Attachment For Extended Pushbutton Catalog No. 0250TA (2.3).63 (4.4) Maintained Pushbutton Catalog No. 0250TA66 Typical 0.88 (22.4) for Each Additional Contact Block.63 (4.4) 0.38 (9.7) 2.06 (52.3) 0.94 (23.9) 0.25 (6.4).5 (38.).06 (26.9).07 (27.2) Adjustable.62 (4.) Min. 2.5 (63.5) Max (22.6) Maintained Contact Attachment Catalog No. 0250TA7 Typical.3 (28.7) Padlock Cover Guard for Flush Pushbutton Catalog No. 0250TA (9.7) 0.9 (23.) 0.97 (24.6).63 (4.4) Min. 2.3 (58.7) Max. 0.9 (23.) Padlock Attachment for Maintained Push-Pull perator Catalog No. 0250TA (9.7) 0.94 (23.9) 0.75 (9.) 2.9 (55.6).9 (48.5) 2.9 (55.6).47 (37.3).6 (29.5).25 (3.8).0 (25.4) Protecting Shroud for Jumbo Mushroom Head Button Catalog No. 0250TA56.65 (4.9) 3.25 (82.6) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-237

238 .7 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Protecting Shroud for Mushroom Head Button Catalog No. 0250TA6.53 (38.9).69 (42.9) Protecting Shroud for Illuminated Pushbutton Catalog No. 0250TA5.75 (44.5).50 (38.) Padlock Hasp or Flip-Up Guard Catalog No. 0250TA (2.3).75 (44.5).50 (38.) Extended Retaining Nut Catalog No. 0250TA2.38 (35.).25 (3.8).3 (33.3) Lever for Roto-Push perator Catalog No. 0250TA (.2).8 (46) Panel Drilling and Minimum Spacing Terminals on Top B Min. Legend Plate A Min. Horizontal Rows A Min. A Min. B Min. 0.6 (5.2).22 (3) Terminals at Side Vertical Rows B Min. or 2 Circuit Contact Blocks Small or none.63 (4.4) 2.25 (57.2) Standard.75 (44.5) 2.25 (57.2) Jumbo 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2) Extra large 2.50 (63.5) 2.60 (66) 4 Circuit Contact Block 0250T44 Small or none.88 (47.8) 2.25 (57.2) Standard.88 (47.8) 2.25 (57.2) Jumbo 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2) Extra large 2.50 (63.5) 2.60 (66) Notes Locating nib hole or notch is.36.4 in ( mm) #29 drill. If jumbo plates are to be placed one above the other vertically, add 0.3 (3.3) to minimum dimensions listed. V7-T-238 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

239 30.5 mm Heavy-Duty Watertight/iltight 0250T.7 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Multiple Button Guard 2.6 (54.9) A.88 (47.8) 0.75 (9.) Number of Elements A (0.6) (49.4) (200.2).3 (33.3) Chain Hook Bracket B E Enclosure Size (No. of Elements) D A 0.38 (9.7) Dia. Hole Wide A 2, 3 and (95.3) 6 and (0.6) C High B.94 (49.3) 2.9 (55.6) Deep C 0.3 (3.3) 0.3 (3.3) Mounting D 2.69 (68.3) 2.88 (73.2) E.38 (35.).63 (4.4) (339.9) Master Test Module, Flasher Module and Legend Plate.3 (33.3).63 (4.4).78 (45.2) 6 Mounting Holes.4 (29) Master Test Module, Flasher Module A Legend Plate B Legend Plate A B /2 Round Legend Plates Small.56 (39.6) 0.9 (23.) Standard.59 (40.4).07 (27.2) Jumbo 2.06 (52.3).53 (38.9) Square Legend Plates Small.59 (40.4) sq (22.9) Standard.75 (44.5) sq..06 (26.9) Jumbo 2.9 (55.6) sq..50 (38.) Extra large 2.44 (62.0) sq..63 (4.4) Notes Locating nib hole or notch is.36.4 in ( mm) #29 drill. For plastic legend plate, Dimension B is.2 (28.4). Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-239

240 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Contents Description Page 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Product verview V7-T-24 Product Identification V7-T-242 Selection V7-T-243 rdering Complete Devices V7-T-245 Product Selection Non-Illuminated Momentary Pushbutton Units V7-T-246 Plastic Lens Indicating Light Units V7-T-246 Pushbuttons V7-T-247 Illuminated Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights V7-T-248 Push-Pull Units V7-T-250 Illuminated Push-Pull Units V7-T-25 Potentiometers V7-T-253 Push-Pull perators V7-T-254 Selector Switch Units V7-T-258 Selector Switch Selection V7-T-259 Selector Switch perators V7-T-262 Key perators V7-T-262 Illuminated Selector Switch perators.... V7-T-264 Accessories V7-T-265 ptions V7-T-267 Replacement Parts V7-T-273 Technical Data and Specifications V7-T-275 Dimensions V7-T-278 Product Description Eaton s E34 Series 30.5 mm pushbutton line features the same rugged die cast construction of our 0250T line with an additional two-layer 00% solid thermosetting cathodic epoxy coating. This coating provides a flat black smooth, consistent, corrosion resistant surface that has passed a demanding 600 hour salt spray test. (The industry standard for this 4 test requires only 200 hours.) Features Epoxy-coated metal operators Corrosion resistant Integral ground screw terminal on operators FDA approved for sanitary chemical resistance requirements Standards and Certifications CE EN and UL 508 File No. E3568 CSA C22.2 No. 4 File No. LR6855 FDA 3-A Sanitary Standards Ingress Protection When mounted in similarly rated enclosure Standard indicating lights UL (NEMA) Type, 2, 3, 3R, 3S, 4, 4, 2, 3 IEC IP65 All other operators UL (NEMA) Type, 2, 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 IEC IP65 V7-T-240 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

241 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Product verview Ultraviolet Light E34 cathodic coating is not recommended for use in applications where exposure to ultraviolet light exists use NEMA T operators. Reliability Nibs Eaton s contact blocks feature enclosed silver contacts with pointed reliability nibs for reliable performance from logic level up to 600V. To ensure reliable switching, nibs bite through oxide which can form on silver contacts, eliminating the need for expensive logic level blocks for most applications. Reliability Nibs Dry Circuit Medium Duty Heavy-Duty Diaphragm Seal with Drainage Holes Liquid Drainage Eaton s pushbutton operators offer front of panel drainage via holes in the operator bushing. Hidden from view by the mounting nut, these holes prevent buildup of liquid inside the operator, which can prevent operation in freezing environments. The holes also provide a route for escaping liquid in high pressure washdowns, effectively relieving pressure from the internal diaphragm seal, ensuring reliable sealing in applications even beyond NEMA 4. Diaphragm Seal Foam Neoprene Panel Sealing Gasket Drainage Hole Flexible Diaphragm Stainless Steel perating Spring Colorfast Molded Button Drainage Hole Mounting Nut Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-24

242 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Product Identification 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Series ctagonal Mounting Nut Self-Adjusts to Panel Thickness Eliminates Spacer Washers and Set Screws Die Cast Construction with Thick, Tough Corrosion Resistant Coating Three Styles of Legend Plates in Four Sizes Internal Sealing Diaphragm for Excellent Sealing Wide Variety of perator Types and Colors Terminal Clamps Shipped pen Ready to Wire Stackable Contact Blocks up to 2 Circuits per perator V7-T-242 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

243 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons Illuminated and Non-Illuminated Push-Pulls Note perator GDB = Two-position maintained GEB = Three-position mom push-mom pull GFB = Three-position mt push-mom pull GHB = Three-position mom push-mom pull perator PB = Flush EB = Extended LB = 40 mm mushroom JB = 65 mm mushroom EVB = /2 shroud vertical mount EHB = /2 shroud horizontal mount Incandescent Light Unit Blank = Non-illuminated 89 = 24V/FR 63 = 20V/FR 64 = 208V/FR 65 = 240V/FR 82 = 277V/FR 66 = 380V/FR 67 = 480V/FR 68 = 600V/FR 69 =6V/FV 70 = 2V/FV 79 = 24V/FV 83 = 32V/FV 80 = 20V/RES 8 = 240V/RES Add at end of catalog number to receive parts assembled from factory. E34 PB = Black 2 = Red 3 = Green 4 = Yellow Button Color 7 = Gray 5 = White 6 = Blue 8 = range Circuit Blank = perator only = N-NC 2 = 2N 3 = 2NC 5 =NC 53 =N E34 GDB 63 M2 LED Light Unit Blank = Non-illuminated 89L =24V/FR 63L = 20V/FR 64L = 208V/FR 65L = 240V/FR 82L = 277V/FR 66L = 380V/FR 67L = 480V/FR 68L = 600V/FR 97L = Full voltage Non-Illuminated Illuminated Button Incandescent LED Lens Type C = Black 40 mm C2 = Red 40 mm C2N8 = Red 40 mm E STP C3 = Green 40 mm C6 = Blue 40 mm = Black 65 mm J2 = Red 65 mm J2N8 = Red 65 mm E STP = Green 65 mm = Yellow 65 mm LED Voltage Blank = Non-illuminated Blank = Incandescent 06 = 6 Vac/Vdc 2 = 2 Vac/Vdc 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc 48 = 48 Vac/Vdc 60 = 60 Vac/Vdc 2A = 20 Vac 2D = 20 Vdc M2 = M2N8 = M3 = M6 = M9 = M5 = M0 = Circuit Blank = perator only = N-NC 2 = 2N 3 = 2NC 5 =NC 53 =N RD = Red 40 mm ED = Red 40 mm E STP GD = Green 40 mm LD = Blue 40 mm AD = Amber 40 mm WD = White 40 mm = Clear 40 mm Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-243

244 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Illuminated Pushbuttons Standard Indicating Lights, PresTest and Master Test Note Light Unit Type B = Transformer CB = Full voltage SB = Resistor Incandescent Light Unit 024 = 24V/FR 20 = 20V/FR 240 = 240V/FR 277 = 277V/FR 380 = 380V/FR 480 = 480V/FR 600 = 600V/FR 06 =6V/FV 2 = 2V/FV 24 = 24V/FV 32 = 32V/FV 48 = 48V/FV 20 = 20V/RES 240 = 240V/RES Light Unit Type Standard Incandescent TB20 = 20V/FR TB240 = 240V/FR TB277 = 277V/FR TB380 = 380V/FR TB480 = 480V/FR TB600 = 600V/FR FB06 = 6V/FV FB2 = 2V/FV FB24 = 24V/FV FB32 = 32V/FV FB48 = 48V/FV RB20 = 20V/RES RB240 = 240V/RES NB20 = 20V/neon NB240 = 240V/neon PresTest Incandescent TPB20 = 20V/FR TPB240 = 240V/FR TPB380 = 380V/FR TPB480 = 480V/FR TPB600 = 600V/FR FPB06 = 6V/FV FPB2 = 2V/FV FPB24 = 24V/FV FPB32 = 32V/FV FPB48 = 48V/FV RPB20 = 20V/RES RPB240 = 240V/RES LED Light Unit 024L =24V/FR 20L = 20V/FR 240L = 240V/FR 277L = 277V/FR 380L = 380V/FR 480L = 480V/FR 600L = 600V/FR 397L = Full voltage Standard LED TB20L = 20V/FR TB240L = 240V/FR TB277L = 277V/FR TB380L = 380V/FR TB480L = 480V/FR TB600L = 600V/FR FB97L = Full voltage PresTest LED TPB20L = 20V/FR TPB240L = 240V/FR TPB380L = 380V/FR TPB480L = 480V/FR TPB600L = 600V/FR FPB297L = Full voltage Add at end of catalog number to receive parts assembled from factory. E34 B 24 V2 Incandescent Lens Color V2 =Red V3 =Green V4 = Yellow V5 =White V6 =Blue V9 =Amber V0 = Clear E34 FB06 H2 LED Lens Color RD =Red GD =Green YD = Yellow WD =White LD = Blue AD =Amber Blank = Incandescent 06 = 6 Vac/Vdc 2 = 2 Vac/Vdc 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc LED Voltage Circuit Blank = perator only = N-NC 2 = 2N 3 = 2NC 5 =NC 53 =N 48 = 48 Vac/Vdc 60 = 60 Vac/Vdc 2A = 20 Vac 2D = 20 Vdc Plastic Glass Lens Color Plastic Glass Lens Color Standard/Master Incandescent Standard/Master/PresTest LED H2 = H3 = H4 = H5 = H6 = H9 = H0 = G2 = Red G3 = Green G4 = Yellow G5 = White G6 = Blue G9 = Amber G0 = Clear PresTest Incandescent V2 = V3 = V4 = V5 = V6 = V9 = V0 = P2 = Red P3 = Green P4 = Yellow P5 = White P6 = Blue P9 = Amber P0 = Clear RP = GP = YP = WP = LP = AP = RG = Red GG = Green YG = Yellow WG = White LG = Blue AG = Amber LED Voltage Blank = Incandescent 06 = 6 Vac/Vdc 2 = 2 Vac/Vdc 24 = 24 Vac/Vdc 48 = 48 Vac/Vdc 60 = 60 Vac/Vdc 2A = 20 Vac 2D = 20 Vdc V7-T-244 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

245 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. rdering Complete Devices Complete E34 pushbuttons, indicating lights and/or selector switch operators including contact block(s) and legend plate can be ordered using a single composite catalog number. The For Complete E34 Device rdering perator individually packaged components will be shipped unassembled in a single overpack carton marked with the composite catalog number. E34B20 V2 53 SP90 Lens E34V2 Insert Hyphen Before Contact Block(s) Legend Plate E34;SP90 Contact Blocks 0250T and 0250T53 rdering Example Illuminated Pushbutton Device E34B20V2-53SP90 For a complete Catalog Number breakdown, see Pages V7-T-243 to V7-T-244. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-245

246 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Product Selection Non-Illuminated Momentary Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Flush Button Extended Button Mushroom Button Jumbo Mushroom Pushbutton Units Contact Type Button Color Plastic Lens Indicating Light Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 24V Full Voltage Indicating Light Indicating Light Units Flush Button Extended Button Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. Anodized aluminum head may not be suitable for some corrosive environments. Mushroom Button Jumbo Mushroom N Black E34PB-53 E34EB-53 E34LB-53 E34JB-53 Red E34PB2-53 E34EB2-53 E34LB2-53 E34JB2-53 Green E34PB3-53 E34EB3-53 E34LB3-53 E34JB3-53 Red Engraved EMERG. STP E34JB2N8-53 NC Black E34PB-5 E34EB-5 E34LB-5 E34JB-5 Red E34PB2-5 E34EB2-5 E34LB2-5 E34JB2-5 Green E34PB3-5 E34EB3-5 E34LB3-5 E34JB3-5 Red Engraved EMERG. STP E34JB2N8-5 N-NC Black E34PB- E34EB- E34LB- E34JB- Red E34PB2- E34EB2- E34LB2- E34JB2- Green E34PB3- E34EB3- E34LB3- E34JB3- Red Engraved EMERG. STP E34JB2N8- Type Voltage Color LED/Lamp Number Indicating Light LED Lamp; Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red Bayonet base E34FB97LRP24 Green E34FB97LGP24 Amber E34FB97LAP24 20 Vac Red E34FB97LRP2A Green E34FB97LGP2A Amber E34FB97LAP2A Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red #757 E34FB24H2 Green E34FB24H3 Amber E34FB24H9 Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc Red 20MB E34RB20H2 Green E34RB20H3 Amber E34RB20H9 Transformer 20 Vac Red #755 E34TB20H2 50/60 Hz Green E34TB20H3 Amber E34TB20H9 V7-T-246 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

247 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Pushbuttons UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 E34PB_ E34EB_ E34EHB_ E34LB_ E34JB_ Momentary Pushbutton perators, Non-Illuminated Button Color Flush button Black E34PB Red E34PB2 Green E34PB3 Yellow E34PB4 White E34PB5 Blue E34PB6 Gray E34PB7 range E34PB8 Extended button Black E34EB Red E34EB2 Green E34EB3 Yellow E34EB4 White E34EB5 Blue E34EB6 Gray E34EB7 range E34EB8 Half shrouded button Vertical Horizontal Black E34EVB E34EHB Red E34EVB2 E34EHB2 Green E34EVB3 E34EHB3 Yellow E34EVB4 E34EHB4 White E34EVB5 E34EHB5 Blue E34EVB6 E34EHB6 Gray E34EVB7 E34EHB7 range E34EVB8 E34EHB8 Mushroom button Black E34LB Red E34LB2 Green E34LB3 Yellow E34LB4 Blue E34LB6 Anodized aluminum jumbo Black E34JB mushroom button Red E34JB2 Red (Engraved EMERG. STP) Green Yellow E34JB2N8 E34JB3 E34JB4 Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. Anodized aluminum head may not be suitable for some corrosive environments. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-247

248 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Illuminated Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Illuminated Pushbutton Indicating Light PresTest perators without Lens Type Voltage Lamp Number Illuminated Pushbutton Indicating Light PresTest LED Lamp (LEDs not included) Full voltage Bayonet E34CB497L E34FB97L E34FPB297L Transformer AC only 24 base E34B024L 20 E34B20L E34TB20L E34TPB20L 240 E34B240L E34TB240L E34TPB240L 277 E34B277L E34TB277L 380 E34B380L E34TB380L E34TPB380L 480 E34B480L E34TB480L E34TPB480L 600 E34B600L E34TB600L E34TPB600L Incandescent Lamp Full voltage AC/DC 6 #755 E34CB06 E34FB06 E34FPB06 2 #756 E34CB2 E34FB2 E34FPB2 24 #757 E34CB24 E34FB24 E34FPB24 32 #828 E34CB32 E34FB32 E34FPB32 48 #835 E34CB48 E34FB48 E34FPB48 Resistor AC/DC MB E34SB20 E34RB20 E34RPB E34SB240 E34RB240 E34RPB240 Transformer AC only 24 #755 E34B E34B20 E34TB20 E34TPB E34B240 E34TB240 E34TPB E34B277 E34TB E34B380 E34TB380 E34TPB E34B480 E34TB480 E34TPB E34B600 E34TB600 E34TPB600 Neon AC/DC 20 NE5H-R-22 E34NB NE5H-4-68 E34NB240 Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. These units do not include lamps. rder LED separately to match lens color, see Page V7-T-225 for LED Selection and Pages V7-T-243 to V7-T-244 for Catalog Numbering Selection. 2 Resistor units are not available for use with LEDs, choose either transformer or full voltage LED style. V7-T-248 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

249 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Plastic Glass E34V_ Plastic Glass Indicating Light Lens Color Illuminated Pushbutton Lens Color PresTest Lens Note Plastic Red E34H2 E34G2 Green E34H3 E34G3 Yellow E34H4 E34G4 White E34H5 E34G5 Blue E34H6 E34G6 Ambler E34H9 E34G9 Clear E34H0 E34G0 Red Green Yellow White Blue Ambler Clear Color E34V2 E34V3 E34V4 E34V5 E34V6 E34V9 E34V0 Plastic Red E34V2 E34P2 Green E34V3 E34P3 Yellow E34V4 E34P4 White E34V5 E34P5 Blue E34V6 E34P6 Ambler E34V9 E34P9 Clear E34V0 E34P0 Glass lens has black anodized aluminum bezel. Glass Glass Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-249

250 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Push-Pull Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two- and three-position Non-illuminated Two-Position Push-Pull Unit Three-Position Push-Pull Unit Standard Jumbo Mushroom Head Two-Position Push-Pull Units, Non-Illuminated perator Position Pull Push Mounting Location Contact Button Type/Color 2 Type A B Maintained Push, Maintained Pull Three-Position Push-Pull Units, Non-Illuminated perator Position Pull Intermediate Push Mounting Location Contact Button Type/Color 2 Type A B Maintained Push, Momentary Pull Momentary Push, Momentary Pull Button and Color Selection Color Suffix Code Standard 40 mm Black C E34C Red C2 E34C2 Red (EMERG. STP) C2N8 E34C2N8 Green C3 E34C3 Blue C6 E34C6 Jumbo Mushroom Head 3 (Anodized) Aluminum 65 mm Red J2 E34J2 Red (EMERG. STP) J2N8 E34J2N8 Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color buttons, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the table. Example: E34GDBC6-. 3 Anodized aluminum may not be suitable for use on some corrosive applications. 40 mm/red N E34GDBC2-40 mm engraved NC E34GDBC2N8- EMERG. STP/red 65 mm aluminum engraved EMERG. STP/red E34GDBJ2N8-40 mm/black NC E34GFBC-3 40 mm/red NC E34GFBC mm engraved EMERG. STP/red E34GFBC2N mm/black NC E34GEBC-3 40 mm/red NC E34GEBC mm/black N E34GHBC- 40 mm/red NC E34GHBC2- V7-T-250 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

251 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Illuminated Push-Pull Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two-position maintained Illuminated Illuminated Push-Pull Unit Standard Two-Position Illuminated Maintained Push, Maintained Pull perator Position Maintained Pull Maintained Intermediate Lens and Color Selection Incandescent Color Suffix Code Lamp Type Voltage Contact Type Mounting Location A B LED/Lamp Number Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color lens, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from Lens and Color Selection table above. Example: E34GDB79M3 -. For LEDs with different voltages see ordering example on Page V7-T-257. Red Standard Push-Pull 2 LED Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N Bayonet E34GDB97LRD24-20 Vac/Vdc NC base E34GDB97LRD2A- Transformer 24 Vac E34GDB89LRD06-20 Vac E34GDB63LRD06- Incandescent Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N #757 E34GDB79M2- Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc NC 20MB E34GDB80M2- Transformer 24 Vac #755 E34GDB89M2- LED Suffix Code 20 Vac E34GDB63M2- Standard Red M2 RD E34M2 Red (EMER. STP) M2N8 ED E34M2N8 Green M3 GD E34M3 Blue M6 LD E34M6 Amber M9 AD E34M9 White M5 WD E34M5 Clear M0 CD E34M0 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-25

252 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Three-position maintained Illuminated Illuminated Push-Pull Unit Three-Position Illuminated Momentary Push, Momentary Pull perator Position Momentary Pull Maintained Intermediate Momentary Push Lamp Type Voltage LED Full voltage Full voltage Contact Type Mounting Location A B LED/Lamp Number Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color lens, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from Lens and Color Selection table on the bottom of Page V7-T-25. Example: E34GEB79M3-3. For LEDs with different voltages see ordering example on Page V7-T-257. Red Standard Push-Pull 2 24 Vac/Vdc N Bayonet E34GHB97LRD24- base 20 Vac NC E34GHB97LRD2A- 24 Vac E34GHB89LRD06-20 Vac E34GHB63LRD06-24 Vac/Vdc NC Bayonet E34GEB97LRD24-3 base 20 Vac NC E34GEB97LRD2A-3 24 Vac E34GEB89LRD Vac E34GEB63LRD06-3 Full 24 Vac/Vdc N #757 E34GHB79M2- voltage Resistor 20 Vac NC 20MB E34GHB80M2-24 Vac #755 E34GHB89M2-20 Vac E34GHB63M2- Full 24 Vac/Vdc NC #757 E34GEB79M2-3 voltage Resistor 20 Vac NC 20MB E34GEB80M2-3 Transformer Transformer Incandescent Transformer Transformer 24 Vac #755 E34GEB89M Vac E34GEB63M2-3 V7-T-252 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

253 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Three-position maintained push, momentary pull Illuminated Illuminated Push-Pull Unit Vertical or Horizontal ne-hole Mounting 3 Three-Position Illuminated Maintained Push, Momentary Pull perator Position Momentary Pull Maintained Intermediate Maintained Push Potentiometers UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Lamp Type Voltage Contact Type Potentiometer with Knob and Standard Dial Plate Linear Type ±0% Potentiometer hms 2 Watt (60V Max.) Single Potentiometer with Standard Aluminum Dial Plate E34PDBF 2500 E34PDBF E34PDBF E34PDBF E34PDBF E34PDBF50 perator only 6 E34PDBA0 Alternative black plastic large legend with standard markings E34LP99 Dimensions, see Page V7-T-278. LED Full voltage Mounting Location A B Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color lens, substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from table on the bottom of Page V7-T-25. Example: E34GFB79M3-3. For LEDs with different voltages see ordering example on Page V7-T Shown with standard aluminum dial plate. 4 Large dial plate with space for legend is available at no charge. To order, add suffix 36 to catalog number. Example: E34PDBF36. To order separately, see footnote 5 below. 5 Large dial plate has space at top for 5 letters. 3/32 in high. For custom stamped legend plates, order legend plate as separate item 0250TR30 and specify stamping. 6 For use with commercially purchased potentiometers having shaft dimensions per dimension drawing on Page V7-T-230. LED/Lamp Number Red Standard Push-Pull 2 24 Vac/Vdc NC Bayonet E34GFB97LRD24-3 base 20 Vac NC E34GFB97LRD2A-3 24 Vac E34GFB89LRD Vac E34GFB63LRD06-3 Full 24 Vac/Vdc NC #757 E34GFB79M2-3 voltage Resistor 20 Vac NC 20MB E34GFB80M2-3 Transformer Incandescent Transformer 24 Vac #755 E34GFB89M Vac E34GFB63M2-3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-253

254 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Push-Pull perators An illuminated push-pull pushbutton unit, arranged for one-hole mounting, can replace two pushbuttons and a pilot light or the nonilluminated form can replace two pushbuttons. These units are available in three basic types: Maintained (Twoposition). Maintains in the pulled or pushed position until manually actuated to the opposite mode. Momentary (Threeposition). Spring returns to an intermediate position when pulled or pushed and released. Two-Position Maint. Push-Pull Momentary Pull, Maintained Push (Threeposition). Spring returns to intermediate position when pulled. Maintains in pushed position until manually returned to intermediate (ready to reset) position. Maintained stop holds circuit open and will prevent other series connected operators from starting the system. The operators, buttons, contact blocks, etc., are offered as building block components that can be intermixed to satisfy many requirements. This minimizes the need for a varied and costly inventory. Application Guide To assist in the selection of contact blocks, the sketch below shows pictorially by symbols A and B locations of contact circuits after assembly of contact blocks and adapter to the operator. The table below shows the effect of the push and pull operations on either N or NC contacts. ( = contact closed, = contact open). Contact Circuit Locations Locating Nib Push-Pull perator Components perator Position and Circuit Arrangement ut Pull Intermediate In Push Type of perator Two-Position perator without Lens Maintained push-pull Three-Position perator without Lens Momentary push-pull Maintained push-momentary pull Momentary push-pull Contact Block Mounting Location A B A B A B or or or or No intermediate position Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. See Typical Applications on Page V7-T-89. Shown without button on lens. 2 Maximum of two blocks, four circuits. Special function contact blocks shown on Page V7-T-272 CANNT be used with three-position push-pull operators E34GEB, E34GFB or E34GHB. or or or or or or or A B Contact Block 2 N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2NC E34GDB E34GEB 2 E34GFB 2 E34GHB 2 V7-T-254 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

255 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Push-Pull Light Units, Lenses and Buttons rdering Example with ne Composite Number Non-illuminated: E34GDB + E34C T = E34GDBC2- Incandescent: E34GDB T79 + E34M T = E34GDB79M2- LED: E34GDB T97L + E34M2 + Voltage Code T = E34GDB97LRD Vac/Vdc 2 2 Vac/Vdc Vac/Vdc Vac/Vdc Vac/Vdc 2A 20 Vac 2D 20 Vdc Light Units for Illuminated Push-Pull Devices Light Unit Type Type Voltage LED/Lamp Number LED Full voltage Bayonet 0250T97L (LEDs not included) Transformer 24 base 0250T89L AC only 50/60 Hz T63L T64L Incandescent Full voltage AC or DC Resistor AC or DC Transformer AC only 50/60 Hz T65L T82L T66L T67L T68L 6 # T69 2 #756 # T70 24/28 # T T MB 0250T T8 24 # T T T T T T T T68 Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. These units do not include lamps. rder LED separately to match lens color from chart on Page V7-T-257. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-255

256 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Standard Jumbo Mushroom Head E34M_ Buttons for Non-Illuminated Push-Pull Devices Incandescent Color Suffix Code Alternate Lenses for Illuminated Push-Pull Devices Standard Button Black C E34C Red C2 E34C2 Red (EMERG. STP) C2N8 E34C2N8 Green C3 E34C3 Blue C6 E34C6 Jumbo Mushroom Head Red J2 E34J2 Red (EMERG. STP) J2N8 E34J2N8 Color Incandescent Suffix Code LED Suffix Code 2 Red M2 RD E34M2 Red (EMERG. STP) M2N8 ED E34M2N8 Green M3 GD E34M3 Blue M6 LD E34M6 Amber M9 AD E34M9 White M5 WD E34M5 Clear M0 E34M0 Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. Anodized aluminum may not be suitable for use on some corrosive applications. 2 Suffix codes should only be used for assembling composite catalog numbers. To order lens, order by catalog number. V7-T-256 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

257 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Standard LED Lamp LED Selection Voltage Color Voltage Color 6 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED006RN 60 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED060RN suitable for use with range E22LED006N range E22LED060N transformers Yellow E22LED006YN Yellow E22LED060YN Green E22LED006GN Green E22LED060GN Blue E22LED006BN Blue E22LED060BN White E22LED006WN White E22LED060WN 2 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED02RN 20 Vac Red E22LED20RA range E22LED02N range E22LED20A Yellow E22LED02YN Yellow E22LED20YA Green E22LED02GN Green E22LED20GA Blue E22LED02BN Blue E22LED20BA White E22LED02WN White E22LED20WA 24 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED024RN 20 Vdc Red E22LED20RD range E22LED024N range E22LED20D Yellow E22LED024YN Yellow E22LED20YD Green E22LED024GN Green E22LED20GD Blue E22LED024BN Blue E22LED20BD White E22LED024WN White E22LED20WD 48 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED048RN range E22LED048N Yellow E22LED048YN Green E22LED048GN Blue E22LED048BN White E22LED048WN Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-257

258 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Selector Switch Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two-, three- and four-position maintained Non-illuminated and illuminated Two-Position Maint. Switch Knob Three-Position Maint. Switch Knob Four-Position Maint. Switch Lever Two-Position Selector Switch perator Position perator Action 2 Contact Type Three-Position Selector Switch perator Position perator Action 2 Four-Position Selector Switch perator Position M M perator Action 2 M M M M Mounting Location A B Cam Code Non-Illuminated Color Selection, Non-Illuminated Color Code Letter Color Code Letter Black White 5 Red 2 Blue 6 Green 3 Gray 7 Yellow 4 range 8 Notes For Light Unit Voltage Suffix and Knobs, Levers tables, see Page V7-T-264. Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 M = Maintained. 3 To order different type or color selector switch, substitute the underlined character with appropriate suffix code from the Color Selection table. Example: E34VFBK2-. Illuminated 20V Transformer Black Knob Black Lever Red Knob Red Lever NC E34VFBK- E34VFBL- E34VFB20ER- E34VFB20FR- N Contact Type Mounting Location A B Cam Code Non-Illuminated Illuminated 20V Transformer Black Knob Black Lever Red Knob Red Lever N 3 E34VHBK-2 E34VHBL-2 E34VHB20TER-2 E34VHB20TFR-2 M N M N 3 E34VHBK-23 E34VHBL-23 E34VHB20TER-23 E34VHB20TFR-23 2NC (Series) N Contact Type Mounting Location A B Cam Code Non-Illuminated Illuminated 20V Transformer Black Knob Black Lever Red Knob Red Lever NC 7 E34VTBK-23 E34VTBL-23 E34VRB20TER-23 E34VRB20TFR-23 M N N NC V7-T-258 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

259 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Selector Switch Selection Cam and Contact Block Selection Selector switches in their varied forms (two-position, three-position and fourposition) are a big factor contributing to the great flexibility of control that a well rounded line of pushbuttons can achieve. Because of their flexibility, they tend to cause difficulty with product selection and application. The following systematic approach should simplify that task. Cam and contact block selection is better understood if you: Work with each incoming and outgoing wire/circuit separately. Recognize the terms N and NC only identify the type of contact by its mode before mounting to the operator. The - chart (Page V7-T-26) shows how that contact will act after assembly to the operator with the selected cam shape. = closed circuit, = open circuit. Up to six N or NC contacts may be mounted behind each plunger location for a total of twelve contacts. Single circuit contact blocks have only one plunger with the other side of the block open. Therefore, single circuit contact blocks transmit motion to blocks behind them only for the position containing the circuit. Each cam has two separate lobes, each of which operates one of the two contact block plungers independently of each other. Those are identified as position A (locating nib side) and position B (opposite of locating nib). The position designations give direction in selecting and mounting of the contact blocks. Contact Circuit Locations Locating Nib A B Systematic Approach Application: HAND-FF- AUT selector switch. In this circuit, one incoming line is distributed to two other outgoing circuits by the switch. The two circuits can be looked at individually. Step : Elementary Diagram. Construct on paper, or in your mind, a simple elementary diagram of the switching scheme as follows: Incoming Line Step 2: - Pattern. From the elementary diagram, you can construct an - diagram which describes when the contacts are to be closed () or open () in the various positions of the switch. The - for the HAND circuit looks like this: HAND HAND FF AUT FF AUT utgoing Circuit utgoing Circuit In this circuit, you want a contact closed on the left (HAND) but open in the center and right. For the AUT circuit, the - diagram would look like this: HAND FF AUT Putting them together, the complete - diagram is: nce the - diagram has been generated, the next step is to select the cam and contact block, or blocks, needed to perform the desired - functions. The selection tables on the following pages list the various types (shapes) of cams by number to choose from and the type of contact and position to achieve the function outlined in your - diagram. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-259

260 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Step 3: Cam Selection. The cam you select determines the operation of all contact blocks mounted to the operator. It is selected on the basis that it provides the simplest circuitry for the desired - diagram. The selection tables show all the - combinations. For the purpose of this example, the applicable portion of those tables is shown on this page. Now to make the cam selection, make a simple worksheet such as: Cam 2 Cam 3 (A)N-(B)NC (B)N (A)N (B)N It becomes immediately obvious that cam 3 is the better choice for two reasons, () the series combination can be avoided making it simpler to wire, (2) only two contacts are required, which is less expensive than the three contacts required by cam 2. Step 4: Contact Block Selection. Having selected the cam, contact block selection is simply a matter of gathering the A position and B position circuits into pairs which make up the most convenient contact block arrangement. If there is an imbalance in the number of circuits under A or B, then single circuit blocks must be selected for these leftover circuits. Step 5: Selector Switch perator. Lastly, you have to choose from the many types of operators knob and lever in various colors or keyed. Also what combinations of maintained and spring return functions are required. Selection of these operators can be found on Page V7-T-262. For the example in step 4, you may want a three-position maintained black knob, cam 3 E34VHBK. The Complete Switch: E34VHBK with one 0250T2 or, for one composite catalog number, E34VHBK-Y found on Page V7-T-259. Diagrams Circuits shown illustrate connections to obtain a selector switch circuit combination and are shown with their appropriate line diagrams. Field wiring of jumper connections required as shown. = Closed circuit = pen circuit Wiring of Jumper Connections Series Connection Parallel Connection Example Selection Table No. Two-Position Selector Switch Contact Block Selection Desired Circuit and perator Position Contact Blocks Required to Accomplish Circuit Function No. Top Plunger A Bottom Plunger B Note - Pattern Wired in series. Cam Code #2 Cam Code #3 Top A Bottom B Top A Bottom B N NC N 4 2 a NC N N or or NC N N Back to the worksheet, having selected cam 3 do this: AN BN 0250T2 Four-position selector switches are limited to four contact blocks. Contact Blocks For selection and number of available contact blocks per operator, see Page V7-T-27. V7-T-260 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

261 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Three-Position Switch Cam and Contact Block Selection Contact Blocks Required to Accomplish Circuit Function (Jumpers must be installed where indicated) Desired Circuit and perator with Cam Code #2 perator with Cam Code #3 perator Position Mounting Location Mounting Location No Top Plunger A Four-Position Switch Contact Block Selection Contact Blocks Required to Accomplish Circuit Function Desired Circuit and Mounting Location perator Position No Top Plunger A NC N NC N N NC Bottom Plunger B N NC N N NC Bottom Plunger B N NC NC N NC N N NC NC N N Top Plunger A N NC Bottom Plunger B NC N N NC NC NC No. Desired Circuit and perator Position Contact Blocks Required to Accomplish Circuit Function Mounting Location Top Plunger A NC N NC N N N NC NC Bottom Plunger B N NC N NC N NC Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-26

262 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Selector Switch perators UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Two-Position Knob Selector Switch Key perators Three-Position Keyed Selector Switch perators with Knob Assembled Positions perator Action Key perators with Cam and Cap Black Knob Selector Switch Vertical Mounting 2 Cam Code 3 4 Two-position 60 throw E34VFBK M M E34VEBK Three-position 60 throw M 2 E34VGBK M M 3 E34VHBK M 2 E34VJBK S M 3 E34VKBK M 2 E34VLBK S S 3 E34VMBK M 2 E34VNBK M S 3 E34VPBK Four-position 40 throw M M 7 E34VTBK Positions M M perator Action S M Cam Code 3 Key Removal Positions 5 Vertical Mounting Horiz. Mounting Two-position 60 throw, 2, 3 E34KFB_ E34KFHB_ M M M S 2 E34KEB_ E34KEHB_ Three-position 60 throw M 2 7 E34KGB_ E34KGHB_ M M 3 E34KHB_ E34KHHB_ M 2, 4, 5 E34KJB_ E34KJHB_ S M 3 E34KKB_ E34KKHB_ M 2 4 E34KLB_ E34KLHB_ S S 3 E34KMB_ E34KMHB_ M 2 2, 4, 6 E34KNB_ E34KNHB_ M S 3 E34KPB_ E34KPHB_ Four-position 40 throw M M 7 7 E34KTB_ E34KTHB_ M M Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow (R). 2 Field convertible to horizontal mounting. 3 For selection of the proper cam and contact block to obtain the proper circuit sequence, see selection instructions and tables on Pages V7-T-259 to V7-T For other colors of either the knob or lever, replace the underlined characters of the catalog number with the appropriate suffix code from Alternate Knob and Lever table on Page V7-T-263. Example: E34VFBL2. 5 Choose key removal position required for application from table on Page V7-T-263. Add key removal code number to listed catalog number. Example: E34KFB2. V7-T-262 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

263 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Key Removal Positions L Code Suffix C R Key Removal Position Right only 2 Left only 3 Right and left 4 Center only 6 Left and center 7 All positions E34K_ E34L_ E34A_ Dissimilar Locks and Keys Listed operators have identical locks and keys (Key Code H66), 0250ED824. For dissimilar lock and key combinations, see Page V7-T-98. Alternate Knobs and Levers for perators 2 Color Knob Suffix Code Lever Suffix Code Notes Key removal in spring return from positions not recommended. 2 See operators on Page V7-T For use on maintained operators only. Lever Designed for Added Ingress Protection 3 Suffix Code Black K E34K L E34L A E34A Red K2 E34K2 L2 E34L2 A2 E34A2 Green K3 E34K3 L3 E34L3 A3 E34A3 Yellow K4 E34K4 L4 E34L4 A4 E34A4 White K5 E34K5 L5 E34L5 A5 E34A5 Blue K6 E34K6 L6 E34L6 A6 E34A6 Gray K7 E34K7 L7 E34L7 A7 E34A7 range K8 E34K8 L8 E34L8 A8 E34A8 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-263

264 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Illuminated Selector Switch perators 20 Vac Transformer Selector Switch, Cam Knob Lever perator without Knob or Lever Positions Knobs and Levers Knob Color 9 and Code Number perator Action Transformer Type 50/60 Hz Full Voltage Type AC or DC 6V #755 Lamp Lamps #755, #757, #835, 20MB Two-position 60 throw Cam Code 5 Cam Code 5 M M E34VFB_ E34SFB_ Three-position 60 throw M Cam Code 2 5 Cam Code 3 5 Cam Code 2 5 Cam Code 3 5 M M E34VGB_ E34VHB_ E34SGB_ E34SHB_ M S S M M M S M S E34VNB_ 6 E34VPB_ 6 E34SNB_ 7 E34SPB_ 7 E34VJB_ 6 E34VKB_ 6 E34SJB_ 7 E34SKB_ 7 E34VLB_ E34VMB_ E34SLB_ E34SMB_ Four-position 40 throw M M E34VRB_ E34SRB_ M M Lever and Code Number Red 0250TER 0250TFR Green 0250TEG 0250TFG Yellow 0250TEA 0250TFA Blue 0250TEL 0250TFL Clear 0250TEC 0250TFC White 0250TEW 0250TFW Amber 0250TEM 0250TFM Light Unit Voltage Suffix Add to operator listed in table above. Type of Light Unit Transformer Type Full Voltage Type 50/60 Hz AC or DC Voltage Suffix Code Voltage Suffix Code Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Pages V7-T-67 to V7-T-239. Full voltage light units can be used at other than listed voltages by changing lamp. Replacement lamps are listed on Page V7-T MB lamps are used on both 20V and 240V operators. 3 perator includes lens gasket and lens attachment screws. 4 Add suffix code for light unit voltage to listed catalog number from Light Unit Voltage Suffix table above. Example: For 24V transformer type light unit, order E34VFB For selection of the proper cam and contact block required to obtain a specific circuit sequence, see selection tables on Pages V7-T-259 to V7-T and 240V transformer only full voltage only. 8 Resistor type. May generate excess heat if used in high density. 9 Amber, clear and white lenses have a black arrow (R). Red, green and blue lenses have a white arrow (R). V7-T-264 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

265 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Accessories E34TA2 0250TA_ E34TA3_ E34TA6 E34TA2 E34TA5 E34TA Accessories Description Padlocking Attachment for Flush Pushbutton perators. Permits locking NC contacts in open position with /4 in padlock. Will not lock N contact. Notes Should not be used on flush button for STP function. 2 Not suitable for single contact block depth cast enclosure. Cover is too thick. E34TA2 Flexible Weather Resistant Boot for use with flush pushbutton operators. Clear 0250TA46 Black 0250TA47 Red 0250TA48 Green 0250TA49 Flexible Weather Resistant Boot for use with button operators (extended buttons preferred). Black 0250TA3 Red 0250TA4 Green 0250TA0 Clear 0250TA85 Transparent Boot for regular, illuminated pushbutton operators and PresTest. 0250TA25 2 Special Retaining Nut to accommodate thick panel. Indicating light E34TA30 PresTest, pushbuttons and selector switches E34TA3 Shroud for Mushroom Head perator prevents accidental operation. (Not for push-pull operators.) Extended Retaining Nut replaces standard nut and provides guard for flush type pushbutton operators. Guard for illuminated pushbutton Padlocking Attachment for non-illuminated knob selector switches accommodates up to five, /4 in padlocks. E34TA6 E34TA2 E34TA5 E34TA Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-265

266 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 E34TK3 0250TA7_ 0250TMT8 0250TFL_ E22CW 0250TA0 Accessories, continued Description Thrust Washer To meet Ford Motor Company mounting specifications. E34TK3 Contact Block Terminal Jumps Available in multiples of 00 only. Terminal to terminal within block (short): 00 per package 0250TA per package 0250TA70-2 Terminal to terminal block to block (long): 00 per package 0250TA7 000 per package 0250TA7-2 Master Test (Dual Input) Module Internal Form C relay suitable for either AC or DC applications. Total electrical isolation between monitored and test circuit. Fits all illuminated 0250T, E22, E30 and E34 devices. 48 Vdc 0250TMT8 Flasher Module Internal Form C relay suitable for AC applications. ne unit required for each operator in master test circuit. 24 Vac 0250TFL2 20 Vac 0250TFL Panel Mounting Nut Wrench E22, E30, E34 and octagonal 0250T. Fingerproof Shroud 0 per package Fits new style contact blocks and light units. E22CW 0250TA0 V7-T-266 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

267 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 ptions Legend Plates Field Color Legend plates can be supplied printed on black, red, silver or white field. To order legend printed on a color other than indicated add Standard Jumbo suffix code to the end of the catalog number as follows: R for Red field; W for White field; or S for Silver field. For Pushbutton perators and Indicating Lights Legend Example: E34SP26R Standard plate with red field marked PEN. Blank Plastic Legend Plates Square 3 Color Field Standard Jumbo Extra Large Lettering Side Side 2 Black White Silver 0250TSP TLP TEP76 White Red Black 0250TSP TLP TEP77 Notes Color of Field Standard 2 Jumbo Legend Color of Field For dimensions, see Page V7-T /32 in high lettering. 3 Legend plates with non-standard markings or aluminum legend plates see 0250T listing on Page V7-T-28. Standard 2 Jumbo Letters on Legend Plates Below are 3/6 in High CLAMP Black E34SP90 E34LP90 FF Red E34SP24 E34LP24 CLSE E34SP73 E34LP73 N Black E34SP25 E34LP25 DWN E34SP74 E34LP74 PEN E34SP26 E34LP26 EMERG. STP Red E34SP3 E34LP3 UT E34SP27 E34LP27 FAST Black E34SP75 E34LP75 PWER N E34SP80 E34LP80 FASTER E34SP87 E34LP87 RAISE E34SP28 E34LP28 FEEDER N E34SP94 E34LP94 READY E34SP86 E34LP86 FEEDER FF E34SP95 E34LP95 RESET E34SP29 E34LP29 FRWARD E34SP5 E34LP5 REVERSE E34SP30 E34LP30 HIGH E34SP6 E34LP6 RUN E34SP3 E34LP3 IN E34SP7 E34LP7 SAFE E34SP85 E34LP85 INCH E34SP8 E34LP8 SLW E34SP32 E34LP32 JG E34SP9 E34LP9 SLWER E34SP88 E34LP88 JG FR. E34SP20 E34LP20 START E34SP33 E34LP33 JG REV. E34SP2 E34LP2 STP Red E34SP34 E34LP34 LW E34SP22 E34LP22 TEST Black E34SP83 E34LP83 LWER E34SP23 E34LP23 TRANSFER E34SP93 E34LP93 LUBE-FAIL E34SP92 E34LP92 TRIP E34SP84 E34LP84 MTR RUN E34SP8 E34LP8 UNCLAMP E34SP9 E34LP9 MTR STP E34SP82 E34LP82 UP E34SP35 E34LP35 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-267

268 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Standard Jumbo For Selector Switch perators Legend For Push-Pull Units Notes Color of Field 3/32 in (2.4 mm) high lettering. 2 /8 in (3.2 mm) high lettering. Standard Jumbo Legend Color of Field Standard Jumbo Two-Position 3/6 in High Lettering Three-Position 3/6 in High Lettering FR. REV. Black E34SP38 E34LP38 AUT FF HAND Black E34SP49 E34LP49 HAND AUT E34SP39 E34LP39 FR. FF REV. E34SP50 E34LP50 HIGH LW E34SP40 E34LP40 FR. SAFE REV. E34SP69 E34LP69 JG RUN E34SP4 E34LP4 HAND FF AUT E34SP5 E34LP5 MAN. AUT E34SP67 E34LP67 MAN. FF AUT E34SP68 E34LP68 FF N E34SP42 E34LP42 PEN FF CLSE E34SP53 E34LP53 PEN CLSE E34SP43 E34LP43 RUN SAFE JG E34SP70 E34LP70 RUN JG E34SP44 E34LP44 UP FF DWN E34SP54 E34LP54 SAFE RUN E34SP45 E34LP45 N STP SAFE E34SP7 E34LP7 START JG E34SP46 E34LP46 START STP E34SP47 E34LP47 UP DWN E34SP48 E34LP48 Legend Color of Field Standard PULL N/PUSH FF Black E34PP5 E34R5 PULL PEN/PUSH CLSE Black E34PP8 E34R8 PULL UP/PUSH DWN Black E34PP E34R Jumbo 2 V7-T-268 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

269 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Enclosures Die Cast, Polyester and Stainless Steel Enclosures Die Cast Enclosure Polyester Enclosure Stainless Steel Enclosure Mounting Instructions These E34 Die Cast Enclosures feature a corrosion resistant coating identical to finish on the E34 operators except gray in color. Not for use in ultraviolet light applications. Enclosures (Case and Cover) Surface Mounting Number of ne Contact Block Depth Two Contact Block Depth Elements Die Cast Enclosure In-Line 23 NEMA 4, 4, 2, 3 E34N E34N 2 E34N2 E34N2 3 E34N3 E34N3 4 E34N4 Polyester In-Line NEMA 3, 4, 2 E34N5 2 E34N52 3 E34N53 4 E34N54 Stainless Steel 4 In-Line NEMA 4, 4, TN TN TN TN36 Dimensions, see Page V7-T-278. ne and Two Contact Block Depth Enclosures ne Contact Block Depth Enclosure Two Contact Block Depth Enclosure Enclosure Layouts Top For Vertical Mounting Notes For spacing increments, see Page V7-T All die cast enclosures can be converted to base mounting of contact blocks with spacers 0250TA22 or 0250TA23. See listing on Page V7-T When used with E30 pushbuttons, only the one element enclosure can be used. 4 4 gauge, type Top For Horizontal Mounting Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-269

270 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Die Cast and Stainless Steel Flush Mount, Covers nly Flush Mounting Covers Covers nly Flush Mounting Number of Elements Flush Die Cast Covers Spacing Increments Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Spacing Increments for Enclosures In-Line Deep Cover Enclosure Layouts In-Line Flat Cover E34F E34F 2 E34F2 E34F2 3 E34F3 E34F3 4 E34F4 E34F4 In-Line Stainless Steel Flush Plates 2 With Pullbox Without Pullbox 0250TS0 0250TS TS 0250TS TS2 0250TS TS4 0250TS4 Dimensions, see Page V7-T-279. Type F G H Die cast 2.44 (62) 2.5 (63.5).88 (47.8) Polyester.88 (47.8) Min. 2.3 (54.) 2.25 (57.2) Stainless steel.69 (42.9) Min..73 (43.9) 2.25 (57.2) F G H Top For Vertical Mounting Notes These E34 die cast covers feature a corrosion resistant coating identical to the finish on the E34 operators except gray in color. 2 Not oiltight. NEMA applications only Top For Horizontal Mounting V7-T-270 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

271 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Contact Blocks Standard Contact Blocks UL A600/P600 rated Color-coded plungers red/ green for NC/N circuits Silver contact tips with reliability nibs Black (opaque) or amber (translucent) housings Pressure plate or spade terminals Fingerproof shrouds (for pressure terminals only) Logic Level Contact Blocks UL A600/P600 rated Black plungers Inert palladium knife-blade contacts Black (opaque) housings Pressure plate or spade terminals Fingerproof shrouds not available Special Function Contact Blocks UL A600/P600 rated Black plungers Silver contact tips with reliability nibs Black (opaque) housings Pressure plate terminals only Fingerproof shrouds not available Special Purpose Contact Block Maximum 300V rated Black plungers Silver contact tips with reliability nibs Black (opaque) housings Pressure plate terminals only Fingerproof shrouds not available Reliability Nibs Reliability nibs are the hallmark of Eaton s contact blocks. A pointed silver nib on the contact tip ensures reliable switching from logic level (5V) up to 600V applications. Therefore standard contact blocks can be used for most logic level applications where the contacts are not exposed to any harsh environmental conditions. Palladium Contacts Palladium, which is more inert than gold, is well suited for voltages and currents approaching zero and is recommended for applications where environmental conditions are a factor. Maximum Contact Block Mounting per perator Type Max. perator Stack Pushbuttons 6 Push-pull operators 2 Roto-push operators 4 Two- or three-position 6 selector switches Four-position selector 4 switches Joysticks 4 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-27

272 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E T Contact Blocks Symbol Circuit Description Blank No Plunger Blank No Plunger NC N N-NC 2NC 2N Special Function Blocks 3 Blank No Plunger LNC ECN- NC ECN- N 2LNC LNC- ECN Special Purpose Blocks 5 2N- 2NC Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. Late opening NC. Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard NC. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard N. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Two late opening NC contacts. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. verlapping contacts. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Four circuits in single block depth. Rated 300V max. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Standard Pressure Terminal Spade Terminal 2 Logic Level Pressure Terminal Spade Terminal T5 0250T T5E 0250T59E 0250T T T53E 0250T60E 0250T 0250T TE 0250T40E 0250T3 0250T T3E 0250T42E 0250T2 0250T4 0250T2E 0250T4E 0250T T7E T T47E T T57E T T45E T T55E T44 5 Notes All 0250T contact blocks shown are suitable for use on standard 0250T and E34 operators. These contact blocks are not suitable for Class I Division 2 type 0250T or E34 devices. 2 Contact blocks with spade terminals are limited to a maximum of one contact block per operator and minimum spacing between devices is 2.5 in (63.5 mm). Not suitable for use in 0250T or E34 enclosures. Also available in amber housing. Not available with fingerproof shrouds. 3 Special function contact blocks are not suitable for use with roto-push operators, three-position push-pull operators, or four-position selector switches. 4 ECN contact blocks are not suitable for use with two-position joysticks or when operators are used with padlock attachments. 5 Special purpose 0250T44 contact blocks are not suitable on selector switches or roto-push operators. kay to use with three-position push-pull operators only on low voltage (30V or less) circuits. V7-T-272 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

273 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E TCP Replacement Parts Contact Blocks with Fingerproof Shrouds Symbol Circuit Description Blank No Plunger Blank No Plunger Special Function Blocks 3 Blank No Plunger Standard Pressure Terminal 2 Logic Level Pressure Terminal 2 NC Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250T5P 0250T5EP N Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250T53P 0250T53EP N-NC Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250TP 0250TEP 2NC Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250T3P 0250T3EP 2N Stack up to six blocks (2 circuits) unless otherwise noted. 0250T2P 0250T2EP LNC ECN-NC ECN-N 2LNC LNC-ECN Late opening NC. Stack up to six blocks (six circuits) unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard NC. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. Early closing N and standard N. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. Two late opening NC contacts. Stack up to six blocks unless otherwise noted. verlapping contacts. Stack up to four blocks unless otherwise noted. 0250T7P T7EP T47P T47EP T57P T57EP T45P T45EP T55P T55EP 4 Replacement Lamps For E34 Illuminated perators Mfg. Lamp Type Voltage Base Style Application Part Number 20MB 20V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T resistor indicating light # V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T flasher 0250ED986-4 # V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T transformer, PresTest and full voltage #756 2V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T full voltage #757 24V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T full voltage #828 32V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T full voltage #835 55V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T resistor NE48 20V T 4-/2 bayonet 0250T neon NE5H-R22 20V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T neon NE5H-R68 240V T 3-/4 bayonet 0250T neon Notes All 0250T contact blocks shown are suitable for use on standard 0250T and E34 operators. These contact blocks are not suitable for Class I Division 2 type 0250T or E34 devices. 2 To order contact blocks with translucent amber housing, change suffix P to CP in catalog number e.g. 0250T5CP. 3 ECN contact blocks are not suitable for use with two-position joysticks or when operators are used with padlock attachments. 4 Special function contact blocks are not suitable for use with roto-push operators, three-position push-pull operators, or four-position selector switches. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-273

274 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Flush Head Pushbutton perator Illuminated Pushbutton perator E34 Style perator Replacement Parts Item No. Description Mushroom Head Pushbutton perator Transformer Type Indicating Light No. Req. Part Number Gasket Mounting nut Set screw (#6-32 x in long hollow hex) Mushroom head button (includes [2] item 5) As Req. Below Black Red Yellow Green Blue Set screw (#0-32 x in long hollow hex) Jumbo mushroom head button As Req. Below (aluminum includes [2] item 5) Red Black Yellow Green Jumbo mushroom head button (aluminum red EMERG. STP) does not include item 5 8 Mounting screw (#6-32 x 0.70 in long) TA79 Washer Terminal screw and lug (captive) Req Gasket (supplied with basic unit) Round head screw (#4-40 x in long) (supplied with basic unit) Jumbo Mushroom Head perator Knob-perated Selector Switch perator Item No. Description Potentiometers Full Voltage, Resistor and Transformer Type Illuminated Selector Switch No. Req. Part Number 2 Mounting screw Simple potentiometer As Req. Below (does not include items 8, 28 or 29),000 ohms ,500 ohms ,000 ohms ,000 ohms ,000 ohms ,000 ohms Connector (includes screw and lug) Indicating plate As Req. Above Standard size (without legend) Large size (specify legend) 0250TR30 6 Retaining nut Knob Socket set screw (#6-32 x in long) Coupling Set screw (#6-32 x 0.88 in long) Spacer Connector (includes screw and lug) Mounting nut V7-T-274 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

275 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Technical Data and Specifications Mechanical Ratings Description Specification Frequency of peration All pushbuttons 6000 operations/hr. Key and lever selector switches 3000 operations/hr. Auto-latch devices 200 operations/hr. Life Pushbuttons 0 x 0 6 operations Contact blocks 0 x 0 6 operations PresTest units 0 x 0 6 operations Lever and key selector switches 0.25 x 0 6 operations Twist to release pushbuttons 0.3 x 0 6 operations Shock Resistance Duration 20 ms >5g General Specifications Description Specification Climate Conditions perating temperature to 50 F ( 7 to 66 C) Storage temperature 40 to 76 F ( 40 to 80 C) Altitude 6,562 ft (2,000m) Humidity Max. 95% RH at 60 C Terminals Marking NC-N on the contact block to meet the NEMA requirements. Dual marking system 2 for normally closed, 3 4 for normally open to meet BS5472 (Cenelec EN50 005). Clamps Terminals are saddle clamp type for x 22 AWG (0.34 mm 2 ) to 2 x 4 AWG (2.5 mm 2 ) conductors Torque 7 lb-in (0.8 Nm) Degree of protection against direct electrical contact IP2 with fingerproof shroud Light Units Transformers Will withstand short-circuit for hour per IEC Bulbs average life: Transformer type 20,000 hrs. Resistor/direct voltage type 2500 hrs. minimum at rated V LED 60,000 to 00,000 hrs. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-275

276 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Electrical Ratings Description Insulation Thermal Specification U i = 660 Vac or Vdc I th = 0A Short Circuit Coordination to IEC/EN Rated conditional short circuit current ka Fuse type GE power controls TIA 0, red spot type gg, 0A, 660 Vac, 460 Vdc, BS88-2, IEC UL rating A600, P600 AC load life duty cycle 200 operations/hour 0A 0V pf 0.4 x 0 6 operations 5A 250V pf 0.4 x 0 6 operations 2A 600V pf 0.4 x 0 6 operations Switching capacity AC 5 rated make/break ( x l e at. x U e ) 6A 20V pf 0.3 4A 240V pf 0.3 2A 660V pf 0.3 DC3 rated make/break (. x l e at. x U e ).0A 25V L/R >0.95 at 300 ms 0.55A 250V L/R >0.95 at 300 ms 0.A 660V L/R >0.95 at 300 ms 0A 0V pure resistive Maximum ratings for logic level and hostile atmosphere application Maximum amperes 0.5A Maximum volts 20 Vac/Vdc Low voltage switching Conical shaped points or reliability nibs improve performance in dry circuit, corrosive, fine dust and other contaminated atmospheres. Under normal environmental conditions, the minimum operational voltage is 5V and the minimum operational current is ma, Vac/Vdc. Contact operation Slow make and break. All normally closed contacts have positive opening operation, i.e., normally closed contacts are forced open in the event of contact weld or spring breakage. Electrical Ratings Contact Block Meet or Exceed NEMA Rating Designations A600, A300 and B300 for AC and P600 for DC Description 50 Vac or 60 H Vdc / Meet or Exceed NEMA Rating Designations A600, A300 and B300 for AC and P600 for DC Make and emerg. interrupting capacity (amp) Normal load break (amp) Thermal current (amp) Voltamperes: Make and emerg. interrupting capacity Normal load break V7-T-276 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

277 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Mounting ptions Panel Thickness Minimum: 0.06 in (.6 mm) Maximum: 0.25 in (8 mm) including legend plate Maximum can be increased to in (5.9 mm) using optional retaining nut Indicating light: 0250TA30 Pushbutton/selector switch: 0250TA3 Mounting Matrix Legend Plate Mounting ptions in Inches (mm) Horizontal mounting means terminals are located top and bottom of contact block. Vertical mounting means terminals are left and right of contact block. This allows close spacing of adjacent operators with easy access to terminals. Locating nib hole or notch is 0.4 in (3.6 mm) #29 drill. Drilling Dimensions in Inches (mm) Dimensions in Inches (mm) A B C D Small.63 (4.3) 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2).63 (4.3) Medium.75 (44.5) 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2).75 (44.5) Large 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2) 2.25 (57.2) 0.4 (3.6) Dia. B Min. 0.4 (3.6) Dia. Terminals on Top A Min. Horizontal Mounting.20 (30.5) 0.6 (5.2) C Min. D Min..22 (3) Vertical Mounting 0.6 (5.2) Terminals at Side Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-277

278 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Potentiometer Std. Dial Plate 0.94 (23.9) 0.75 (9.) Surface Mounting 0.94 (23.9) 0.94 (23.9) Die Cast, Polyester and Stainless Steel Enclosures Notes Depth given is for two contact block deep stations. ne contact block deep stations subtract 3/4 in (9. mm). 2 No conduit entrance holes provided. Drill as required. Legend Plates Large Dial Plate (55.6) (47.8) (33.3) (27.7).0 (45) (25.4) 4 Mtg. Holes 0-32 Screw Size for 4 Element Die Cast/ Stainless Steel Enclosure 7/32 Screw Size for Polyester Number of Elements D A E B Surface Element Arrangement C Wide A High B Deep C.77 (45) Mounting D E Standard Die Cast In-line 3.88 (98.6) 4.0 (0.6) 3.0 (76.3) 2.69 (68.3) 3.25 (82.6) 3/ (98.6) 5.88 (49.4) 3.0 (76.3) 2.69 (68.3) 5.3 (30.3) (98.6) 7.75 (96.9) 3.0 (76.3) 2.69 (68.3) 7.0 (77.8) (98.6) 9.63 (244.6) 3.0 (76.3) 2.69 (68.3) 8.88 (225.6) Polyester In-line 3.8 (96.8) 6.63 (68.4) 3.38 (85.9) 2.94 (74.7) 4.88 (24.0) (96.8) 6.63 (68.4) 3.38 (85.9) 2.94 (74.7) 4.88 (24.0) (96.8) 8.88 (225.6) 3.38 (85.9) 2.94 (74.7) 7.3 (8.) (96.8).3 (282.7) 3.38 (85.9) 2.94 (74.7) 9.38 (238.3) Stainless Steel In-line 3.00 (76.2) 3.50 (88.9) 3.00 (76.2).50 (38.) 4.25 (08.0) (88.9) 6.75 (7.5) 3.00 (76.2).50 (38.) 7.50 (90.5) (88.9) 9.00 (228.6) 3.00 (76.2).50 (38.) 9.00 (228.6) (88.9).25 (285.8) 3.00 (76.2).50 (38.) 2.00 (304.8) Conduit Entrance 2.9 (55.6) Jumbo V7-T-278 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

279 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Flush Mounting Die Case and Stainless Steel Covers nly 4 Mtg. Holes Screw Size for - Element Encl, /4-20 Screw Size for 2 Element and Larger Number of Elements E B D C A Surface or Pendant Wide A High B Notes Depth given is for flat cover. Deep cover is 3/4 in (9. mm) deeper. 2 Depth given includes pull box. Deep C Mounting D Die Cast 3.88 (98.6) 4.0 (0.6) 0.25 (6.4) 3.50 (88.9) 3.63 (92.2) (98.6) 5.88 (49.4) 0.25 (6.4) 3.50 (88.9) 5.50 (39.7) (98.6) 7.75 (96.9) 0.25 (6.4) 3.50 (88.9) 6.0 (52.4) (98.6) 9.63 (244.6) 0.25 (6.4) 3.50 (88.9) 9.25 (235) Stainless Steel 5.00 (27) 5.0 ( (63.5) (82.6).88 (47.8) (27) 6.88 (74.8) 2.50 (63.5) (82.6) 3.63 (92.2) (27) 8.63 (29.2) 2.50 (63.5) (82.6) 5.50 (39.7) (27) 0.50 (266.7) 2.50 (63.5) (82.6) 7.25 (84.2) E Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-279

280 .8 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Padlocking Attachment for Flush Pushbutton perators 0.75 (9.) Flexible Weather Resistant Boot.47 (37.3) Transparent Boot.92 (48.8) Shroud for Mushroom Head perator.53 (38.9) Extended Retaining Nut.38 (35.).25 (3.8) 0.84 (2.3).63 (4.4).50 (38.) Guard for Illuminated Pushbutton.50 (38.).59 (40.4).3 (33.3).63 (4.4).59 (40.4) 0.94 (23.9) 0.25 (6.4) Contact Block Terminal Jumps 0.45 (.4) Master Test Module and Flasher Module.3 (33.3) 0.25 (6.4).63 (4.4) 0.86 (2.8) 6 Mounting Holes Flush Pushbutton.78 (45.2) 0.88 (22.4) Extended Pushbutton.78 (45.2) 0.88 (22.4) Half Shroud Pushbutton.78 (45.2) 0.88 (22.4) Each Addl. Contact Blk. Each Addl. Contact Blk. Each Addl. Contact Blk. Contact Blk..09 (27.7) Contact Blk..09 (27.7) Contact Blk..09 (27.7).44 (36.6).44 (36.6) 0.25 (6.4).78 (45.2).4 (29).06 (26.9).38 (35.).38 (35.).38 (35.) V7-T-280 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

281 30.5 mm Corrosion Resistant Watertight/iltight E34.8 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Mushroom Pushbutton.78 (45.2) 0.88 (22.4) Jumbo Mushroom Pushbutton.78 (45.2) 0.88 (22.4) Push-Pull Switch 0.88 (22.4) Contact Block Indicating Light.78 (45.2). (27.9).09 (27.7).63 (4.4) PresTest Indicating Light.78 (45.2) Each Addl. Contact Blk. Each Addl. Contact Blk. Contact Blk. Contact Blk..09 (27.7) 0.88 (22.4) Light Unit 0.25 (6.4).9 (48.3) Each Addl. Contact Blk. Contact Blk..38 (35.).09 (27.7).75 (44.5).78 (45.2).50 (38.) 2.50 (63.5) 0.06 (.5) to 0.25 (6.4) Panel Thickness.3 (28.7).38 (35.).3 (28.7) 0.69 (7.5).38 (35.) 2.63 (66.8).65 (4.9) Illuminated Pushbutton.09 (27.7).78 (45.2) Selector Switch 0.88 (22.4).09 (27.7) Key Selector Switch Each Addl. Contact Blk (22.4) Each Additional Contact Block Light Unit.09 (27.7) Contact Block.09 (27.7).3 (28.7).5 (38.) 0.69 (7.5).58 (40.) Knob.58 (40.) Lever.38 (35.).58 (40.) to Remove Key Illuminated Selector Switch Each Additional Contact Block 0.88 (22.4) Contact Block Light Unit.09 (27.7).58 (40.) Knob.58 (40.) Lever Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-28

282 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Contents Description 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Selection Product Selection Momentary Pushbutton Units, Non-Illuminated Illuminated Pushbutton Units Guarded Illuminated Pushbutton Units Indicating Light Units Push-Pull Units Illuminated Push-Pull Units Selector Switch Units Selector Switch Contact Block Selection Accessories ptions Replacement Parts Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Product Description The HT800 Series from Eaton s electrical sector is a family of 30.5 mm pushbutton devices which includes momentary, illuminated and mushroom head pushbuttons, selector switches, indicating lights and push-pull switches. The HT800 devices have a familiar appearance found in most industrial applications and are suitable for replacement of several other manufacturers 30.5 mm pushbutton devices. Features Anodized aluminum mounting rings Watertight double V-gasket seals Extended height bulbs Transparent housing contact blocks Color-coded contact blocks Gold-plated contacts (on low voltage contact block) Reliability ridge on movable contact Stackable screw-mounted contact blocks Contact blocks can be mounted in left/right or top/ bottom positions Standard NC contact opens before N contact closes (break before make operation) Bright and long lasting LED indicating lights in six colors Field convertible maintained selector switches from two- to three-position and vice versa Field selectable knob/lever mounting positions at any 22.5 increment Benefits Corrosion resistant NEMA 4 finish Watertight and oiltight NEMA 4, 3 ingress protection Increased side illumination of indicating lights and illuminated pushbuttons Easy visual inspection of contact conditions Easily identifiable N (white) or NC (black) contact blocks Gold-plated contacts suitable for logic level circuits Reliability ridge penetrates contamination buildup on stationary contacts Left/right or top/bottom mounted contact blocks allow correct positioning in retrofit applications All-purpose selector switches are convertible and can rotate in 22.5 increments to suit panel layouts Standards and Certifications Page V7-T-283 V7-T-284 V7-T-286 V7-T-288 V7-T-290 V7-T-292 V7-T-293 V7-T-294 V7-T-296 V7-T-297 V7-T-298 V7-T-30 V7-T-302 V7-T-303 UL508 per File No. E3568 CSA C22.2 No. 4 per File No. LR6855 Ingress Protection UL (NEMA) Type, 2, 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 when mounted in similarly rated enclosures V7-T-282 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

283 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. HT800 Pushbuttons, Push-Pulls and Indicating Lights HT800 Selector Switch Notes Style Pushbuttons AA = Flush AB = Extended AE = Mushroom head Illuminated Pushbuttons GB = Illuminated PB Push-Pull perators CB = Two-position, maintained Indicating Lights HF = Full voltage/resistor type HB = Transformer type Push-to-Test perators GT = All types perator JA = Two-pos., knob, maint. JB = Three-pos., knob, maint. JC = Four-pos., knob, maint. JD = Two-pos., lever, maint. JE = Three-pos., lever, maint. JF = Four-pos., lever, maint. JK = Two-pos., knob, spr. rtn., left JL = Two-pos., lever, spr. rtn., left JN = Two-pos., knob, spr. rtn., right JP = Two-pos., lever, spr. rtn., right JR = Three-pos., knob, spr. rtn., left JS = Three-pos., lever, spr. rtn., left JU = Three-pos., knob, spr. rtn., right JV = Three-pos., lever, spr. rtn., right J = Three-pos., knob, spr. rtn., both JY = Three-pos., lever, spr. rtn., both LN = Four-pos., knob, spr. rtn., pos to 2 LP = Four-pos., lever, spr. rtn., pos to 2 LR = Four-pos., knob, spr. rtn., pos 4 to 3 LS = Four-pos., lever, spr. rtn., pos 4 to 3 Button Color G = Green H = Black R = Red Lens Color A = Amber/range B = Blue C = Clear G = Green R = Red W = White Y = Yellow Maximum of four contact blocks per side or a total of eight contact blocks recommended. 2 Maximum of two contact blocks per side or a total of four contacts blocks recommended. HT8 GB R AB T Contact Block Location (viewed from rear) Left Side Right Side A = N A2 = 2N B = NC B2 = 2NC C = NEM C2 = 2 NEM D = NCLB D2 = 2NCLB E = NEM-NCLB F = N and NC F4 = N-NC HT8 JA H 3A FQ Switch Color H = Black Cam Location/Type D = For all three-pos. 3A = For all two-pos. 8E = For all four-pos. A5 = N A6 = 2N B = NC B6 = 2NC C5 = NEM C6 = 2 NEM D = NCLB D6 = 2NCLB E5 = NEM-NCLB Q = N and NC Light Unit Type/Voltage F3 = 24V FV, LED F7 = 20V FV, LED L = 20V transformer, LED T = 20V transformer, incandescent V3 = 24V FV, incandescent V7 = 20V res., incandescent Contact Block Location (viewed from rear) 2 Left Side Right Side A = N A2 = 2N B = NC B2 = 2NC C = NEM C2 = 2 NEM D = NCLB D2 = 2NCLB E = NEM-NCLB F = N and NC F4 = N-NC A5 = N A6 = 2N B = NC B6 = 2NC C5 = NEM C6 = 2 NEM D = NCLB D6 = 2NCLB E5 = NEM-NCLB Q = N and NC Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-283

284 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Product Selection Momentary Pushbutton Units, Non-Illuminated UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Flush, extended or 40 mm mushroom head operators HT800 Pushbuttons HT800 Pushbuttons Point-of-Purchase Units Description Two-position maintained selector switch N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: FF N, MAN. AUT, UP DWN Three-position maintained selector switch, black knob, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: HAND FF AUT, FR. FF REV., PEN FF CLSE Three-position selector switch, spring return from left and right, black knob, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: UP FF DWN, FR FF REV., PEN FF CLSE Red push-pull emergency stop, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: STP, EMERG. STP, FF Illuminated push-pull maintained red pushbutton, 20V full voltage low profile LED, three square legend plates: STP, EMERG. STP, FF Illuminated push-pull maintained red pushbutton, 24V full voltage low profile LED, three square legend plates: STP, EMERG. STP, FF Green flush pushbutton, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: START, N, RUN Black flush pushbutton, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: RESET, JG, PEN Red flush pushbutton, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: STP, CLSE, FF Red extended pushbutton, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: STP, CLSE, FF Black extended pushbutton, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: RESET, JG, PEN Illuminated green pushbutton, 20V full voltage incandescent, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: START, N, RUN Illuminated green pushbutton, 24V full voltage incandescent, N/NC contact block, three square legend plates: START, N, RUN HT8JAH3AAB-PP HT8JBHDAB-PP HT8JHDAB-PP HT8CBRAB-PP HT8FBRABFL7-PP HT8FBRABFL3-PP HT8AAGAB-PP HT8AAHAB-PP HT8AARAB-PP HT8ABRAB-PP HT8ABHAB-PP HT8GBGABV7-PP HT8GBGABV3-PP V7-T-284 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

285 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 Flush Head perator Extended Head perator 40 mm Mushroom Head perator Momentary Contact Pushbutton Units, Non-Illuminated Contact Type Button Color Flush Head Extended Head No contact Black HT8AAH HT8ABH HT8AEH Red HT8AAR HT8ABR HT8AER Green HT8AAG HT8ABG HT8AEG N Black HT8AAHA HT8ABHA HT8AEHA Red HT8AARA HT8ABRA HT8AERA Green HT8AAGA HT8ABGA HT8AEGA NC Black HT8AAHB HT8ABHB HT8AEHB Red HT8AARB HT8ABRB HT8AERB Green HT8AAGB HT8ABGB HT8AEGB N-NC Black HT8AAHAB HT8ABHAB HT8AEHAB Red HT8AARAB HT8ABRAB HT8AERAB Mushroom Head (40 mm) Green HT8AAGAB HT8ABGAB HT8AEGAB 2N-2NC Black HT8AAHFQ HT8ABHFQ HT8AEHFQ Red HT8AARFQ HT8ABRFQ HT8AERFQ Green HT8AAGFQ HT8ABGFQ HT8AEGFQ Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-285

286 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Illuminated Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Incandescent or LED Full voltage or transformer type 24V and 20V Illuminated Pushbutton perator Illuminated Pushbuttons Type Volts Lens Color Note Light unit base operator without lens or bulb. perator nly N NC N-NC 2N-2NC Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8GBFV Red HT8GBRV7 HT8GBRAV7 HT8GBRBV7 HT8GBRABV7 HT8GBRFQV7 Green HT8GBGV7 HT8GBGAV7 HT8GBGBV7 HT8GBGABV7 HT8GBGFQV7 Amber HT8GBAV7 HT8GBAAV7 HT8GBABV7 HT8GBAABV7 HT8GBAFQV7 Clear HT8GBCV7 HT8GBCAV7 HT8GBCBV7 HT8GBCABV7 HT8GBCFQV7 White HT8GBWV7 HT8GBWAV7 HT8GBWBV7 HT8GBWABV7 HT8GBWFQV7 Yellow HT8GBYV7 HT8GBYAV7 HT8GBYBV7 HT8GBYABV7 HT8GBYFQV7 Blue HT8GBBV7 HT8GBBAV7 HT8GBBBV7 HT8GBBABV7 HT8GBBFQV7 24 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8GBFV Red HT8GBRV3 HT8GBRAV3 HT8GBRBV3 HT8GBRABV3 HT8GBRFQV3 Green HT8GBGV3 HT8GBGAV3 HT8GBGBV3 HT8GBGABV3 HT8GBGFQV3 Amber HT8GBAV3 HT8GBAAV3 HT8GBABV3 HT8GBAABV3 HT8GBAFQV3 Clear HT8GBCV3 HT8GBCAV3 HT8GBCBV3 HT8GBCABV3 HT8GBCFQV3 White HT8GBWV3 HT8GBWAV3 HT8GBWBV3 HT8GBWABV3 HT8GBWFQV3 Yellow HT8GBYV3 HT8GBYAV3 HT8GBYBV3 HT8GBYABV3 HT8GBYFQV3 Blue HT8GBBV3 HT8GBBAV3 HT8GBBBV3 HT8GBBABV3 HT8GBBFQV3 Transformer 20 Vac No lens HT8GBT Red HT8GBRT HT8GBRAT HT8GBRBT HT8GBRABT HT8GBRFQT Green HT8GBGT HT8GBGAT HT8GBGBT HT8GBGABT HT8GBGFQT Amber HT8GBAT HT8GBAAT HT8GBABT HT8GBAABT HT8GBAFQT Clear HT8GBCT HT8GBCAT HT8GBCBT HT8GBCABT HT8GBCFQT White HT8GBWT HT8GBWAT HT8GBWBT HT8GBWABT HT8GBWFQT Yellow HT8GBYT HT8GBYAT HT8GBYBT HT8GBYABT HT8GBYFQT Blue HT8GBBT HT8GBBAT HT8GBBBT HT8GBBABT HT8GBBFQT V7-T-286 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

287 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Illuminated Pushbutton perator Illuminated Pushbuttons, continued perator nly Type Volts Lens Color Note Light unit base operator without lens or bulb. N NC N-NC 2N-2NC LED Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8GBFV Red HT8GBRF7 HT8GBRAF7 HT8GBRBF7 HT8GBRABF7 HT8GBRFQF7 Green HT8GBGF7 HT8GBGAF7 HT8GBGBF7 HT8GBGABF7 HT8GBGFQF7 Amber HT8GBAF7 HT8GBAAF7 HT8GBABF7 HT8GBAABF7 HT8GBAFQF7 Clear HT8GBCF7 HT8GBCAF7 HT8GBCBF7 HT8GBCABF7 HT8GBCFQF7 White HT8GBWF7 HT8GBWAF7 HT8GBWBF7 HT8GBWABF7 HT8GBWFQF7 Yellow HT8GBYF7 HT8GBYAF7 HT8GBYBF7 HT8GBYABF7 HT8GBYFQF7 Blue HT8GBBF7 HT8GBBAF7 HT8GBBBF7 HT8GBBABF7 HT8GBBFQF7 24 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8GBFV Red HT8GBRF3 HT8GBRAF3 HT8GBRBF3 HT8GBRABF3 HT8GBRFQF3 Green HT8GBGF3 HT8GBGAF3 HT8GBGBF3 HT8GBGABF3 HT8GBGFQF3 Amber HT8GBAF3 HT8GBAAF3 HT8GBABF3 HT8GBAABF3 HT8GBAFQF3 Clear HT8GBCF3 HT8GBCAF3 HT8GBCBF3 HT8GBCABF3 HT8GBCFQF3 White HT8GBWF3 HT8GBWAF3 HT8GBWBF3 HT8GBWABF3 HT8GBWFQF3 Yellow HT8GBYF3 HT8GBYAF3 HT8GBYBF3 HT8GBYABF3 HT8GBYFQF3 Blue HT8GBBF3 HT8GBBAF3 HT8GBBBF3 HT8GBBABF3 HT8GBBFQF3 Transformer 20 Vac No lens HT8GBT Red HT8GBRL HT8GBRAL HT8GBRBL HT8GBRABL HT8GBRFQL Green HT8GBGL HT8GBGAL HT8GBGBL HT8GBGABL HT8GBGFQL Amber HT8GBAL HT8GBAAL HT8GBABL HT8GBAABL HT8GBAFQL Clear HT8GBCL HT8GBCAL HT8GBCBL HT8GBCABL HT8GBCFQL White HT8GBWL HT8GBWAL HT8GBWBL HT8GBWABL HT8GBWFQL Yellow HT8GBYL HT8GBYAL HT8GBYBL HT8GBYABL HT8GBYFQL Blue HT8GBBL HT8GBBAL HT8GBBBL HT8GBBABL HT8GBBFQL Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-287

288 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Guarded Illuminated Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Incandescent or LED Full voltage or transformer type 24V and 20V Guarded Illuminated Pushbutton perator Guarded Illuminated Pushbuttons perator nly Type Volts Lens Color Note Light unit base operator without lens or bulb. N NC N-NC 2N-2NC Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8GDFV Red HT8GDRV7 HT8GDRAV7 HT8GDRBV7 HT8GDRABV7 HT8GDRFQV7 Green HT8GDGV7 HT8GDGAV7 HT8GDGBV7 HT8GDGABV7 HT8GDGFQV7 Amber HT8GDAV7 HT8GDAAV7 HT8GDABV7 HT8GDAABV7 HT8GDAFQV7 Clear HT8GDCV7 HT8GDVAV7 HT8GDCBV7 HT8GDCABV7 HT8GDCFQV7 White HT8GDWV7 HT8GDWAV7 HT8GDWBV7 HT8GDWABV7 HT8GDWFQV7 Yellow HT8GDYV7 HT8GDYAV7 HT8GDYBV7 HT8GDYABV7 HT8GDYFQV7 Blue HT8GDBV7 HT8GDBAV7 HT8GDBBV7 HT8GDBABV7 HT8GDBFQV7 24 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8GDFV Red HT8GDRV3 HT8GDRAV3 HT8GDRBV3 HT8GDRABV3 HT8GDRFQV3 Green HT8GDGV3 HT8GDGAV3 HT8GDGBV3 HT8GDGABV3 HT8GDGFQV3 Amber HT8GDAV3 HT8GDAAV3 HT8GDABV3 HT8GDAABV3 HT8GDAFQV3 Clear HT8GDCV3 HT8GDVAV3 HT8GDCBV3 HT8GDCABV3 HT8GDCFQV3 White HT8GDWV3 HT8GDWAV3 HT8GDWBV3 HT8GDWABV3 HT8GDWFQV3 Yellow HT8GDYV3 HT8GDYAV3 HT8GDYBV3 HT8GDYABV3 HT8GDYFQV3 Blue HT8GDBV3 HT8GDBAV3 HT8GDBBV3 HT8GDBABV3 HT8GDBFQV3 Transformer 20 Vac No lens HT8GDT Red HT8GDRT HT8GDRAT HT8GDRBT HT8GDRABT HT8GDRFQT Green HT8GDGT HT8GDGAT HT8GDGBT HT8GDGABT HT8GDGFQT Amber HT8GDAT HT8GDAAT HT8GDABT HT8GDAABT HT8GDAFQT Clear HT8GDCT HT8GDCAT HT8GDCBT HT8GDCABT HT8GDCFQT White HT8GDWT HT8GDWAT HT8GDWBT HT8GDWABT HT8GDWFQT Yellow HT8GDYT HT8GDYAT HT8GDYBT HT8GDYABT HT8GDYFQT Blue HT8GDBT HT8GDBAT HT8GDBBT HT8GDBABT HT8GDBFQT V7-T-288 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

289 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Guarded Illuminated Pushbutton perator Guarded Illuminated Pushbuttons, continued perator nly Type Volts Lens Color Note Light unit base operator without lens or bulb. N NC N-NC 2N-2NC LED Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8GDFV Red HT8GDRF7 HT8GDRAF7 HT8GDRBF7 HT8GDRABF7 HT8GDRFQF7 Green HT8GDGF7 HT8GDGAF7 HT8GDGBF7 HT8GDGABF7 HT8GDGFQF7 Amber HT8GDAF7 HT8GDAAF7 HT8GDABF7 HT8GDAABF7 HT8GDAFQF7 Clear HT8GDCF7 HT8GDCAF7 HT8GDCBF7 HT8GDCABF7 HT8GDCFQF7 White HT8GDWF7 HT8GDWAF7 HT8GDWBF7 HT8GDWABF7 HT8GDWFQF7 Yellow HT8GDYF7 HT8GDYAF7 HT8GDYBF7 HT8GDYABF7 HT8GDYFQF7 Blue HT8GDBF7 HT8GDBAF7 HT8GDBBF7 HT8GDBABF7 HT8GDBFQF7 24 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8GDFV Red HT8GDRF3 HT8GDRAF3 HT8GDRBF3 HT8GDRABF3 HT8GDRFQF3 Green HT8GDGF3 HT8GDGAF3 HT8GDGBF3 HT8GDGABF3 HT8GDGFQF3 Amber HT8GDAF3 HT8GDAAF3 HT8GDABF3 HT8GDAABF3 HT8GDAFQF3 Clear HT8GDCF3 HT8GDCAF3 HT8GDCBF3 HT8GDCABF3 HT8GDCFQF3 White HT8GDWF3 HT8GDWAF3 HT8GDWBF3 HT8GDWABF3 HT8GDWFQF3 Yellow HT8GDYF3 HT8GDYAF3 HT8GDYBF3 HT8GDYABF3 HT8GDYFQF3 Blue HT8GDBF3 HT8GDBAF3 HT8GDBBF3 HT8GDBABF3 HT8GDBFQF3 Transformer 20 Vac No lens HT8GDT Red HT8GDRL HT8GDRAL HT8GDRBL HT8GDRABL HT8GDRFQL Green HT8GDGL HT8GDGAL HT8GDGBL HT8GDGABL HT8GDGFQL Amber HT8GDAL HT8GDAAL HT8GDABL HT8GDAABL HT8GDAFQL Clear HT8GDCL HT8GDCAL HT8GDCBL HT8GDCABL HT8GDCFQL White HT8GDWL HT8GDWAL HT8GDWBL HT8GDWABL HT8GDWFQL Yellow HT8GDYL HT8GDYAL HT8GDYBL HT8GDYABL HT8GDYFQL Blue HT8GDBL HT8GDBAL HT8GDBBL HT8GDBABL HT8GDBFQL Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-289

290 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Indicating Light Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Incandescent or LED Full voltage or transformer type Indicating Light Unit PresTest Light Unit Indicating Light Units Standard and PresTest types 24V and 20V Type Volts Lens Color Note Light unit base operator without lens or bulb. PresTest This device incorporates a press-to-test feature whereby depressing the lens disconnects the light from the source Indicating Light PresTest Incandescent Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8HFFV HT8GTFV Red HT8HFRV7 HT8GTRV7 Green HT8HFGV7 HT8GTGV7 Amber HT8HFAV7 HT8GTAV7 Clear HT8HFCV7 HT8GTCV7 White HT8HFWV7 HT8GTWV7 Yellow HT8HFYV7 HT8GTYV7 Blue HT8HFBV7 HT8GTBV7 24 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8HFFV HT8GTFV Red HT8HFRV3 HT8GTRV3 Green HT8HFGV3 HT8GTGV3 Amber HT8HFAV3 HT8GTAV3 Clear HT8HFCV3 HT8GTCV3 White HT8HFWV3 HT8GTWV3 Yellow HT8HFYV3 HT8GTYV3 Blue HT8HFBV3 HT8GTBV3 Transformer 20 Vac No lens HT8HBT HT8GTT 50/60 Hz Red HT8HBRT HT8GTRT Green HT8HBGT HT8GTGT Amber HT8HBAT HT8GTAT Clear HT8HBCT HT8GTCT White HT8HBWT HT8GTWT Yellow HT8HBYT HT8GTYT Blue HT8HBBT HT8GTBT being monitored and connects the lamp to a continuously energized circuit for immediate detection of faulty lamps. V7-T-290 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

291 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Indicating Light Unit PresTest Light Unit Indicating Light Units, continued Type Volts Lens Color Note Light unit base operator without lens or bulb. Indicating Light PresTest LED Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8HFFV HT8GTFV Red HT8HFRF7 HT8GTRF7 Green HT8HFGF7 HT8GTGF7 Amber HT8HFAF7 HT8GTAF7 Clear HT8HFCF7 HT8GTCF7 White HT8HFWF7 HT8GTWF7 Yellow HT8HFYF7 HT8GTYF7 Blue HT8HFBF7 HT8GTBF7 24 Vac/Vdc No lens HT8HFFV HT8GTFV Red HT8HFRF3 HT8GTRF3 Green HT8HFGF3 HT8GTGF3 Amber HT8HFAF3 HT8GTAF3 Clear HT8HFCF3 HT8GTCF3 White HT8HFWF3 HT8GTWF3 Yellow HT8HFYF3 HT8GTYF3 Blue HT8HFBF3 HT8GTBF3 Transformer 20 Vac No lens HT8HBT HT8GTT 50/60 Hz Red HT8HBRL HT8GTRL Green HT8HBGL HT8GTGL Amber HT8HBAL HT8GTAL Clear HT8HBCL HT8GTCL White HT8HBWL HT8GTWL Yellow HT8HBYL HT8GTYL Blue HT8HBBL HT8GTBL Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-29

292 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Push-Pull Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 40 mm mushroom head Two-position maintained Non-illuminated Round Head Two- Position Push-Pull Unit Flat Head Two-Position Push-Pull Unit Two-Position Push-Pull, Maintained, Non-Illuminated perator Position Maintained Round Head Flat Head Mushroom Head Mushroom Head Button Button Button Contact Type ut In Color No contact Black HT8CBH HT8DBH Red HT8CBR HT8DBR Green HT8CBG HT8DBG N Black HT8CBHA HT8DBHA Red HT8CBRA HT8DBRA Green HT8CBGA HT8DBGA NC Black HT8CBHB HT8DBHB Red HT8CBRB HT8DBRB Green HT8CBGB HT8DBGB N-NC NCLB NC NCLB NCLB Note NCLB = normally closed late break. Black HT8CBHAB HT8DBHAB Red HT8CBRAB HT8DBRAB Green HT8CBGAB HT8DBGAB Black HT8CBHDB HT8DBHDB Red HT8CBRDB HT8DBRDB Green HT8CBGDB HT8DBGDB Black HT8CBHDD HT8DBHDD Red HT8CBRDD HT8DBRDD Green HT8CBGDD HT8DBGDD V7-T-292 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

293 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 Illuminated Push-Pull Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Incandescent or LED Full voltage or transformer type 24V and 20V Illuminated Push-Pull Unit Illuminated Push-Pull Units Lens Type Volts Color perator nly N Note: Complete illuminated push-pull switches will not fit in a standard 3 in deep enclosure. Illuminated Push-Pull Units with Low Profile Light Units NC N-NC 2NCLB Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc Red HT8FBRV7 HT8FBRAV7 HT8FBRBV7 HT8FBRABV7 HT8FBRDDV7 Green HT8FBGV7 HT8FBGAV7 HT8FBGBV7 HT8FBGABV7 HT8FBGDDV7 24 Vac/Vdc Red HT8FBRV3 HT8FBRAV3 HT8FBRBV3 HT8FBRABV3 HT8FBRDDV3 Green HT8FBGV3 HT8FBGAV3 HT8FBGBV3 HT8FBGABV3 HT8FBGDDV3 Transformer 20 Vac Red HT8FBRT HT8FBRAT HT8FBRBT HT8FBRABT HT8FBRDDT Green HT8FBGT HT8FBGAT HT8FBGBT HT8FBGABT HT8FBGDDT LED Lamp Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc Red HT8FBRF7 HT8FBRAF7 HT8FBRBF7 HT8FBRABF7 HT8FBRDDF7 Green HT8FBGF7 HT8FBGAF7 HT8FBGBF7 HT8FBGABF7 HT8FBGDDF7 24 Vac/Vdc Red HT8FBRF3 HT8FBRAF3 HT8FBRBF3 HT8FBRABF3 HT8FBRDDF3 Green HT8FBGF3 HT8FBGAF3 HT8FBGBF3 HT8FBGABF3 HT8FBGDDF3 Transformer 20 Vac Red HT8FBRL HT8FBRAL HT8FBRBL HT8FBRABL HT8FBRDDL Green HT8FBGL HT8FBGAL HT8FBGBL HT8FBGABL HT8FBGDDL Type Voltage Color Fingersafe LED Lamp Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc 24 Vac/Vdc Incandescent Full voltage 20 Vac/Vdc 24 Vac/Vdc perator nly N NC N-NC 2NCLB N-NCLB Red Yes HT8FBRFL7P HT8FBRAFL7P HT8FBRBFL7P HT8FBRABFL7P HT8FBRDDFL7P HT8FBRDBFL7P Red No HT8FBRFL7 HT8FBRAFL7 HT8FBRBFL7 HT8FBRABFL7 HT8FBRDDFL7 HT8FBRDBFL7 Red Yes HT8FBRFL3P HT8FBRAFL3P HT8FBRBFL3P HT8FBRABFL3P HT8FBRDDFL3P HT8FBRDBFL3P Red No HT8FBRFL3 HT8FBRAFL3 HT8FBRBFL3 HT8FBRABFL3 HT8FBRDDFL3 HT8FBRDBFL3 Red Yes HT8FBRVL7P HT8FBRAVL7P HT8FBRBVL7P HT8FBRABVL7P HT8FBRDDVL7P HT8FBRDBVL7P Red No HT8FBRVL7 HT8FBRAVL7 HT8FBRBVL7 HT8FBRABVL7 HT8FBRDDVL7 HT8FBRDBVL7 Red Yes HT8FBRVL3P HT8FBRAVL3P HT8FBRBVL3P HT8FBRABVL3P HT8FBRDDVL3P HT8FBRDBVL3P Red No HT8FBRVL3 HT8FBRAVL3 HT8FBRBVL3 HT8FBRABVL3 HT8FBRDDVL3 HT8FBRDBVL3 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-293

294 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Selector Switch Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Two-, three- and four-position Non-illuminated Standard Knob perator Standard Lever perator Standard Knob perator Standard Lever perator Two-Position Selector Switch Units, Non-Illuminated Contact Type perator Position perating Mode 2 Standard Black Knob Three-Position Selector Switch Units, Non-Illuminated Notes = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 M = Maintained, S = Momentary. 3 For, NC contacts must be wired in series see Three-Position Selector Switch table on Page V7-T-296. Standard Black Lever No contacts M M HT8JAH3A HT8JDH3A S M HT8JKH3A HT8JLH3A M S HT8JNH3A HT8JPH3A N M M HT8JAH3AA5 HT8JDH3AA5 S M HT8JKH3AA5 HT8JLH3AA5 M S HT8JNH3AA5 HT8JPH3AA5 2N M M HT8JAH3AAA5 HT8JDH3AAA5 S M HT8JKH3AAA5 HT8JLH3AAA5 M S HT8JNH3AAA5 HT8JPH3AAA5 2N-2NC M M HT8JAH3AFQ HT8JDH3AFQ S M HT8JKH3AFQ HT8JLH3AFQ M S HT8JNH3AFQ HT8JPH3AFQ Contact Type perator Position perating Mode 2 Standard Black Knob Standard Black Lever No contacts M M M HT8JBHD HT8JEHD S M M HT8JRHD HT8JSHD M M S HT8JUHD HT8JVHD S M S HT8JHD HT8JYHD 2N M M M HT8JBHDAA5 HT8JEHDAA5 S M M HT8JRHDAA5 HT8JSHDAA5 2N-2NC 3 2N-2NC M M S HT8JUHDAA5 HT8JVHDAA5 S M S HT8JHDAA5 HT8JYHDAA5 M M M HT8JBHDFQ HT8JEHDFQ S M M HT8JRHDFQ HT8JSHDFQ M M S HT8JUHDFQ HT8JVHDFQ S M S HT8JHDFQ HT8JYHDFQ M M M HT8JBHDFQ HT8JEHDFQ S M M HT8JRHDFQ HT8JSHDFQ M M S HT8JUHDFQ HT8JVHDFQ S M S HT8JHDFQ HT8JYHDFQ V7-T-294 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

295 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3 Standard Knob perator Standard Lever perator Four-Position Selector Switch Units, Non-Illuminated Contact Type Notes = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 M = Maintained, S = Momentary. perator Position perating Mode 2 Standard Black Knob Standard Black Lever No contacts M M M M HT8JCH8E HT8JFH8E S M M M HT8LNH8E HT8LPH8E 2N-2NC M M M S HT8LRH8E HT8LSH8E M M M M HT8JCH8EFQ HT8JFH8EFQ S M M M HT8LNH8EFQ HT8LPH8EFQ M M M S HT8LRH8EFQ HT8LSH8EFQ Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-295

296 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Selector Switch Contact Block Selection For Two-, Three- and Four-Position Selector Switches Two-Position Selector Switch (Cam Code 3A) perator Position Left Right or N NC or NC N Three-Position Selector Switch (Cam Code D) perator Position Left N NC NC Four-Position Selector Switch (Cam Code 8E) perator Position Left N NC Right NC N NC Right N NC V7-T-296 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

297 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 Accessories HT8A5 HT8WRENCH HT8LAMPTL HT8 HT82 HT83 HT8GR HT8GR2 Light Unit HT800 Accessories Description Illuminated Pushbutton Guard Wrench Tool Lamp/Bulb Removal Tool Thrust Washer (Anti-rotation) (Included with every operator) Trim Ring (Included with every operator) Sealing/Spacer Washer (Five included with every operator) Grounding Kit for Pushbuttons and Selector Switches (Included with every operator) Grounding Kit for Indicating Lights (Included with indicating lights) HT8A5 HT8WRENCH HT8LAMPTL HT8 HT82 HT83 HT8GR HT8GR2 Light Units Type Voltage Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc HT8F3V3 20 Vac/Vdc HT8F7V8 Transformer 20 Vac HT8LT Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-297

298 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 ptions Legend Plates Standard Jumbo Standard Jumbo For Push-Pull Units Color of Legend Field Notes For dimensions, see Page V7-T /32 in high lettering. 3 /8 in high lettering. For Pushbutton perators and Indicating Lights Legend Color of Field Standard For Selector Switch perators Jumbo Legend Color of Field Standard Blank Plastic Legend Plates Square Jumbo Letters on Legend Plates Below are 3/6 in High CLAMP Black HT8SP90 HT8LP90 FF Red HT8SP24 HT8LP24 CLSE HT8SP73 HT8LP73 N Black HT8SP25 HT8LP25 DWN HT8SP74 HT8LP74 PEN HT8SP26 HT8LP26 EMERG. STP HT8SP3 HT8LP3 UT HT8SP27 HT8LP27 FAST HT8SP75 HT8LP75 PWER N HT8SP80 HT8LP80 FASTER HT8SP87 HT8LP87 RAISE HT8SP28 HT8LP28 FEEDER N HT8SP94 HT8LP94 READY HT8SP86 HT8LP86 FEEDER FF HT8SP95 HT8LP95 RESET HT8SP29 HT8LP29 FRWARD HT8SP5 HT8LP5 REVERSE HT8SP30 HT8LP30 HIGH HT8SP6 HT8LP6 RUN HT8SP3 HT8LP3 IN HT8SP7 HT8LP7 SAFE HT8SP85 HT8LP85 INCH HT8SP8 HT8LP8 SLW HT8SP32 HT8LP32 JG HT8SP9 HT8LP9 SLWER HT8SP88 HT8LP88 JG FR. HT8SP20 HT8LP20 START HT8SP33 HT8LP33 JG REV. HT8SP2 HT8LP2 STP Red HT8SP34 HT8LP34 LW HT8SP22 HT8LP22 TEST Black HT8SP83 HT8LP83 LWER HT8SP23 HT8LP23 TRANSFER HT8SP93 HT8LP93 LUBE-FAIL HT8SP92 HT8LP92 TRIP HT8SP84 HT8LP84 MTR RUN HT8SP8 HT8LP8 UNCLAMP HT8SP9 HT8LP9 MTR STP HT8SP82 HT8LP82 UP HT8SP35 HT8LP35 Legend Color of Field Standard Jumbo Legend Color of Field Standard Jumbo Two-Position 3/6 in High Lettering Three-Position 3/6 in High Lettering FR. REV. Black HT8SP38 HT8LP38 AUT FF HAND Black HT8SP49 HT8LP49 HAND AUT HT8SP39 HT8LP39 FR. FF REV. HT8SP50 HT8LP50 HIGH LW HT8SP40 HT8LP40 FR. SAFE REV. HT8SP69 HT8LP69 JG RUN HT8SP4 HT8LP4 HAND FF AUT HT8SP5 HT8LP5 MAN. AUT HT8SP67 HT8LP67 MAN. FF AUT HT8SP68 HT8LP68 FF N HT8SP42 HT8LP42 PEN FF CLSE HT8SP53 HT8LP53 PEN CLSE HT8SP43 HT8LP43 RUN SAFE JG HT8SP70 HT8LP70 RUN JG HT8SP44 HT8LP44 UP FF DWN HT8SP54 HT8LP54 SAFE RUN HT8SP45 HT8LP45 N STP SAFE HT8SP7 HT8LP7 START JG HT8SP46 HT8LP46 START STP HT8SP47 HT8LP47 UP DWN HT8SP48 HT8LP48 Standard 2 Jumbo 3 N/FF Black HT8PP5 HT8R5 PEN/CLSE HT8PP8 HT8R8 UP/DWN HT8PP HT8R Legend Color of Field Standard Jumbo Black White/Silver HT8SP76 HT8LP76 White Red/ Black HT8SP77 HT8LP77 V7-T-298 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

299 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 Legend Plates with Non-Standard Markings When rdering Specify Catalog number of blank plate. Insert the following into rder Notes: legend, letter size and locations. See information below. Legend Positions rdering Example: Catalog no.: HT85P76STAMP Letter size: 3/32 in (2.4 mm) Pos. A PWER HUSE Pos. B START PUMP Blank Plastic Legend Plates for Non-Standard Markings Plastic Legend Note Jumbo Size HT8LP Series A B C D K Color of Field Can be used on top row only of any enclosure. B4 A4 Standard Jumbo Black White/Silver HT8SP76STAMP HT8LP76STAMP White Red/Black HT8SP77STAMP HT8LP77STAMP A B AB Standard Size HT8SP Series C4 D4 Legend Characters Available A B C D E F G H I J K L M N P Q R S T U V W Y Z / -., Maximum Characters per Legend Plate and Approximate Dimensions Character Size Top 3/32 in High /8 in High 3/6 in High (Aluminum Number Number of Number Number of Number and Plastic) Style of Lines Characters of Lines Characters of Lines Standard Square Jumbo Square G AE G A H F AF I Number of Characters Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-299

300 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Contact Blocks N Contact Block NC Contact Block Contact Blocks 2 Description/Function Contact Type Contact Block Location (Viewed from Rear) Suffix Codes 34 Left Side Right Side A =N A5 =N A2 =2N A6 =2N B =NC B =NC B2 =2NC B6 =2NC C =NEM C5 = NEM C2 = 2 NEM C6 = 2 NEM D = NCLB D = NCLB D2 =2 NCLB D6 =2 NCLB E =NEM-NCLB E5 = NEM-NCLB F = N and NC Q = N and NC F4 = N-NC Without Guard Standard normally open contact N HT8A HT8AP Standard normally closed contact NC HT8B HT8BP Normally open early make contact will make circuit before standard N contact. DC ratings do not apply. Normally closed late break contact will open after standard NC contact. DC ratings do not apply. Logic level, low voltage N contact. Gold plated contacts. NEM HT8C HT8CP NCLB HT8D HT8DP N HT8E HT8EP Notes See Page V7-T-302 for contact block electrical ratings. 2 Maximum of four contact blocks per side or a total of eight contact blocks recommended. 3 Maximum of two contact blocks per side or a total of four contact blocks recommended. 4 Standard contact blocks without fingerproof protection. Fingerproof V7-T-300 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

301 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 Replacement Parts Incandescent Bulb LED Bulb Replacement Bulbs and LEDs Voltage Color Incandescent 6V HT8BULBV 24V HT8BULBV3 20V HT8BULBV7 LED 6 2V (For use with transformers with 6V secondary winding) Replacement Lenses Red Green Amber/orange White/clear HT8LEDRF HT8LEDGF HT8LEDAF HT8LEDWF Yellow HT8LEDYF Blue HT8LEDBF 24V Red HT8LEDRF3 Green Amber/orange White/clear HT8LEDGF3 HT8LEDAF3 HT8LEDWF3 Yellow HT8LEDYF3 Blue HT8LEDBF3 20V Red HT8LEDRF7 Color Green Amber/orange White/clear Yellow Blue Indicating Lights HT8LEDGF7 HT8LEDAF7 HT8LEDWF7 HT8LEDYF7 HT8LEDBF7 Amber HT8LA HT8BA Blue HT8LB HT8BB Clear HT8LC HT8BC Green HT8LG HT8BG Red HT8LR HT8BR White HT8LW HT8BW Yellow HT8LY HT8BY PresTest Lights Illuminated Pushbuttons Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-30

302 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Technical Data and Specifications HT800 Specifications Description Electrical Ratings HT800 Standard Contact Blocks, UL Rating Contact Description/Function Type AC DC UL A600 and P600 Ratings Notes Heavy-duty. 2 Standard duty. 3 DC ratings do not apply to NEM (Normally pen Early Make) and NCLB (Normal Closed Late Break) contact blocks HT8C and HT8D. 4 Maximum make or break volt-amperes at 300V or less. Specification Mechanical Ratings Frequency of operation Pushbuttons 6,000 operations per hour Selector switches 3,000 operations per hour Push-pull operators 3,000 operations per hour Mechanical endurance/life Pushbuttons 0 x 06 operations 6K ops/hr with 6 N on left and 6 NC on right Selector switches 250 x 03 operations 3K ops/hr with 2 N on left and 2 NC on right Push-pull operators 250 x 03 operations 3K ops/hr with 6 N on left and 6 NC on right Climatic Conditions perating temperature 0 to 40 F ( 2 to 60 C) Storage temperature 40 to 76 F ( 40 to 80 C) Altitude 6,562 ft (2,000m) Humidity 95% RH at 60 C Terminals Contact blocks #6-32 posidrive saddle clamp type, x 6 AWG to 2 x 4 AWG, 2 in-lbs max. Light units #6-32 posidrive saddle clamp type, x 22 AWG to 2 x 4 AWG, 7 in-lbs max. Electrical Ratings Standard contact blocks UL (NEMA) rating See table below. Logic level contact block power rating 5V ma (minimum) 28V 500 ma (maximum) Standard normally open contact N A600 P600 2 HT8A Standard normally closed contact NC A600 P600 2 HT8B Normally open early make contact will make circuit before standard NEM A600 HT8C N contact. DC ratings do not apply. Normally closed late break contact will open after standard NC contact. DC ratings do not apply. NCLB A600 HT8D Logic level, low voltage N contact. Gold plated contacts. N 5V ma (minimum) 28V 500 ma (maximum) HT8E Description 50 Vac or 60 Hz Vdc Make and emerg. interrupting capacity (amp) Normal load break (amp) Thermal current (amp) Voltamperes: Make and emerg. interrupting capacity Normal load break V7-T-302 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

303 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 Dimensions Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Momentary Pushbuttons Non-Illuminated Back, side and bottom views of pushbutton operator with attached contact blocks. Stacking Screw Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. #6-32 Posi-drive Saddle Clamp Type x6 AWG to 2 x4 AWG Terminal Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. Copper Wire nly Back View Panel.40 (35.6) Illuminated Pushbuttons Back, side and bottom views of pushbutton operator with attached contact blocks. Light Unit #6-32 Posi-drive Saddle Clamp Type x6 AWG to 2x4 AWG Terminal Torque: 7 in-lbs Max. Copper Wire nly Stacking Screw Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. Contact Block #6-32 Posi-drive Saddle Clamp Type x6 AWG to 2 x4 AWG Terminal Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. Copper Wire nly.00 (25.4) 2.00 (50.8) Back View.00 (25.4) Panel 2.00 (50.8) ptional 2 Stacks.40 (35.6) ptional 2 Stacks 4.60 (6.8) 3.70 (94.0) 2.90 (73.7) 0.90 (22.9) 2.00 (50.8) Extended Side View Recommended 4 Stacks (8 Contact Blocks Total) Bottom View 5.5 (30.8) 4.35 (0.5) 3.55 (90.2) 2.75 (69.9) Side View 0.75 (9.) Flush Note Recommended maximum of four tandem stacks of contact blocks behind operator. At users discretion, two additional tandem stacks may be added. Recommended 4 Stacks (8 Contact Blocks Total) Bottom View.50 (38.) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-303

304 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Mushroom Head Pushbuttons and Round Head MRH Push-Pull perators Back, side and bottom views of mushroom head operator with attached contact blocks. Stacking Screw Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. #6-32 Posi-drive Saddle Clamp Type x6 AWG to 2x4 AWG Terminal Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. Copper Wire nly Illuminated and Non-Illuminated Flat Head MRH Push-Pull perators Back, side and bottom views of push-pull operator with attached contact blocks. Light Unit #6-32 Posi-drive Saddle Clamp Type x22 AWG to 2 x4 AWG Terminal Torque: 7 in-lbs Max. Copper Wire nly Stacking Screw Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. Notes Back View Contact Block #6-32 Posi-drive Saddle Clamp Type x6 AWG to 2 x4 AWG Terminal Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. Copper Wire nly.00 (25.4) Panel 2.00 (50.8).00 (25.4) Back View Panel 2.00 (50.8).40 (35.6) ptional 2 Stacks 4.60 (6.8) 3.70 (94.0) 2.90 (73.7) Side View Bottom View 2.00 (50.8) Recommended 4 Stacks (8 Contact Blocks Total).50 (38.) Recommended maximum of four tandem stacks of contact blocks behind operator. At users discretion, two additional tandem stacks may be added. 2 Contact blocks mount directly to operator adaptor in non-illuminated version..40 (35.6) 2 ptional 2 Stacks 5.5 (30.8) 4.35 (0.5) 3.55 (90.2) 2.75 (69.9) Side View Recommended 4 Stacks (8 Contact Blocks Total) Bottom View.30 (33.0) V7-T-304 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

305 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800.9 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Indicating Lights Back, side and bottom views of indicating light operator with attached contact blocks. #6-32 Posi-drive Saddle Clamp Type x22 AWG to 2x4 AWG Terminal Torque: 7 in-lbs Max. Copper Wire nly Stacking Screw Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. Back View Panel.30 (33.0) Side View Bottom View Selector Switches Back, side and bottom views of selector switch operator with attached contact blocks. Stacking Screw Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. #6-32 Posi-drive Saddle Clamp Type x6 AWG to 2x4 AWG Terminal Torque: 2 in-lbs Max. Copper Wire nly.00 (25.4) Back View.68 (42.7) Panel 2.00 (50.8) Light Unit Assembly.40 (35.6) Side View Bottom View.67 (42.4) 2.90 (73.7) 2.00 (50.8) Recommended 2 Stacks (4 Contact Blocks Total).26 (32.0).20 (38.) Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-305

306 .9 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Watertight/iltight HT800 Approximate Dimensions in Inches (mm) Mounting Matrix and Minimum Panel Spacing Requirements 0.8 (4.6) 2.50 (63.5) 0.68 (7.3) Legend Plates.77 (45) 2.9 (55.6) ptional Notch Locations 2.50 (63.5).77 (45) Standard Jumbo 2.9 (55.6).20 (30.5) Diameter V7-T-306 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

307 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Contents Description 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Product verview Product Identification Selection Product Selection Momentary Pushbutton Units Non-Illuminated Pushbutton Units Illuminated Pushbutton Units Guarded Illuminated Pushbutton Units.... Indicating Light Units Illuminated Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Push-Pull Units Illuminated Push-Pull Units Push-Pull perators Selector Switch Units Selector Switch Selection Selector Switch perators Illuminated Selector Switch perators.... ptions Technical Data and Specifications Dimensions Ratings Product Description All the Industry-Proven Quality of Eaton s 0250T and E34 Series of Logic Devices, plus Class I Division 2 Certification The 0250TH consists of a normally open-normally closed factory sealed contact block that is UL Listed for use in Class I, Division 2, Groups B, C and D (NEC ) Class I, Zone 2, IIB + H2 (NEC 505) hazardous locations and is rated for both NEMA A600 and NEMA Q T and E34 illuminated components have also been UL Listed for use in Class I, Division 2, Groups B, C and D (NEC ) Class I, Zone 2, IIB + H2 (NEC 505). This, combined with the industry-proven Eaton 0250T 30.5 mm pushbutton line, offers a complete solution to Division 2 hazardous location requirements. Single composite catalog numbers for complete assembled stations and operators for use in Division 2 hazardous locations are featured throughout this section. Features Factory sealed contact blocks Heavy-duty zinc die cast construction NEMA rated, 2, 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Front-of-panel drainage holes Grounding nibs on the operator casing Solid thermosetting cathodic epoxy coating on E34 Corrosion resistance in E34 Benefits Pushbutton for hazardous locations Drainage holes prevent buildup of liquid inside the operator which can prevent operation in freezing environments Grounding nibs bite through paint and other coatings to provide secure ground Suitable for corrosive environments (E34 only) Earth terminal provides additional grounding point and allows for daisy chain grounding (E34 line) Standards and Certifications Page V7-T-308 V7-T-309 V7-T-309 V7-T-30 V7-T-34 V7-T-36 V7-T-37 V7-T-38 V7-T-39 V7-T-32 V7-T-323 V7-T-326 V7-T-330 V7-T-332 V7-T-335 V7-T-338 V7-T-340 V7-T-343 V7-T-345 V7-T-346 UL 508 File No. E3568 UL 604 File No. E0323 CSA Certified C22.2 No.4 File No. LR 6855 CSA Certified C22.2 No. 23-M987 File No. LR 2073 Ingress Protection Standard indicating lights UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 3S, 4, 4, 2, 3 IEC IP65 All other operators UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 IEC IP65 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-307

308 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Product verview perator The 30.5 mm 0250T pushbutton line features a zinc die cast construction with chrome-plated housing and mounting nut. Eaton s E34 Series 30.5 mm pushbutton line features the same rugged die cast construction of our 0250T line with an additional twolayer 00% solid thermosetting cathodic epoxy coating. This coating provides a flat black smooth, consistent, corrosion resistant surface that has passed a demanding 600 hour salt spray test. (The industry standard for this 4 test requires only 200 hours.) Ultraviolet Light E34 epoxy coating is not recommended for use in applications where exposure to ultraviolet light exists use NEMA T operators. Ratings ur Class I Division 2 line of pushbuttons are UL Listed (NEMA type), 2, 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2 and 3. ur Class I Division 2 E34 line meets IEC 947- IP66 standards and the cathodic coating meets FDA 3A sanitary chemical resistance requirements. For a complete listing of all applicable ratings see Pages V7-T-343 to V7-T T Grounding Nibs 0250T line operators have grounding nibs four metal points on the operator casting designed to bite through most paints and other coatings on metal panels to enhance the grounding connection when the operator is securely tightened. 0250T Grounding Nibs E34 Grounding Nibs E34 line of operators is equipped with a ground screw terminal as part of its die cast construction. This earthing terminal provides an easily accessible point for grounding operators when used in a painted or nonmetallic enclosure and eliminates the need for extra kits when daisy chain grounding is required. E34 Grounding Nibs Nib Earth Terminal Diaphragm Seal with Drainage Holes Liquid Drainage Eaton s pushbutton operators offer front of panel drainage via holes in the operator bushing. Hidden from view by the mounting nut, these holes prevent buildup of liquid inside the operator, which can prevent operation in freezing environments. The holes also provide a route for escaping liquid in high pressure washdowns, effectively relieving pressure from the internal diaphragm seal, ensuring reliable sealing in applications even beyond NEMA 4. Diaphragm Seal Foam Neoprene Panel Sealing Gasket Drainage Hole Flexible Diaphragm Stainless Steel perating Spring Colorfast Molded Button Drainage Hole Mounting Nut V7-T-308 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

309 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Product Identification 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations Selection Selection is for illustrative purposes only and not to be used to create new catalog numbers. Non-Illuminated Assembled perators perator Type 0250T = Heavy-duty oiltight E34E = Corrosion resistant oiltight 706 = Flush N-NC 707 = Flush 2N-2NC 708 = Extended N-NC 709 = Extended 2N-2NC 70 = Mushroom N-NC 7 = Mushroom 2N-2NC 72 = JMB mushroom N-NC 73 = JMB mushroom 2N-2NC 74 = 2P MT push-pull N-NC 75 = 2P MT push-pull 2N-2NC 76 = 3P MT push-mom pull N-NC 77 = 3P MT push-mom pull 2N-2NC 78 = 3P mom push-pull N-NC 72 = 3P mom push-pull 2N-2NC perator and Contact Block 0250T 78 E J 722 = 2P SS MT,-CAM 723 = 2P SS MT,,,-CAM 724 = 2P SS SPR-R,-CAM 725 = 2P SS SPR-R,,,-CAM 726 = 3P SS MT,-CAM3 727 = 3P SS MT,,-CAM3 728 = 3P SS SPR-L,-CAM3 729 = 3P SS SPR-L,,-CAM3 730 = 3P SS SPR-L&R,-CAM3 73 = 3P SS SPR-L&R,,-CAM3 732 = 3P SS SPR-R,-CAM3 733 = 3P SS SPR-R,,-CAM3 743 = 4P SS MT,,,-CAM7 Button Color B = Black R = Red G = Green Y = Yellow W = White L = Blue N = range E = Red EMERG. STP T = Keyed-SS ACC/SS Type Blank = None J = JMB push-pull B = Booted-FL/ET G = Guarded-FL K = Knob-SS L = Lever-SS A = Lever W/IP-SS C = Coin-SS Keyed-SS Cam Key Removal = RT only 2 = LT only 3 = RT and LT 4 = CT only 5 = RT and CT 6 = LT and CT 7 = All Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-309

310 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Product Selection Momentary Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D 0250T Flush Button E34 Flush Button 0250T Extended Button E34 Extended Button Non-Illuminated Flush and Extended Pushbuttons Flush Button Contact Type Button Color 0250T E34 Color Selection Color Suffix Code Color Suffix Code Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. To order different color guarded button, simply substitute the underlined character in catalog number with appropriate suffix code from Color Selection table above. Example: 0250T70Y. 2 Blue not available on jumbo mushroom pushbutton. 3 range is only available on flush or extended pushbuttons. 4 Red with EMERG. STP engraved on button head for jumbo mushroom pushbutton only. Extended Button 0250T E34 N-NC Black 0250T706B E34E706B 0250T708B E34E708B Red 0250T706R E34E706R 0250T708R E34E708R Green 0250T706G E34E706G 0250T708G E34E708G 2N-2NC Black 0250T707B E34E707B 0250T709B E34E709B Red 0250T707R E34E707R 0250T709R E34E709R Green 0250T707G E34E707G 0250T709G E34E709G Black B White W Red R Blue L 2 Green G range 3 N Yellow Y Red (EMERG. STP) 4 E V7-T-30 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

311 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D 0250T Mushroom Button E34 Mushroom Button 0250T Jumbo Mushroom Button E34 Jumbo Mushroom Button Non-Illuminated Mushroom and Jumbo Mushroom Pushbuttons Mushroom Button Contact Type Button Color 0250T E34 Color Selection Color Suffix Code Color Suffix Code Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. To order different color guarded button, simply substitute the underlined character in catalog number with appropriate suffix code from Color Selection table above. Example: 0250T70Y. 2 Anodized aluminum head is not suitable for use in ultraviolet applications. 3 Blue not available on jumbo mushroom pushbutton. 4 range is only available on flush or extended pushbuttons. 5 Red with EMERG. STP engraved on button head for jumbo mushroom pushbutton only. Jumbo Mushroom Button 0250T 2 E34 2 N-NC Black 0250T70B E34E70B 0250T72B E34E72B Red 0250T70R E34E70R 0250T72R E34E72R Green 0250T70G E34E70G 0250T72G E34E72G 2N-2NC Black 0250T7B E34E7B 0250T73B E34E73B Red 0250T7R E34E7R 0250T73R E34E73R Green 0250T7G E34E7G 0250T73G E34E73G Black B White W Red R Blue L 3 Green G range 4 N Yellow Y Red (EMERG. STP) 5 E Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-3

312 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Momentary contact Non-illuminated Booted or guarded Booted Flush Button Booted Extended Button Guarded Extended Button 0250T Pushbuttons Booted and Guarded Booted Flush Button Contact Type Button Color Booted Extended Button N-NC Black 0250T706BB 0250T708BB 0250T706BG Red 0250T706RB T708RB 0250T706RG Green 0250T706GB 0250T708GB 0250T706GG 2N-2NC Black 0250T707BB 0250T709BB 0250T707BG Red 0250T707RB T709RB 0250T707RG Green 0250T707GB 0250T709GB 0250T707GG Color Selection Color Suffix Code Color Suffix Code Black B White W Red R Blue L Green G range N Yellow Y Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. To order different color guarded button, simply substitute the underlined character in catalog number with appropriate suffix code from Color Selection table above. Example: 0250T706YG. 2 Red booted flush pushbutton is not recommended for STP function. Guarded Extended Button V7-T-32 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

313 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Momentary contact Non-illuminated Booted or guarded Booted Flush Button Booted Extended Button Guarded Extended Button E34 Pushbuttons Booted and Guarded Booted Flush Button Contact Type Button Color Booted Extended Button N-NC Black E34E706BB E34E708BB E34E706BG Red E34E706RB 2 E34E708RB E34E706RG Green E34E706GB E34E708GB E34E706GG 2N-2NC Black E34E707BB E34E709BB E34E707BG Red E34E707RB 2 E34E709RB E34E707RG Green E34E707GB E34E709GB E34E707GG Color Selection Color Suffix Code Color Suffix Code Black B White W Red R Blue L Green G range N Yellow Y Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. To order different color guarded button, simply substitute the underlined character in catalog number with appropriate suffix code from Color Selection table above. Example: 0250T706YG. 2 Red booted flush pushbutton is not recommended for STP function. Guarded Extended Button Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-33

314 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Non-Illuminated Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, and T Flush Button E34 Flush Button 0250T Extended Button E34 Extended Button 0250T Half Shrouded Button E34 Half Shrouded Button Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Momentary Contact Half Shrouded Button Flush Button Extended Button 0250T E34 Color 0250T Catalog Number E34 Catalog Number 0250T Catalog Number E34 Catalog Number Vertical Catalog Number Horizontal Catalog Number Vertical Catalog Number Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. To order operator with factory assembled extended retaining nut, 0250TA2, for thick panel applications, add suffix letter E to listed catalog number. Horizontal Catalog Number Black 0250T0 E34PB 0250T E34EB 0250T T5 E34EVB E34EHB Red 0250T02 E34PB2 0250T2 E34EB2 0250T T52 E34EVB2 E34EHB2 Green 0250T03 E34PB3 0250T3 E34EB3 0250T T53 E34EVB3 E34EHB3 Yellow 0250T04 E34PB4 0250T20 E34EB4 0250T T54 E34EVB4 E34EHB4 Gray 0250T05 E34PB5 E34EB5 0250T T55 E34EVB5 E34EHB5 White 0250T06 E34PB6 0250T6 E34EB6 0250T T56 E34EVB6 E34EHB6 Blue 0250T08 E34PB7 0250T8 E34EB7 0250T T58 E34EVB7 E34EHB7 range 0250T09 E34PB8 0250T9 E34EB8 0250T T59 E34EVB8 E34EHB8 V7-T-34 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

315 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, and T Mushroom Button E34 Mushroom Button 0250T Jumbo Mushroom Button E34 Jumbo Mushroom Button Mushroom Head Non-Illuminated Pushbuttons, Momentary Contact Mushroom Button Anodized Aluminum Jumbo Mushroom Button Color 0250T E34 Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. Anodized aluminum head is not suitable for use in ultraviolet light applications. 2 Anodized aluminum head may not be suitable for some corrosive environments. 0250T Black 0250T2 E34LB 0250T7 E34JB Red 0250T22 E34LB2 0250T72 E34JB2 E34 2 Red (EMERG. STP) 0250T723 E34JB2N8 Green 0250T23 E34LB3 0250T73 E34JB3 Yellow 0250T24 E34LB4 0250T74 E34JB4 Blue 0250T29 E34LB6 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-35

316 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Illuminated Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Momentary contact Illuminated Plastic lenses 0250T8_ E34E8_ 0250TC_ E34V _ Illuminated Pushbuttons Type Voltage Color Contact Lens Selection Suffix Color Code Color Note To order different color lens, simply substitute the underlined character in the catalog number with appropriate suffix code from Lens Selection table above. Example: 0250T828YD T E34 LED/Lamp Number LED/Lamp Number LED Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red N-NC Bayonet 0250T828RD24 Bayonet E34E828RD24 Green base 0250T828GD24 base E34E828GD24 Amber 0250T828AD24 E34E828AD24 20 Vac Red N-NC 0250T828RD2A E34E828RD2A Green 0250T828GD2A E34E828GD2A Amber 0250T828AD2A E34E828AD2A Transformer 20 Vac Red N-NC 0250T802RD06 Bayonet E34E802RD06 Green 0250T802GD06 base 6 Vac E34E802GD06 Amber 0250T802AD06 E34E802AD06 Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red N-NC # T88RD #757 E34E88RD Green 0250T88GD E34E88GD Amber 0250T88AD E34E88AD Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc Red N-NC 20MB 0250T824RD 20MB E34E824RD Green 0250T824GD E34E824GD Amber 0250T824AD E34E824AD Transformer 20 Vac Red N-NC # T802RD #755 E34E802RD Green 0250T802GD 6 Vac E34E802GD Amber 0250T802AD E34E802AD Suffix Code 0250T E34 Red R 0250TC2 Red R E34V2 Green G 0250TC22 Green G E34V3 Yellow Y 0250TC23 Yellow Y E34V4 Amber A 0250TC43 Amber A E34V9 Blue L 0250TC24 Blue L E34V6 Clear C 0250TC25 Clear C E34V0 White W 0250TC26 White W E34V5 V7-T-36 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

317 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Guarded Illuminated Pushbutton Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Momentary contact Guarded illuminated Plastic lenses 0250T8_ E34E8_ 0250TC2_ E34V_ Guarded Illuminated Pushbuttons Type Voltage Color Contact Lens Selection Suffix Color Code Color Note To order different color lens, simply substitute the underlined character in the catalog number with appropriate suffix code from Lens Selection table above. Example: 0250T828YD T E34 LED/Lamp Number LED/Lamp Number LED Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red N-NC Bayonet 0250T828RG24 Bayonet E34E828RG24 Green base 0250T828GG24 base E34E828GG24 Amber 0250T828AG24 E34E828AG24 20 Vac Red N-NC 0250T828RG2A E34E828RG2A Green 0250T828GG2A E34E828GG2A Amber 0250T828AG2A E34E828AG2A Transformer 20 Vac Red N-NC 0250T802RG06 E34E802RG06 Green 0250T802GG06 E34E802GG06 Amber 0250T802AG06 E34E802AG06 Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red N-NC # T88RG #757 E34E88RG Green 0250T88GG E34E88GG Amber 0250T88AG E34E88AG Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc Red N-NC 20MB 0250T824RG 20MB E34E824RG Green 0250T824GG E34E824GG Amber 0250T824AG E34E824AG Transformer 20 Vac Red N-NC # T802RG #755 E34E802RG Green 0250T802GG 6 Vac E34E802GG Amber 0250T802AG E34E802AG Suffix Code 0250T E34 Red R 0250TC2 Red R E34V2 Green G 0250TC22 Green G E34V3 Yellow Y 0250TC23 Yellow Y E34V4 Amber A 0250TC43 Amber A E34V9 Blue L 0250TC24 Blue L E34V6 Clear C 0250TC25 Clear C E34V0 White W 0250TC26 White W E34V5 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-37

318 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Indicating Light Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 3S, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Standard Plastic lenses 0250T_ E34_ Plastic Glass Indicating Lights Type Voltage Color Lens Selection Plastic Suffix Color Code LED/Lamp Number 0250T E34 LED Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red Bayonet 0250T97HLRP24 E34FB97HLRP24 Green base 0250T97HLGP24 E34FB97HLGP24 Amber 0250T97HLAP24 E34FB97HLAP24 20 Vac Red 0250T97HLRP2A E34FB97HLRP2A Green 0250T97HLGP2A E34FB97HLGP2A Amber 0250T97HLAP2A E34FB97HLAP2A Transformer 20 Vac Red 0250T8HLRP06 E34TB20HLRP06 Green 0250T8HLGP06 E34TB20HLGP06 Amber 0250T8HLAP06 E34TB20HLAP06 Incandescent Lamp Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc Red # T206HRP E34FB24HRP Green 0250T206HGP E34FB24HGP Amber 0250T206HAP E34FB24HAP Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc Red 20MB 0250T20HRP E34RB20HRP Green 0250T20HGP E34RB20HGP Amber 0250T20HAP E34RB20HAP Transformer 20 Vac Red # T8HRP E34HB20HRP Green 0250T8HGP E34HB20HGP Amber 0250T8HAP E34HB20HAP 0250T Glass Suffix Code Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. To order different color lens, simply substitute the underlined characters in the catalog number with appropriate suffix code from the Lens Selection table above. Example: 0250T20HYP. Color E34 Plastic Suffix Code Glass Suffix Code Red RP 0250TCN RG 0250TC7N Red RP E34H2 RG E34G2 Green GP 0250TC2N GG 0250TC8N Green GP E34H3 GG E34G3 Amber AP 0250TC9N AG 0250TC9N Amber AP E34H9 AG E34G9 Yellow YP 0250TC3N Yellow YP E34H4 YG E34G4 Blue LP 0250TC4N LG 0250TC0N Blue LP E34H6 LG E34G6 Clear CP 0250TC5N CG 0250TCN Clear CP E34H0 CG E34G0 White WP 0250TC6N WG 0250TC2N White WP E34H5 WG E34G5 V7-T-38 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

319 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Illuminated Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D 0250T Illuminated Pushbutton perators without Lenses Type Resistor 2 AC/DC Transformer AC only Neon AC/DC Voltage LED/Lamp Number Illuminated Pushbutton 0250T E34 Indicating Light 0250T Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. These units do not include lamps. rder LED separately to match lens color from the LED Selection table on Page V7-T Resister units are not available for use with LEDs, choose either transformer or full voltage LED style. E34 LED Light Unit Type (LEDs not included) Full voltage Bayonet 0250T397HL E34CB497HL 0250T97HL E34FB97HL base E34 Illuminated Transformer T46HL E34B024HL Pushbutton AC only T4HL E34B20HL 0250T8HL E34TB20HL T42HL E34B240HL 0250T82HL E34TB240HL T49HL E34B277HL 0250T98HL E34TB277HL T43HL E34B380HL 0250T83HL E34TB380HL T44HL E34B480HL 0250T84HL E34TB480HL T45HL E34B600HL 0250T85HL E34TB600HL 0250T Indicating Light Incandescent Light Unit Type Full voltage 6 # T473H E34CB06H 0250T203H E34FB06H AC/DC 2 # T474H E34CB2H 0250T204H E34FB2H E34 Indicating Light 24 # T476H E34CB24H 0250T206H E34FB24H 32 # T477H E34CB32H 0250T207H E34FB32H 48 # T478H E34CB48H 0250T208H E34FB48H 20 20MB 0250T47H E34SB20H 0250T20H E34RB20H MB 0250T472H E34SB240H 0250T202H E34RB240H 24 # T46H E34B024H T4H E34B20H 0250T8H E34TB20H T42H E34B240H 0250T82H E34TB240H T49H E34B277H 0250T98H E34TB277H T43H E34B380H 0250T83H E34TB380H T44H E34B480H 0250T84H E34TB480H T45H E34B600H 0250T85H E34TB600H 20 NE5H-R T226H E34NB20H 240 NE5H T227H E34NB240H Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-39

320 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Plastic 0250TC_ E34H_ Glass 0250TC_ E34G_ 0250TC_ E34V_ Indicating Light Lenses Color 0250T Plastic Red 0250TCN E34H2 Green 0250TC2N E34H3 Amber 0250TC9N E34H9 Yellow 0250TC3N E34H4 Blue 0250TC4N E34H6 Clear 0250TC5N E34H0 White 0250TC6N E34H5 Glass Red 0250TC7N E34G2 Green 0250TC8N E34G3 Amber 0250TC9N E34G9 Yellow E34G4 Blue 0250TC0N E34G6 Clear 0250TCN E34G0 White 0250TC2N E34G5 Illuminated Pushbutton Lenses 0250T Color Red 0250TC2 E34V2 Green 0250TC22 E34V3 Yellow 0250TC23 E34V4 Amber 0250TC43 E34V9 Blue 0250TC24 E34V6 Clear 0250TC25 E34V0 White 0250TC26 E34V5 E34 E34 V7-T-320 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

321 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Push-Pull Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Two- and three-position Non-illuminated 0250T7_ E34E7_ 0250T7_ E34E7_ Two-Position Maintained Push, Maintained Pull perator Function (Position) Maintained Pull Three-Position Maintained Push, Momentary Pull perator Function (Position) Momentary Pull Notes Maintained Push Maintained Intermediate Contact Type N NC 2N 2NC Maintained Push Contact Type N NC NC NC Mounting Location 2 Mounting Location 2 Red Standard Push-Pull T 0250T74R 0250T75R Bolded circuit corresponds to - circuit selection. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color buttons, simply substitute underlined character with appropriate suffix code from the Button and Color Selection table on Page V7-T-322. Example: 0250T74G. 3 To order different type or color buttons, simply substitute underlined character with appropriate suffix code from the Button and Color Selection table on Page V7-T-322. Example: 0250T76G. E34 E34E74R E34E75R Red Standard Push-Pull T 0250T76R 0250T77R E34 E34E76R E34E77R Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-32

322 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Two- and three-position Non-illuminated 0250T7_ E34E7_ Standard Jumbo Mushroom Head Three-Position Momentary Push, Momentary Pull perator Function (Position) Momentary Pull Button and Color Selection Suffix Color Code Notes Maintained Intermediate Momentary Push Contact Type Mounting Location 2 Bolded circuit corresponds to - circuit selection. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color buttons, simply substitute underlined character with appropriate suffix code from the Button and Color Selection table above. Example: 0250T78G. N NC NC NC 0250T E34 Standard Red R 0250TB62 E34C2 Red (EMERG. STP) E 0250TB63 E34C2N8 Green G 0250TB6 E34C3 Black B 0250TB60 E34C Blue L 0250TB64 E34C6 Jumbo Mushroom Head (Anodized) Aluminum Red RJ 0250TJ62 E34J2 Red (EMERG. STP) EJ 0250TJ63 E34J2N8 Green GJ 0250TJ6 Black BJ 0250TJ60 Yellow YJ 0250TJ64 Red Standard Push-Pull T 0250T78R 0250T72R E34 E34E78R E34E72R V7-T-322 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

323 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Illuminated Push-Pull Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Two-position maintained Illuminated 0250T8_ E34E8_ Standard Side-Lighted (Anodized) Aluminum HD Aluminum with Transparent Center Two-Position Illuminated Maintained Push, Maintained Pull perator Function (Position) Maintained Pull LED Lamp Lens and Color Selection 0250T E34 Color Suffix Code Suffix Code Notes Maintained Push Incandescent Lamp Type Voltage Contact Type Mounting Location 2 Bolded circuit corresponds to - circuit selection. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color lens, simply substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the Lens and Color Selection table above. Example: 0250T85GS. Red Standard Push-Pull T E34 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N 0250T853RD24 E34E853RD24 20 Vac NC 0250T853RD2A E34E853RD2A Transformer 24 Vac 0250T843RD06 E34E843RD06 20 Vac 0250T844RD06 E34E844RD06 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N 0250T849RD E34E849RD Resistor 20 Vac/Vdc NC 0250T85RD E34E85RD Transformer 24 Vac 0250T843RD E34E843RD Standard Red RD 0250TC47 RD E34M2 Red (EMERG. STP) ED 0250TC53 ED E34M2N8 Green GD 0250TC48 GD E34M3 Blue LD 0250TC49 LD E34M6 Amber AD 0250TC50 AD E34M9 White WD 0250TC5 WD E34M5 Clear CD 0250TC52 CD E34M0 Side-Lighted (Anodized) Aluminum Red RS 0250TC57 Red (EMERG. STP) ES 0250TC63 Green GS 0250TC58 Blue LS 0250TC59 Amber AS 0250TC64 Yellow YS 0250TC60 White WS 0250TC6 Clear CS 0250TC62 Heavy-Duty Aluminum with Transparent Center Red RH 0250TC65 Green GH 0250TC66 Amber AH 0250TC67 20 Vac 0250T844RD E34E844RD Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-323

324 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Three-position maintained push, momentary pull Illuminated 0250T8_ E34E8_ Three-Position Illuminated Maintained Push, Momentary Pull perator Function (Position) Momentary Pull LED Lamp Maintained Intermediate Incandescent Lamp Maintained Push Type Voltage Contact Type Mounting Location 2 Notes Bolded circuit corresponds to - circuit selection. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color lens, simply substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the Lens and Color Selection table on the bottom of Page V7-T-323. Example: 0250T862AS. Red Standard Push-Pull T E34 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N 0250T864RD24 E34E864RD24 20 Vac NC 0250T864RD2A E34E864RD2A Transformer 24 Vac 0250T854RD06 E34E854RD06 20 Vac 0250T855RD06 E34E855RD06 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC 0250T875RD24 E34E875RD24 20 Vac NC 0250T875RD2A E34E875RD2A Transformer 24 Vac 0250T865RD06 E34E865RD06 20 Vac 0250T866RD06 E34E866RD06 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N 0250T860RD E34E860RD Resistor 20 Vac NC 0250T862RD E34E862RD Transformer 24 Vac 0250T854RD E34E854RD 20 Vac 0250T855RD E34E855RD Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC 0250T87RD E34E87RD Resistor 20 Vac NC 0250T873RD E34E873RD Transformer 24 Vac 0250T865RD E34E865RD 20 Vac 0250T866RD E34E866RD V7-T-324 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

325 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Three-position momentary Illuminated 0250T8_ E34E8_ Three-Position Illuminated Momentary Push, Momentary Pull perator Function (Position) Momentary Pull LED Lamp Maintained Intermediate Incandescent Lamp Maintained Push Type Voltage Contact Type Mounting Location 2 Notes Bolded circuit corresponds to - circuit selection. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 To order different type or color lens, simply substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the Lens and Color Selection table on the bottom of Page V7-T-323. Example: 0250T862AS. Red Standard Push-Pull T E34 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N 0250T886RD24 E34E886RD24 20 Vac NC 0250T886RD2A E34E886RD2A Transformer 24 Vac 0250T876RD06 E34E876RD06 20 Vac 0250T877RD06 E34E877RD06 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC 0250T897RD24 E34E897RD24 20 Vac NC 0250T897RD2A E34E897RD2A Transformer 24 Vac 0250T887RD06 E34E887RD06 20 Vac 0250T888RD06 E34E888RD06 Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc N 0250T882RD E34E882RD Resistor 20 Vac NC 0250T884RD E34E884RD Transformer 24 Vac 0250T876RD E34E876RD 20 Vac 0250T877RD E34E877RD Full voltage 24 Vac/Vdc NC 0250T893RD E34E893RD Resistor 20 Vac NC 0250T895RD E34E895RD Transformer 24 Vac 0250T887RD E34E887RD 20 Vac 0250T888RD E34E888RD Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-325

326 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Push-Pull perators An illuminated push-pull pushbutton unit, arranged for one-hole mounting, can replace two pushbuttons and a pilot light or the nonilluminated form can replace two pushbuttons. These units are available in three basic types: Maintained (Twoposition). Maintains in the pulled or pushed position until manually actuated to the opposite mode. Momentary (Threeposition). Spring returns to an intermediate position when pulled or pushed and released. Momentary Pull, Maintained Push (Threeposition). Spring returns to intermediate position when pulled. Maintains in pushed position until manually returned to intermediate (ready to reset) position. Maintained stop holds circuit open and will prevent other series connected operators from starting the system. The operators, buttons, contact blocks, etc., are offered as building block components that can be intermixed to satisfy many requirements. This minimizes the need for a varied and costly inventory. Application Guide To assist in the selection of contact blocks, the sketch below shows pictorially by symbols and 2 locations of contact circuits after assembly of contact blocks and adapter to the operator. The table below shows the effect of the push and pull operations on either N or NC contacts. ( = contact closed, = contact open). Locating Nibs Locating Nib T_ Push-Pull perator Components perator Position and Circuit Arrangement ut Pull Intermediate In Push E34G_ Type of perator Two-Position perator without Lens Maintained push-pull Three-Position perator without Lens Momentary push-pull Maintained push-momentary pull Momentary push-pull Contact Block N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2NC N NC 2N 2NC Note Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. Contact Block Mounting Location or or or No intermediate position or or or or or 0250T 0250T5 0250T4 0250T9 0250T0 E34 E34GDB E34GEB E34GFB E34GHB V7-T-326 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

327 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Push-Pull Light Units, Lenses and Buttons NEC Class I Division 2 Groups B, C and D Light Units for Illuminated Push-Pull Devices Light Unit Type Type Voltage LED/Lamp Number LED Full voltage Bayonet 0250T97HL (LEDs not included) Transformer 24 base 0250T89HL AC only 50/60 Hz T63HL T64HL T65HL Incandescent Full voltage AC or DC Resistor AC or DC Transformer AC only 50/60 Hz T82HL T66HL T67HL T68HL 6 # T69H 2 #756 # T70H 24/28 # T79H T83H 20 20MB 0250T80H T8H 24 # T89H T63H T64H T65H T82H T66H T67H T68H Note These units do not include lamps. rder LED separately to match lens color from table on Page V7-T-329. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-327

328 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Standard Side-Lighted (Anodized) Aluminum HD Aluminum with Transparent Center Standard Jumbo Mushroom Head Alternate Lenses for Illuminated Push-Pull Devices Color 0250T Buttons for Non-Illuminated Push-Pull Devices 0250T Color Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light. Anodized aluminum head is not suitable for use with ultraviolet light applications. E34 Standard Red 0250TC47 E34M2 Red (EMERG. STP) 0250TC53 E34M2N8 Green 0250TC48 E34M3 Blue 0250TC49 E34M6 Amber 0250TC50 E34M9 White 0250TC5 E34M5 Clear 0250TC52 E34M0 Side-Lighted Anodized Aluminum Ring Red 0250TC57 Red (EMERG. STP) 0250TC63 Green 0250TC58 Blue 0250TC59 Amber 0250TC64 Yellow 0250TC60 White 0250TC6 Clear 0250TC62 Heavy-Duty Aluminum with Transparent Center Red 0250TC65 Green 0250TC66 Amber 0250TC67 E34 Standard Red 0250TB62 E34C2 Red (EMERG. STP) 0250TB63 E34C2N8 Green 0250TB6 E34C3 Black 0250TB60 E34C Blue 0250TB64 E34C6 Jumbo Mushroom Head (Anodized) Aluminum Red 0250TJ62 E34J2 Red (EMERG. STP) 0250TJ63 E34J2N8 Green 0250TJ6 Black 0250TJ60 Yellow 0250TJ64 V7-T-328 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

329 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Standard LED Lamp LED Selection Voltage Color Voltage Color 6 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED006RN 60 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED060RN suitable for use with range E22LED006N range E22LED060N transformers Yellow E22LED006YN Yellow E22LED060YN Green E22LED006GN Green E22LED060GN Blue E22LED006BN Blue E22LED060BN White E22LED006WN White E22LED060WN 2 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED02RN 20 Vac Red E22LED20RA range E22LED02N range E22LED20A Yellow E22LED02YN Yellow E22LED20YA Green E22LED02GN Green E22LED20GA Blue E22LED02BN Blue E22LED20BA White E22LED02WN White E22LED20WA 24 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED024RN 20 Vdc Red E22LED20RD range E22LED024N range E22LED20D Yellow E22LED024YN Yellow E22LED20YD Green E22LED024GN Green E22LED20GD Blue E22LED024BN Blue E22LED20BD White E22LED024WN White E22LED20WD 48 Vac/Vdc Red E22LED048RN range E22LED048N Yellow E22LED048YN Green E22LED048GN Blue E22LED048BN White E22LED048WN Note For a complete listing of all LEDs available, see Page V7-T-225. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-329

330 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Selector Switch Units UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Two- and three-position Non-illuminated 0250T72_ E34E72_ 0250T_ Two-Position Selector Switch Non-Illuminated perator Position Notes perator Action 2 Contact Type NC N NC N NC N Mounting Location 2 Three-Position Selector Switch Non-Illuminated perator Position perator Contact Mounting Location Action 2 Type 2 M M M M M S S M M S S M M M M M M M M M M S M S M M S S M M S S N N N NC-NC (Series) N Bolded circuit corresponds to - circuit selection. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow ( W ). 3 To order different type or color selector switch, simply substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the table on Page V7-T-33. Example: 0250T722LL. For keyed selector switch, substitute the underlined characters with T_ (cam)+_ (key removal position). Example: 0250T722T3. 4 To order different type or color selector switch, simply substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the Switch and Color Selection table on Page V7-T-33. Example: 0250T726LL. For keyed selector switch, substitute the underlined characters with T_ (cam)+_ (key removal position). Example: 0250T726T3. Cam Code Black Knob Selector Switch T E T722BK E34E722BK 0250T724BK E34E724BK 0250T723BK E34E723BK Cam Code 0250T725BK E34E725BK Black Knob Selector Switch T E T726BK E34E726BK 0250T728BK 0250T730BK 0250T732BK E34E728BK E34E730BK E34E732BK T727BK E34E727BK 0250T729BK 0250T73BK 0250T733BK E34E729BK E34E73BK E34E733BK V7-T-330 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

331 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3, NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Four-position maintained Non-illuminated 0250T743_ E34E743_ Knob Lever Coin Slot 5 Four-Position Selector Switch Non-Illuminated Switch and Color Selection Key perated Selection Key Removal Positions 7 Number of Position Notes perator Action 6 perator Position Color Knob Suffix Code perator Action 2 Lever Suffix Code Contact Type Mounting Location 2 Bolded circuit corresponds to - circuit selection. = closed circuit, = open circuit. 2 M = Maintained. 3 To order different type or color selector switch, simply substitute the underlined characters with appropriate suffix code from the Switch and Color Selection table above. Example: 0250T743LL. For keyed selector switch, substitute the underlined characters with T_ (cam) + _ (key removal position). Example: 0250T743T77. 4 Designed for added ingress protection. For use in maintained operators only T only. 6 M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow ( W ). 7 Key removal in spring return from positions not recommended. M M NC N N NC Lever 4 Suffix Code Black BK BL BA BC Red RK RL RA RC Green GK GL GA GC Yellow YK YL YA YC White WK WL WA WC Gray AK AL AA AC Blue LK LL LA LC range NK NL NA NC Suffix and Removal Position 2 M M T +, 2, 3 M Q S T M M M T3 + 7 S M M T3 +, 4, 5 W S W M Q S T3 + 4 M M S T3 + 2, 4, 6 Q 4 MMMM T7 + 7 L Code Suffix C R Key Removal Position Right only 2 Left only 3 Right and left 4 Center only 6 Left and center 7 All positions M M Coin Slot 5 Suffix Code Cam Code Black Knob Selector Switch T E T743BK E34E743BK Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-33

332 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Selector Switch Selection 0250T Cam and Contact Block Selection Selector switches in their varied forms (two-position, three-position, and fourposition) are a big factor contributing to the great flexibility of control that a well rounded line of pushbuttons can achieve. Because of their flexibility, they tend to cause difficulty with product selection and application. The following systematic approach should simplify that task. Cam and contact block selection is better understood if you: Work with each incoming and outgoing wire/circuit separately. Recognize the terms N and NC only identify the type of contact by its mode before mounting to the operator. The - table (Page V7-T-334) shows how that contact will act after assembly to the operator with the selected cam shape. = closed circuit, = open circuit. E34 ne N-NC contact block may be mounted behind each plunger of the mounting adapter for a total of four circuits. Each cam has two separate lobes, each of which operates one of the two contact block plungers independently of each other. Those are identified as position (locating nib side) and position 2 (opposite of locating nib). The position designations give direction in selecting and mounting of the contact blocks. Contact Circuit Locations Locating Nib 2 Systematic Approach Application: HAND-FF- AUT selector switch. In this circuit, one incoming line is distributed to two other outgoing circuits by the switch. The two circuits can be looked at individually. Step : Elementary Diagram. Construct on paper, or in your mind, a simple elementary diagram of the switching scheme as follows: Incoming Line Step 2: - Pattern. From the elementary diagram, you can construct an - diagram which describes when the contacts are to be closed () or open () in the various positions of the switch. The - for the HAND circuit looks like this: HAND HAND FF AUT FF AUT utgoing Circuit utgoing Circuit In this circuit, you want a contact closed on the left (HAND) but open in the center and right. For the AUT circuit, the - diagram would look like this: HAND FF AUT Putting them together, the complete - diagram is: nce the - diagram has been generated, the next step is to select the cam and contact block, or blocks, needed to perform the desired - functions. The selection tables on the following pages list the various types (shapes) of cams by number to choose from and the type of contact and position to achieve the function outlined in your - diagram. V7-T-332 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

333 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Step 3: Cam Selection. The cam you select determines the operation of all contact blocks mounted to the operator. It is selected on the basis that it provides the simplest circuitry for the desired - diagram. The selection tables show all the - combinations. For the purpose of this example, the applicable portion of those tables is shown on this page. Now to make the cam selection, make a simple worksheet such as below. () or (2) = mounting location from chart above: Cam 2 Cam 3 ()N-(2)NC (2)N It becomes obvious that cam 3 is the better choice because the series connection can be avoided, making it simpler to wire. Step 4: Contact Block Selection. Having selected the cam, contact block selection is simply a matter of determining if you require one N-NC contact block (Cat. No 0250TH) or two. Given the limitations of the factory sealed contact block and the desired - application, you may have circuits that will not be needed as seen here with the two additional NC circuits. () or (2) = mounting location from chart above. ()N (2)N Step 5: Selector Switch perator. Lastly, you have to choose from the many types of operators knob and lever in various colors or keyed. Also what combinations of maintained and spring return functions are required. Selection of these operators can be found on Page V7-T-335. For the example in step 4, you may want a three-position maintained black knob, cam T323 (or 34VHBK). The Complete Switch: 0250T323 (or 34VHBK) with two 0250TH or for one composite catalog number 0250T726BK (or E34E726BK) found on Page V7-T-330. Diagrams Circuits shown illustrate connections to obtain a selector circuit combination and are shown with their appropriate line diagrams in BLD. Field wiring of jumper connections required as shown. = Closed circuit = pen circuit Example Selection Table Desired Circuit and Cam Code #2 Cam Code #3 perator Position Contact Blocks and Contact Blocks and Mounting Location Mounting Location No. 2 2 N NC N 4 Note Wired in series. N N Qty Catalog No. Cam TIH ()N (2)NC ()NC (2)N Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-333

334 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Two-Position Selector Switch Number Desired Circuit and perator Position 2 Cam Code # Contact Blocks and Mounting Location 2 Three-Position Selector Switch Desired Circuit and Cam Code #2 Cam Code #3 perator Position Contact Blocks and Contact Blocks and Mounting Location Mounting Location No. 2 2 N (Series) NC N 2 3 N NC N NC (Parallel) N NC NC N NC N NC N (Parallel) N NC NC (Series) N NC Four-Position Selector Switch Desired Circuit and perator Position Number NC 2 3 N Cam Code #7 Contact Blocks and Mounting Location 2 N NC NC (Parallel) NC N (Parallel) N N (Parallel) NC NC (Parallel) N 9 0 N/NC (Parallel) N/NC (Parallel) V7-T-334 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

335 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Selector Switch perators 0250T Selector Switch perators with Caps UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Black Knob Selector Switch Black Lever Selector Switch Horizontal Mounting Key Removal Positions L C R 0250T Selector Switch perators with Caps Black Knob Selector Switch Black Lever Selector Switch Vertical Mounting 2 Vertical Mounting 2 Positions perator Action Cam Code 3 Cam Code 3 Two-position 60 throw 0250T3 0250T30 M M 0250T Key perators with Cam M S 0250T T307 Three-position 60 throw M T T3022 M M T T3023 M T T3032 S M T T3033 M T T3042 S S T T3043 M T T3052 M S T T3053 Four-position 40 throw M M T T3067 M M Positions perator Action Cam Code 3 Removal Positions 4 ptional Key Vertical Mounting 4 Horizontal Mounting 4 Two-position 60 throw, 2, T5_ 0250T6_ M M M S T57_ 0250T58_ Three-position 60 throw M T522_ 0250T622_ M M T523_ 0250T623_ M 2, 4, T532_ 0250T632_ S M T533_ 0250T633_ M T542_ 0250T642_ S S T543_ 0250T643_ M 2 2, 4, T652_ 0250T662_ M S T653_ 0250T663_ Four-position 40 throw M M T677_ 0250T687_ Key Removal Positions 5 Code Key Removal Code Suffix Position Suffix M M Key Removal Position Replacement Keys or Dissimilar Locks for Above Key perators Listed operators have identical locks and keys (Key Code H66) 0250ED824. Right only 5 Right and center 2 Left only 6 Left and center Replacement Keys 3 Right and left 7 All positions Description 4 Center only Replacement keys (code H66) 0250ED824 Notes M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow ( W ). 2 Field convertible to horizontal mounting or order operator only and separate operator cap. 3 For selection of the proper cam and contact block to obtain the proper circuit sequence, see selection instructions and table on Pages V7-T-332 to V7-T Choose key removal position required for application from table above. Add key removal code no. to listed catalog number. Example: 0250T52. 5 Key removal in spring return from positions not recommended. Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-335

336 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 UL (NEMA) Type 3, 3R, 4, 4, 2, 3 Black Knob Selector Switch E34KFB_ E34 Selector Switch perators with Knob Assembled Black Knob Selector Switch Vertical Mounting 2 Positions perator Action Cam Code 3 4 Two-position 60 throw E34VFBK M M E34 Key perators with Cam and Cap M S E34VEBK Three-position 60 throw M 2 E34VGBK M M 3 E34VHBK M 2 E34VJBK S M 3 E34VKBK M 2 E34VLBK S S 3 E34VMBK M 2 E34VNBK M S 3 E34VPBK Four-position 40 throw M M 7 E34VTBK M M Positions perator Action Cam Code 3 Positions 5 Key Removal Vertical Mounting Horizontal Mounting Two-position 60 throw, 2, 3 E34KFB_ E34KFHB_ M M M S 2 E34KEB_ E34KEHB_ Three-position 60 throw M 2 7 E34KGB_ E34KGHB_ M M 3 E34KHB_ E34KHHB_ M 2, 4, 5 E34KJB_ E34KJHB_ S M 3 E34KKB_ E34KKHB_ S M S 2 4 E34KLB_ E34KLHB_ 3 E34KMB_ E34KMHB_ M 2 2, 4, 6 E34KNB_ E34KNHB_ M S 3 E34KPB_ E34KPHB_ Four-position 40 throw M M 7 7 E34KTB_ E34KTHB_ M M Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Page V7-T-335. M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow ( W ). 2 Field convertible to horizontal mounting. 3 For selection of the proper cam and contact block to obtain the proper circuit sequence, see selection instructions and table on Pages V7-T-332 to V7-T For other colors of either knob or lever, replace the underlined characters of the catalog number with the appropriate suffix code from Alternate Knobs and Levers table on Page V7-T-337. Example: E34VFBL2. 5 Choose key removal position required for application from table on Page V7-T-337. Add key removal code no. to listed catalog number. Example: E34KFB2. V7-T-336 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

337 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34.0 Key Removal Positions L Knob Lever C R Lever for Added Ingress Protection Key Removal Positions Code Suffix Alternate Knobs and Levers for perators Notes Key Removal Position Code Suffix Key Removal Position Right only 5 Right and center 2 Left only 6 Left and center 3 Right and left 7 All positions 4 Center only Color Knob Suffix Code Lever Suffix Code Key removal in spring return from positions not recommended. 2 For use on maintained operators only. Lever Designed for Added Ingress Protection 2 Suffix Code Black K E34K L E34L A E34A Red K2 E34K2 L2 E34L2 A2 E34A2 Green K3 E34K3 L3 E34L3 A3 E34A3 Yellow K4 E34K4 L4 E34L4 A4 E34A4 White K5 E34K5 L5 E34L5 A5 E34A5 Blue K6 E34K6 L6 E34L6 A6 E34A6 Gray K7 E34K7 L7 E34L7 A7 E34A7 range K8 E34K8 L8 E34L8 A8 E34A8 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-337

338 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 Illuminated Selector Switch perators Two-Position Maint. Selector Switch Knob Lever 0250T Illuminated Selector Switch perator nly without Knob or Lever Full Voltage Type AC or DC 4 Transformer Type 50/60 Hz Lamps: 6V #755, 2V #756, 24V #757, 6V #755 Lamp 48V #835, 20/240V 20MB Cam Catalog and Cam Catalog and Position perator Action Code 3 Voltage Code Number 2 Code 3 Voltage Code Number 2 Two-position 60 throw T596H T620H M M T597H T62H T65H T622H T598H T623H T599H T636H T600H T637H T60H Three-position 60 throw M + 2 or T602_H + 2 or T624_H M M T603_H T625_H T652_H T626_H T604_H T627_H T605_H T638_H T607_H T639_H T607_H M + 2 or T620_H + 2 or T622_H M S T656_H Knobs and Levers Knob Catalog and Color 6 Code Number Notes + 2 or T62_H + 2 or T623_H T662_H M + 2 or T64_H + 2 or T628_H S S T65_H T629_H T653_H T630_H T66_H T63_H T67_H T640_H T68_H T64_H T69_H Four-position 40 throw M M T6087H T6327H T6097H T6337H M M T6547H T6347H T607H T6357H T67H T6427H T627H T6437H T637H Lever Catalog and Code Number Color 6 Knob Catalog and Code Number M = Maintained. S = Spring return in direction of arrow ( W ). 2 For selection of the proper cam and contact block, to obtain the proper circuit sequence, see selection table on Page V7-T perator includes lens gasket and lens attachment screws. 4 Full voltage light units can be used at other than listed voltages by changing lamp. Replacement lamps are listed on Page V7-T Resistor type. May generate excess heat if used in high density. 6 Amber, clear and white lenses have a black arrow (pointer), red, green and blue lenses have a white arrow (pointer). Lever Catalog and Code Number Red 0250TER 0250TFR Clear 0250TEC 0250TFC Green 0250TEG 0250TFG White 0250TEW 0250TFW Yellow 0250TEA 0250TFA Amber 0250TEM 0250TFM Blue 0250TEL 0250TFL S M M V7-T-338 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

339 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E Vac Transformer Selector Switch, Cam Knob Lever Illuminated Selector Switch perator nly without Knob or Lever Transformer Type 50/60 Hz Full Voltage Type AC or DC 3 6V #755 Lamp Lamps #755, #757, #835, 20MB 4 Positions perator Action 2 2 Two-position 60 throw Cam Code 5 Cam Code 5 M M E34VFB_H E34SFB_H Three-position 60 throw M Cam Code 2 5 Cam Code 3 5 Cam Code 2 5 Cam Code 3 5 M M E34VGB_H E34VHB_H E34SGB_H E34SHB_H Knobs and Levers Knob Color 9 and Code Number M S S M M M S M S E34VNB_H 6 E34VPB_H 6 E34SNB_H 7 E34SPB_H 7 E34VJB_H 6 E34VKB_H 6 E34SJB_H 7 E34SKB_H 7 E34VLB_H E34VMB_H E34SLB_H E34SMB_H Four-position 40 throw M M E34VRB_H E34SRB_H M M Lever and Code Number Red 0250TER 0250TFR Green 0250TEG 0250TFG Yellow 0250TEA 0250TFA Blue 0250TEL 0250TFL Clear 0250TEC 0250TFC White 0250TEW 0250TFW Amber 0250TEM 0250TFM Light Unit Voltage Suffix Add to operator catalog number listed in table above. Type of Light Unit Transformer Type Full Voltage Type 50/60 Hz AC or DC 3 Voltage Suffix Code Voltage Suffix Code Notes Use NEMA T operators where exposed to ultraviolet light, see Page V7-T-338. perator includes lens gasket and lens attachment screws. 2 Replace underscore with proper voltage suffix code from Light Unit Voltage Suffix table above. Example: three-position maintained with 20V transformer type light unit: E34VGB20H. 3 Full voltage light units can be used at other than listed voltages by changing lamp. Replacement lamps are listed on Page V7-T MB lamps are used on both 20V and 240V operators. 5 For selection of the proper cam and contact block required to obtain a specific circuit sequence, see selection table on Page V7-T and 240V transformer only full voltage only. 8 Resistor type. May generate excess heat if used in high density. 9 Amber, clear and white lenses have a black arrow (pointer). Red, green and blue lenses have a white arrow (pointer). Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April V7-T-339

340 .0 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Hazardous Locations 0250T/E34 ptions Contact Blocks and Mounting Adapters NEC Class I Division 2, Groups B, C and D Contact Block Mounting Adapter Contact Block Description Class I Division 2 factory sealed contact block with N-NC Dimensions, see Page V7-T-345. Mounting Adapter Description Mounting adapter for pushbuttons Mounting adapter for selector switches Dimensions, see Page V7-T-345. Mounting Adapters with Contact Block(s) verpacked Description Pushbutton adapter with N-NC Pushbutton adapter with 2 (N-NC) Selector switch adapter with N-NC Selector switch adapter with 2 (N-NC) 0250TH 0250TD2 0250TD3 0250TD2H 0250TD2HH 0250TD3H 0250TD3HH V7-T-340 Volume 7 Logic Control, perator Interface and Connectivity Solutions CA E April 202

Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights

Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 10250T Pushbuttons.1 Toggle Switches E10 Product Description....................................... Product Selection......................................... Technical Data and Specifications.............................2

More information

Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights

Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 10250T Pushbuttons M22 Modular Pushbuttons.1 Toggle Switches E10 Product Description.......................................... T-2 Product Selection............................................ T-4 Technical

More information

Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights

Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 0250T Pushbuttons. Toggle Switches E0 Product Description....................................... Product Selection......................................... V7-T-2 V7-T-4.2

More information

37.3. Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights. For Immediate Delivery or Tech Support call KMParts.com at (866) Contents. Product Description

37.3. Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights. For Immediate Delivery or Tech Support call KMParts.com at (866) Contents. Product Description .3 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Pushbutton Control Stations Contents Description Page Features.............................. V7-T-15 Product Selection M22 Assembled Control Stations........ V7-T-16

More information

2-Position Cylinder Lock Operator Cat. No. 800T-H33A 800 T H31 A. Protection Rating Description T Metal, Type 4/13

2-Position Cylinder Lock Operator Cat. No. 800T-H33A 800 T H31 A. Protection Rating Description T Metal, Type 4/13 2-Position Selector Switch Devices, Non-Illuminated (Bul. 800T only) 2-Position Cylinder Lock Operator Cat. No. 800T-H33A 800 T H31 A a b c d e a Protection Rating T Metal, Type 4/13 Blank C H31 H32 H33

More information

800 T A 1 A. f (cont'd) d (cont'd) f (cont'd) Momentary Contact Push Button Devices, Non-Illuminated. Rockwell Automation Publication 800-TD009A-EN-P

800 T A 1 A. f (cont'd) d (cont'd) f (cont'd) Momentary Contact Push Button Devices, Non-Illuminated. Rockwell Automation Publication 800-TD009A-EN-P NEM Push Button Specifications 800T/H 30.5 mm Push Buttons Momentary Contact Push Button Devices, Non-Illuminated Flush Head Unit Cat. No. 800T-1 Extended Head Unit Cat. No. 800T-B6 Booted Unit Cat. No.

More information

Push Button & Selector Switch Components. Operator Protective Boots EXPLOSIONPROOF AUXILIARY DEVICES EXPLOSIONPRROOF AUXILIARY DEVICES

Push Button & Selector Switch Components. Operator Protective Boots EXPLOSIONPROOF AUXILIARY DEVICES EXPLOSIONPRROOF AUXILIARY DEVICES Push Button & Selector Switch Components XMB XHDPL Operator locking caps and actuator devices can be adapted to existing explosion proof operators. Simple installation requires removal of top cap and threading

More information

Sensing and Control the Interactive Catalog.

Sensing and Control the Interactive Catalog. Interactive Catalog Supplements Catalog PDFs If you need detailed product information, or help choosing the right product for your application, see our Interactive Catalog Use the Interactive Catalog to

More information

MICRO SWITCH Military-Grade Toggle Switches. TL Series. Datasheet

MICRO SWITCH Military-Grade Toggle Switches. TL Series. Datasheet MICRO SWITCH -Grade Toggle Switches TL Series Datasheet MICRO SWITCH TL Series Toggle Switches Honeywell MICRO SWITCH TL Series toggle switches are military qualified to MIL-DTL-3950, specifications for

More information

877-ETNCARE Press. Press. Press. Press. Press. Customer Segments. General Support. EatonCare Technical Resource Center

877-ETNCARE Press. Press. Press. Press. Press. Customer Segments. General Support. EatonCare Technical Resource Center 877-ETNCARE 877-386-2273 General Support Customer Segments EatonCare Support: Component Order & Component Returns EatonCare Technical Resource Center EatonCare OEM EatonCare Project Order Support EatonCare

More information

Series Panel Mounted Control Devices

Series Panel Mounted Control Devices E_Master2012.qxd:NEW_E_Master_temp.qxd 1/27/12 4:28 PM Page 1 Series Features: Suitable for hazardous and corrosive locations. Installation is easy and precise. Devices fit into a standard 30.5mm, 1.2"

More information

DS185 1G FS Box Switch Cover. Features. Description. Manufacturer Information EATON CROUSE-HINDS SERIES GTIN

DS185 1G FS Box Switch Cover. Features. Description. Manufacturer Information EATON CROUSE-HINDS SERIES GTIN 3804 South Street 75964-7263, TX Nacogdoches Phone: 936-569-7941 Fax: 936-560-4685 DS185 1G FS Box Switch Cover Cooper Crouse-Hinds Catalog Number Manufacturer Description Weight per unit Product Category

More information

January 2001 Vol. 2, Ref. No. [0880] 10250T/E34 Series, Assembled Devices Momentary Pushbutton Units

January 2001 Vol. 2, Ref. No. [0880] 10250T/E34 Series, Assembled Devices Momentary Pushbutton Units 47 2in Cutler-Hammer Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights 30.5 mm Class I Division 2 Watertight/Oiltight Vol. 2, Ref. No. [0880] / Series, Assembled Devices Momentary Pushbutton Units Flush Button 706B Extended

More information

Product Description. Selector Switches

Product Description. Selector Switches -100 F SS Vol. 2, Ref. No. [0770] Contents Description Page Product Description......... -100 Features................... -100 Standards and Certifications............. -100 Technical Data..............

More information

Pushbutton and selector switch series Quality touch!

Pushbutton and selector switch series Quality touch! Pushbutton and selector switch series Quality touch! For Info: sales@switchesunlimited.com www.switchesunlimited.com Phone: 00-1-07 Fax: 71-7-70 Pushbuttons and selector switches Ømm Quality touch! mm

More information

SERIES FEATURE MAX RATING MECHANICAL LIFE APPROVALS CIRCUITRY. B1 Ultra Small 2A 100,000 N/A SPST, SPDT

SERIES FEATURE MAX RATING MECHANICAL LIFE APPROVALS CIRCUITRY. B1 Ultra Small 2A 100,000 N/A SPST, SPDT SWITCH SELECTION GUIDE Basic Switches SERIES FEATURE MAX RATING MECHANICAL LIFE APPROVALS CIRCUITRY (Resistive) B1 Ultra Small 2A 100,000 N/A SPST, SPDT B1-5 Levers 2A 1,000,000 N/A SPST, SPDT B2 Subminiature

More information

Specifications. Description TABLE OF CONTENTS. Page. Description 2. Specifications 2 3. Additional Options 3. How to Order 4 5

Specifications. Description TABLE OF CONTENTS. Page. Description 2. Specifications 2 3. Additional Options 3. How to Order 4 5 TABLE OF CTENTS Page Description Specifications Additional Options How to Order Circuit Descriptions Dimensions 0 Icons into the body of the switch; mounting hardware or special tools are not necessary.

More information

page 28 page 30 page 30 page 31

page 28 page 30 page 30 page 31 25 Gardner Bender switches are available in many different styles and sizes. They are used in countless applications, from basic on-off to multifunction applications. page 28 page 30 page 30 page 31 _Section_0512.indd

More information

PENDANT PUSHBUTTON STATIONS

PENDANT PUSHBUTTON STATIONS SBP2 PENDANT PUSH STATIONS SBP2 PENDANT PUSH STATIONS THE LIGHTWEIGHT PENDANT STATION FOR HEAVYWEIGHT APPLICATIONS COMPLETE PENDANT STATIONS 2, 4, 6, 8, 10, or 12 button configurations 1, 2, or 3 speed

More information

MICRO SWITCH Military-Grade Toggle Switches TL Series Issue 4. Datasheet FEATURES POTENTIAL APPLICATIONS DESCRIPTION DIFFERENTIATION PORTFOLIO

MICRO SWITCH Military-Grade Toggle Switches TL Series Issue 4. Datasheet FEATURES POTENTIAL APPLICATIONS DESCRIPTION DIFFERENTIATION PORTFOLIO MICRO SWITCH -Grade Toggle Switches TL Series 00530 Issue Datasheet FEATURES MIL-DTL-3950 qualified 1-, -, and -pole options - and 3-position, maintained and momentary Wide temperature range: -65 C to

More information

22mm Non Illuminated Metal Operators

22mm Non Illuminated Metal Operators 22mm 22mm Non Illuminated Metal Operators Altech Corp. can provide other push button and actuator options. If your requirement calls for a 22 mm operator which is not shown, please do not hesitate to call.

More information

Limit Switches E47 Precision Switches

Limit Switches E47 Precision Switches June 09 E7 Precision Switches PG.0C.0.T.E 1 E7 Precision The Cost-Effective Solution for Highly Accurate Switching Applications Contents Overview...................... 1 Model Selection, Basic Switches................

More information

Indicator, round, raised, full face with plastic matt chrome bezel, 22.5 mm mounting, lamp block included. Yellow Green

Indicator, round, raised, full face with plastic matt chrome bezel, 22.5 mm mounting, lamp block included. Yellow Green 22.5 mm 3.5 mm IP65 1 A 66 VAC Choose one component from each of the coloured sections to assemble a complete switch. For other options or further information please contact your local sales office. INDICATOR

More information

Model 720 Electromechanical Hour Meter

Model 720 Electromechanical Hour Meter Model 720 Electromechanical Hour Meter A 5 figure (reset) or 6 figure (non-reset), AC hour meter encased in a rugged steel housing and designed to mil-spec environmental requirements. The non-reset models

More information

Sensor Accessories Retroreflectors and Retroreflective Tape Sensor Mounting Brackets Sensor Accessories. 52.

Sensor Accessories Retroreflectors and Retroreflective Tape Sensor Mounting Brackets Sensor Accessories. 52. Retroreflectors Sensor Accessory AC Sensor Tester/Demonstrator Pilot Device E65 Control Unit.1 Retroreflectors and Retroreflective Tape Product............................................. 414 Application..........................................

More information

V-Series. Contura Rotary Switch

V-Series. Contura Rotary Switch V-Series Contura Rotary Switch The V-Series Contura Rotary Switch was designed for maximum performance and reliability leveraging the features of the widely popular V-series Contura Rocker Switches. Available

More information

Distinctive Characteristics

Distinctive Characteristics Distinctive Characteristics Low Profile Pushbuttons Series UB Bright, full face, or spot illumination with red, amber, or green single-element LEDs (an integral part of the switch), plus square or rectangular

More information

N2S and N2SC Series Control Stations

N2S and N2SC Series Control Stations NEMA, 4X, 7BCD (Div. 2), 2 Applications: N2S and N2SC pushbutton stations, selector switches and pilot lights are suitable for use: In Class I, Groups B, C, D; Division 2 hazardous areas where flammable

More information

MICRO SWITCH Commercial-Grade Toggle Switches. NT Series. Datasheet

MICRO SWITCH Commercial-Grade Toggle Switches. NT Series. Datasheet MICRO SWITCH Commercial-Grade Toggle Switches NT Series Datasheet MICRO SWITCH NT Series Commercial-Grade Toggle Switches Honeywell MICRO SWITCH NT Series toggle switches meet the need for a rugged, cost-effective

More information

M C. Ex d M-0... control, monitoring and signalling devices

M C. Ex d M-0... control, monitoring and signalling devices Ex d M-0... control, monitoring and signalling devices M-0 M-0 series control, monitoring and signalling devices are installed as external accessories on Cortem 'Ex d' enclosures used in any industrial

More information

Crane Control Contactors and Relays

Crane Control Contactors and Relays October 8 DC Relays Type KC Heavy-Duty Mill 75 Contact Conversion The fully visible contacts have NEMA ICS--5 heavy-duty interrupting ratings and are easily converted in the field using just a screwdriver

More information

Products :: Circuit Protection :: Hydraulic/Magnetic Circuit Breakers

Products :: Circuit Protection :: Hydraulic/Magnetic Circuit Breakers Products :: Circuit Protection :: Hydraulic/Magnetic Circuit Breakers Miniature Hydraulic/Magnetic Circuit Breaker M-Series M-Series PDF elibrary The M-Series miniature hydraulic/magnetic circuit breakers

More information

Push buttons and selectors

Push buttons and selectors Accessories and spare parts 8 LM2T A130 8 LM2T A140 8 LM2T A185 8 LM2T AL... Order code Description Qty per Wt 8 LM2T A12❶ Coloured diffuser for 10 0.001 double touch buttons 8 LM2T A130 Threaded plug

More information

Single Pole Circuit Breakers 83 Multi-Pole Circuit Breakers 84 APGHX/UPGHX Breakers 86 APGX/UPGX Breakers 87 APGN/UPGN Breakers 88 APG/UPG Handles

Single Pole Circuit Breakers 83 Multi-Pole Circuit Breakers 84 APGHX/UPGHX Breakers 86 APGX/UPGX Breakers 87 APGN/UPGN Breakers 88 APG/UPG Handles Single Pole Circuit Breakers 83 Multi-Pole Circuit Breakers 84 APGHX/UPGHX Breakers 86 APGX/UPGX Breakers 87 APGN/UPGN Breakers 88 APG/UPG Handles and Actuators 89 IPG Breakers 90 Configurations 9 Operating

More information

Push Buttons and Operator Interface New Product Catalog XAL Control Stations

Push Buttons and Operator Interface New Product Catalog XAL Control Stations Push Buttons and Operator Interface New Product Catalog XAL Control Stations CONTENTS Description.................................................... Page General Information................................................104

More information

Contents Rockers. A Series... B4 Process Sealed 0.4VA Logic Level Straight, Right Angle, & Vertical PC

Contents Rockers. A Series... B4 Process Sealed 0.4VA Logic Level Straight, Right Angle, & Vertical PC Contents Rockers Toggles Rockers Supplement Accessories Indicators Touch Tilt Tactiles Slides Rotaries Keylocks Programmable Illuminated P Pushbuttons A Series... 4 Process Sealed 0.4VA Logic Level Straight,

More information

877-ETNCARE Press. Press. Press. Press. Press. Customer Segments. General Support. EatonCare Technical Resource Center

877-ETNCARE Press. Press. Press. Press. Press. Customer Segments. General Support. EatonCare Technical Resource Center 877-ETNCARE 877-386-2273 General Support Customer Segments EatonCare Support: Component Order & Component Returns EatonCare Technical Resource Center EatonCare OEM EatonCare Project Order Support EatonCare

More information

APG/UPG/IPG Series Existing Designs Only APG/UPG/IPG

APG/UPG/IPG Series Existing Designs Only APG/UPG/IPG APG/UPG/IPG Series Existing Designs Only APG/UPG/IPG APG/UPG/IPG Series Hydraulic Magnetic Circuit Protectors INTRODUCTION IMPORTANT NOTICE: The APG/UPG is a legacy product and no new design-in orders

More information

Machine Safety. Products

Machine Safety. Products January 23 Vol. 2, Ref. No. [1263] -1 Machine Safety Products Contents Description Page............................................. -2 Key Interlock Switches DIN Models.............................. -9

More information

Switches and Indicators.

Switches and Indicators. E1 Switches and Indicators Switches and Indicators Series Description Product Assembly Product Range - pushbutton for standard mounting - accessories / spare parts Technical Data Technical Drawing /Dimension

More information

Automation Products. Pilot devices The complete range

Automation Products. Pilot devices The complete range Automation Products Pilot devices The complete range Pilot devices Contents Presentation of the complete range 2 The whole range 4 Modular range, 22 mm General description 7 Pushbuttons, type MP, MPD 10

More information

Control Units Ex e in Stainless Steel LCS*.*

Control Units Ex e in Stainless Steel LCS*.* Features Assembly Stainless steel enclosures Suitable for operation in Zones 1, 2, 21 and 22 Certified Ex de and Ex tb Up to 4 operators per control unit, base-mounted contact blocks Wide choice of operators,

More information

Photoelectric Sensors 20 Series

Photoelectric Sensors 20 Series PG.05E.22.T.E Extremely Rugged Construction, Long Sensing Ranges and High Current Switching Contents Overview........................ Model Selection, Sensors......... 2 Model Selection, Output Devices..................

More information

AllPro Hazardous/Corrosive Area Fluorescent

AllPro Hazardous/Corrosive Area Fluorescent CSA - Class I Div. 2 - Groups A, B, C, & D CSA - Class I Zone 2 - Groups IIA, IIB & IIC CSA - Class II Div. 1 & 2 - Groups E, F & G CSA - 4X UL 844 - Class I Div. 2 - Groups A, B, C, & D UL 4X UL - Outdoor

More information

Enclosed Non-Reversing Combination Controller, AC Operation - Type 1/12K/IP66 ➏➐ (KS7-C0C4R) Discount Schedule F-1

Enclosed Non-Reversing Combination Controller, AC Operation - Type 1/12K/IP66 ➏➐ (KS7-C0C4R) Discount Schedule F-1 KWIKstarter/CX7 CX7 Non-Reversing Combination Controller, AC Enclosed Non-Reversing Combination Controller, AC Operation - Type 1/12K/IP66 ➏➐ ~ ~ ~ ~ 0.10 0.16 2.1 1 CX7-9-10- -AS0.16A-A10-PG 551 Q4 ~

More information

Push Button Switches. 186 Switches. Miniature, round and rectangular push button switches available

Push Button Switches. 186 Switches. Miniature, round and rectangular push button switches available Push utton Switches ulgin s broad line of pushbutton switches are available in various sizes and configurations. This includes a variety of illumination and terminal options as well as several with high

More information

Enclosed Non-Reversing Combination Controller, AC Operation - Type 1/12K/IP66 ➏➐. Non-Metallic Type 1/12K/IP66 Enclosure (KS7-C0C4R)

Enclosed Non-Reversing Combination Controller, AC Operation - Type 1/12K/IP66 ➏➐. Non-Metallic Type 1/12K/IP66 Enclosure (KS7-C0C4R) KWIKstarter/CX7 CX7 Non-Reversing Combination Controller, AC Enclosed Non-Reversing Combination Controller, AC Operation - Type 1/12K/IP66 ➏➐ Catalog Number ➍➏➑➒ ~ ~ ~ ~ 0.10 0.16 2.1 1 CX7-9-10- -AS0.16A-A10-PG

More information

Quality touch! Pushbuttons and selector switches. series

Quality touch! Pushbuttons and selector switches. series Quality touch! Pushbuttons and selector switches series Pushbuttons and selector switches Ø22mm Quality touch! QUICK AND EASY ACTUATOR INSTALLATION Click! Click! - Actuator fixing on the mounting surface,

More information

Selection guide - Section B1 «I» range

Selection guide - Section B1 «I» range Selection guide - Section «I» range Series IC IL IM IP IB-IS IHS IHL IQ mom. & latching hall effect hall effect momentary Page -2-6 -11-15 -25-29 -32-35 Poles 1 1 1 1 1 1 NPN 1 1 Maximum current 5A 28VDC

More information

General Specifications

General Specifications Series M00 Tipped Toggles Toggles Supplement ccessories Indicators Touch Tilt Tactiles Slides Rotaries Keylocks Programmable Illuminated P Pushbuttons Rockers General Specifications Electrical Capacity

More information

Brasch Washdown Unit Heaters

Brasch Washdown Unit Heaters Brasch Washdown Unit Heaters Standard Features: Up to 48 KW Up to 400 Volts Disconnect switch with enclosure interlock Heavy-duty 304 stainless steel shroud Nema 4x non-metallic control panel 24-volt

More information

General Specifications

General Specifications Series M00 Tipped Toggles Toggles Supplement ccessories Indicators Touch Tilt Tactiles Slides Rotaries Keylocks Programmable Illuminated P Pushbuttons Rockers General Specifications Electrical Capacity

More information

ALLEN BRADLEY RELAY Bulletin 700-HF

ALLEN BRADLEY RELAY Bulletin 700-HF ALLEN BRADLEY RELAY Bulletin 700-HF Contact Rating DPDT, 3PDT, 4PDT Plug-in Quick Connect Solder Terminals Options: LED, Push-to-Test Operator DEMENSIONS: Bulletin 700-HF Relay (DPDT) Bulletin 700-HF (3PDT)

More information

Medium Capacity Standard Size Toggles Series S

Medium Capacity Standard Size Toggles Series S GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS FOR S ~ S9 (Resistive & Inductive Load) Power Level: Shown in the following tables Other Ratings Contact Resistance: Insulation Resistance: Dielectric Strength: Mechanical Life:

More information

Contents. Volume 8 Sensing Solutions CA E February

Contents. Volume 8 Sensing Solutions CA E February Limit Switches.2 Product Description The E47 Compact Prewired Limit Switch by Eaton s electrical sector is designed to be a versatile, slim device for hard to fit applications where sealing integrity is

More information

Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights. Protection Type IP66 NEMA 4X, 13

Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights. Protection Type IP66 NEMA 4X, 13 .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Product Description Eaton s M22 double pushbutton line is perfect for applications such as motor and pump starting, as well as anytime space is limited. In addition

More information

Magnetic Circuit Protectors 153. Multi-Pole Circuit Protectors 154. APL/UPL, 205/295 Barriers 155. Configurations 156. Operating Characteristics 158

Magnetic Circuit Protectors 153. Multi-Pole Circuit Protectors 154. APL/UPL, 205/295 Barriers 155. Configurations 156. Operating Characteristics 158 Magnetic Circuit Protectors 53 Multi-Pole Circuit Protectors 54 APL/UPL, 205/295 Barriers 55 Configurations 56 Operating Characteristics 58 Delay Curves 59 Specifications 64 APL/UPL Decision Tables 70

More information

PERCENT OF RATED CURRENT

PERCENT OF RATED CURRENT A-D Series Time Delay Values PERCENT OF RATED CURRENT NOTES: UL489 C-Series Breakers available with Delay Curves 11, 12, 14, 16, 21, 22, 24, 26, 42, 44, 46. Delay Curves 11,12,14,16,21,22,24,26,42,44,46,52,54,56:

More information

EJB Junction Boxes Dimensions Pg. 132

EJB Junction Boxes Dimensions Pg. 132 6F EJB Junction Boxes Dimensions Pg. 132 Application: EJB junction boxes are used in threaded rigid conduit systems in hazardous areas: As a junction or pull box To provide enclosures for splices and branch

More information

Power-Over-Ethernet (PoE) Weatherproof 14 x12 x7 Enclosure with Mounting Plate and Cooling Fan. Model: NB F. Applications and Features

Power-Over-Ethernet (PoE) Weatherproof 14 x12 x7 Enclosure with Mounting Plate and Cooling Fan. Model: NB F. Applications and Features Power-Over-Ethernet (PoE) Weatherproof 14 x12 x7 Mounting Plate and Cooling Fan Model: NB141207-40F Applications and Features Applications: Remote Wireless LAN WiFi equipment installations using Power-Over-

More information

C-Series. Circuit Breaker

C-Series. Circuit Breaker C-Series Circuit Breaker The C-Series hydraulic/magnetic circuit breakers are ideal for applications that require higher amperage and voltage handling capability in a smaller package. They are available

More information

Push-Pull and E-Stop Switches. Datasheet

Push-Pull and E-Stop Switches. Datasheet Push-Pull and E-Stop Switches Datasheet Honeywell Push-pull and E-stop switches are durable, environmentally sealed, sliding contact switches incorporating two circuits with multiple combinations. The

More information

Push Button Switches. Switches 163. Miniature, round and rectangular push button switches available

Push Button Switches. Switches 163. Miniature, round and rectangular push button switches available Push utton Switches ulgin s broad line of pushbutton switches are available in various sizes and configurations. This includes a variety of illumination and terminal options as well as several with high

More information

Products :: Circuit Protection :: Hydraulic/Magnetic Circuit Breakers

Products :: Circuit Protection :: Hydraulic/Magnetic Circuit Breakers Products :: Circuit Protection :: Hydraulic/Magnetic Circuit Breakers Hydraulic/Magnetic Circuit Breaker B-Series B-Series PDF elibrary The B-Series hydraulic/magnetic circuit breakers are compact and

More information

1.4. Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights. Product Overview

1.4. Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights. Product Overview Contents Product Overview Product Description The RMQ-6 pushbutton line offers a wide array of functional and attractively designed illuminated and non-illuminated pushbuttons, selector switches, emergency

More information

Distinctive Characteristics

Distinctive Characteristics Distinctive Characteristics Industry s first molded rocker with TV rating. Designed to handle large inrush current. JWM models certified for TV-5 rating and JWL models for TV-8 rating. Special 5A @ 7V

More information

Versatile Safety Interlock Switch with Guard Door Locking

Versatile Safety Interlock Switch with Guard Door Locking R Conforms to EN1088, EN60947-5-1, EN292, EN60204-1 UL and C-UL listed, BG approved Versatile Safety Interlock Switch with Guard Door Locking High locking force of 450 pounds locks guard door shut until

More information

APL/UPL, 205/295 Series Magnetic Circuit Protectors

APL/UPL, 205/295 Series Magnetic Circuit Protectors APL/UPL, 205/295 APL/UPL, 205/295 Series Magnetic Circuit Protectors Introduction 68 Single & Multi-Pole 69 Barriers 7 Configurations 72 Operating Characteristics 74 Delay Curves 75 Specifications 80 Decision

More information

Distinctive Characteristics

Distinctive Characteristics Distinctive Characteristics Full face, bright LED illumination in choice of red, green, and amber for visible status indication. 9-amp or 6-amp electrical capacity in compact body. Interior shield prevents

More information

DUCT-O-WIRE. Enclosed Pendant Push Button Stations CAUTION

DUCT-O-WIRE. Enclosed Pendant Push Button Stations CAUTION DUCT-O-WIRE Enclosed Pendant Push Button Stations Switches and Accessories Cables and Cable Assemblies has the most complete line of pendant stations in the industry. We offer a variety of pendants ranging

More information

Inductive Proximity Sensors E51 Limit Switch Style, Modular

Inductive Proximity Sensors E51 Limit Switch Style, Modular September 2009 1 E51 Modular Limit Switch Style This Rugged Sensor Family Features Modular Components for Versatile Sensing Contents Overview...................... 1 Assembled Sensors............ 2 Sensor

More information

Power-Over-Ethernet Weatherproof 18" x 16" x 8" Enclosure with Equipment Mounting Plate and Cooling Fans

Power-Over-Ethernet Weatherproof 18 x 16 x 8 Enclosure with Equipment Mounting Plate and Cooling Fans Power-Over-Ethernet Weatherproof 18" x 16" x 8" Equipment Mounting Plate and Cooling Fans Applications and Features Applications: Remote Wireless LAN WiFi equipment installations using Power- Over-Ethernet

More information

Contender LED Luminaires Enclosed and Gasketed Fixtures

Contender LED Luminaires Enclosed and Gasketed Fixtures Class I, Division, Groups A,B,C,D Class I, Zone, Group IIC Class II, Division, Groups E,F,G Zone and, Group IIIC Class II, Division, Groups F,G Type R, 4, 4X Applications Enclosed and gasketed fixtures

More information

TS series Proportional Hall effect thumbsticks

TS series Proportional Hall effect thumbsticks Distinctive features and specifications 1 or 2 axis Pushbutton handle option Non-contact Hall effect technology Submersible to 1m (3.28ft) per IP68 Threaded metal housing option Redundant outputs available

More information

Cat. No. 800B-EPA 800B-EPB 800B-EPC 800B-EPD. Cat. No. 800B-ALB4. Cat. No.

Cat. No. 800B-EPA 800B-EPB 800B-EPC 800B-EPD. Cat. No. 800B-ALB4. Cat. No. Bulletin B mm Push Buttons Product Overview/Specifications Bulletin B mm Push Buttons Designed to worldwide standards (UL, CSA, CE, and CCC) Durable materials Operators are made of corrosion-proof plastic

More information

Devices raised mounting

Devices raised mounting Devices raised mounting Illuminated actuator pushbutton Front protection Switching system Ø 29 mm Contacts Typ-Nr. e Illuminated actuator pushbutton IP 67 LL 1 NC - MA UT 14-476.36 1 4 17 12.15 M UT 14-436.36

More information

M-Line Series MN Multi-Pin Plugs and Receptacles Vac, Vdc

M-Line Series MN Multi-Pin Plugs and Receptacles Vac, Vdc Applications Designed for the roughest industrial applications, providing reliable, rugged service for power, control and instrumentation. For use in the roughest industrial applications, ranging from:

More information

ORDER GUIDES WITH STEEL ROD ACTUATORS WITH HIGH STRENGTH THERMOPLASTIC ROD ACTUATORS*

ORDER GUIDES WITH STEEL ROD ACTUATORS WITH HIGH STRENGTH THERMOPLASTIC ROD ACTUATORS* For application help: call 1-800-537-6945. Honeywell MICRO SWITCH Sensing and Control 89 Style 1 Style 2 Style 3 Style 4 Style 5 Style 6 Style 7 Style 8 Automatically cut power when service door or drawer

More information

General Specifications

General Specifications Series CW Miniature Power Rockers Touch Tilt Rockers Toggles Slides Rotaries Programmable Illuminated P Pushbuttons Supplement ccessories Indicators Tactiles Keylocks General Specifications CWS CWS CWT

More information

Control Buttons / Switches for Panel Mounting Series 8003

Control Buttons / Switches for Panel Mounting Series 8003 www.stahl.de > Different actuators pushbutton mushroom pushbutton mushroom stay-put button mushroom stay-put button with key lock key-operated button key-operated switch selector switch > 2 contact elements

More information

16 Mm. Bulletin 800B 16 mm Push Buttons. Features. Operator Assembly Sequence. Push Button & Pilot Light Operators. Build a Catalog Number

16 Mm. Bulletin 800B 16 mm Push Buttons. Features. Operator Assembly Sequence. Push Button & Pilot Light Operators. Build a Catalog Number 16 Mm Bulletin 800B 16 mm Push Buttons Build a Catalog Number Features Designed to worldwide standards (UL, CSA, CE, and CCC) Durable materials Operators are made of corrosion-proof plastic to ensure long

More information

Switch rated plugs and receptacles with NEMA 4X protection

Switch rated plugs and receptacles with NEMA 4X protection DSN Features and Ratings p. 22 DSN20 p. 23 DSN30 p. 25 DSN60 p. 27 Spare parts p. 29 Dimensions p. 31 21 Switch rated plugs and receptacles with NEMA 4X protection DSN Series products are switch and hp

More information

Crane Control Class 9004

Crane Control Class 9004 Catalog 17 CONTENTS Description.....................................................Page Pricing and Ordering Information...................................... 140 Dimensions and Weights............................................

More information

Standard Size Rotaries Series HS TS PS

Standard Size Rotaries Series HS TS PS Standard Size Rotaries Series HS TS PS GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS Electrical Capacity Resistive Load: Other Ratings Contact Resistance: Insulation Resistance: Dielectric Strength: Mechanical Life: Electrical

More information

Linear Luminaire with LED Series 6012/5

Linear Luminaire with LED Series 6012/5 > For use in Zones 1 & 2, 21 & 22 > Latest LED technology with a high luminous efficacy and a long service life > Extra flat version for low mounting depth > Powder-coated sheet-steel or brushed stainless

More information

C-Series. Circuit Breaker

C-Series. Circuit Breaker C-Series Circuit Breaker The C-Series hydraulic/magnetic circuit breakers are ideal for applications that require higher amperage and voltage handling capability in a smaller package. They are available

More information

INDICATOR LIGHTS SECTION R INDICATOR LIGHTS. Rectangular Indicator Lights. Round AC LED Indicator Lights. Large Format Indicator Lights

INDICATOR LIGHTS SECTION R INDICATOR LIGHTS. Rectangular Indicator Lights. Round AC LED Indicator Lights. Large Format Indicator Lights SECTION R Rectangular Indicator Lights Round Indicator Lights Large Format Indicator Lights Round DC LED Indicator Lights Round AC LED Indicator Lights Flashing Series LED Lights R3 R4 - R6 R7 R8 - R10

More information

7511 / / / 711 / / 731 / Preset 27

7511 / / / 711 / / 731 / Preset 27 22 Timers Timers Electronic 23 7511 / 3410 23 6320 / 720-6300 24 ElectRo-MeCH 25 710 / 711 / 720 25 722 / 731 / 732 26 Preset 27 7932 27 Electronic 23 7511 Series 8 digit self powered LCD electronic timer

More information

SEALED, ILLUMINATED ROCKER SWITCHES

SEALED, ILLUMINATED ROCKER SWITCHES K1/K2 The K series rockers are rugged, high performance sealed switches designed for use under severe conditions found in marine, appliance, heavy equipment and industrial control applications. They are

More information

1.5. Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights. Contents Description Selector Switches Illuminated Switches... Selector Switches

1.5. Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights. Contents Description Selector Switches Illuminated Switches... Selector Switches .5 Pushbuttons and Indicating Lights Selector Switches Contents Description Selector Switches Non-Illuminated Switches................. Illuminated Switches.................... Key Operated..........................

More information

For full product information, visit Use the SpeedSpec Code or scan the QR Code for quick access to the specific web page.

For full product information, visit  Use the SpeedSpec Code or scan the QR Code for quick access to the specific web page. R Safety Interlock Switches TL8012-S TL8012 For full product information, visit www.sti.com. Use the SpeedSpec Code or scan the QR Code for quick access to the specific web page. Versatile Safety Interlock

More information

80 Series Push Button Pendant Features

80 Series Push Button Pendant Features 80 Series Push utton Pendant Features he Conductix-Wampfler 80 Series Push utton Pendants are available with a wide variety of switch types, options, and accessories for easy customization. You can get

More information

Bulletin 800Z Zero-Force Touch Buttons

Bulletin 800Z Zero-Force Touch Buttons Bulletin 800Z Zero-Force Touch Buttons IEC and NEMA Style General Purpose Range Heavy Industrial Range Protection Class 4/4X/3 and 4/3 IP66 Internationally Rated Ergonomically Designed Touch Buttons Table

More information

SEALED, ILLUMINATED ROCKER SWITCHES

SEALED, ILLUMINATED ROCKER SWITCHES K1/K2 LOW COST, ROCKER FOR WET AND DUSTY ENVIRONMENTS; 1 AND 2 POLES The K series rockers are rugged, high performance sealed switches designed for use under severe conditions found in marine, appliance,

More information

ZB5AD39 ZB5ZB5AD39. Product data sheet Characteristics. black selector switch head Ø22 3-position stay put. Main. Complementary.

ZB5AD39 ZB5ZB5AD39. Product data sheet Characteristics. black selector switch head Ø22 3-position stay put. Main. Complementary. Characteristics black selector switch head Ø22 3-position stay put Main Range of product Product or component type Device short name Bezel material Mounting diameter Head type Sale per indivisible quantity

More information

PERFORMANCE SPECFICATION SWITCH, PUSH BUTTON, ILLUMINATED GENERAL SPECIFICATION FOR

PERFORMANCE SPECFICATION SWITCH, PUSH BUTTON, ILLUMINATED GENERAL SPECIFICATION FOR INCH-POUND 21 January 2005 PERFORMANCE SPECFICATION SWITCH, PUSH BUTTON, ILLUMINATED GENERAL SPECIFICATION FOR This supplement forms a part of, dated 21 January 2005. SPECIFICATION SHEETS * MIL-S-22885/1H

More information

Sealed Rocker Switches V-Series: Contura IV & V

Sealed Rocker Switches V-Series: Contura IV & V Sealed Rocker Switches V-Series: Contura IV & V The V-Series Contura IV & V snap-in rocker switches offer countless unique options including choices for ratings, circuits, colors, illuminations and symbols.

More information

Switches and Indicators 84

Switches and Indicators 84 Switches and Indicators 84 84 Switches and Indicators Index Series 84 Description Page 177 Product Assembly Page 178 Mounting Instruction Page 179 Product Range - pushbuttons for flush mounting - accessories

More information

Power-Over-Ethernet (PoE) Weatherproof 14 x12 x7 Enclosure with Mounting Plate. Model: NB Applications and Features

Power-Over-Ethernet (PoE) Weatherproof 14 x12 x7 Enclosure with Mounting Plate. Model: NB Applications and Features Power-Over-Ethernet (PoE) Weatherproof 14 x12 x7 Mounting Plate Model: NB141207-400 Applications and Features Applications: Remote Wireless LAN WiFi equipment installations using Power- Over-Ethernet Indoor

More information

Oiltight Switches & Pilot Devices

Oiltight Switches & Pilot Devices ø22mm - TW Series Accessories TW Series Accessories Appearance Description/Usage Part Number Lamp Removal Tool Rubber tool used to install or remove LED s and incandescent lamps OR-55 Contact Block Remover

More information